Volume I PDF
Volume I PDF
Volume I PDF
VOLUME - I
Editors
Alok Tripathy
D.B. Ramesh
A. K. Sahu
S.K. Biswal
B. Das
P.S.R. Reddy
B.K. Mishra
Jointly Organized by
CSIR-Institute of Minerals and Materials Technology
Bhubaneswar
&
Indian Institute of Mineral Engineers
MPT-2013
Theme of MPT-2013
ISBN 978-81-928552-0-2
Foreword
The XIII International Seminar on Mineral Processing Technology (MPT) is being organized at CSIR-
Institute of Minerals and Materials Technology, Bhubaneswar during 10-12 December 2013. We
are indeed honoured to host this prestigious seminar on the occasion of our Golden Jubilee year.
The theme of the seminar “Minerals to Metal for Sustainable Development (Minmet)” has been
selected to address the current challenges like land, water, and energy faced by mineral based
industries. There are also challenges with respect to sustainability. The International Seminar is
the best platform for mineral processing professionals to deliberate on such challenges.
This year MPT is jointly organized by CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar and IIME Bhubaneswar Chap-
ter with the sponsorship of Essar Steel, Longi Magnet Ltd., JSPL, Tata Steel, Triveni Earthmovers
Pvt. Ltd., Bhushan Power & Steel Ltd., Adhunik Group, Chandan Steel, Mineral Technologies,
Westech, Trimex Group, Gallant, allmineral Gmbh, Vedanta Group, BRPL and many Gold and
Silver sponsors. Altogether 268 abstracts have been received from the all over the world apart
from 9 plenary lectures and 30 invited talks by eminent persons. About 30 technical sessions
have been planned and out of this 4 technical sessions are set aside exclusively for the student
participants. The Technical Committee has reviewed the papers and made suitable format to
publish the full paper in the seminar proceeding.
I am grateful to the members of the International Advisory Committee, National Advisory Com-
mittee and Local Organising Committee for their guidance, help and cooperation. I am especially
grateful to our patrons, sponsors, and Exhibitors for their supports to make this event successful.
I look forward to meet you at Bhubaneswar during MPT 2013.
Prof. B. K. Mishra
Chairman, Organising Committee, MPT-2013
& Director, CSIR-IMMT
iii
MPT-2013
MPT-2013
Preface
Rocks and minerals have contributed immensely to the growth and development of
human civilization. These also provide opportunities to understand the evolving rela-
tionship of humankind with nature. While the evolving relationship varies over time
and place, there is no denying the fact that current consumption of minerals to pro-
duce metals worldwide are taking a heavy toll on our planet—its environment and
resources. Whereas in the nineteenth century, environmental protection was largely
advanced for utilitarian purposes, the scientific basis for the need to protect the envi-
ronment and its natural resources gained significant ground in the twentieth century.
Today it is all about sustainable development. The mineral processing community has
been adequately responding to the call but we still have a long way to go.
Extraction and development of different ores are closely interlinked with other natural
resources like land, water, air and forest. Sustainable development of mineral resources
means to follow scientific methods starting from exploration, mining, and beneficiation,
extraction of metals by proper environmental management to balance the ecology
and improve the socio-economic balance of locality. Mineral development in a region
should be carried out within its available social and environmental ‘carrying capacity’
and infrastructure facility at a given point of time.
The state of art technology is presently available to recover the mineral values in the
most economic and sustainable manner. Simultaneously the associated waste genera-
tion can be minimized by making value added products. To improve the air quality
associated with mining, advanced technologies like pipe conveyor and pipeline for
slurry transportation may be made mandatory to avoid pollution. Without the avail-
ability of water, mineral processing is impracticable. Water is used as medium not only
to transport materials but also to process the ore to meet the required specification of
downstream industries. The major challenges to water management in India are stag-
gering which calls for conservation of water in mining and mineral processing. Min-
eral industry must consider by adopting new technologies to replace the fresh water
with waste water and saline water. The tailings disposal is one of the major problems of
mineral industries which must be tackled using proper disposal method after filtration
or thickening at higher solid concentration.
v
MPT-2013
This seminar has received good number papers on important issues like beneficiation
using low grade ores, effective grinding circuit, equipment development, disposal of
tailings, utilisation of waste generated in the plant, pipe line transportation, pelletisation
of high LOI, high Blaine number iron ore concentrate, chemical reduction of ores,
leaching, solvent extraction, etc. And in all these topics the environmental issues are
addressed.
Alok Tripathy
D.B. Ramesh
A. K. Sahu
S. K. Biswal
B. Das
P.S.R. Reddy
B. K. Mishra
vi
MPT-2013
CONTENTS
Foreword iii
Preface v
Volume I
Characterization
vii
MPT-2013
Gravity Separation
18 A simple laboratory alternative to large scale jigging tests 115
Philip Thompson
19 Misplacement of particles in liquid solid fluidization 119
Alok Tripathy, S.K. Biswal and B.C. Meikap
20 Segregation of minerals in floatex density separator – A study 125
by using synthetic mixture
Sharath Kumar Bhoja , Srijith Mohanan, C. Raghu Kumar, Ashok
Kumar, Shobhna Dey and Avimanyu Das
21 Performance evaluation of ultra fine gravity concentration 130
circuit
Y. Rama Murthy, Sunil K. Tripathy, V. Singh, A. Ranjan and A.
Srinivsulu
22 Developments in fine mineral spiral separation technologies 137
Glen Rampola, Alex, D Costa and O.K. Venugopal
viii
MPT-2013
Flotation
ix
MPT-2013
Coal Preparation
41 Chemical beneficiation of high sulphur North-East Indian coals 281
by alkaline oxidation
Runjun Chetia, Binoy K Saikia , Dileep K Dutta and Bimala P Barauh
42 Microbial up-gradation of Meghalaya coal by Rhodococcus 287
Rhodochras and Pseudomonous Aeruginosa
A.Ghosh, Sujata, Abhilash and B.D.Pandey
43 Washability curve versus Mayer’s curve 294
Ajit Singh Choudhary, Eshan Tiwari and I.Narendra Kumar
44 Media stability issues with heavy medium separators 299
Pankaj Kumar Jain and S. Bhattacharya
45 Application of native microbes for biodesulphurization of North 308
east high sulphur coal
S. Mishra, P. P. Panda, N. Pradhan, D. Satapathy, S. K. Biswal and
B.K. Mishra
46 Semi supervised classification of mapping between coal blend 313
x
MPT-2013
B.K. Mishra
46 Semi supervised classification of mapping between coal blend 313
parameters and coke strength after reaction (CSR)
Tathagata Ray, A. Suresh, Pratikswarup Dash and Pradip Banerjee
47 Studies on the cleaning potentialities of Ib valley coals by 318
washability investigations for power generation
T. Gouri Charan, P. C. Nagnoor and B. P. Ravi
48 Chemical fractionation analysis on some Indian coal sources and 322
their correlation with ash fusion temperature
S. Chakravarty, A. K. Mohanti, Anita Kumari, Arun K Mahato and
Mamta Sharma
49 Process amenability studies for de-shaling of coking coal sample 326
from Bokaro, central coalfields limited, India
P. C. Naganoor, T. Gouricharan, B. S. Prasad, S. M. Gowda, K.
Manjula and G. B. Balachandar
50 Prediction of coking properties of coals using 329
thermogravimetric analysis
J.V.S. Murty, C.V. Nageswara Rao, Nilu Kumar, A. Srinivasa Rao,
U. Hari Prasad and Ch. V. R. Murty
51 Studies on the effect of coal beneficiation on ash fusion 334
temperatures
Banashree Mahanta, Binoy K Saikia, Arju Moni Dutta, Prasenjit
Saikia and Bimala P Baruah
52 Beneficiation of low rank north east Indian coals by ultrasonic 338
action in ionic liquids: a green approach
Arju Moni Dutta, Binoy K Saikia, Lakshi Saikia and Bimala P Baruah
53 Washability characteristics of Kusmunda seam coals, Korba 344
coalfield
A.K.Chattopadhyay, M.K.Sethi and S.K.Konar
54 Scope of selective washing of thick inter-banded coal seams: 348
Few case studies
A.K.Chattopadhyay, M. K. Sethi and S.K.Konar
55 Chemical beneficiation of physically treated Hingula coal on 352
laboratory scale
S. Pramanik, B.K. Purohit, P. Meshram, S.K. Sahu and B.D. Pandey
56 A study on pressure and sp. gravity inside heavy media 360
cyclone to optimize the yield & quality of washed coal
Mofid Hussain, S.P. Singh, and Bidhan Ch. Dey
xi
MPT-2013
2
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
The mining and utilization of coals may cause serious impact on the environment. In present
investigation, the nano-mineralogy of some coal and coal fly ash (CFA) samples from North Eastern
region (NER) of India were extensively studied for sustainable environment. A combined approach
using XRD and FE-SEM/HR-TEM techniques has revealed the presence of major minerals such as
Quartz, Calcite, Bassanite, Kaolinite, Dolomite, Tschermigite and Ankerite. The pyrite in these
coals is found to occur in different forms, e.g. framboids and cubic crystals. The nano-minerals
with Fe-Al nano-(hydr) oxides, e.g. hematite, goethite, magnetite; and nano-sulphates, e.g. jarosite,
are found in the coal and fly ash samples. The hematite, magnetite and goethite have high
concentrations of hazardous elements viz. As, Cd, Cr, Hg, Pb, and V. The coal-derived nano-
particles from coals, which could be environmentally hazardous, are discussed in this paper.
Keywords: Indian coal; nano-mineralogy; high sulphur coals; coal fly ash.
3
MPT-2013
Coal fly ash (CFA) is one of the residues properties using standard procedures (ASTM,
generated in combustion, and comprises the 1991 and 1996) (Table 1). The mineralogy of
fine particles that are transported with the flue coal and fly ash was analysed by X-ray powder
gases. Depending upon the sourc e and diffraction using a X-ray diffractometer
composition of the coal being burned, the (Rigaku) with Cu K-alpha radiation, and the
components of CFAs vary considerably, but all minerals present identified by reference to the
CFAs include substantial amounts of SiO2 (both ICDD Powder Diffraction File.
amorphous and crystalline) and Al2O3, with In order to provide further information on the
lesser amounts of CaO. Therefore, a more minerals and ultrafine particles present in the
detailed study on the mineralogy of this CFA is coals high-resolution transmission electron
required towards the enhancement of their microscopy (HR-TEM) and scanning electron
utilization in other aspects and to assess the microscope with energy dispersive X-ray (SEM/
potential exposure risks to human and EDS) were performed on samples from the
ec ologic al systems, espec ially from the different sites.
c ontribution from the re-suspension of 2. Results and Discussions
ultrafine/nano-particles to air particulate
matter around the power plant. 2.1 Petro-chemical characteristics of the coals
The present Field Emission Scanning Electron
Microscope (FE-SEM) and high-resolution The chemical analyses of the two coals are
transmission electron microscope (HR-TEM) shown in Table 1 respectively, which expresses
with energy-dispersive X-ray spectroscopy the coal to be of sub-bituminous in rank with
(EDS) study is the first to identify nanominerals, high sulphur. The fly ash samples have high
ultrafine particles, and hazardous elements in ash and carbon contents.
any Indian coals and coal fly ashes. Thus, a 2.2. Mineralogy of the coal and coal fly ash
better understanding of the chemistry of these
A combined study consisting of XRD and FTIR
coals to improve their environmental concerns
analysis were carried out on the coal and fly
in the coal fired sector is a crucial step towards
ash samples and are depicted in Figs. 1 and 2. It
correct energy planning and management. The
indicates the presence of minerals viz. quartz,
knowledge on mineral matter and associated
kaolinite, calcite etc. as the major phases in the
nano-minerals in these c oals will surely
coal samples. The fly ash samples include the
provide a systematic route to design the clean
major phases of quartz and hematite. Hematite
coal technology principle. Thus, some of the
in the fly ash samples are formed during the
advanced instrumental techniques are used for
c oal c ombustion through the mineral
mineralogical investigation of two industrially
transformation. The dominance of silicate and
important coal samples to understand the
detrital clay minerals including kaolinite were
potential importance of hazards associated
seen in these sub-bituminous NE Indian coals.
with their increased utilization.
Calcite was also found in these coals. The
2. Materials and Methods abundant quartz identified by the XRD analysis
The representative coal and c oal fly ash suggests its form as á-quartz.
samples were supplied by Shyam Century 2.3. Nano-mineralogy of the coals and fly ash
Ferrous Limited, Meghalaya and Nagaon Paper
The pyrite in these coals is found to occur in
Mill, Assam. The c oal samples were
different forms, inc luding nanomineral
characterized for their physical and chemical
4
MPT-2013
5
MPT-2013
Figure 1: Map showing the coal sample 1000 2000 3000 4000
locations in dark spots (not to scale) 45
SCF
40 K
Q K K
35
30
50
45 K
BP
40 K
Q K
35
30
FA-2 40
Q K
30
K
Table 1: Physico-chemical properties of the 20
coals (as received basis, wt%)
10
40
Coal Samples (wt Ash Moisture VM FC C H N Stotal O
%)
35
MK 14.64 2.56 42.47 40.33 65.01 4.61 1.07 2.54 12.13 Q K
30
FA-1
P H P C H K
Q
P I
P H P C
Q
P PH
0 20 40 60 80 100
2
*******
6
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Characters of Some Lead-Zinc Ores from the Benue Trough,
Nigeria
Abstract
Mining of solid minerals in Nigeria is very limited and insignificant. The ‘Pb-Zn sulfide deposits’
in the Benue Trough is being exploited in small-scales and in a crude method that needs attention
for sustainable mining development. In an attempt to characterize the ore, we have investigated
two samples of lead-zinc ore from the Enyigba and Arufu lodes belonging to the Lower- and
Middle Benue Troughs of Nigeria respectively using optical microscopy, XRD, and scanning electron
microscopy (SEM/EPMA) in order to delineate their mineralogy and mineral chemistry. The samples
were similar being dominated by galena and with subordinate sphalerite. While the mineralogy
in case of Enyigba is very straightforward and simple (galena + minor other sulfides + quartz), the
Arufu sample is a bit complex (galena + sphalerite + minor other sulfides + complex mixed sulfides
+ various carbonates + quartz). The minor sulfides are chalcopyrite and pyrite. While quartz is
found to be the main gangue mineral in Enyigba sample, the Arufu sample contains significant
carbonates. The richness of these Pb-Zn ores keeps promise for the Nigerian Government to
pursue for potential large-scale mining where copper, silver and gold can be recovered as by-
products in addition to lead and zinc.
7
MPT-2013
objective in this study is to c ompare the the mineralized vein in order to represent its
mineralogical and geochemical aspects of the general characteristics. The samples were
Pb-Zn sulfides from Enyigba- and Arufu lodes massive (Fig. 2) and physically appear to be
and assess their economic potentialities in dominated mainly by galena.
terms of valuable minerals/elements those can
be recovered as by-products in addition to lead a
b
and zinc.
c d
8
MPT-2013
content are significant which occur up to the Galena in the Arufu lode showed two
first decimal level. Presence of strontium, variations: one similar to that of the Enyigba
arsenic, antimony and silver was also recorded (Table 2, point-13); and the other containing
in galena. Irregular and variable distribution significant copper and higher iron (Table 2,
of arsenic in this type of galena is notable (Fig. point-4). Sphalerite is more prevalent in the
3). Arufu sample. It contains significant iron (~4
wt.%), minor lead (~0.2 wt.%) and trace
9
MPT-2013
quantities of cobalt, nickel, copper, strontium, Published data on the trac e element
and c admium. Point analyses indic ated distribution of the Pb-Zn sulfide ores in the
presence of silver and gold as well. Elemental Benue Trough are very scarce. Olade and
image mapping revealed loc alized Morton (1985) had presented trace element data
concentration of silver in sphalerite bordering only on few elements such as Fe, Mn, Cu, Cd,
chalcopyrite (Fig. 4). The associated dendritic Ag, Sb, and Ge from mineral concentrates
pyrite which is secondary in nature is arsenic (namely sphalerite and galena) using atomic
bearing and contains elemental gold (Table 2). absorption spec trometry (AAS) and
It also contains significant cobalt (>1 wt.%) colorimetry. The data were from lower Benue
along with traces of nickel, copper, zinc and lead. (Ishiagu, Abakaliki) and few from upper Benue
Elemental gold is also occasionally traced in the (Zurak-Wase). However, Pb-Zn sulfides from
lattices of other sulfides and siderite. the middle Benue were not analyzed. Recently
Olubambi et al. (2008) also presented very
a
b
limited data from the Ishiagu sulfides in the
lower Benue. Although our data are only from
two localities, it scans both lower and middle
Benue samples, covers more elements and are
expected to fill up the knowledge gaps on the
c d
trace element content of the Benue Pb-Zn
sulfides.
4. Conclusion
10
MPT-2013
*******
11
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Shale gas, hailed by many as a game changer and even a ‘silent revolution’ in US, is drastically
altering the international energy landscape. Shales are unconventional gas systems where the
shale acts as both source and reservoir rocks for gas mainly methane. Organic matter in shale
typically ranges from below 1 wt % to more than 45 wt % and is responsible for in situ gas
generation as well as provides storage sites for shale gas in the organic matter micropore structure.
India has several potential shale gas basins. For the purpose of study authors have selected borehole
shale samples from different parts of Raniganj coal basin. Total of 70 samples were studied for
assessing the shale gas potentiality, out of which 2 belongs to Panchet Formation, 6 belongs to
Barakar Formation, while 24 and 38 samples belong to Barren Measures and Raniganj Formation
respectively. Depth varies from 755 to 812 m for the samples from Panchet Formation, 773 to 1070
m for samples from Barakar Formation, while for samples from Barren Measures and Raniganj
Formations it varies from 55.80 to 1480 m and 177.10-1370.00 m respectively.
TOC (total organic carbon) and Rock eval pyrolysis analysis of the samples were carried out for
determining their organic richness and hydrocarbon generation potential. Samples from Panchet
Formation are marked by low TOC content (0.02-0.29 wt %). The TOC content of the samples from
Barakar Formation varies between 4.49-7.23 wt %, while those from Barren Measures Formation
vary from 3.51 to 8.11 wt %. TOC content of the samples from Raniganj Formation are placed in the
range of 0.82 to 46.28 wt %. The hydrocarbon generative potential of the samples (S2; mg HC/g
rock) from Barakar, Barren Measures, Raniganj and Panchet Formations are placed within the
range of 2.07-3.91, 2.56-13.67, 0.37 to 71.94 and 0.02 to 1.90 respectively.
Tmax values of the samples from Barakar Formation shows that they are all in early to peak stage of
maturity. The samples from Barren Measures Formation are mostly in early to peak maturity
stage barring 3 samples, 1 of which falls in immature stage and other 2 falls in late mature stage.
Tmax of the samples from Raniganj Formation vary between 421-450 °C and shows that majority of
the samples are in early mature to peak mature stage while few are in immature stage. Tmax of the
samples from Panchet Formation varies between 340-463 °C. Hydrogen index (HI) of the studied
samples varies from 31 to 655.
Keywords: Total organic carbon, Rock eval pyrolysis, shale gas
* Correspending Author: Atul Kumar Varma, Coal Geology and Organic Petrology Lab., Dept. of Applied
Geology, Indian School of Mines, Dhanbad-826004, India, Contact no.: (+91)-326-2235271; Fax: (+91)-326-
2296563; Email: atulvarma@hotmail.com
12
MPT-2013
13
MPT-2013
Tertiary Light grey mudstone and siltstone with bands 300 from 755 to 812 m for the samples from Panchet
of marlstone; white, soft fine grained clayey
sandstone, mottled clay and loose sand with
pebbles of vien quartz; occasionally lignite at
the basal part.
Formation, 773 to 1070 m for samples from
-----------------------Unconformity-------------------
------------------
Barakar Formation, while for samples from
Cretaceous
Igneous
intrusive
Basic (dolerite) dykes; Ultrabasic (mica-
peridotite, mica-lamprophyre, lamprophyre)
___ Barren Measures and Raniganj Formations it
sills and dykes.
Cretaceous Rajmahal Greenish grey to black, fine to medium 120 varies from 55.80 to 1480 m and 177.10-1370.00
Formation grained vesicular porphyritic basalt and
volcanic breccia; weathered aphanitic basalt
at places; one to five inter-trappeans
consisting of grey shale, fine grained
m respectively.
sandstone and carbonaceous shale.
------------------------Unconformity------------------
------------------ Rock Eval-VI was used for carrying out Rock-
Upper
Triassic*
Supra-
Panchet/
Massive, very coarse to coarse quartzose
sandstone, conglomeratic at places; bands of
300
Eval Pyrolysis and TOC analysis of the samples.
Durgapur dark red silty shale.
Beds
------------------------Unconformity------------------
For this, the samples were washed, dried,
------------------
14
MPT-2013
15
MPT-2013
16
MPT-2013
Northeastern British Columbia, Canada. Int. J. gas-shale play with multi-trillion cubic foot
Coal Geol. 70, 223–239. potential. AAPG Bulletin. 89, 155–175.
Cipolla, C. L., Lolon, E. P., Erdle, J. C. and Rubin, Mukhopadhyay, G., Mukhopadhyay, S.K.,
B., 2009. Resrvoir modeling in shale gas Roychowdhury, M., and Parui, P.K., 2010.
reservoirs. Society of Petroleum Engineers, Stratigraphic Correlation between Different
Paper SPE-125530. 19. Gondwana Basins of India. J. Geol. Society of
Fox, C. S., 1931. The Gondwana system and India. 76, 251-266.
related formations. Mem. Geol. Surv. India. Nie, H.K., Zhang, J.C., Zhang, P.X., Song, X.W.,
58, 1 – 241. 2009. The characteristics of Barnett shale gas
Gee, E. R., 1932. The Geology and Coal Resources reservoir in Fort Worth basin and its
of Raniganj Coalfield. Mem. Geol. Surv. Ind. indications. Geological Science & Technology
61. Information 28 (2), 87-93 (in Chinese with
GSI, 2003. Coal Resources of West Bengal. R.K. English abstract).
Dutta compiled, A.B. Dutt, (ed.) Bull. Geol. Peters, K. E., Walters, C. C., Moldowan, J. M., 2005.
Surv. Ind. Series A 45, 1-109. The Biomarker Guide. Biomarkers and
Krooss, B. M., Busch, A., Alles, S. and Isotopes in the Environment and Human
Hildenbrand, A., 2003. Experimental History Ch. 4,. Cambridge University Press,
investigation of molecular diffusion of CO2 New York.
in coals and shales. International Conference Pollastro, R. M., 2007. Total petroleum system
on Gas–Water–Rock Interactions Induced by assessment of undiscovered resources in the
Reservoir Exploitation, CO2 Sequestration, giant Barnett Shale c ontinuous
and Other Geological Storage. November (unconventional) gas accumulation, Fort
18–20, Rueil-Malmaison, France. Worth Basin, Texas. AAPG Bull. 91, 551–578.
Lafargue, E., Marquis, F. and Pillot, D., 1998. Ross, D. J. K., Bustin, R. M., 2007. Shale gas
Rock–Eval 6 applications in hydrocarbon potential of the Lower Jurassic Gordondale
exploration, produc tion, and soil Member, northeastern British Columbia,
contamination studies. Institut Français du Canada. Bulletin of Canadian Petroleum
Pétrole. 53, 421–437. Geology. 55, 51–75.
Lewis, R., Ingraham, D., Pearcy, M., Williamson, Ross, D. J. K., Bustin, R. M., 2008. Characterizing
J., Sawyer, W. and Frantz, J., 2004. New the shale gas resource potential of Devonian-
evaluation tec hniques for gas shale Mississippian strata in the Western Canada
reservoirs. Reservoir Symposium, 1-11 Sedimentary Basin: Application of an
(Denver, Colorado, July 29-30, 2004). integrated formation evaluation. American
Mastalerz, M., Schimmelmann, A., Lis, G. P., Association of Petroleum Geologists Bulletin.
Drobniak, A., Stankiewicz, A., 2012. Influence 92, 87–125.
of maceral composition on geochemical Ross, D. J. K., Bustin, R. M., 2009. The importance
characteristics of immature shale kerogen: of shale composition and pore structure upon
Insight from density fraction analysis. Int. J. gas storage potential of shale gas reservoirs.
Coal Geol. 103, 60-69. Marine and Petroleum Geology. 26, 916–927.
McCarthy, K., Roja, K., Niemann, M., Sarkar, A., Paul, D. K., Balasubramanyan, M. N.,
Palmowski, D., Peters, K., Stankiewicz, A., Sengupta, N. R., 1980. Lamprophyres from
2011. Basic petroleum geochemistry for Indian Gondwanas—K–Ar age and
source rock evaluation. Oilfield Review 23, chemistry. J. Geol. Soc. India. 21, 182– 193.
32-43. Strapoc, D., Mastalerz, M., Schimmelmann A.,
Montgomery, S.L., Jarvie, D.M., Bowker, K.A., Drobniak A., Hasenmueller, N. R., 2010.
Pallastro, R.M., 2005. Mississippian Barnett Geochemical constraints on the origin and
Shale, Fort Worth basin, north-central Texas: volume of gas in the New Albany Shale
17
MPT-2013
(Devonian–Mississippian), eastern Illinois Tissot, B., Welte, D.H., 1978. Petroleum Formation
Basin. AAPG Bulletin. 94, 1713–1740. and Occurrence Part V, Ch. 1. Springer-
Taylor, G. H., Teichmuller, M., Davis, A., 1998. Verlag, Berlin, Heidelberg, New York.
Organic Petrology Ch. 7. Gebrüder
Borntraeger, Berlin.
******
18
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Characterization of minerals in coal provides data which are useful in various coal related pro-
cesses, viz mining, correlation of seams and sub-seams, beneficiation, combustion, gasification,
carbonisation and liquefaction. Indian coals are of drift origin and therefore, they are rich in miner-
als, which need to be characterized in detail for better utilization of coals. Minerals do not con-
tribute to the heat value of coal, but their deleterious effects in any coal conversion process make
their characterization indispensable for working out an abatement strategy. Isolation of minerals
intact from coal prior to characterization by instrumental techniques is essential as the carbon
matrix interferes in the process of quantitative estimation of minerals. But the existing process of
isolation by oxygen plasma, a standard technique used worldwide, is a cost-intensive and time-
consuming process, which stands in the way of its use as a routine tool.
The present communication reports a novel device, which oxidises rapidly the organic part of
coal in a flow of oxygen leaving behind the inorganic part almost intact. The device is robust, low
cost, rapid and less sophisticated requiring little maintenance. It has been found to be capable of
isolating the major minerals in Indian coals of diverse types, non-coking and coking. The time for
extraction of minerals depends on the instrumental parameters, viz the flow rate of oxygen and
temperature of oxidation. At a flow rate of 0.2 l/min and temperature of 3500C, time of isolation of
minerals could be as low as 8 hrs, which has not yet been reported. Investigations on composition
of the inorganic residues obtained under these conditions using FTIR and XRD have revealed that
kaolinite and quartz are the major constituents along with other minerals, viz illite and carbon-
ates, occurring in smaller proportions.
The low-temperature ash yields obtained from the device and from the oxygen plasma asher
have been compared. The results from the two methods are found to agree well when the results
from plasma ashing are corrected for the unburnt organic residues. Further, the XRD and FTIR
spectra of the low-temperature ashes obtained from the device compared favourably with those
from the plasma asher, justifying thereby the appropriateness of extraction of minerals using the
simple device. Notably, as the temperature of the device can be accurately controlled, moisture in
Corresponding Author: Dr. A.K. Bandopadhyay, Advisor to Silica Project and Ex-Chief Scientist , RPL Division,
CIMFR, Dhanbad-826015, Jharkhand, India Contact no. +919431377405 Email: akban2002@rediffmail.com
19
MPT-2013
coals were determined and the results agreed with those from standard determination. The de-
vice, therefore, holds promise for application in industry for determination of mineral matter and
subsequent analysis of minerals along with other applications, viz moisture determination and
proneness of oxidation of coal.
1. Introduction
Characterization of minerals in coal provides ing and utilisation. First, the minerals are the
data which are useful in various coal related constituents of coal that participate in the coal
processes, viz mining, correlation of seams and conversion processes. Hence their determina-
sub-seams, beneficiation, combustion, gasifi- tion is essential for understanding both their
cation, carbonisation and liquefaction. More individual effects and collective alterations, if
than a hundred minerals are documented and any, during any process. For example, recently
they are classified under clays (silicates), it has been demonstrated (Bandopadhyay,
sulphides, sulphates, phosphates and oxides 2010a, 2010b; Shobha et al., 2012) that direct
(Van Krevelen, 1993; Vassilev and Vassileva, determination of quartz, one of the major min-
1996; Ward, 2002). However, the number of eral constituents in most coals, and its abun-
minerals actually found in coals of a country dance in Indian coals is useful for correlation of
depends on their origin and geological forma- abrasive propensity of thermal coals with
tion. Indian coals are of drift origin and there- quartz contents. Secondly, the knowledge of
fore, they are rich in minerals, which need to minerals helps in correlation of seams and sub-
be characterized in detail for their better utili- seams (Ward, 2002). Thirdly, quantitative
zation. Notably, minerals do not contribute to analysis of the minerals present in coal also
the heat value of coal, but their deleterious ef- helps to fix acid mine drainage problems
fects (Ward, C.R., 2002; Pinetown and Boer, (Pinetown et al., 2007) and helps in prediction
2006; Van Dyk et al., 2009) in any coal conver- of the presence of heavy elements that that are
sion process make their characterization essen- known to cause environmental pollution
tial for knowing possible interference and (Ward, 2002). Fourthly, for conversion of the
working out an abatement strategy. testing and analytical results of coal obtained
on air dried basis to dry mineral matter free
At present the data on ash yield of coal and ash basis.
analysis provide inputs to assessing coal from
utilisation point of view, as the deleterious ef- But characterization of minerals requires their
fects induced by minerals can be predicted in- prior isolation from coal, as the organic matrix
directly (Raask, 1985; Van Krevelen, 1993; of coal interferes in the analytical process us-
Meenakshi et al., 1997; Tickner and Maier, R.W., ing instrumental techniques, viz Fourier Trans-
2005; Ritz and Klika, 2010). However, direct form Infra-Red Spectroscopy (FTIR) and X-ray
characterization of minerals is highly signifi- Diffractometry (XRD). However, isolation of
cant for a number of reasons in coal science minerals is not as easy as the determination of
and technology and for assessment of the envi- ash at 8150C because of several problems. The
ronmental effects of the minerals during min- standard technique, that is universally ac-
20
MPT-2013
cepted now, is the low-temperature plasma The low-temperature asher was designed and
ashing (Gluskoter, 1965; Mahajan, 1985; Ward, constructed in the laboratory. Figure 1 shows
2002; Pinetown et al. 2007; López and Ward its basic features. It is basically a modification
2008; Bond and Giroux, 2013). However, the of high-temperature muffle furnace used for the
method is time consuming, cost intensive and determination of ash. The muffle is made of sil-
not so perfect as to produce exactly the same limanite which can withstand a high tempera-
minerals in unaltered form as are present in ture of 14000C The muffle is wound with im-
coals. Therefore, with these limitations, the oxy- ported Kanthal A1 heating element, which has
gen plasma asher technique has remained con- high current carrying capacity and can main-
fined as a research tool for mineral investiga- tain a high temperature of 10000 C within the
tions. heating space of the muffle. The selection of
these materials endows high longevity to the
It is in the above mentioned context, develop- device as the experimental temperature for this
ment of a device, which is low-cost, less time work never exceeds 4000C.
consuming and less sophisticated requiring a
little maintenance so that it is readily accept-
able in coal industry as a routine tool, is essen-
tial. The present communication describes a
method which can rapidly oxidise coal (also
other carbonaceous substances) in a flow of
oxygen reducing the time of isolation of miner-
als significantly and compares the results with
those of plasma asher. Further, the applications
of this device as an aid to mineral character-
ization and determination of moisture content
of coals have also been discussed.
Fig.1: Basic layout of the furnace, showing
2. Materials and Methods regulated supply of oxygen and electrical con-
The various steps taken to accomplish this nections with the digital controller
work are detailed in the following paragraphs:
2.1 Selection of coal samples The muffle is surrounded by ceramic wool blan-
Two coals of diverse nature, one non-coking ket supported by refractory bricks. The tem-
while the other coking, were selected for the perature inside the furnace is indicated and
study. The former was c ollec ted from controlled digitally. The preset temperature on
Vasundhara mine of Ib Valley Coalfield and the the control panel can be varied by rotating the
latter from Kathara mine of East Bokaro adjustable screw on the controller and simul-
coalfield. The coal samples after proper taneously pressing the set bottom. The asher is
sampling were crushed to -72 BS mesh and then c onnected to the mains through a relay
subjected to ash and moisture determinations contactor which is digitally controlled by elec-
as per IS: 1360 Part1 [13]. The results are trical signal from the control unit. Tempera-
included in Table 1. ture inside the furnace is sensed by PT -100
sensor (class 2B as per IEC 751:1983). The out-
2.2 Development of low-temperature asher put of the sensor is fed to the controller to main-
21
MPT-2013
tain the temperature of the asher at the set stirring the samples, they were put in the asher.
point. The low-temperature asher has a hole It was found that after 8 hrs the weights of the
at the centre through which oxygen gas (com- dishes containing the samples were constant,
mercial grade) can be made to flow at a desired thus indicating complete ashing.
rate measured by a flowmeter, as shown in Fig-
ure 1. The flowmeter can read gas flow rates 2.4. Effect of particle size
from 0 to 1 l/min. The asher was calibrated To study the effect of particle size on the
against a standard Fluke 52 digital thermom- oxidation of coal taking place inside the asher,
eter with J-type thermocouple as sensor. It has powdered coal of -72 BS mesh size was further
been found that the readings of the digital read ground to still lower sizes passing through 100
out of the furnace and the Fluke readings agreed BS mesh and 200 BS mesh, respectively. The
reasonably well (within ± 20C). The tempera- coal samples with these sizes were then
ture inside the asher was found to be maxi- subjected to ash and moisture determinations
mum in the middle and slowly varied up to a following the IS specifications [13]. The three
maximum of 100C on either side of the middle samples were then ashed at 3500C for 8 hrs in
of the asher. The silica dishes (diameter 56 mm) the asher till constant weight was achieved
containing samples to be ashed were, therefore, for each. The process is illustrated in Figure 2.
placed as close to the tip of the thermocouple as
possible so that the samples were heated to
temperature indicated by the digital thermom-
eter.
0.0255 g/cm2. Each of the samples was taken in -72 BS mesh 2.6 56.7 (58.2) 61.7 (63.4)
four silica dishes so that the amount of ash -100 BS mesh 2.5 56.8 (58.2) 61.46 (63.1 )
obtained was suffic ient enough for -200 BS mesh 2.7 56.8 (58.4) 61.76 (63.5)
22
MPT-2013
Transmittance
removal of the organic matrix. It was found that 60
k
200
selected coals q
q
0
Mineral matter from low-
P la s m a L T A
Ash Mineral matter from
Coal
Moisture tem- perature ashing
plasma ashing 600 0 20 q 40 60 80
(%wt./wt.)
Lin (Counts)
(%wt./wt.) (% wt./wt.)
(%wt./wt.)
400
Ib Valley 2.7 56.8 (58.4) 61.8 (63.5) 67.5 (69.4)
200
k q
Kathara,E 1.8 28.2 (28.7) 30.3(30.9) 31.1 (31.7) q
ast
0
Bokaro LTA Asher
0 20 40 60 80
2 -T h e ta - S c a le
23
MPT-2013
24
MPT-2013
such that they do not undergo change at low ashes prepared are found to be kaolinite and
temperature heating (< 4000C), thus favouring quartz in the two Indian coals studied. Abun-
ash to be produced at 3500C without any ap- dance of these minerals together with low per-
preciable alteration. The supply of oxygen rap- centage of pyrite (< 1%) has been main reason
idly oxidises the coaly matrix, making it fea- for the success of the laboratory developed
sible for rapid isolation of minerals to take place. asher as at the ashing temperature (3500C) no
The FTIR spectra shown in Figure 4 are not only significant alterations of the minerals are likely
similar but of nearly equal in intensity with to take place. The device is flexible as it can be
respect to bands at 915 cm -1 due kaolinite and operated for ashing without any flow of oxy-
800 cm-1 due to quartz. This indicates that the gen, but in this case the ashing time will be
composition of the minerals in the LT ash that more.
of plasma is identical. Further, the XRDs of the
LT ash and the plasma ash are similar indicat- Acknowledgements
ing the minerals in both samples are identical. The authors are grateful to CSIR-CIMFR for
It is encouraging to note that the low-tempera- encouragement and permission to publish the
ture device developed has opened up scope for paper.
investigation on minerals in Indian coals.
Another interesting point to note is that results References
of moisture determination of a number of coals Bandopadhyay, A.K., 2010a. Determination of
with the LT asher tallied well with those of quartz content for Indian coals using an
plasma asher (Figure 5). This, however, is not FTIR technique. Int. J. Coal Geol. 81, 73-78.
the main application of the LT asher, but a job Bandopadhyay, A.K., 2010b. A study on the
that may be tried in case of necessity. The de- abundance of quartz in thermal coals of
vice is very flexible. In the absence of oxygen, India and its relation to abrasion index:
air oxidation of coal for protracted periods de- Development of predictive model for abra-
pending on selected temperature can be car- sion. Int. J. Coal Geol. 84, 63-69.
ried out for mineral extraction. This is an ad- Bond, J., Giroux, L., 2013. Low temperature
vantage if time is not a factor for mineral analy- plasma ashing of coal for quantitative
sis to be carried out. mineral analysis. 2013 World of Coal Ash
(WOCA) Conference, April 22-25, 2013,
4. Conclusions Lexington, KY, pp.6.
Mineral characterisation of coal is an integral Brown, H.R., Durie, R.A., Schafer, H.N.S., 1959.
part of coal c harac terisation for proper The inorganic constituents in Australian
utilisation of coal. Isolation of minerals intact coals I: The direct determination of the
is essential prior to characterisation by FTIR total mineral-matter content. Fuel 38,
and XRD. The laboratory developed low-tem- pp.295-308.
perature asher has shown promise for isola- Gluskoter, H.J., 1965. Electronic low-tempera-
tion of minerals in Indian coals rapidly, accu- ture ashing of bituminous coal. Fuel 44,
rately and at a significantly low cost compared pp. 285-291.
to the standard plasma ashing technique. Pow- Huggins, F.E., 2002. Overview of analytical
dered coal of size 72 BS mesh has been found to methods for inorganic constituents in
be useful for ashing in 8 hrs in the low-tem- coal. Int. J. Coal Geol. 50, 169-214.
perature device. The major minerals in the
25
MPT-2013
IS:1360 Part1 1984. Indian Standard methods ses. Acta Geodyn. Geomater. 7(4), 453–
of test for coal and coke , Part 1 Proximate 460. 2010.
Analysis (Second Revision) Second Re- Shobha, K., T Gouricharan, T., Chattopadhyay,
print 1995. U.S., Pandey, J.K., Udayabhanu, G., Saini,
López, I.C., Ward, C.R., 2008. Composition and M.K., Bandopadhyay, A.K., 2012. Miner-
mode of occurrence of mineral matter in alogical characterization of raw and ben-
some Colombian coals. Int. J. Coal. Geol. eficiated fractions of an ib valley coal for
73, 3-18. beneficiation characteristics, quality and
Mahajan, O.P., 1985. Determination of organic behaviour on combustion. Paper no. 985,
oxygen content of coals. Fuel 64, 973-990. Proc Int Min Proc Cong, New Delhi, Sept.
24-28, 2012, pp. 336-343.
Meenakshi, K., Mandal, P.K., Thakur, J.S., Hirani, Tickner, D., Maier, R.W., 2005. Design consider-
M., 1997. Effect of coal constituents on ash ations in pulverised coal fire boilers com-
fusibility in pulverised coal fired boiler busting Illinois basin coals. Paper pre-
furnace. R & D Journal 3(1), 1-18. sented to Electric Power 2005, April5-7,
2005, Chicago, Illinois, USA, p. 15.
Mukherjee, S., Srivastava, S.K., 2006. Minerals Van Dyk, J.C., S.A. Benson, S.A., Laumb, M.L.,
transformation in North-Eastern region Waanders, B., 2009. Coal and coal ash
coals of India on heat treatment. Energy characteristics to understand mineral
& Fuels 20, pp. 363-367. transformations and slag formation. Fuel
88, 1057–1063
Pinetown, K.L., Boer, R.H., 2006. A quantitative Van Krevelen, D.W., 1993.Coal: Typology-Phys-
evaluation of the modal distribution of ics-Chemistry-Constitution. (3rd com-
minerals in coal deposits in the highveld pletely revised edition), Elsevier,
area and the associated impact on the gen- Amsterdam.
eration of acid and neutral mine drain- Vassilev, S.V., Vassileva, C.G., 1996. Occurrence,
age. WRC report no. 1264/1/06, ISBN No. abundance and origin of minerals in coals
1-77005-440-5, pp.92. and coal ashes. Fuel Proc. Technol. 48, . 85-
106.
Pinetown, K.L., Ward, C.R., van der Ward, C.R., 2002. Analysis and significance of
Westhuizen, 2007. Quantitative evalua- mineral matter in coal seams. Int. J. Coal.
tion of minerals in coal deposits in the Geol. 50, 135-168.
Witbank and Highveld coalfields, and the
potential impact on acid mine drainage.
Int. J. Coal. Geol. 70, 166-183.
26
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
PGEs are of strategic importance due to their growing use in advanced technology and rarity in
occurrence. PGE mineralization is found in various rock types, stratigraphic levels and geotec-
tonic set up. Most important deposits occur as reefs in layered intrusions of Archean to Protero-
zoic age. Boula Nuasahi Igneous Complex is the only proven PGE deposit in India. PGE mineral-
ization is confined to a 3 km long breccia zone. This breccia zone is the manifestation of late
intrusion of Bangur Gabbro at the contact of ultramafic and mafic rocks in the eastern part of the
complex. This zone is a heterogeneous assemblage of randomly oriented angular to sub-rounded
blocks/ fragments of chromite, ultramafic rocks which are pervaded by the leucogabbro and
clinopyroxenite. PGE minerals are associated with oxide, sulfide and silicate facies. Chromite and
base metal sulfides are principal hosts for PGE mineralisation. Pt dominant PGE mineralisation
in chromite is pronounced in the southern part and Pd dominant PGE mineralization in base
metal sulfides is prevalent in the northern part of the breccia zone. The mineralisation has both
magmatic and hydrothermal signatures. The mineralisation in the southern part is presumed to
be magmatic where as mineralisation in northern part is hydrothermal in nature.
PGMs are mostly present as inclusions and exsolution in chromite and BMS. PGE contents of the
rocks of the breccia zone vary from <1 ppm to 5 ppm. PGMs are mostly associated with sulphides,
arsenides, tellurides besides present in alloy form such as Isoferroplatinum. Important minerals
are sudburyite, braggite, laurite, sperrylite, merenskyite, hollingworthite, malanite,
isoferroplatinum etc. Grain size varies from <2 µ to 50µ with an average size of around 15µ. The
grade of mineralization is very poor compared to world scenario. Magnetic separation and flota-
tion methods of beneficiation can be tried upon to pre-concentrate PGE values from this low
grade ore.
27
MPT-2013
trated together geologically. They don’t occur nents of implant devices used for treatment of
as independent natural ores but are mostly heart ailments. Platinum and palladium are
found as tellurides, arsenides, antimonides, mixed with ruthenium and/or iridium to pro-
sulphides and various complicated mineral duce alloys for dental restorations.
phases. They are divided into two groups: IPGE
(Ir, Os, Ru) and PPGE (Pt, Pd, Rh) depending on Multifarious applications have increased the
their refractory nature and temperature of for- demand for PGE at a faster rate. Due to rare
mation. Out of the six, platinum, iridium and occurrence, discovery of new PGE deposits/
osmium are very heavy (sp.gr.>12) where as mineralized zones as well as recovery from
palladium Rhodium and ruthenium are light very low grade sourc es by suitable
(sp.gr.<12) metals. They all have commonality beneficiation-extraction processes will enhance
of extreme rarity in occurrence on the surface the resource base of PGE in world. The total
of the earth and attractive appearance with world reserve is 66110 t with metal content of
noncorrosive qualities even with long use and 2125 million oz tr (Table 1). Economically min-
normal exposure to the ambience and the envi- able world resources of PGM in mineral con-
ronment. Their crustal abundance is very low centrations are estimated to total more than
(less than sub-ppb level to maximum 10 ppb) 100,000 t (3.2 million troy ounces) (USGS, 2011).
and PGE deposits are too few in number com-
Table 1: World reserve of PGE
pared to other metalliferous or more specifi-
cally other precious metal deposits of the world. Country PGM, t PGM, M oz tr Share, %
South Africa 63000 2025 95.3
PGE and Au are strongly siderophile and Russia 1100 35 1.7
chalcophile and exhibit different associations. USA 900 29 1.4
Canada 310 26 0.5
Because of an aversion to bonding with oxy- Others 800 10 1.2
gen, PGE-Oxide mineral is rare and the PGEs
Major PGE deposits are mainly confined to S.
are scarce in the crusts and concentrated in the
Africa and Russia. South Africa is the leading
core-forming Fe–Ni alloy.
producer (58%) followed by Russia (28%) and
Canada (5%) of Pt+Pd. South Africa production
With ever increasing application of the mod-
centers on the Bushveld Complex where the
ern technologies at various industries, the de-
PGM bearing ores are being primarily mined
mand of the PGEs has increased many folds.
for the recovery of these metals. Canada’s PGE
They find application in chemical and petro-
are by-products of nickel–copper mining, pri-
chemical industries, electrical and electronics,
marily from Falconbridge’s and Inco’s deposits
glass, jewellery and medical sciences. Utility
in the Sudbury area. The major deposits and
in electronic sector is increasing day by day
occurrences are shown in Fig. 1.
where the elements are used to increase the ef-
The total Indian demand is met by export. In-
ficiency of many storage devices and chips.
dian lacks any deposit of significance till date
With high melting point and resistance to
except a very low grade deposit at Odisha. This
chemical attack, these elements find uses in
paper describes style of PGE mineralisation,
production of high purity single crystals for a
mode of occurrence of PGE and the problems
variety of applications, high quality optical
associated with beneficiation of such ore from
glasses. Owing to their biocompatibility, high
a mineralogical perspective.
electrical conductance and resistance to corro-
sion, Pt and Pt-Os alloys are essential compo-
28
MPT-2013
*
* PGE mineralisation at Boula area was first re-
ported by Nanda & Patra (1993) and later on
... .
Stillwater Shimoga schist
Complex,Montana (USA) belt
Baula-Nausahi
confirmed by detail geological and geochemi-
Sittam pundi-Karungalpatti
Anorthosite Com plex cal work, jointly carried out by GSI and BRGM,
Great Dyke
(Zimbabwe) *
*
France. It is estimated the reserve to be around
Index
.
* Major Deposit
Reported occurrences
Kalgoorlie 14.2 million tone having 24935 kg of Pt+Pd. But
Bushveld
Coronet Hill
Complex
(Australia) the grade is very poor (“PGE H”1.5 ppm). This
concentration is too low for any commercial
Fig. 1: Important PGE deposits of world exploitation.
29
MPT-2013
of PGE in this complex (Mondal et al., 2001; Auge grains form a compact granular mosaic in
et al., 2002). The PGE mineralization is confined chromitite and show a variety of cumulus tex-
to a breccia zone lying to the east ultramafic tures. Chromite also exhibits different primary
unit. The complex has been affected by later and secondary textures like granular, foam
faulting, shearing and open folding. ENE-trend- (auto-annealing), brecciated / mylonitised,
ing faults and shear zones are more prevalent banded, pull apart, corrosion and alteration
than NNW-trending faults. textures. Based on physical & optical proper-
ties, two types of chromite are identified viz.,
normal chromite and ferritchromite. Normal
c hromite has lower reflec tivity and
ferritchromite has higher reflectivity. The mi-
cro-hardness of the chromite varies from 1200
to 1458 (VHN). The normal chromite is non-
magnetic with very low magnetic susceptibil-
ity whereas the ferritchromite is highly mag-
netic in nature. The chromite grains contain
inclusions of various shape, size and composi-
tion. The normal chromite has olivine and
enstatite as inclusions where as ferritchromite
has diopside, amphibole and muscovite inclu-
sions. Ferritchromite also contains ilmenite
Fig. 3: Geological map of Boula Igneous exsolution and vermicular chalcopyrite. Sec-
complex ondary sulfide minerals (millerite and pyrite)
are confined to the matrix and formed due to
2.2. Chromite mineralization alteration of the ultramafic host rocks. The two
The complex hosts three chromite lodes viz. types of chromite show different alteration
Durga, Laxmi and Ganga-Shankar composite characters. Normal chromite may have formed
lode from south to north within the ultramafic at an early stage where as ferritchromite crys-
rocks. The ultramafic suit consists of inter lay- tallized at a late stage of chromite crystalliza-
ered sequence of chromite bearing ultramafic tion.
rocks. The Durga and Laxmi lodes occur in the
chromite bearing dunite-peridotite while the 2.3. Breccia Zone
Shankar-Ganga composite lode is hosted in In the eastern part of the ultramafic belt, on the
pyroxenite. The lodes exhibit a continuum from hanging-wall side of the orthopyroxenite unit,
disseminated chromite to layered chromite fol- a NNW-SSE trending breccia zone is developed
lowed by massive chromite. Chromites of due to intrusion of coarse grained Bangur gab-
Durga and Laxmi lode are normal chromite bro. The breccia zone is 1 to 40 m thick, almost
where as chromite from the Ganga-Shankar continuous over a length of 2000 m and shows
composite lode is magnetic in nature. Later in- marked vertical and lateral variations. It cuts
trusion of Bangur gabbro has severely affected obliquely across the ultramafic succession, in
the chromite lodes. particular at the level of Ganga-Shankar
chromite layer.
Chromite, the major primary mineral, occurs
as euhedral to subhedral grains. The chromite
30
MPT-2013
Fig. 4: Schematic diagram showing irregular Fig. 5.a. Random distribution of fragments of
distribution of rocks & chromite in the dunite and pyroxenite in a gabbroic rock, b.
breccia zone Rounded chromitite of different size in a py-
roxenite matrix, c. Nodule shaped chromite as
The Breccia Zone is characterized by a hetero- enclaves in a coarse grained gabbro, d. ver-
geneous assemblage of randomly oriented an- micular chalcopyrite in ferritchromite
gular to sub-rounded blocks of chromite/
chromitite, dunite, peridotite, serpentinite, py- The Pegmatitic gabbro in the southern part of
roxenite whic h are pervaded by the the Breccia Zone is porphyritic with large
leucogabbro and clinopyroxenite (Fig. 4). Sul- subhedral to anhedral crystals of pyroxene and
phide enrichment is found in the matrix mate- plagioclase. The primary texture is obliterated
rial. The breccia matrix is predominantly py- by hydrothermal alteration, with the forma-
roxene-rich gabbro showing hypidiomorphic tion of amphibole. Clinopyroxene, amphibole
texture formed of cumulus plagioclase and py- (tremolite-actinolite, cummingtonite) and pla-
roxene which are hydrothermally altered. gioclase are the principal minerals. Plagioclase
Coarse grained gabbroic rock encloses ran- shows granular texture with deformed twin-
domly disposed dunite and pyroxenite frag- ning and strain effect. The gabbro with
ments (Fig. 5a). Fine grained, rounded massive c hromite nodules is c omposed of large,
and disseminated chromites of earlier genera- euhedral, c umulus plagioc lase c rystals,
tion are embedded in an altered pyroxenite and poikilitically overgrown by clinopyroxene, lo-
gabbroic matrices (Fig. 5b). Towards the south- cally showing pegmatoid texture. Plagioclase
ern part of the breccia zone, chromite nodules (labradorite), augite and hypersthene are es-
of varying sizes are engulfed within coarse sential minerals. Chromite of different sizes is
grained gabbro (Fig. 5c). Presence of vermicu- present with interstitial plagioc lase,
lar chalcopyrite in ferritchromite is a striking c linopyroxene and partly altered
textural feature indicating late stage formation orthopyroxene.
for the chromite of Ganga-Shankar lode (Fig.
5d). The matrix rock is mineralized with vari- Sulfide mineralization occurs in the matrix of
able PGE concentrations in both sulphide and the breccia zone and more commonly within
non-sulphide carriers. the chromitite fragments. Sulfides occur as
veins, stringers, and irregular pockets in the
matrix rocks of the breccia zone. The gabbroic
rocks in the hanging wall portion of the breccia
31
MPT-2013
zone contain disseminated sulfides in intersti- of Naldrett (2004) and closely similar to Lac
tial spaces of silicates. Concentration of sulfides des Iles deposit (Hinchey et al., 2005).
in chromite-sulfide assemblage is more in the Broadly speaking, two types of mineralization
northern part than the southern part of the have been identified in the breccia zone de-
breccia zone. pending on the prime PG element, principal
host mineral and the environment of
Primary sulfide minerals viz.. chalcopyrite, mineralisation. They are type 1 and type 2.
pyrrhotite, pentlandite and pyrite occur in Type-1 mineralisation has taken place in a sul-
ferritchromite- and sulfide- rich breccia zone. phide poor magmatic environment within the
(Mohanty, 1994). PGE bearing sulfide minerals Bangur gabbro, near its contact with the ul-
have been reported from matrix materials of tramafic complex. This is characterized by high
altered pyroxenite in the Breccia Zone of the platinum (upto 14ppm) and low Pd contents
composite Ganga- Shankar lodes of Boula- (between 0.8 and 1 ppm) and high Pt/Pd value
Nausahi Complex. It is observed that the brec- (8-9) and prominent towards southern part of
cia zone consists of varieties of rock types in- the breccia zone. The mineral assemblage is
cluding chromite. The rock types are analysed dominated by isoferroplatinum, braggite,
for their PGE content to find out the major host malanite, sperrylite and laurite. In this asso-
and the data are given in Table 2. ciation, PGM occur mainly as inclusions in
ferritchromites and associated silicates (plagio-
Table 2: PGE in different rock types of the clase, pyroxene). Type-2 mineralisation is re-
breccia zone (in ppm) stricted to the hydrothermally altered matrix
Elements Gabbro Pyroxenite Dunite BMS Normal Ferritchromite of the breccia zone towards its northern part
(N= 20) (N=10) (N=5) (N=5) Chromite (N=10)
(N=5) and associated with the base metal sulphides
Pt 0.003 -.290 0.003 - 1.580 0.012 0.644 - 1.245 0.008 - 0.102 0.265 - 2.395
Pd 0.002 -.44 0.007 - 2.876 0.011 1.417 - 2.876 0.007 - 0.050 0.228 - 2.672 and ferritchromite. Depending on base metal
Ru 0.002 - 0.114 0.001 - 0.218 0.046 0.04 - 0.171 0.023 - 0.074 0.054 - 0.31
Ir 0 - 0.052 0.0002 - 0.110 0.011 0.01 - 0.062 0.001 - 0.066 0.015 - 0.039 sulfide content, this is divided into two sub-
Rh 0.0002 - 0.013 0.0002 - 0.049 0.001 0.037 - 0.132 0.0004 - 0.005 0.004 - 0.613
Os 0.0004-0.039 0.0002-0.063 0.010 0-0.048 0.002-0.060 0.012-0.016 types; Type-2A & B. Type 2A mineralization is
∑PGE 0.02-0.661 0.026-0.293 0.02-0.15 0.75-3.756 0.02-0.143 0.882-4.583
Ag 0.078-0.544 0.070-6.094 0.321 0.232-18.142 0.051-0.468 0.083-6.975 associated with BMS without ferritchromite.
Au 0.003-0.064 0.006-0.665 0.011 0.66-0.75 0.003-0.022 0.006-0.162
It is Pd dominant (Pt/Pd <1). The sulfide min-
(N= No. of analyses) eral assemblage consists of chalcopyrite, pyr-
From the above data, it is observed that rhotite, pentlandite, violarite, millerite and
ferritchromite and BMS are important hosts for pyrite. The PG minerals are mainly sudburyite,
PGE mineralisation. It is also observed that pres- sperrylite, and Pd-Bi-Te-Sb minerals. Miner-
ence of BMS/ferritchromite enhances the PGM als of cobaltite-gersdorffite solid solution se-
c ontent of the rocks. Roc ks with BMS/ ries are found to be present (Mondal et al.
ferritchromite have more PGM than rocks with- 2001).The sulfide minerals generally occur in-
out them. terstitially to hydrothermal silicates. Type-2B
is mostly free of BMS and platinum dominant
2.4. Style of mineralization (Pt/Pd – 2-3). PGE mineral phases are from the
The PGE mineralization in the Baula Nuasahi Pt-Sb-As system (geversite, sperrylite) coexist
complex is restricted to the breccia zone with Pd antimony (mertieite-II).
(Mondal and Baidya 1997). It is a discordant From the above discussion, it is clear that the
type of mineralization akin to discordant type sulphide-rich rocks (± ferritchromite) are domi-
nated by Pd whereas the ferritchromite bear-
32
MPT-2013
ing sulfide- free rocks are systematically Pt- in nature. Braggite contains lower values of Fe,
rich. The PGMs are found in association mostly Cu, Co and Rh, Ir, Os. Under SEM, braggite is
with ferritchromite and BMS (Base metal sul- found to be homogenous in composition. Auge
phide) and less prominently in silicate matrix. et al. (2002) described zoning in braggite where
the concentration of Pt is more in the core and
2.5. Mineralogy Pd is more in the rim. Veryn and Merkle (1994)
The PGMs are present as tiny grains in almost concluded that the Ni content of braggite de-
all the lithounits of the breccia zone. Because of pends on the temperature of formation. Braggite
their extreme small size, they are identified and with a lower Ni content indicates a lower tem-
analysed by EPMA (Table 3). Some of the im- perature of formation in S-rich environments.
portant PGMs are discussed below: Laurite: Laurite is mainly found in silicate ma-
Sperrylite: Sperrylite is present in sulfide bear- trix of ferritchromite with grain size ranging
ing pyroxenite. It is anhedral in nature. The from very small to 15 x 20 µm (Fig. 6g). It is
grains are fine and occur within chromite and reported from both the types of mineralization
at the silicate-chromite interface (Fig. 6a ). It is (Auge et al.,2002). Laurite is present as well de-
also reported from sulfide and silicate environ- veloped euhedral to subhedral crystals. Minor
ments (Fig. 6 b & c). Sperrylite is found to be amounts of Fe, Ni, Cu, Rh and Sb are present in
associated with geversite as two-phase grains laurite.
and more abundant in hydrothermal BMS rich Merenskyite: Merenskyite is found in base
mineralization. It shows coupled substitution metal sulfide assemblage. It shows little varia-
of Sb+S for As similar to sperrylite from tion from the ideal composition of PdTe2 with
Sudbury c omplex, Canada (Cabri and considerable amounts of Pt upto 6.5 wt % and
Laflamme, 1976). Pd, Rh, Fe, Ni, Cu and Co are Bi upto 30.83 wt %. Auge et al. (2002) also have
present in minor to trace amounts. reported Pt and Bi upto 6.15 and 22.52 wt %
Sudburyite: Sudburyite is reported from sul- respectively. The present composition as almost
fides present in rocks (gabbro and pyroxenite), similar to the composition reported from other
ferritchromite and silicates associated with complexes.
BMS. It occurs as subhedral grains marginally Testibiopalladite: Testibiopalladite is present
included within euhedral chromite grain (Fig. in silicate vein in ferritchromite (Fig. 6h) and
6d) and exsolution in ferritchromite (Fig. 5e) also included in a pentlandite vein. The grains
Sudburyite grains ranges from fine size to are euhedral to subhedral with very fine grain
(25x50) µm. Pd content is almost in equal pro- size to around 15-20 µm. Ni, S, Fe, Ag and Bi are
portion with Sb and composition approaches present in fairly considerable amounts while
very c lose to the ideal PdSb with minor Co, Ir and As are present in trace amounts.
amounts of Ni and traces of Pt, Cu and As. Te Hollingworthite: Hollingworthite is found as
(upto 5.37 wt %) and Bi (upto 5.56 wt %) substi- small crystals of the size <1 µm in ferritchromite
tute Sb as in the case of nickeloan variety of (Fig. 6i). It is found in both types of mineraliza-
sudburyite (Cabri and Laflamme ,1974). tion in the form of discrete and complex asso-
Braggite: Braggite occurs in ferritchromite ciation. It contains appreciable amounts of Pd
with sulfide association in breccia zone (Fig. which may have substituted Rh. Pt and Fe are
6f). However, Auge et al. (2002) have reported present in the range of 1.65-6.15 and 2.83-4.57
braggite from BMS free environment. The grains wt % respectively. It contains minor amounts
are of very small (25 x 15µm) size and anhedral
33
MPT-2013
in size. S, Ni, Cu, Rh and Pd occur as minor S 0.13 35.94 2.01 16.34 0.08 14.64 3.09 0.00 28.47 2.28
Fe 0.62 0.12 0.13 0.16 1.52 3.57 3.90 0.00 11.27 9.13
elements. Ni 0.10 0.11 0.20 4.29 0.10 0.86 5.34 0.00 0.39 1.05
Cu 0.31 0.05 1.4 0.02 2.18 0.00 0.01 0.00 21.16 1.56
Pd 47.10 0.53 0.10 15.68 23.25 7.74 25.38 25.96 0.15 1.70
34
MPT-2013
observed that PGMs in the breccia zone of BNIC larities to occurrences at UG2 and Platreef of
exhibit different elemental affinity. However, S.Africa and Great Dyke, Zimbabwe. Type 2 is
affinity towards Sb/Bi/Sn/Te is more pro- hydrothermal in nature and prominent in the
nounced. northern part of the breccia zone. PGM is con-
fined to hydrothermally altered matrix of the
3. Discussion breccia zone. PGM and BMS are associated with
Mineralogical characterisation of an ore deposit hydrous silicates such as amphibole, mica, chlo-
has dual importance as it (i) provides genetic rite, apatite and ferritchromite etc. The hydrous
information i e., about the source and physico- minerals were formed during late magmatic
chemical environment of formation of a deposit evolution of Bangur gabbro without introduc-
and (ii) plays a critical role in optimum utiliza- tion of external fluids and with deuteric fluids.
tion of scarce natural resources. It helps in the Abundance of hydrous silicates indicates that
selection of suitable recovery method and dic- residual phase was dominated by fluid. BMS
tates the process flow sheet and plant flow are related to a fluid rich hydrothermal stage
sheet optimization (Petruk and Hughson, 1977, with crystallization temperature in the range
Cabri, 1981b, Henley, 1983, Xiao and Laplante, of 300-500oC. Contribution from the country
2004). Although advanced ore characterisation rock is negated by isotopic study (O/H for sili-
techniques are available, there is a distinct cates and S for BMS). The fluid was generated
problem in characterizing the PGM because of by the crystallization of silicates at a magmatic
their low tenor as well as fine grain size. This stage in the gabbro and became concentrated
problem can be overcome by pre-concentra- in the breccia zone at the top of the magmatic
tion techniques such as gravity, magnetic or system.
flotation or a combination of these techniques. The low grade PGE mineralisation in the brec-
Hence mineralogy plays a critical role in selec- cia zone of the Boula Nuasahi igneous complex
tion of suitable beneficiation technique(s) for is related to late intrusion of Bangur gabbro
processing of such ores. and is a cumulative effect of both magmatic and
From the mineralogical study, it is observed hydrothermal processes.
that two types of PGE mineralisation is present Sulfides occur as veins, stringers, and irregu-
in the breccia zone of the BNIC. Type 1 is mag- lar pockets in the matrix of the breccia zone.
matic in nature and prominent in the southern The gabbroic rocks in the hanging wall side of
part of the breccia zone. In this type, PGM are the breccia zone contain disseminated sulfides.
present as inclusions in pyroxene and plagio- Chalcopyrite, pyrrhotite, pentlandite and py-
clase that suggest early crystallization in the rite are the common sulfide minerals. The PGE
evolution of the magma. As there is no signifi- mineralogy in sulfide rich assemblages is domi-
cant PGE anomaly in the ultramafic rocks of nated by Pd, Pt, Sb, Bi, Te, S and/or As bearing
the complex and chromitite layers, it is pre- phases, e.g., sudburyite, mic henerite,
sumed that the source of PGE may be the gab- testibiopalladite, sperrylite, merenskyite and
bro itself with precipitation of PGM being pro- palladium bearing melonite, irarsite and
voked by sudden changes in physic-chemical hollingworthite. These minerals are present as
conditions due to incorporation of partial di- tiny inclusions in sulfides.
gested ultramafic materials. The PGM miner- Like many other deposits, PGMs at BNIC are
alogy is characteristics of high temperature and associated with ferritchromite with or with-
magmatic sulfide free and shows striking simi- out BMS (Razin et al. 1965, Naldrett and
35
MPT-2013
Cabri,1976; Vermaak and Hendriks,1976, Cous- and chromite are mixed up to form a hybrid
ins and Vermaak,1976). The mineral assem- matrix. Two types of PGE mineralisation have
blage is dominated by isoferroplatinum, been identified in this breccia zone represent-
braggite, malanite, sperrylite and laurite. In ing both magmatic and hydrothermal milieu.
this association, PGM occur mainly as inclu- Two types of mineralisation exhibit contrast-
sions in ferritchromites and associated silicates ing mineralogical characteristics. Pt is domi-
(plagioclase, pyroxene). nant in southern part where chromite is the
principal host and Pd is dominant towards
It is a difficult proposition to assess the asso- north with BMS as the important host. PGM
ciation of PGEs in silicates. Exact quantifica- are reported from all the matrices such as
tion of PGMs in different hosts is a very diffi- chromite, sulfide and silicate in the breccia zone.
cult task as the rocks and ores in the breccia The PGM are very fine grained and display
zone are thoroughly mixed due to intrusion various textural dispositions in chromite, sul-
and brecciation resulting in a hybrid assem- fide and silicate. PGM are mostly present as
blage. As is the case with Sudbury, Merensky included grains in sulfide, inclusions and
reef and Plat reef where a significant portion exsolutions in ferritchromite. Some PGM are
of minute PGMs, occur as interstitial grains also present as inclusions within silicates
and as solid solutions in silicates (Sizgoric, whic h are in turn present within
1984; Kinloch, 1982; Merkle, 1992; Maier et al., ferrochromite. The sulfide assemblage is rep-
1999, Peyerl, 1982; Bryson, 2008), at BNIC the resented mainly by chalcopyrite, pyrrhotite,
PGMs are also found as discrete grains in the pentlandite and pyrite. Minor amounts of mil-
silicate matrix (often as clusters). The silicates lerite, bravoite, cubanite, geversite, cobaltite are
may be with or without ferritchromite asso- also found to be present. The southern part is
ciation. Some of the PGM are reported from predominated by ferrochromite with very less
secondary silicates such as apatite, tremolite inter granular BMS.
etc. Any scheme to recover/pre-concentrate PGE
values from this complicated matrix material,
As PGMs are associated with ferritchromite needs thorough assessment of the different fa-
which is magnetic in nature, pre-concentra- cies; both qualitatively and quantitatively for
tion of PGM can be tried by magnetic separa- PGE content and a combination of beneficiation
tion by reducing the size of the ROM by stage techniques may be adopted to concentrate the
grinding. Similarly, the sulfide hosted PGM can PGE values from such a low tenor hybrid ma-
be pre-concentrated by flotation technique. trix material of the breccia zone of BNIC. The
These pre-concentrated materials can be used chromite (± BMS) can be concentrated by a
to extract PGE values. combination of processes such as gravity sepa-
ration followed by magnetic separation (as
4. Conclusion chromite is highly magnetic). As in practice at
The breccia zone that hosts PGE mineraliza- UG-2, where chromite is being concentrated
tion has resulted due to intrusion of coarse by flotation, flotation can be tried upon for the
grained gabbro into the preexisting ultrama- concentration of chromite at BNIC.
fic-mafic sequence. This intrusion has resulted The spatial distribution of PGM in this breccia
in dismemberment of the rocks/chromite of zone is very complex because of the intimate
earlier formation. Due to brecciation, the rocks association of three major hosts viz. chromite,
36
MPT-2013
sulfide and silicate. The intermingling of sili- Cousins, C. A. and Vermaak, C. F., 1976. The
cates has resulted in a low tenor and needs pre- contribution of Southern African ore de-
concentration before recovery of PGM from posits to the geochemistry of the plati-
this complex matrix association. Looking at the num group metals. Econ. Geol., 71, 287-
complexity of the PG mineralization and host 305.
rock/mineral association, the low grade ore of Devaraju, T. C., Alapieti, T. T., Kaukonen, R. J.,
this breccia zone can be processed by a combi- Sudhakara, T. L. and Anatha murthy, K.
nation of processes depending on specific S. 2009. Geochemistry of the PGE miner-
physical characters to recover/pre-concentrate alized petrologic al units of the
the PGE values. Hanumalapur segment of the Channagiri
mafic -ultramafic c omplex, Western
Acknowledgement Dharwar craton, South India. Intl. Symp.
The authors are thankful to Prof. B. K. Mishra, Magmatic Ore Deposits (ISMO-09),
Director, CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar for his Bhubaneswar, 55-56.
kind permission to carry out this work. The Freeman, C., 2003. Mineral beneficiation of the
financial support by Ministry of Mines, Govt. platinum group elements: A review
of India, is highly acknowledged. through the hand-lens. J. Eng. Mining, 3,
241-245.
Reference Henley, K. J., 1983. Ore-dressing mineralogy: A
review of techniques, applications and
Auge, T., Salpeteur, I., Bailly, I., Mukherjee, M. recent developments. Geol. Soc. S. Africa
M. and Patra, R. N. 2002. Magmatic and spl. Publn. 7, 175-200.
hydrothermal Platinum Group Minerals Hinchey, J. G., Hattori, K. H. and Lavigne, M. J.,
and base metal sulfides in the Baula Com- 2005. Geology, petrology, and controls on
plex, India. Can. Min., 40, 277-309. PGE mineralization of the southern Roby
Bryson, M., 2008. Review of metallurgical char- and Twilight Zones, Lac des Iles Mine,
acteristics of Akanani ore. Mintek re- Canada. Econ. Geol., 100, 43-61.
stricted presentation, 22 January 2008. Kinloch E.D., 1982. Regional trends in the plati-
Cabri, L. J. 1981. Relationship of mineralogy to num group mineralogy of the Bushveld
the recovery of platinum-group elements Complex, S.Africa. Econ.Geol. 77, 1328-
from ores. In: Cabri, L.J. (Ed.), Platinum 1347
Group Elements: Mineralogy, Geology, Maier, W. D. & Barnes, S. J., 1999. Platinum
Recovery. Canadian Institute of Mining group elements in silicate rocks the lower,
and Metallurgy, Spl. Vol. 23, 233-252. critical and main zones at Union section,
Cabri, L. J. and Laflamme, J. H. G., 1974. western Bushveld Complex, J.Petrol. 40,
Sudburyite, a new palladium-antimony 1647-1671.
mineral from Sudbury, Ontario. Can. Min., Mohanty, J. K., 1994. The geology, mineralogy
12, 275-279. and geochemistry of the igneous complex
Cabri, L. J. and Laflamme, J. H. G., 1976. The around Boula, Keonjhar district, Orissa
mineralogy of the platinum-group ele- with particular reference to the associ-
ments from some copper-nickel deposits ated economic minerals, Unpublished
of the Sudbury area. Econ. Geol., 71, 1159- Ph.D. thesis, Utkal University, Orissa, In-
1195. dia
37
MPT-2013
Mondal, S. K., and Baidya, T. K., 1997. Platinum- Peyerl,W., 1982. The influence of the Driekop
group minerals from the Nuasahi ultra- dunite pipe on the platinum group min-
mafic-mafic complex, Orissa, India. Min. eralogy of the UG-2 chromitites in its vi-
Mag. 61, 902–906. cinity. Econ.Geol.77, 1432-1438
Mondal, S. K., Baidya, T. K., Rao, K. N. G. and Razin, L.V., Khvostov, V.J. and Norikov, V.A.,
Glascock, M. D., 2001. PGE and Ag miner- 1965. Platinum metals in the essential
alization in a breccia zone of the Precam- and accessory minerals of ultramafic
brian Nuasahi ultramafic-mafic complex, rocks. Geochem. Int., 2, 118-131.
Orissa, India. Can. Min., 39, 979-996. Singh, P. K., and Farooqui, S. A. 2009. PGE-Au-
Merkle, R.K.W., 1992. Platinum group minerals Ag hosted rocks of Ikauna area, district
in the middle group of chromitite layers at Lalitpur, U.P: Its implication to be a PGE
Marikana, western Bushveld Complex: in- deposits of India. Intl. Symp. Magmatic
dication for collection mechanism of post Ore Deposits (ISMO-09), Bhubaneswar,
magmatic modifications. Can.J.Earth Sci. 51.
29, 209-221. Sizgoric, M.B., 1985. Tracking platinum group
Naldrett, A. J., 2004. Magmatic sulfide deposits: minerals in the milling of cu-Ni ores at
Geology, geochemistry and exploration, Sudbury. In: proceedings of the 9th Intl.
Springer-Verlag. Precious Metals Institute Conf., N.Y., 923-
Naldrett, A. J., and Cabri, L. J., 1976. Ultramafic 932.
and related mafic rocks: their classification U.S. Geological Survey (USGS) 2011: Commod-
and genesis with special reference to the ity statistics and information, platinum
concentration of nickel-sulphides and group metals: http://minerals.usgs.gov/
platinum-group elements. Econ. Geol., 71, minerals/pubs/commodity.
1131-1158. Vermaak, C. F., and Hendriks, L. P., 1976. A re-
Nanda, J. K., and Patra, R. N., 1993. Search for view of the mineralogy of the Merensky
platinum in Boula-Nausahi sec tor, reef with specific reference to new data
Keonjhar district, Orissa. Extended ab- on the precious metal mineralogy. Econ.
stract, Records of the GSI, 127 (3), 67-68. Geol., 71, 1244-1269.
Nathan, N. P., Vijay Kumar, R., Balukkarasu, A. Veryn, S. M. C., and Merkle, R. K. W., 1994.
and Sesha Sai, V. V., 2009. Petrography and Compositional variation of cooperite,
c harac terisation of PGE ores in braggite and vysotskite from the
Chettiyampalaiyam block in Sittampundi Bushveld Complex. Min. Mag., 58, 223-
anorthosite complex, Tamil Nadu. Intl. 234.
Symp. Magmatic Ore Deposits (ISMO-09), Xiao, Z., and Laplante, A.R., 2004. Character-
Bhubaneswar, 53-54. izing and recovering the platinum group
Petruk, W., and Hughson, M.R., 1977. Image minerals-a review. Min Eng., 17, 961-979.
analysis evaluation of the effect of grind-
ing media on selective flotation of two
zinc–lead–copper ores. CIM Bull. 70, l28-
135.
38
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
39
MPT-2013
EIOC may be regional linear structural ridge, The Chilpi Ghat series is divisible in to two
starting from Bailadila iron ore deposits in groups, the older meta-volcanic and the
south (average altitude 1200 m) and in north younger meta-sediments. The meta-volcanics
(average altitude 550 m) through Rowghat, are primarily composed of tuffaceous rock of
Hahaladdi, Aridongri and Dalli-Rajhara iron intermediate composition. The passage from
ore deposits of Chhattisgarh. This iron ore volcanics to the sedimentaries is apparently
deposits are known as Eklama Iron Ore Complex without any hiatus, as no separating
(EIOC) because of this iron ore deposits conglomerate beds are noted. In Chilpi-Borla
encountered near village of Eklama. EIOC is section a sandstone horizon with wave type
present in Tahsil Sahapur, Lohara, Kabirdham ripple marks and thin intercalation of chert
district falling under the SOI topo sheet no. 64 bands immediately overlie the metavolcanics.
G/1. The metasedimentary sequence is dominantly
EIOC is hosted within Chilpi Group of rock and composed of interbedded sequence of phyllite
associated with the ferruginous pink and white and shales. Sandstone is found mostly at top of
quartzite, shale and volcanic slate/argillite the sequence and in narrow zones in the lower
rocks. EIOC is possesses similarity with the parts. Lenses of quartzitic composition mostly
Bailadila iron formation although Chilpi Ghat of unmappable dimension occur within the
Group is younger than Bailadila Group and as phyllites. A zone of hematite-Jasper occurs as a
such no detailed literature is available on the narrow, nearly continuous bed toward the
geochemistry and geology of this deposits. lower part of the metasedimentary sequence.
C. Tripathi et al (1973-74) eluc idated The basement rocks exposed in the area are
stratigraphy and structure of the Chilpi Ghat mostly andesite and rhyolite of Pitepani
rocks. Although fragmentary information is volcanic belonging to Nandgaon Group of
provides by (Tripathi et al 1981; Rao 1981), there Dongargarh Supergroup. Chilpi Group
is a scarcity of published literature regarding comprises of quartzite, shale, slate, phyllite,
the stratigraphic status and other genetic aspect argillite, ferruginous sandstone, jasperoid,
of the Chlilpi Ghat Group rocks. massive iron ore, B.H.Q., B.M.Q., jaspilite (B.H.J.),
The present study embodies the result carried limestone, dolomite and basal conglomerate etc.
out on the geological characteristic of iron ore Most of the limestone and dolomite of Chilpi
deposits, and geochemistry of EIOC. Group of rock are crystalline in nature and at
places spec ks of pyrite and c halcopyrite
2. Geology of the area
recorded. The rocks of Chilpi occur in the area
The Chilpi group of rocks occur along the
in North-South trending two distinct flanks,
eastern flank of the Maikal range from
which are divided by the Pitepani volcanics and
Kabirdham (22 0 0’:810 15’) in the North to
Deccan trap in the central portion. The general
Lohara (210 50’:810 08’) in the South. The beds
strike direction is NNE-SSW with high dips up
strike N-S with moderate dips towards East.
to 450 towards East. At places, fold and fault
The rocks of the Chhattisgarh Super group lie
have been also occurring. The rocks of Chilpi
to the East of the Chilpi group of rocks and in
Group rocks is have steep dips towards the west
the Chilpi Ghat series are c onfined by
however at places change in dip direction is
horizontal to sub-horizontal infra-trappeans
also observed which may be due to folding.
and the Dec c an basalts. A low grade
Sarkar (1957) reported canoe shape folding in
metamorphic impress is observed in the Chilpi
this area. By the nature of contact of different
group of rock.
40
MPT-2013
41
MPT-2013
and K2O in wt.%. The marked enrichment of iron high value of the CaO+MgO. It is suggested a
in all ore sample is attributed to the effective near absence of calcite and dolomite. TiO2 bears
removal of SiO2, MgO and CaO (Gutzmer et al a positive moderate correlation (0.5) with Al2O3
2008). in iron ore (Fig no.1). Aluminium and titanium
In iron ore TiO2 concentration ranges between are considered to be generally immobile during
0.073 to 0.121 wt.% with an average 0.098 wt.%. hydrothermal, digenetic and weathering
High grade iron ore is depleted in CaO+MgO, processes (MacLean and Kranidiotis 1987).
only one sample (R-21) shows exceptionally Alkali content (K2O+Na2O) in iron ore represents
less amount.
Table No.1: Bulk composition of EIOC irons ore R-3 and R-19 is BIF.
sample Al 2 O3 LOI Na2 O
Fe % SiO2 % S% P% TiO2 % MnO % CaO% MgO% K 2 O%
ID % % %
R-6 68.10 1.12 0.69 0.006 0.066 0.121 0.037 0.47 0.008 0.009 0.004 0.006
R-8 67.47 0.88 0.94 0.006 0.159 0.090 0.027 0.48 0.226 0.032 0.014 0.021
R-10 67.35 0.87 0.96 0.007 0.178 0.110 0.014 0.48 0.441 0.039 0.021 0.013
R-15 65.11 2.62 2.14 0.008 0.076 0.120 0.035 1.48 0.011 0.016 0.009 0.012
R-20 67.60 1.12 0.84 0.006 0.064 0.070 0.011 0.66 0.021 0.014 0.011 0.009
R-21 64.95 1.76 1.78 0.007 0.275 0.110 0.041 0.92 1.36 0.139 0.019 0.026
R-22 65.18 4.74 0.78 0.006 0.115 0.070 0.024 0.64 0.022 0.032 0.018 0.021
R-3 27.63 53.64 3.80 0.007 0.075 0.112 0.009 2.40 0.018 0.022 0.016 0.009
R-19 34.43 45.13 3.47 0.008 0.075 0.110 0.058 1.82 0.011 0.009 0.006 0.008
(A) (B)
(C) (D)
42
MPT-2013
(E) (F)
(G) (H)
(I)
(J)
43
MPT-2013
around Bacheli, Dist. Bastar, C.G., Phd thesis, geochemistry of the high-grade iron ores
pp148. of the Aguas Claras Mine and
comparison with the Capao Xavier and
Dasgupta, D.J., Pal, R.N., Roy, S.K., 1982. Chilpi
Tamanduá iron ore deposits,
Ghat group of Roc k along some
Quadrilatero Ferrifero, Brazil, Miner
Selected Traverses in the Balaghat at M.P.,
Deposita, Springer, pp.229–254.
GSI project progress report.
Spierra, C. A., Maria, S., Rosiere, C. A., 2003.
Mukharjee, A., 1999. Ore Genesis (A holistic
Geology and geochemistry of the A´ guas
approach), allied Pub., Ltd, pp. 637.
Claras and Pico Iron Mines, Quadrilatero
Roy, S., Venkatesh, A. S., 2009. Mineralogy and Ferrýfero, Minas Gerais, Brazil,
geochemistry of banded iron formation Mineralium Deposita , Springer, pp.751–
and iron ores from eastern India with 774.
implications on their genesis, J.Earth Syst.
Tripathi, C., Ghosh, P.K., Chandra, S., (1973-74).
Sci. 118, pp.619–641.
Eluc idation of Stratigraphy and
Spierra, C. A., Maria, S., Rosiere, C. A., Ardisson, Structure of the Chilpi Group, Balaghat,
J. D., 2008. Mineralogy and trace-element GSI project progress report.
*******
44
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Keywords: Gua ore, Kiriburu goethite, XRD, liberation study, petrological study
* Correspending Author: : Sa nja y Hembram, Mineral
Processing Div ision, CSIR- Na tio nal Metallurgical
Laboratory, Jamshedpur-831007
Email: snjhembram@gmail.com
45
MPT-2013
46
MPT-2013
E: Fe: 61.4% LOI : 3.1% F: Fe: 64.7% LOI:3.5%, G: Preparation of Polish Section
Fe: 61.4%, LOI : 2.7%, The concentrate sample from Gua mine was
(a) +210 µ crushed to -74 µ (b) +149 µ crushed to studied in microscope the sample were size
-74 µ fraction of (+250#), (+350#), (-350#). Sample
© +105 µ crushed to -74 µ (d) + 74 µ crushed to were mounted for polishing. The rough surface
-74 µ
of the sample ground initially with 80 meshes
(e) + 63 µ (f) +38 µ (g) -38 µ
for 30 minutes, then further ground down using
600 mesh c arborandum powders for 30
minutes. Eac h sample were ground with
Manual Polishing Machine using different
silicon carbide water-proof paper (400, 600, 800,
1000, 1200 mesh) for 20 minute each to achieve
a topographically relief free surface. The
samples were polished using Disc Polisher with
1 micron diamond grit for 30 minutes, followed
Fig. 3: Sieve vis-à-vis chemical analyses by ¼ micron diamond grit papers for another
of the concentrate 30 minutes to achieve a good reflectance and
2.1.2. Kiriburu goethitic ore scratch free surface.
Highly goethitic ore where c ollec ted Polished sections were prepared from selected
handpicked and collected from the Kiriburu samples for ore petrographic studies. Fresh Iron
mines of SAIL was studied. Samples were ore samples from Kiriburu were cut as polish
collected from the mine site in form of run-of- section for microscopic studies. The section was
mine ore (ROM) which consists of boulders, further cut down to required size using
lumps. The color of the ore generally varies from Logitech cutting and lapping machine (10 inch
Grey to shades of reddish brown to pale white. diameter diamond saw) desired size. The rest
All the ores have a distinct earthy luster and procedure polishing adopted for the Gua ore
are granular to angular in form. concentrate was subsequently followed.
The sample thus collected for beneficiation Microscopic Study
studies at NML was crushed to below 30 mm Polished sec tions were studied and
and was characterized. It is found that the photographs were taken using a Leica-make
normal crushing operation yielded ~64 wt.% optical petrological microscope having both
lumps (-30+10 mm), ~28 wt.% fines (-6+0.15 reflected and transmitted light facilities using
mm) and ~ 8 wt.% ultra-fines (-0.15mm). 5x, 10x, and 20x, 50x dry-objectives and with
oil objective.
2.2. Methods
2.2.1. XRD study 2.2.3. Liberation study
XRD studies of the samples ,ground to -200 # Screen Analysis
size was carried out with Co- Ká radiation The specimen samples of Kiriburu goethitic ore
using X-ray diffraction machine in 2è range were crushed manually using iron mortar to a
10- 120 degrees. size of around 10#. Then crushed sample were
2.2.2. Petrological study homogenized by conventional coning-
The ore was studied under Petrological optical
microscope and Petrological zooming stereo
microscope.
47
MPT-2013
quartering method. Half of the sample were kept Major Phase: Hematite [2.70 (100), 2.52 (60), 1.69
as head sample and another half were sieved (45), 1.84 (35)]
(Both Wet and Dry sieving) to different micron Minor Phase: Gibbsite, Al(OH)3 [4.85 (55),
size (-10+14) mesh, (-14+20) mesh, (- 2.45(20)]
20+30)mesh, (-30+48)mesh, (-48+65) mesh, (- Minor Phase: Goethite, áFe(OH) [4.18(37), 2.45,
2.69, 1.72(16)]
65+100) mesh, (-100+150) mesh, (-150+200)
mesh, (-200+250) mesh, and (-250+300) mesh. He
High LOI Goethatic Iron ore
d=2.70105
using vibratory sieve shaker. Weight percent
1800
1700
1600
1400 Go
d=4.18016
1300
d=2.51802
1100
Lin (Counts)
G
d=4.85394
b He
1000
d=3.68454
He
d=1.69577
d=2.44740
900
d=4.99208
800 He
d=1.84140
He
5005393
88410645
700
d=1.45
Go
d=1.71497
d=1.48649
d=2.1d=2.2
d=2.58173
600 Go Go He
d=1.4
d=1.31139
d=2.25215
08
d=1.60014
607
622
500
d=1.79906
d=1.05573
d=1.10309
d=1.5
d=0.96029
d=0.95151
d=1.25547
d=1.5
delineate the liberation characteristics of the
400
300
200
2-Theta - Scale
mineral and interlocked grain by manual grain High LOI Goethatic Iron ore - File: High LOI Goethatic Iron ore.raw - Type: 2T h/Th locked - Start: 6.000 ° - End: 120.009 ° - Step: 0.020 ° - Step time: 86.4 s - Temp.: 25 °C (Room) - Time Started: 9 s - 2-Th
Operations: Import
counting method.
Fig. 4b: XRD of Kiriburu high LOI iron ore
Major Phase: Goethite [4.18(71.7)), 2.58 (26.5),
Table 1: Weight percent of different sieve
fraction 2.25 (21.7), 1.60 (21.2)]
1St LOT 2nd LOT
Minor Phase: Gibbsite, Al(OH)3 [4.85 (51.2)
Size in mesh Wt. in gm Wt. % Wt. in gm Wt. % Avg. Wt. % Minor Phase: Hematite, áFe(OH) [3.68(48.7),
(+10) 440 91.10 817 83.45 87.27 2.70(100), 1.84(34.6), 1.31(22)]
(+14) 14.9 3.08 54.74 5.59 4.34
(+30) 5.2 1.08 23.07 2.36 1.72
(+48) 6.1 1.26 29.17 2.98 2.12
3.2. Morphological characteristics
(+65) 2.6 0.54 5.89 0.60 0.57
(+100) 1.6 0.33 11.38 1.16 0.75 a) Gua Ore Concentrate
(+150) 1.4 0.29 5.16 0.53 0.41
(+200) 1.3 0.27 5.73 0.59 0.43 Fig. 5 shows the view of grain having size
(+250) 1.2 0.25 2.25 0.23 0.24
(+300) 0.2 0.04 1.01 0.10 0.07
fractions, -74 µ and -40 µ in zooming stereo-
(-300) 8.45 1.75 23.65 2.42 2.08 microscope in 50x pix.
Total 482.95 99.99 979.05 100.00 100.00
600
(a) (b)
500
d=2.51735
d=1.69582
d=3.68322
d=1.45002 d=1.45368
d=1.84185
d=2.20673
d=1.48628
200
d=2.44865
5
d=1.59901
19
d=1.10337
08
31
d=1.13775
d=1.02339
d=1.80099
.3
d=1.00094
1
==
dd 1.
100
0
b) Kiriburu Goethitic Ore
6 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120
2-Theta - Scale
gua iron ore - File: gua iron ore.raw - Type: 2Th/Th locked - Start: 6.000 ° - End: 120.009 ° - Step: 0.020 ° - Step time: 21.6 s - Temp.: 25 °C (Room) - Time Started: 8 s - 2-Theta: 6.000 ° - Theta: 3.000 ° -
Oper ations: Impo rt
The ore samples where lumpy, rough to touch,
and laminated with an iron, silica, kaolinitic
Fig. 4a: XRD of Gua iron ore concentrate clay, quartz, gibbsite and limonitic matter.The
48
MPT-2013
ores where crystalline in nature. The colors of often showing a layered appearance. Minor
the ore generally vary from shades of yellows, impurity in form of c lays oc curs in the
reddish brown. The streak of the ore was found weathering pits and micro-fractures. However,
to be reddish brown in color. The ore has a majority of the ore fall in the category of
distinct earthy luster and granular in form. The lateritized-type which was of varied character.
ores sample was not fresh and weathering effect They vary from iron-rich hard lateritic ores to
was visible to the naked eye. Photographs of alumina-rich soft lateritic ores and are porous.
the samples studied are presented in figure In the lateritic ores goethite is the major ore
(Fig.6a and 6b). mineral and occurred in various forms such as
vitreous, colloform bands, fine crystals, spongy,
and earthy etc. The pores had been often filled
with clays. The minerals, clays, silica, gibbsite
and limonitic matter were found to be very
intricately bound by goethite. Sometimes this
intricacy occurred in very fine sizes (in micron
levels) that has put restric tion on their
(a) (b)
Fig. 6 (a) & (b): Photographs of the samples liberation behaviour.
Therefore, it is expected that very fine grinding
3.3. Microscopic characteristics may be required to release liberate these grains
from the hematite. Conversely, the silica also
a) Gua Ore Concentrate contains iron minerals. Clay impurities being
The microscopic examination shows that the mainly confined to fractures and cavities can
hematite crystallites coalesce forming larger be easily exposed and removed by washing.
polygonal grains in matrix of goethite along The microscopic examination shows the early
with clay matter. Photomicrograph also shows stage of formation of colloform which has taken
trace amount of magnetite in size fraction of - plac e due to dehydration of goethite.
200 mesh., The petrological investigation also Subsequently, colloform due to dehydration of
reveals the alteration of iron ore due to goethite which gets altered into hematite was
dehydration of goethite which has changed into observed. In the later stage lateralized portion
hematite in same size frac tion. Besides, of the hard ore having intermingling of clayey
lateralized portion of the hard ore was observed matter was observed. Due to metamorphism
showing intermingling of clayey matter within different stages of alteration of goethite was
the pit. observed through the present microscopic
study.
b) Kiriburu Goethitic Ore
It was observed that the Kiriburu goethtic ore 3.4. Liberation result
was mineralogic ally very c omplex and
consisted of high-grade hematitic ore pieces to
iron-rich and aluminous laterites. Under the
microscope hematite and goethite minerals
were found to be the major ore-minerals. The
gangue minerals consisted of kaolinitic clay, I: Interlocking, Ge: Goethite, H: Hematite,
quartz, gibbsite and limonitic matter. In a hard- Q: Quartz, C: Clay material
massive ore piece, hematite was the dominating Fig. 7: Photograph showing the liberated and
mineral phase and occurred as fine crystals inter-locked grains of the minerals
49
MPT-2013
*******
50
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Ruby is found in and around Jhilingdhar and Dumerpadar area, Kalahandi district, Odisha.
Corundum (and ruby) occurs in eluvial zone of altered metapyroxenite below the alluvial
overburden/soil of 0.5 to 4.0 m thickness. This paper describes mineralogy and textural
characteristics of eluvial corundum (and ruby) grains collected from different pits and trenches
within alluvial soil horizons at Dumerpadar.
Corundum is rose red, carmine or purple red in colour with well developed crystal faces and
mostly exhibitsbasal partings. The corundum grains contain inclusions of zircon and rutile, and
often surrounded by dark coloured spinel exhibiting corona texture. The corona thickness varies
from sample to sample and also within the same grains. Thick and thin veinlets of goethite and
diaspore traverse spinel aggregates. Sapphirine grains occur as rim around spinel and also as
fracture filing and in direct contact with corundum grains. Semi-quantitative chemical analysis
by energy dispersive spectrometer (EDS) attached to scanning electron microscope (SEM) indicated
that (i) corundum contains trace amounts of Fe and Cr, (ii) spinel is pleonaste-hercynite (Al-Mg-
Fe oxide) type with trace amounts of Cr, Mn, and Zn and (iii) sapphirine contains about 10% silica.
The corona textural feature suggests that under high P-T gradient in granulite facies
metamorphism and low fO2 corundum reacted with annite (or Fe-rich biotite) to form spinel:
3 Al2O3 + K(Mg,Fe)3AlSi3O10(OH)2 = 3 (Fe,Mg)Al2O4 + KAlSi3O8 + H2O
Corundum + Annite = Spinel + K-feldspar + Water
Keywords: Ruby, Corundum-spinel corona texture, Sapphirine
51
MPT-2013
ruby production (Indian Bureau of Mines, 2011). grains frequently contain inclusions of rutile
The entire resource of ruby (5348 tonnes) is (Fig. 5). Rutile is blood red in colour. Often
located in the state of Odisha, mainly in the zircon grains are also noted within ruby grains
districts of Kalahandi and Nuapada. (Fig. 5 and 6). Corona texture is well observed
At Jhillingdhar area, Kalahandi district, Mishra in which spinel partially surrounds the host.
and Mohanty (2006) reported occurrences of Spinel is translucent, light blue in colour and
ruby and corundum at the contact between occurs as polygonal to subhedral grains. In a
metapyroxenite and granite gneiss and also few samples, subhedral sapphirine grains are
eluvial placer ruby in the surrounding soil noted. It exhibits prominent pleochroism from
horizons. In this paper, we report preliminary blue, pale yellow to sapphire blue and strong
investigation on eluvial corundum (ruby) second order interference colour. It occurs as
grains from Dumerpadar area, Kalahandi partial rim around spinel (corona texture), as
district area, Odisha. veinlets, fracture and cavity filling within
c orundum and spinel. The textural
2. Materials and Methods
characteristics indicate that sapphirine is
Corundum (ruby) samples were collected by formed at the expense of the spinel and replace
hand picking from different pits and trenches the latter minerals. Ore microscopic studies
dug within alluvium zone near Dumerpadar indicate fine veins of goethite within spinel and
village. The size of the samples ranges between sapphirine.
20 to 3 mm. In the laboratory the samples were
3.3. SEM studies and mineral chemistry by EDS
washed with dil. HCL to remove the
ferruginous coatings followed by cleaning with The SEM micrographs of ruby grains are shown
water in ultrasonic machine. Thin sections of in different images (BSE images) (Figs. 7-12). In
the grain mounts were prepared. Polished BSE images the contrast between the different
sections were made for study under ore minerals is distinct. Corona texture shown by
microscope and Scanning Electron Microscope corundum-spinel is distinct in Fig. 7 while Fig.
(SEM). Semi-quantitative analaysis of the 8 shows suc c essive rims of spinel and
mineral phases were done by EDS attached to sapphirine around corundum grain. Sapphirine
SEM. occurs as fracture filling and cavity filling
within corundum grain (Figs. 9 and 11). Fig. 12
3. Results
shows direct contact between sapphirine and
3.1. Megascopic description corundum with fine veins of diaspore within
The colour of the ruby grains vary from rose sapphirine. The dendritic pattern in spinel
red, purple red and pale pink. Basal parting is grains is illustrated in Fig. 10. Fine veinlets of
prominent with conchoidal fracture, and thin goethite and hematite are observed within
fractures are also noted within ruby grains spinel grains.
(Figs. 1 and 2). The semi-quantitative analysis of corundum,
spinel and sapphirine is given in Table 1.
3.2. Microscopic description Corundum contains minor to trace amounts of
Under thin section the colour of ruby is purple Fe and Cr which occur in the crystal structure
red to faint pinkish to colourless. The grains of corundum. The incorporation of these
are mostly fractured and the fracture patterns elements imparts red colour to corundum
are perpendicular to each other and also (Bowles et al., 2011). Spinel contains high
anastomising in character (Figs. 3 and 4). Ruby amounts of alumina (Al2O3= 66.15%) and
52
MPT-2013
moderate amounts of Fe and Mg and minor The textural observation in the studied
amount of chromium. The analytical data corundum (ruby) grains suggests that the
indicate that the spinel is of hercynite-pleonaste spinel is derived from reaction between
c omposition. Sapphirine c ontains high corundum and other silicate mineral. In the
amounts of alumina (Al 2 O 3= 66. 46%), eluvial corundum grains, no other silicate
moderately high amounts of Mg (MgO=18.34%), mineral, except sapphirine, is found. This is due
moderate amounts of silica (SiO2=9.46%) and possibly to transportation, reworking of the
iron (FeO= 5.24%) and minor amount of grains and weathering conditions in which the
chromium. other primary silic ate minerals were
Table 1: Semi quantitative analyses of destroyed. Spinel grains contain significant
corundum (Crd), spinel (Spl), sapphiine (Spr) amounts of Fe and Mg suggesting that spinel
and diaspore (Dias). Analyses are recalculated might have been formed by reaction of
to 100 corundum and Mg-Fe containing silic ate
mineral, biotite. Sapphirine is a reaction
Crd Spr Dias Spl
MgO 0 18.34 0 19.73 product of spinel and other silica bearing
Al2 O3 99.35 66.46 97.89 65.15 mineral.
SiO2 0 9.46 0 0 3 Al2O3 + K(Mg,Fe)3AlSi3O10(OH)2 = 3
FeO 0.42 5.24 1.95 13.77 (Fe,Mg)Al2O4 + KAlSi3O8 + H2O
Cr2 O3 0.23 0.50 0.16 1.35 Corundum + Biotite
100 99.99 100.00 100.00 = Spinel + K-feldspar + Water
3.4. Discussions 4. Conclusions
Many authors have noted that spinel -
(1) The eluvial corundum (ruby) grains are
corundum intergrowth formed due to reactions
purple red in colour but mostly highly fractured
at high temperature and pressure metamorphic
and contain inclusions of rutile and zircon.
conditions involving:
(2) Corundum-spinel corona texture is well
Biotite + Corundum = Spinel + K-feldspar
developed in a few grains suggesting reaction
+water
of corundum and biotite to form spinel during
Corundum + Sillimanite = Spinel (hercynite) +
high grade metamorphic episodes. Sapphirine
Quartz
occurs in contact with corundum and also as
Corundum + Garnet = Spinel
partial rim around spinel. Sapphirine is formed
Sapphirine ((Mg,Fe2+,Fe3+Al)2O2[(Al,Si)6O18] is
by reaction of spinel and silicate mineral under
mostly reported from aluminium rich silicon
metamorphic conditions.
poor rocks of the high grade metamorphic rocks,
granulite and hornblende granulite. Sapphirine Acknowledgements
is formed by reaction of: (i) Spinel (Mg, Fe) Al2O4)
+ Silica (SiO 2), (ii) spinel (Mg, Fe) Al 2O4) + Authors are grateful to Prof. B.K. Mishra,
sillimanite (Al2O3.SiO2), (iii) spinel + garnet, (iv) Direc tor, IMMT, Bhubaneswar for his
Spinel (Mg, Fe) Al2O4) + Cordierite and (v) encouragement and kind permission to publish
Cordierite + Spinel + Corundum (Bowles et al., this paper. The authors thank Mr. M.K. Senapati,
2011 Prakash et al, 2013). Prakash et al. (2013) Joint Director of Geology, Directorate of Geology,
also reported different generation of sapphirine Govt. of Odisha for discussion and Mr. Mund at
in granulites of Eastern Dharwar Craton. Bhawanipatna for sample collection.
53
MPT-2013
54
MPT-2013
Crd Dias
Crd
Spr
Spr
Fig. 10: Spinel grain showing Fig. 11: Sapphirine (Spr) Fig. 12: Contact of
dendritic texture. Veins of within spinel as inclusion. corundum (Crd) and
goethite in spinel sapphirine (Spr). Diaspore as
veins.
*******
55
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
1. Introduction
Pradesh. The beach placer sand deposits of
The Indian coastline of 6500 km stretch is Chavara in Kerala, Manavalakurichi in Tamil
marked by accumulation of various types and Nadu and Chhatrapur in Odisha are under
grades of placer deposits. Heavy mineral active exploitation by Indian Rare Earth Ltd.
deposits are mostly concentrated in the states (IREL), Govt. of India.
of Kerala, Tamil Nadu, Odisha and Andhra The beach placer sand deposits serve as a major
source of economic minerals due to their easy
* Correspending Author: S. K. Das, Chief Scientist, Mineral mineability, the availability of cost effective
Processing Department, CSIR-Institute of Minerals and
Materials Technology, Bhubaneswar-13, Odisha, E-mail: mining technology and beneficiation practices
subir@immt.res.in and better profit ratio. The state of Odisha is
56
MPT-2013
well known for its huge reserve of placer ultrafine slimes. Bulk samples were prepared
deposits of about 116 million tonnes and the by thoroughly mixing the samples of the two
Chhatrapur deposit has about 62.06 million sectors separately. The samples were wet
tonnes deposit (Padhi and Mishra, 2006). sieved into different size fractions, viz., +1, -
Besides Chhatrapur deposit, the other 1+0.5,-0.5+0.25, -0.25+0.125, -0.125+0.063 and -
important localities along the coasts are (a) 0.063 mm sizes. From each size fractions, heavy
Ramayapatna, (b) Markandi, (c) Mayurpada, (d) minerals were isolated by gravity separation
Niladripur, (e) Paluru, (f) Malud, (g) Astaranga (sink-float method) using a heavy liquid
and (h) Ersama. The c oastal trac t near (bromoform; d=2.89) and total heavy mineral
Astaranga and Ersama area, located on either content (THM) in the samples was determined.
side of confluence of Devi River with the Bay of In some selected bore hole samples, the
Bengal (Fig. 1), contains significant quantity of distribution of individual heavy mineral
placer deposits. The Eastern Ghats Mobile Belt phases in each size fractions were determined
consisting of charnockite, khondalite and by grain counting (min. 300 grains) using
migamatite acts as provenance for coastal stereo- and petrological microscopes. Semi-
placer deposits of southern coast of Odisha quantitative mineral c ompositions were
(Bhattacharya and Sengupta, 1994; Dwivedy, obtained by EDS (M/S. Bruker) attached to SEM
1995; Mohanty et. al., 2004). (M/s. ZEISS) operating at 25 kV and beam
This paper focuses on the evaluation of (a) heavy current of 11 µA.
mineral concentrations in beach and dunes in
22 nos. of vertical profiles of 2 m depth of
Astaranga and Ersama coastal belts, (b)
concentrations of heavy minerals in sizes, (c)
individual heavy mineral phase distribution
in different sizes and (d) c hemic al
characteristics of ilmenite and its alteration
products. This study will help in understanding
in selecting beneficiation strategy of the coastal
sands.
57
MPT-2013
shown in Fig. 2. In this figure, HM contents of 10.31 (av. 5.38) and Astaranga: 0.45-1.85 (av.
different size fractions of each sample are also 1.64), 0.85-3.34 (av. 1.63) and 0.84-4.13 (av. 2.78).
given. The THM contents in the samples of The maximum percents of rutile, zircon and
Astaranga and Ersama sectors vary between monazite of Ersama and Astaranga samples are:
2.26-13.64 (av. 6.80%) and 3.88-23.07% (15.43%) 0.14, 0.35, 0.09 and 0.06, 0.15 and 0.08
respectively. The heavy mineral contents in respectively (Table-1). The distribution of
different size fractions of the samples indicate garnet, sillimanite and ilmenite in each size
that heavy minerals are strongly distributed fractions are given in Figs. 3 and 4. The results
between 0.25-0.125 mm (av. 0.185 mm), followed indicated that (a) in all samples, ilmenite
by 0.125 -0.063 mm (av. 0.094 mm) and 0.5-0.25 percents in the THM are high to very high in
mm (av. 0.375 mm) sizes (Fig. 2). The HM 0.125+0.063 mm constituting 49-75.4 (av.
concentrations in +0.5 mm and below 0.063 mm 60.5%) and 52.8-69.75 (av. 63.79%) respectively
sizes are in negligible amounts. for Ersama and Astaranga samples. The data
25 23.07 22.79 22.70 suggest that ilmenite is finer grained compared
W t.%
21.69
20 17.04 17.71
15.43
Ersama and Astaranga to garnet and sillimanite. (b) Garnet and
13.64
15
11.34 10.98 10.58
12.66 12.88
sillimanite are predominantly concentrated in
10
4.24
7.69
4.62
6.29 6.90 6.06 6.80 coarse sizes, -0.5+0.25 and -0.25+0.125 mm, and
3.88 3.28
5 2.26
1.96
the distribution is variable (Figs. 3 and 4). (c)
0
E-1 E-2 E-3 E-4 E-5 E-6 E-7 E-8 E-9 E- E- E- A- A- A- A- A- A- A- A- A- A- A- A- Zircon and monazite are concentrated below
10 11 Av. 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 Av.
0.125 mm. (d) In the coarsest size fractions
Fig. 2: THM contents (wt.%) and HM (+0.50 mm) goethite and limonite percents are
distribution (%) in different sizes. Index: E-1 high.
etc. – Ersama, A- Astaranga; Av. Average. Open Table 1: Mineral contents (wt.%) in the samples
bar- THM with contents (wt.%); Filled triangle: of Ersama (E) and Astaranga (A) sectors
0.500+0.25 mm; Filled square: 0.250+0.125 mm;
Ersama
Filled diamond shape: 0.125+0.063 mm. Rutil Mo
Sample Gar. Silli Ilm e Zir n Pyx Lim Oth. Total
E-1 4.81 5.34 5.75 0.08 0.35 0.05 0.48 0.04 0.15 17.09
3.2. Individual heavy mineral distribution E-2 4.56 2.56 3.62 0.04 0.08 0.06 0.30 0.08 0.04 11.34
(wt.%) in different size fractions and in total E-3 1.03 1.01 1.55 0.02 0.10 0.02 0.11 0.01 0.03 3.88
E-8 4.33 5.46 6.69 0.11 0.06 0.03 0.58 0.06 0.38 17.70
sample E-9 8.89 8.02 10.31 0.14 0.13 0.09 0.88 0.15 0.42 29.04
E-Av. 4.63 4.42 5.38 0.08 0.14 0.05 0.47 0.07 0.20 15.45
Twelve samples (6 nos. from each sector) were Astaranga
A-12 1.85 1.58 3.59 0.03 0.14 0.01 0.33 0.01 0.08 7.62
taken for determination of different heavy A-15 0.79 0.87 1.17 0.03 0.05 0.01 0.16 0.03 0.03 3.28
mineral species (Table-2). The dominant heavy A-16 4.37 3.34 4.13 0.06 0.15 0.05 0.51 0.05 0.01 12.66
A-20 1.26 1.30 2.67 0.02 0.13 0.03 0.61 0.00 0.04 6.06
minerals identified are garnet, sillimanite, A-22 0.45 0.85 0.84 0.02 0.04 0.01 0.07 0.00 0.00 2.27
A.-Av. 1.64 1.69 2.78 0.03 0.10 0.02 0.33 0.02 0.03 6.65
ilmenite, rutile, zircon and monazite with small
amounts of magnetite, goethite, apatite, epidote, 100 Ersama
80
60
lighter mineral constituent. Amongst the HM, 40
20
garnet, sillimanite and ilmenite constitute the 0
58
MPT-2013
E-A- Av. of 11 Ersama samples. Index: leaching of hematite lamellae from ilmenite (Fig.
1,4,7,10,13: -0.500+0.250 mm; 2,5,8,11,14,17: - 6). Hematite also contains exsolution laths and
0.250+0.125 mm; 3,6,9,12 ,15,18: -0.125+0.063 streaks of ilmenite. Ilmenite grains variously
mm. alter to pseudoilmenite, pseudorutile,
100
leucoxene/rutile along frac ture, margins,
Astaranga
cavities and structural weak planes (Figs. 7-8
% mineral distb.
80
60
and SEM BSE images: Figs. 9-12). The alteration
40
20
products are present as coarse to very fine
0 bands, veins, granules, dots, flames, and
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
59
MPT-2013
60
MPT-2013
A-5
A-1
A-2
A-6
A-4
A-3
80 µm 12
A-12
11
A-11
Er-1
Er-2
Er-4
Er-5
Er-6
Er-3
61
MPT-2013
Table 2: Semi-quantitative analyses (wt.%) of ilmenite and the alteration products. (A)- Astaranga;
(B)- Ersama. Index: Herc.- Hercynite, Dias.- Diaspore, Leuc.- Leucoxene, Ilm.- ilmenite, Pseu.-
Pseudorutile.
*******
62
MPT-2013
63
MPT-2013
64
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Grinding is an age old techniques of size reduction but most of the milling technologies are energy
inefficient. Various studies have been carried out to improve energy efficiency of grinding processes
but limited success has been achieved. Use of additives is common practice in wet as well as dry
grinding operations but it is much difficult to understand the underlying mechanism for dry
grinding process. This study has been carried out to estimate the effect of five different types of
grinding additives (Expansive Solids – Split AG, Disintegrators- Agar Powder, Sublime Solids-
Naphthalene, Acicular Particles- Wollastonite, and Swelling Solids- Alginic Acid) on dry grinding
process. Manganese ore samples of 0-1mm was properly mixed, characterized and subdivided for
test work. Experiments were conducted in a laboratory scale ball mill. Additive dosages were
kept 3, 5 and 7% of ore weight. Size analysis of grinding products was compared using D36.8, D50
and D80 calculated using Rosin Rammler equitation. Effects of additives on fracture pattern and
particles surfaces were analyzed using SEM and QEMSCAN mineralogy analyzer. It was found
that lime based additive Split AG is most effective dry grinding additive and it is able to reduce
coarser fraction (>150microns) by 5% using 5% additive dosages. Algenic Acid and Wollastonite
also shown positive effect on size reduction and reduced the coarser fraction by 2 to 5%. D36.8
particle diameters were reduced by 50, 27 and 19 micron for Algenic Acid, Split AG and Calcium
Silicate, respectively. Naphthalene and Agar powder create glue effect on particle surfaces and
did not affect grinding significantly. It was found that Split AG, Algenic Acid and Calcium Silicate
have the potential to develop as the dry grinding additives and other organic additives can be
explored to develop the dust reducing agents for dry grinding.
65
MPT-2013
various attempts has been made to improve recover values. Comminution is required to
the energy efficiency and these can be broadly liberate the valuable minerals from gangue in
c lassified into two c ategories i.e., (a) finer sizes. Grinding additives are most simple
Tec hnologic al advancement (b) Material and easy to implement improvement method
pretreatment. Technological advancements are for industries. But the major problem is
focused to design and develop energy efficient contamination of the product and it can be
grinding mills and crushers. High Pressure addressed by proper selection of the grinding
Roller Mill (HPRM), Sala Agitate Mill (SAM), additive. Rose and Sullivan have summarized
Eccentric Vibrating Mills (ESM) and Jet Mills most of the work reported prior to 1950, and
are commercially available new technologies Fuerstenau reviewed the efforts made prior to
(Daniel, 2006; Marmor, 1993; Gock and Kurrer 80s about grinding additive literature (Rose et
1998; Thaler 2000). The major pretreatment al. 1958, Fuerstenau 1995). Literature review
methods developed are chemical, thermal, reveals that effect of grinding additives can
ultrasonic, microwave treatment and electric classified in five major categories and these are
disintegration (Klimpelm and Austin 1982; presented in table 1. Flow properties, particle
Singh et al. 2012; Gaete-Garreton et al. 2000; agglomeration, frothing, media-partic le
Kumar, et al, 2010, Wang et al. 2011). Most of interactions and softening of the material are
these methods still not commercialized mainly the main area of interest for researcher to
because of the cost economic problems. develop a grinding additive but still low
High grade natural resources are depilating and availability and popularity of grinding
mineral industry is facing challenges to process additives indicate the research gap in the area.
the low grade ores and process tailings to
Table 1: Different grinding additives and working mechanism (Fuerstenau 1995; Paramasivam
and Vedaraman, 1992a; Hasegawa et al. 2006; El-Shall 1984; Paramasivam and Vedaraman 1992b;
Wang and Wang 2009)
S. No. Effect Additives
1. Modification of the flow of pulp in the Water
grinding mill
2. Influence on re-agglomeration of the Alcohol, Glycol (Ethylene glycol, propylene glycol,
freshly produced fines butylenes Glycol, Triethanol amine. Carbon
tetrachloride, Methyl cyclohexane, Nitrogen, HCI
and NaCH.
3. Modification of frothing characteristics of Flotigam P (C12-C14) , Amine, Coconut oil, Oleic
the pulp during grinding; acid, Sodium oleate, Amine acetate, sodium silicate,
Dodecyl ammonium chloride, caustic soda and soap
66
MPT-2013
Dry grinding is now being reconsidered due to surface interactions, whereas the kinematic
emerging water and tailing disposal constrains. viscosity and vapor pressure are expected to
But development of grinding additives for dry influence the drag force acting over the particles
grinding is more challenging than wet during grinding (Paramasivam and
processing. Wet grinding provided proper Vedaraman, 1992a; Hasegawa et al. 2006; El-
mixing and dispersion of additives in materials Shall 1984; Paramasivam and Vedaraman
and these additives can change the flow 1992b; Wang and Wang 2009). These effects can
properties to improve grinding characteristics. be broadly classified into four areas:
But these advantages are not with dry grinding (a) Solid flow properties: Dry grinding additives
and measurement of the effect of these additives can increase the surface smoothness and
on particles is difficult to measure. Cement c an reduc e or increase the partic le
industry commonly opt the dry grinding agglomeration during milling. These
process and first dry grinding additive was phenomena can increase the uniformity of
explored almost 60 years back. Commonly used grinding feed and will provide the equal
dry grinding additives are amines, glycol, opportunity to all kinds of particles for
resins, cod oil, kojic acid, carbon black wool grinding.
grease, calcium sulphate, urea, asphaltenes, etc (b) Abrasion and erosion: Dry grinding additive
(Fuerstenau, 1995). However, grinding aids have can modify the surface hardness and
scarcely been utilized in fields other than the surfaces charges. The variation in this can
cement industry, because of the undesirable help for particle erosion and abrasion
contamination of the product and the lack of which may result in increased particle size
instruction in application of grinding aids. Use reduc tion. This phenomenon c an be
of grinding additives on other than cement has increased by acidic additives as well as
also been mentioned in literature. Some of the additives with acicular particles.
examples are wool grease for gypsum, limestone (c) Fracture propagation: The additives can
and quartz, effect of hydrocarbons in milling of accumulate in the fractures and pores on
aluminum powder, the sue of silicones in ball partic les surfac es due to available
milling of quartz, and the use of acetone, carbon moisture. The polar additives can affect the
tetrachloride, benzene and nitromethane for surface energies at fracture openings.
grinding of glass, marble and quartz Swelling of these additives can impact the
(Fuerstenau, 1995). The mechanism behind the pressure on the fracture and it can break
effect of dry grinding additives has been studies the partic les. Various kinds of super
by Paramasivam and Vedaraman 1992 and disintegrator used by pharmaceutical
they concluded that the additive action depends industry can be used for these purposes.
on the nature of the additive used, the size (d) Heat effect: During the milling an additive
distribution of the mill c ontent and the will be heated due to energy release due to
adsorption phenomena of additive molecules collision of grinding media. Whereas some
on particle surfaces which alters the powder additive release the energy during
flowability and particle breakage mechanisms. hydration and some absorb the heat
The surface tension and dipole moment of the during sublimation. These additives can
liquid are assumed to influence the solid-liquid change the environment inside the mill
67
MPT-2013
whic h c an affec t the grinding proc ess additives either use the moisture present in the
significantly. cracks and microspores on the material surfaces
Present study is carried out to find new or it erode the particle surfaces due to nature of
grinding additives and tried to study the effects additive. Five different additives were tested
of additives on frac ture patterns using with three different quantities. Usually, dry
conventional techniques. Despite large number grinding additive dosages are kept less than one
of research papers it is not clearly understood percentage but in current test work we kept
that how the additives affect the grinding. We the dosage slightly higher for easy estimation
tried to explore some new additives which can of the effect using SEM and mineralogical
enter into the pre-existing cracks in the solid analysis. Details of these additives are described
particles and can widen these cracks using the in next section.
unique properties of these additives. These Manganese ores found in Joda region, India
phenomena can be related with artificial were selected and collected for the studies. These
weathering phenomena of rocks (Faria and ores mainly c ontain pyrolusite, quartz,
Bieniawski 1984). The five additives (Expansive hematite and kaolinite as main mineral phases.
Solids, Disintegrators, Sublime Solids, Acicular Initial size reduction by roll crusher upto <1mm
Particles, and Swelling Solids) were selected generate significant amount of cracks on particle
from literature survey and experiments were surface and lower brittleness of ores help to
carried out using laboratory scale ball mill and carry many fractured particles for next stage
effect on size reduction is studied. Their effect experimentation as shown in Figure 1. Two kg
on pre-existing cracks and particles surfaces of sample was grounded in a laboratory scale
were studies using SEM and QEMSCAN ball mill (Length: 0.56mm Diameter: 0.5m, No.
mineralogy analyzer. of lifter: 2) for 30 minutes with 6kg balls of 30mm
diameter.
2. Experimental work
a) Expansion additives: Expansion additives
Dry grinding is again getting popularity due to are powdery materials that expand
water crises and environmental concerns. But considerably when mixed with water through
effective of additives on dry grinding is not chemical hydration, by the formation and
explored fully. Present study is carried out to development of ettringite crystals (Taylor,
know effect of additives on dry grinding. These 1997). Under confinement, this expansion can
Figure 1 : Micro-cracks in the broken manganese ore particles (a) Visible cracks in bigger
particles (b) Pores and Cracks in coagulated ore particles (c) Microcraks in small particles
68
MPT-2013
generate significant expansive pressure, which study for experimentation. Three different
causes cracking of rock or concrete, when it dosages of these powders were added during
exceeds the tensile capacity of materials. grinding to support the grinding process. The
Objective of our study to use utilize these D80 of the particles was 38 micron.
additive to widen the pre-existing cracks in the d) Acicular particles: Autogenous grinding
material and help in size reduc tion. In got much popularity in last few decades. These
experimental work we added 3, 5 and 7% Split- additives are selected to explore the same
AG (SG) (D80 :50mm) in the manganese ore and concept for using acicular particle solids to
carried out the grinding experiments. assist the grinding process. CaSiO 3 (CS,
b) Super disintegrators: Disintegrates are Hardness: 4-5) is a commonly available solid
substances or mixture of substances added the with acicular particles with D80:50mm. During
drug formulation that facilitates the breakup crushing, wollastonite breaks into lath-or
or disintegration of tablet or capsule content needle-shaped (acicular) particles because of its
into smaller particles. Recently new materials unique cleavage properties. It is used as an anti-
termed as superdisintegrant have been caking agent in food preparation and an
developed to improve the disintegration antac id. It absorbs water and makes the
processes. These additives mainly work on material free flowing. Three different dosage of
Capillary action, swelling properties and the material is tested for grinding additive.
chemical reactions of chemicals (Paramasivam e) Swelling solids: Various solids have a
and Vedaraman 1992b). In current study we strong ability to absorb the water and swell
used the Agar Powder (AP) as an additive for quickly. Alginic acid (AlA, (C6H8O6)n, Density:
grinding. Agar is the dried gelatinous substance 1.60 g/c m³; pH :2-3) is a c ommon
obtained from Gelidium Amansi. Ito et al superdintegrator and we tested it in the current
investigated the use of agar powder as a study. The swelling can impart the pressure on
disintegrating agent for the development of the cracks and can help in sizing process. It is
rapidly disintegrating oral tablets. Agar was capable of absorbing 200-300 times its own
chosen because it absorbs water and swells weight in water (Ito and Sugihara 1996). Three
significantly but do not become gelatinous in different quantities of the additive were tested
water at physiological temperature (Taylor, for grinding applications. The D80 of the particles
1997). Current research work explored the was 38 micron.
possibilities of these additives to reach in cracks 3. Results and discussion
and support the fragmentation process during
grinding process. Five different additives were ground in the ball
c) Sublime solids: substance directly from mill. The product achieved after ball milling
the solid phase to the gas phase without was screened at different sizes and plotted
passing through an intermediate liquid phase. using Gaudin-Schumann Plots. These plots are
Sublimation is an endothermic phase transition presented in Figure 2. These plots indicate that
that occurs at temperatures and pressures cumulative passed material using different
below a substance’s triple point in its phase additives shown increasing trend but the
diagram. Naphthalene (NP, C10H8, Crystalline) pattern was different for different additives.
is commonly available solid and used in this Split AG did not shown any significant
69
MPT-2013
difference for 3% addition of additive but it was Table-2: Estimated particle sizes using Rosin-
similar for 5 and 7% and both were significantly Rambler distribution
different from the head sample. There was
almost 10% reduction in 100 micron size Additive C1 T1 (3%) C2 T2 C3 T3
(5%) (7%)
particles. The disintegrator did not shown any D36.8 213 209 208 181 203 177
SG D50 143 169 129 113 117 111
significant effect and rise in fine particles were D80 32 38 29 25 26 25
D36.8 212 221 206 219 201 219
uniform with increased additive dose and it NP D50 133 163 116 124 101 101
was between 3 to 5% weight rise in 100 micron D80 30 36 26 28 23 23
D36.8 212 211 206 217 200 212
partic les. Sublime additive shown very AP D50 125 175 106 212 90 111
D80 28 39 24 47 20 25
interesting result and rise in fines were uniform D36.8 213 198 208 228 208 189
70
MPT-2013
Naphthalene is an organic sublime solid and Micorscopic studies were carried out to study
during milling its particles behave complexly. the effect of these additives on particles surface
Some of particles convert into very fine powered and fractures. The mean particle sizes of
and coat the particles. It was the main reason additives were <38micron. It was observed in
that with all the three dosage levels the product microscopic analysis of ground product that
is coarser than the feed. It indicates that its effect
during milling the harder additives (SG, CS and
on grinding is not effective for size reduction.
AP) did not get fully grounded and some
But the coating phenomena can be used to
minimize the fine generation during milling of particles of these additives were seen in the
materials. product. Uncrushed coarese particles of softer
Calcium silicate has acicular particles and additives (NP and AlA) were not seen in the
should has generated autogenous type of products. Micrographs are shown in Figure 2.
milling characteristics. It was found that Figure 2 indicate that there is difference in
initially coarser fraction of material get reduced particle brightness in all the samples and it was
due to lower dosage and finer frac tion mainly due to slight coating of different
increased. This phenomenon was observed with additives on particles surfaces. It was expacted
increased dosage and found that for 7% dosage
that these additives will approach the pore and
there was a significant difference in material
fractures on particles surfaces. This phenomena
size distribution and fines were more than the
was checked using QEMSCAN and SEM-
head sample for all the measures.
Alginic ac id (AlA) is known as a element mapping technque at addiferent pore
superdintegrator and swells with moisture and fractures on particle surface and shown in
content. It was seen that for all three dosage (3, Figures 4 & 5.
5 and 7%) coarse material reduced significantly QEMSCAN provided automated mineralogical
and has an increasing trend. But for finer analysis of ore samples using a Scanning
fraction this effect was not very significant. It Elec tron Mic roscopy and spec ified
might be due to fracture pattern in the particles. mineralogic al database. A sample was
Bigger particles carry cracks and moisture prepared using the product obtained by
which help in size reduction but in fines it was
grinding of ore with calcium silicate (CS). The
not having this support to affect the grinding.
frame captured using QEMSCAN is presented
It was found in comparative analysis that most
of the organic additives (AP & NP) create glue in Figure 4. The mineral list attached was
effect on the particle surface during dry grinding modified to see the distribution of Ca and Si
and its effect on size reduction cannot be bearing materials and new minerals (Mn
quantified. Bec ause finer partic les get Others) was added in it. It shows that most of
agglomerated and D50 or D80 shown higher the particles have coating of this material as
values than the feed composite sample. It was well as it was finally distributed in the sample.
found that AlA, CS and SG shown some ray of Comparison of head sample particle view and
hope for additive development. Their effects product ground using additive shown that
were much significant on coarser sizes (D36.8) particles grounded using additives were having
than the finer sizes (D80). Their performance can
small particles adhering to the surface of big
be sequentially arranged in following manner:
particles. It was distributed on open pores and
Effect on D36.8: AIA > SG >CS
grain boundaries. It indicates that there is a
Effect on D80: SG >CS > AIA
71
MPT-2013
72
MPT-2013
probability that the additive was able to these were creating glue effect on particle
produce the erosion effect. surfaces which were adversely affecting
Elements which were considered as a prime the size reduction as well measurement
part of material compsition were selected for process.
mappling. Ca, O, C, Si and C are the majour (c) Algenic acid and Calcisum silicate shown
elemnts found in SG, AP,NP,CS and AlA, positive effec t on size reduction and
respectively. Figure 5.a indicate that Ca is reduced the coarser fraction (>150microns)
distributed on the particles surface but it is not by 2 to 5%. D36.8 particle diameters were
c onc entrated in the frac ture but O reduced by 50 and 19 micron for Algenic
concentration was observed in this crack. This Acid and Calcisum Silicate, respectively.
might be due to widgth of crack which less than (d) QEMSCAN and SEM element mapping
5micron. Agar powder contain a chain of O techniques is very useful tool to measure
and OH moluecular and it was observed that the effect of additives on the dry grinding
distribution of oxygen was thicker in the cracks. process.
It indicate presence of additive in the cracks.
References
Naphthalene is an organic sublime solid and it
was found that concentration of C was higher Daniel, M., 2006. Energy efficient mineral
in the pores which were not very useful for size liberation using HPGR technology. AMIRA
reduction. Figure 5.d also indicates a uniform P9N Project, Review, 15th Nov [9].
distribution of Ca and Si in the materials and El-Shall, H., 1984. Physico-Chemical aspects of
particle surfaces. Allergenic acid is also a grinding: a review of use of additives.
hydrocarbon and carbon distribution was Powder Technology, 38, 275 - 293.
observed on particles surfaces. Faria ,Santos, Bieniawski, C.A.F., 1984. Effect of
artificial weathering on properties of
4. Conclusion
LOYALHANNA Sandstone, Proceedings
Identifying the additives for dry grinding is a of the 27th US Symposium on Rock
challenging subject and its importance will Mechanics, 1984, Tuscaloosa, AL, USA.
increase in coming years due to water scarcity. Fuerstenau, D.W., 1995. Grinding Aids. KONA,
There are various possible mechanism by 13, 5-17.
which the dry grinding additives can improve Gaete-Garreton, L.F., Vargas-Hermandez, Y.P.,
the milling performance but success of these Velasquez-Lambert, C., 2000.
additives depend on material characteristics, Applic ation of ultrasound in
additives properties and their interaction. comminution. Ultrasonics, 38, (1-8), 345-
(a) Five different types of materials were 52.
tested and found that a lime based Gock , E., Kurrer, K.E., 1998. Increased efficiency
expansive material (SG) is most effective of the vibratory milling process with the
dry grinding additive and it is able to eccentric vibratory mill. Aufbereitungs-
reduce coarser fraction (>150microns) by Technik, 39 (3), 103–111.
5% using the 5% additive dosages. It Hasegawa, M., Kimata, M., Yaguchi, M., 2006.
reduced the D36.8 particle diameter by 27 Effect and behavior of liquid additive
micron. molecules in dry ultrafine grinding of
(b) The organic additive Naphthalene and limestone, KONA, (24).
Agar powder were not found suitable and
73
MPT-2013
Ito ,A., Sugihara, M., 1996. Chem. Pharm. Bull. Rose, H., Sullivan, R., Bail, 1958. lkbe and Rod
44(11), 2132 – 2136. Milk. Chemical Publishing Co., New York,
Klimpelm, R.R., Austin, L.G., 1982. Chemical 236 - 251.
additives for wet grinding of minerals, Singh, V., Tathavadkar, V., Denys , M. B.,
Powder Technology, 31, 2, 239–253. Venugopal, R., 2012. Application of
Kumar, P., Sahoo, B.K., De, S., Kar, D.D., quartz inversion phenomenon in mineral
Chakraborty, S., Meikap, B.C., 2010. Iron processing – A case study of siliceous
ore grindability improvement by manganese ores. Mineral Engineering,
microwave pre-treatment, J. of Industrial 32, 8-11.
and Eng. Chemistry. 16 (5), 805-812. Somasundaran, P., Lin, I. J., 1972. I and EC
Mangal, M., Thakral, S., Goswami, M., Ghai, P., Processes Des. Dev. 11, 321.
2012. Superdisintegrants: An Updated Taylor, H.F.W., 1997. Cement Chemistry, 2nd ed.,
Review, Inter. Journal of Pharmacy and Thomas Telford, London. 313-316.
Pharmaceutical Science Research. 2(2) 26- Thaler, H., 2000. Ultrafine jet mill grinding.
35. Industrial Mineral. 389, 39-45.
Marmor, F., 1993. Energy-saving fine-grinding Wang, E., Shi F., Manlapig, E., 2011. Pre-
using the Sala-Agitated-Mill SAM. weakening of mineral ores by high
Aufbereitungs-Technik, 34(10), 506-511. voltage pulses. Mineral Engineering. 24
Paramasivam, R., Vedaraman, R., 1992a. Effects (5), 455-462.
of the physical properties of liquid Wang ,D., Wang, Z., 2009. Research and
additives on dry grinding. Powder Application of Func tional Polymer
Technology. 70 (1). 43-50. Grinding Aids. Materials Science &
Paramasivam,R., Vedaraman, R., 1992b. Studies Tec hnology 2009 Conferenc e and
in additive grinding of minerals. Exhibition. 1974-1983.
Advanced Powder Technology.3(1),31-37.
*******
74
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
75
MPT-2013
76
MPT-2013
Table 1: Experimental Sizing data of samples Table 4: Experimental Sizing data of samples
collected from stream I collected from stream IV
77
MPT-2013
Cu m % p a sin g
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0.001 0.010 0.100 1.000 10.000 100.000
Size (mm)
1:Autogenous Mill 3 Combiner, Bal 2:Autogenous Mill 3 Prod, Bal
3:Ball Mill 4 Combiner, Bal 4:Ball Mill 4 Prod, Bal
5:Single Deck Screen 5 O/S, Bal 6:Single Deck Screen 5 U/S, Bal
7:Hy drocy clone 6 U/F, Bal 8:Hy drocy clone 6 O/F, Bal
9:Hy drocy clone 7 U/F, Bal 10:Hy drocy clone 7 O/F, Bal
11:Feed 1 Combiner, Bal
S izin g
100
Table 7: The mass balance results for stream III 90
80
Cum% p assing
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0.001 0.010 0.100 1.000 10.000 100.000
Size (mm)
1:Feeder Combiner, Bal 2:SAG Mill Prod, Bal
3:Single Deck Screen O/S, Bal 4:Single Deck Screen U/S, Bal
5:Ball Mill Combiner, Bal 6:Ball Mill Prod, Bal
7:2nd stage cy clone U/F, Bal 8:2nd stage cy clone O/F, Bal
9:Ist stage cy clone O/F, Bal 10:Ist stage cy clone U/F, Bal
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0. 01 0.10 1. 00 10.00 100.00 1000.00
S ize (mm)
1: Feed Combiner, Bal 2:SAG Mill Prod, Bal
3: Single Deck Screen O/ S, Bal 4:Single Deck Screen U/S, Bal
5: Ball Mill Combiner, Bal 6:Ball Mill Prod, Bal
7: 2nd st age cy clone U/F, Bal 8:2nd stage cy clone O/F, Bal
9: Ist stage cy clone U/F, Bal 10: Ist stage cy clone O/F, Bal
70
60
50
mass balance studies are as follows stream wise.
40
30
4.1 Stream I
20
10
0
Reduction ratio for Rod mill is observed as
0.001 0.010 0.100 1.000
S ize (mm)
10.000 100.000
6 and for Ball Mill as 5
1:Rod Mill C ombiner, Bal 2: Rod Mill Prod, Bal
3:Ball Mill Prod, Bal
5:2nd stage cy clone O/F , Bal
7:Ist stage cy clone O/ F, Bal
4: 2nd stage cy clone U/F, Bal
6: Ist stage cy clone U/F, Bal 307% Recirculation load is observed at BM,
which is equivalent to 295 T/Hr for 96Ton of
Figure 3: The balanced sizing data for stream I fresh feed. Almost 29% of Feed to BM (86
Tons) is having size less than 75 micron &
18.5% having size less than 37microns.
Mineralogical study could indicate if these
fines contain important metallic minerals
78
MPT-2013
79
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
81
MPT-2013
(Xiao and Tong 2013). The primary function of fed to the screens thus completing the loop of
screening is to pass the undersize particles and closed circuit crushing. The desired size of coal
reject the oversize particles. If the particles are fed to the main washing plant is -15mm.The
brought at the openings at such a velocity and main washing plant is comprised of dense
in such a direction that the passage of undersize media cyclone and froth flotation circuits for
is not hindered, effective screening can be beneficiation of coal. Figure 1 shows the
achieved. If every particle of undersize could material flow diagram of coal handling section
be brought to the opening at substantially zero in the plant.The circuit is very critical for plant
velocity and in a perpendicular direction operation as it is online with the main washing
probability of passage of particle will increase plant. The performance of both the screens thus
to a large extent. But tonnage requirements and significantly affects the plant operation. The
mechanical considerations forbid this type of screen surfaces of both the screens were of
particle presentation and therefore the design woven wire type. One of the major concerns of
of screening equipment and the type of screen this section was screen downtime due to
surface affect the process of industrial screening frequent clogging of material in the woven wire
significantly.The screening can be wet or dry and wire breakage. Dismantling of damaged
depending upon the requirements of operation. woven wire panel and replacing it required a
However, results have shown that during wet lot of time and manpower. In this work, one of
screening, the fine fraction is increased the sc reen surfac es was replac ed with
indicating fragmentation during screening polyurethane panel and c omparison of
(Govender and Van Dyk 1947). In this work, performance of both the screens was done with
comparison of performance of two different respect to different parameters.
sc reening surfac es with respec t to both Rotary Breaker
Shale/Stone
operation and maintenance has been done for Raw Coal
perforations is stored in bunkers. The coal from Fig.1: Layout of Coal Handling Section at
these bunkers is fed to a belt conveyor system
Jamadoba Coal Preparation Plant
that feeds the material to two vibrating screens
through a pyjama discharge chute. The oversize 2.2. Plant sampling and methods of analysis
material from the screens is fed to an impact Individual samples of feed, oversize and
crusher and the undersize is fed to the main undersize were taken from both the vibrating
washing circuit. The crushed material is again
82
MPT-2013
screens. While collecting samples from one Overall Screen Efficiency = o(f-u)(1-u)(o-f) / f(o-
screen, electrical shutdown was taken in the u)2(1-f)……. Equation (1)
other screen so that the samples were a true
3.1.2. Screening efficiency for woven wire
representative of individual sc reen
surface
performance. A number of samples were taken
on daily basis in different shifts and A number of data sets were chosen and screen
corresponding performance of screens was efficiency was calculated based on the recovery
analysed. Efficiency of screening surfaces were of material at the cut size of 15mm. Figure 2
calculated using mass balance equations. The shows an example of size distribution curves
feed rates at the time of sampling were also noted for woven wire surface. The efficiency of screen
and important derivations were made. Open using the mass balance formulae has been
Area of both the screens was calculated and calculated.
the results obtained were compared with the
clogging tendency of screen surfaces. Time
100.00
required for maintenance of screens was also g
n
sis 90.00
Feed
taken into accord. a
p 80.00
t
n 70.00
ce
r
3. Results and Discussion e 60.00
p Screen
t 50.00
h Overflow
ig
3.1. Screening efficiency e 40.00
w
e
ivt 30.00
3.1.1. Mathematical expression for efficiency al 20.00
u
Screen
Underflow
m 10.00
calculation u
C
0.00
83
MPT-2013
13 0
12 5
12 0
100.00
11 5
90.00
Polyure th an e
te11 0
g80.00 a
R10 5 Su rfac e
n
sis d
e
a70.00 e
F10 0
W ove n w ire
p Su rfac e
t 60.00
n 95
e
cr Fe e d
e50.00 90
p Scre e n O ver flow
t 40.00 85
h
ig Scre e n Unde rflow
e30.00 80
w
ve 20.00 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 1 2 1 3 1 4 1 5
it
la10.00
u
m 0.00
u
C Average feed rate achieved from woven wire
Size surface was found to be greater than that of
polyurethane surface. Both screens add up to
Fig. 3: Size distribution curve for feed, oversize give a feed rate of over 200 tons per hour to the
and undersize of screen with polyurethane main washing plant.
surface
3.2.1. Open area calculation
Screen Efficiency for woven polyurethane
surface: Open area is expressed as the ratio of hole area
Fraction of material above 15mm in feed (f) = or area that is free for passage of material to the
39.8 total screen area. Per cent open area is a measure
Fraction of material above 15 mm in overflow to predict how readily a material will pass
(o) = 81.55 through a screen.
Fraction of material above 15 mm in underflow Open Area for Woven Wire Surface
(u) = 0.83 Size of hole =20mm x 16mm =320 mm2
Using Equation 1 for calculation of screening No. of holes in one woven wire cloth =95x75=
efficiency 7125
Overall Screen Efficiency = 0.842 Open Area= 320 x 7125 = 2280000 mm 2
A number of similar trials were done and Dimension of one woven wire cloth = 8 ft x 5 ft=
screening efficiency of polyurethane surface 40ft2= 3716121.6 mm2
excelled that of woven wire surface by 4 per Per cent open area= 2280000 x 100 /3716121.6
cent. =61.3 %
Open Area for polyurethane surface:
3.2. Comparision of feed rates
Size of hole = 18mm x 18mm = 324 mm2
Feed rate obtained from individual screens was No. of holes in one panel = 240
observed and recorded for a number of times. Open Area =240 x 324 = 77760 mm2
Care was taken that feed characteristics to both Dimension of one panel = 2ft x 1ft =2 ft2 = 185806
the screens during test runs remain same. This mm2
was done by feeding the screens from the same Per cent open area = 77760/185806= 41.8 %
storage bunkers in which coal from a particular
3.3. Comparison of clogging tendency of
sourc e was stored. Figure 4 shows the
screen surfaces
c omparison of feed rates obtained from
individual screens during various test runs. Clogging of coal particles on screen surfaces
Average feed rate for woven wire surface:110.2 during operation was one of the major concerns
Average feed rate with polyurethane for the plant. Clogging of screen surface leads
surface:96.4 to blinding of apertures due to which undersize
84
MPT-2013
material reports to overflow. This leads to of operation. The time required for maintenance
increase in recirculating load of the closed circuit of both the screen surfaces was compared and
and drastic reduction in efficiency of screening. analysis was done. It was found that the
The quantity of fines generated in impact average life of woven wire surface was about
c rusher depends upon the size and one month whereas life of polyurethane
c harac teristic s of c oal been proc essed screening surface was near to six months.
(Eswaraiah et al. 2008).Cleaning of screen Figure 5 and 6 show the average time for
surfaces in each shift of plant operation was maintenance for woven wire surface and
scheduled and the time required for cleaning of polyurethane surface respectively.
the screen surfaces was noted for both the types
160
of screen surface. s 140
e
Table 1: Time required for cleaning of t
u 120
n
i 100
m
polyurethane screen surface f 80
o
r
e 60
b
m 40
Shift A Shift B Shift C u
N 20
Day 1 15 20 15 0
Day 2 10 15 15 Week 1 Week 2 Week 3 Week 4
Day 3 20 10 15
Day 4 10 15 10
Day 5 Scheduled Maintenance 20 25
Figure 5: Time required for maintenance of
Day 6 20 15 20 one woven wire cloth
Day 7 Scheduled Maintenance In the initial days the time required for
Table 2: Time required for cleaning of woven maintenance of woven wire surfaces was
wire screening surface mainly due to wire breakage. Wire binding took
a time of about 45 minutes. The time increased
Shift A Shift B Shift C
Day 1 35 25 30
gradually in the next few days with
Day 2 30 30 25 requirements of side and centre bolt tightening.
Day 3 35 30 25
Gradual deterioration of surface with inability
Day 4 30 25 35
Day 5 Scheduled Maintenance 35 40 to resist the vibrations and high size feed,
Day 6 35 25 30 complete replacement of the surface had to be
Day 7 Scheduled Maintenance
done which took a time of about two and a half
The clogging tendency for woven wire surface hours.
was found to be much more than polyurethane
surface. Open Area in polyurethane surface is 10 0
90
less than woven wire surface but the reduction s
te
u
80
70
n
i
in clogging tendency of material leads to more M
f
o
60
50
r
effec tive screening. Reduced equipment e
b
m
40
30
u
N 20
downtime and increased efficiency of screening 10
0
are the direct benefits of reduced clogging
tendency.
3.4. Comparison of time required for
maintenance of both the screens Figure 6: Time required for maintenance of
one polyurethane panel
The life of sc reen surfac es is of utmost Polyurethane panels required less time for
importance in industrial applications as it maintenance throughout its wear life. The
directly impacts the screen downtime and cost initial maintenance tome required was for
85
MPT-2013
placing the panel in the desired. The time clogging tendency in the panel leads to more
gradually increased with panel dislocation effec tive sc reening. Minimal time for
during operation and damage to panel surfaces. maintenance and maximum availability of
The process continued up to six months till the screens can be attained using polyurethane
panel and rail had to be replaced completely surfaces.Reduced blinding of screen apertures
and it required a time of about one and half and reduced recirculating loads are definitely
hours. Figure 6 shows the average maintenance the clear advantages of using a polyurethane
time required for one polyurethane panel surface panel.
throughout its wear life of about six months. References:
The time for maintenance directly affects the
plant availability and the coal handling section Eswaraiah, C., Gupta, Anshul, Nagarajan, R.,
being online with the main plant, directly affects Rajavel, M., Nanadakumar, K., 2008,
the throughput of the day. Many works have Minimization of fines generation in size
been done to highlight the significance of reduction of coals by impact crusher.
c ondition based maintenanc e and plant Govender, A., Van Dyk, J.C., 1947. Effect of wet
availability in coal preparation plants (Lester screening on particle size distribution and
et al. 1998). Polyurethane panels being lighter coal properties. South Africa.
in weight and easy to fit also pose significant Lester M et al., EUR, 1998, Coal Preparation
advantages of safer condition to do work and plant condition based maintenance.
requirement of lesser manpower. Wills, Barry A, Tim Napier Munn, EUR, 2006
Mineral Proc essing Tec hnology, An
4. Conclusion Introduction to the practical aspects of ore
The screening efficiency of polyurethane panel treatment.
screen surface wasfound to be greater than that Xiao, Jianzhang, Tong, Xin, China, 2013.
of woven wire panel surface. The open area of Characteristics and efficiency of new
polyurethane surface is less but the reduced vibrating screen with a swing trace.
*******
86
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Grinding is most cost & energy intensive in entire milling operations and optimization of grinding
circuit is important. Along with energy optimization and smooth operations, product quality
control is a critical requirement for downstream leaching operations. One of the most important
product quality parameters is particle size. In general particle size is analyzed in the laboratory
by collecting periodic samples and results are used for any corrective action. Irregularity in
sampling and delays in analysis coupled with inherent human errors in collecting representative
samples make quality control a challenging task. With the development of new online analyzers
and control instruments has made easy in operation and control of grinding circuit. This paper
deals with the control philosophy and instrumentation used for optimization of grinding circuit.
87
MPT-2013
Means for measurement of the controllable 3. Controlled and Manipulated Variables in the
variables and the process response. Grinding Circuit
The direction of change to be implemented
on the controllable variables and the Control of a grinding circuit is relatively
methodology to translate the control action simplified because of the fact that there are only
to the system that is development of control two important variables, namely.
strategy and implementation of control. a) The feed rate of the ore to the circuit and
b) The rate of addition of water to the circuit.
2. Control Objectives Which are controlled to achieve the desired
objectives. The circuit is however subject to
The objectives of all control strategies are common disturbances such as:
directed towards economic optimisation of the a) Changes in the Ore characteristics, such
whole system and not for the individual circuit as hardness, specific gravity and size
only. Typical objectives for grinding circuit distribution
control are: b) Uncontrolled water additions to the
(i) Maintaining a constant grind at constant c irc uit, suc h as floor waste water
feed rate. intermittently pumped into the circuit,
(ii) Maintaining a constant grind at maximum c) Change in quality/ quantity of the grinding
possible tonnage. media
(iii) Maintaining a constant grind and density d) Changes in the characteristics of the feed
of the product at maximum tonnage. pulp to cyclones caused by aeration,
For any specific concentrator, the objectives of surging of pump etc.
the grinding circuit control are to be considered e) changes in the performances of the mill
in the context of the local conditions and classifier circuit due to wear and tear of
physical limitations of the circuit. These mill liners and cyclone spigot; improper
objec tives might c hange with c hanged distribution of pulp to parallel processing
production requirements of the mill or due to unit ( for example, cyclones) and other
constraints from mine/smelter production mechanical reasons such as blockage of
schedules and capacities. launders, pipelines etc.
For example at UCIL Tummalapalle mill, the The objectives of the control system are thus to
grinding size required is be realized by manipulation of controllable
-65+100# 3.2%; -100+200 # 11.30%; -200+325 # variables by applying suitable control action
14.7%; -325 # 70.80%. as and when disturbances occur and persist
Also it must be pointed out here when there for long times. One of the primary objectives of
are more than one constraint in the objectives, any grinding circuit control system being to
and the circuits is operating at the peak stabilize the produc t size at a point
capacity; in the event of a major disturbance to corresponding to optimum mineral libration,
the circuit, one constraint must be relaxed to the produc t size bec omes an important
achieve the other. For example, when the controlled variable. As a high circulating load
grinding circuit is operating at its full capacity at a fixed produc t size lowers energy
and the ore bec omes harder, the same consumption, control of circulating load also
maximum through put cannot be maintained becomes important. Further for smooth flow of
without sacrificing the requirement in the pulp from the mill it is necessary to control the
grind. mill density below a critical level. Another basic
88
MPT-2013
89
MPT-2013
4.2 Measurement of Density of Slurry This can be inferred from a model of the cyclone
(or the classifier in the circuit) or can be obtained
The only satisfactory method for measuring
by direct measurement. Both techniques have
slurry density is the Gama ray instrument. This
been successfully used in grinding circuit
instrument is based on the princ iple of
control. At our Turamdih Plant Particle size
transmission of Gama ray through the slurry.
indicator is in use. The basic principle is, as the
As the slurry becomes densor it transmits less
slurry flows through the Partic le Size
and this shielding is used to measure the slurry
Transmitter (ISTS), individual particles are
density. Typical application include density
physically measured by a reciprocating caliper
measurement of thickener under flow, density
sensor, that converts each measurement into
of cyclone feed in closed loop grinding. The Gama
an electronic signal. These signals are processed
source is cesium 137 in the thickeners under
by a modern set of industrial electronics (PCCS)
flow line at Tummalapalle. mill
designed to operate in a harsh plant
environment.
Make: Endress+Hauser
Model: FMG 60
4.3 Measurement of Sump Level
Particle Size Indicator
A Pulsed Sound Weave, Generated By A Make: outokumpu
Transmitting Crystal, Is Reflected From The intec(outotec)
Interface Between The Fluids And Returned To Model: PSI-200
The Receiving Crystal. The Level Is Measured
In Terms Of The Time Required For The Sound 5. Codes and Standards
Pulse To Travel From The Transmitter To The
Interface And Return STANDARDS:
Instrumentation and control equipment will be
in accordance with the latest
Applicable standards of the following:
Institute of Electrical & Electronics
ENGINEER (IEEE)
Instrument Society of America (ISA)
Make: Endress+Hauser National Electrical Manufacturers’
Model: Micropilot Association (NEMA)
American National Standards Institute
4.4 Measurement of Particle Size of the Product (ANSI)
Indian Standards (IS)
One of the most important measurements Scientific Apparatus Manufacturers’
required for effective control of grinding circuits Association (SAMA)
is the particle size (distribution) of the product.
90
MPT-2013
Americ an Soc iety of Mec hanic al c) Finally, training of the plant metallurgists in
Engineers (ASMA) the necessary skills to develop, operate and
International Elec tro-tec hnic al maintain digital c omputer based control
Commission (IEC) system.
American Society for Testing Materials
(ASTM) 8. Conclusion
Underwriters’ Laboratories (UL) For automating industrial wet grinding
Institute of Printed Circuits (IPC) c irc uits, the nec essary instruments,
Deutsche Institute Normale (DIN) transducers, actuators and other pieces of
British Standards Institute (BSI) hardware equipment are readily available in
All other national standards meeting or our country. Substantial economic benefits can
exceeding the requirements of the above be realized by automating mineral processing
listing shall also be considered. operations.
6. Metering Bases and Chart units It must be emphasised here that, to derive the
maximum benefits out of automatic control,
The following system of units shall be followed mechanical breakdowns in the mill should be
throughout the specification eliminated or minimized through adequate
unless otherwise mentioned. maintenance.
a) Pressure: Kg/Sq.cm; b) Differential Pressure:
mm of Water Column/Kg/Sq.cm Acknowledgment
c ) Draught: mm of Water Column; d) The authors are thankful to the Management of
Temperature: Degree Celsius (deg.C) Uranium Corporation of India Limited for
e) Flow (solid / Slurry): Tonnes/ hr; f) Flow presentation of this paper and to the colleagues
(Water): NM3/hr; g) Density: gms/CC at Uranium Corporation of India Limited,
h) Level: Meter; i) Particle Size: mm with % pass Tummalapalle for their help and suggestion.
7. General Remarks References
In the Indian context, some important factors Course II, Optimisation and Control of Mineral
to be considered while opting for automatic Beneficiation Plants. Khetrinagar: 2nd-7th Feb,
control systems are. 1987.
a) Availability and after sales service facilities Tender doc ument for UCTL-1,
for special purpose sensing instruments, the Crushing,Grinding etc. prepared by M/s DCPL,
controller hardware and process control Kolkata.
computers,
b) In plant maintenanc e fac ilities for
minimizing mechanical breakdowns and also
for the additional instrumentation required for
automation
91
MPT-2013
*******
92
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Keywords: Ball mills; design and scale-up; power specific parameters; fines production rate.
93
MPT-2013
94
MPT-2013
mill operating conditions were: % solids: 60; N: value does not change and remains constant
0.6; U: 1.0, J: 0.5. It can be seen in Fig. 2 that as up to U=0.8. After this point, the F** values
the mill speed increases from 50 to 70% critical, c ontinuously decrease up to the U= 0.2.
the F** value does not show any significant Moreover, there is an overall decrease of 38% in
increase. Further increase in the mill speed leads the F** value.
to a sharp decline in the F** value.
96
MPT-2013
3.5. Effect of mill diameter operating conditions, is not correct. They have
shown that even the breakage distribution
Siddique (1977) has presented data on dry function varies significantly with the mill
grinding of 10/14 mesh limestone in 25.4, 38.1 operating conditions. The overall result of the
and 76.2 cm diameter ball mills. The mill speed, variation in all the S and B parameters is
ball load and particle load values corresponded reflected in the rate of production of fines. It is
to: (N: 0.6; J: 0.5; U: 1.0). Balls of four different for this reason that the F* parameter is more
diameters, 12.7, 19.05, 25.4 and 38.1 mm, were appropriate for carrying out the scale-up and
used for preparing the ball charge. Fig. 8 shows design work. Even the Bond (1960,1961) scale-
the variation of F** with mill diameter for this up model is based on the rate of production of
set of operating conditions. It can be seen that fines, whic h is c harac terized by the
grindability parameter, G, of the Bond work
the F** value increases linearly with mill
index equation.
diameter, showing an overall increase of 16%.
It should be pointed out that in the mineral
processing plants most of the grinding is carried
out in the wet mode. However, no significant
data is available in the literature on the wet
mode of operation. The grindability test of Bond
is a dry batch grinding test. And, the scale-up
model of Herbst and Fuerstenau (1980) is also
based on dry grinding data.
4. Conclusions
97
MPT-2013
In view of the complex nature of variation in Berlioz, L.M., 1966. Kinetics of dry grinding. M.S.
the value of the F* parameter, it is proposed that Thesis, University of California, Berkeley,
depending on the likely range of operating Calif., USA.
conditions for the production mill, the optimum Bond, F.C., 1960. Confirmation of the third
values of various operating variables should theory. Trans. AIME 217, 139-153.
be established by carrying out some well Bond, F.C., 1961. Crushing and grinding
designed grinding experiments in a laboratory calculations. Brit. Chem. Eng. 6, 378-391.
ball mill of a moderate size. Gupta, V.K., Kapur, P.C., 1976. A c ritical
appraisal of the discrete size models of
Nomenclature
grinding kinetics. in: Rumf, H., Schonert,
bi,j weight fraction of the material breaking K. (Eds.), Proceedings, Fourth European
out of sieve size interval j that reports to Symposium Zerkleinern, Dec hema
sieve size interval i. Monographien 79, Nr. 1576-1599, Verlag
Bi,,j fraction of broken product that is finer Chemie, Weinheim, pp. 447-465.
than lower size limit of the size interval i Gupta, V.K, 2013. Validation of an energy-size
when particles of size interval j undergo relationship obtained from a similarity
breakage solution to the batch grinding equation. Powder
F* absolute rate of production of fine material Technol. 249, 396-402.
per unit power input Gupta, V.K., Sharma, S., 2013. Analysis of ball
F** power specific absolute rate of production mill grinding operation using mill power
of fine material relative to the specific kinetic parameters. Adv. Powder
corresponding value for some chosen Technol. (in press).
value of the operating condition under Herbst, J.A., Fuerstenau, D.W., 1973. The zero
consideration order produc tion of fine sizes in
Fi mass fraction of particulate solids finer comminution and its implications in
than sieve i simulation, Trans. AIME 241, 538-546.
H total mass of the particulate charge in the Herbst, J.A., Fuerstenau, D.W., 1980. Scale-up
mill procedure for continuous grinding mill
J fraction of mill volume filled by static ball design using population balance models.
charge Int. J. Miner. Process. 7, 1 - 31.
Mi mass fraction of the particulate solids in Kim, J.H. 1974. Normalized model for wet batch
the sieve size interval i ball milling, Ph.D. Dissertation, University
N fraction of critical speed of mill of Utah, Utah, USA.
P net power drawn by mill Malghan, S.G., 1975. The scale-up of ball mills
Si specific breakage rate for particles of size using population balance models. D. Eng.
class i Dissertation. University of California,
t grinding time Berkeley, California.
U fraction of void volume of the static ball Reid, K.J., 1965. A solution to the batch grinding
charge occupied by the particulate solids equation. Chem. Eng. Sci.. 20, 953-963.
Siddique, M., 1977. A kinetic approach to ball
References mill scale-up for dry and wet systems.
Austin, L.G., Klimpel, R.R., Luckie, P.T., 1984. M.S.Thesis, University of Utah, USA.
Process Engineering of Size Reduction: Ball Smaila, F.M., 1982. An investigation of the
Milling, Society of Mining Engineers, New kinetics of dry batch ball milling. M.S.
York, pp. 341-384. Thesis, The Pennsylvania State University,
Pennsylvania, USA.
*******
98
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Bond Work Index, Wi, is widely used for estimation of the mill motor power and the size of ball
and rod mills for grinding of minerals, ores, cement and various other materials. The definition of
Work Index has no sound theoretical basis. It is purely an empirical correlation developed from a
large amount of plant operating data. In case of complex, non-homogeneous materials which
exhibit significant variation in the breakage characteristics with particle size, and in case of very
soft and very hard materials, Wi value fails to provide a reasonable estimate of the power required
to grind the material to the required degree of fineness. Therefore, it is found that in most of the
plants the grinding mills are overdesigned to reduce the risk. This paper discusses some of the
important drawbacks and limitations of the Bond Work Index with a view to developing a better
understanding from the point of view of its correct interpretation and practical application.
Keywords: Size reduction, Rod and ball mills, Scale-up, Specific power consumption, Bond work
index
99
MPT-2013
100
MPT-2013
of the feed passes. We have used here letter y for one for which á value is 0.5. It follows that the
particle size because we are now considering greater is the deviation in á value from a value
the actual feed to the grinding mill and the of 0.5, the greater will be the error in the
actual mill product. As Bond proposed his Third predicted Work Index value.
Theory after rejecting the theories of Rittinger
(1867) and Kick (1885), originally his Third 2.3. Influence of the X values on the accuracy
Theory referred to the material being actually of the work index
broken in the mill. Later, while proposing Eqs. (1) The standard procedure for preparation of the
and (2) he used the 80% passing sizes of the fresh fresh feed for carrying out the Bond grindability
feed to the grinding circuit and the final circuit test requires stage crushing of the as received
product, i.e., the classifier overflow( test sieve sample of the test material to 100% passing 6
undersize in case of Eq.(2)). No justification was mesh sieve. It has been observed that in a large
given by Bond for doing so. It should be noted number of cases the 80% passing size for the
that in general the three sets of x, X and y values fresh feed prepared in this manner,X80(f), lies in
are quite different in magnitude. In view of these a narrow range of 1900 – 2100 µm, and the 80%
passing size for the last c yc le test sieve
observations, it can be concluded that Eqs. (1)
undersize product,X80(p), lies in a narrow range
and (2) are purely empirical equations and have
of 110-125 µm (see Table 1). In such cases, it can
nothing to do with Bond’s original Third Theory. be easily seen that irrespective of the value of
2.2. Choice of the exponent of particle size the exponent , for a chosen value of S, the
work index value will be mainly determined
In Eqs. (1), (2) and (3) Bond, based on his by the parameter G. However, if the values of
argument that the energy input is proportional the parameters X80(f) and X80(p) are found to be
to the new crack tip length produced, has used far removed from the respective range of values
mentioned above, as is the case with some
a value of 0.5 for the exponent of particle size.
samples of iron ore and chromite ore, depending
However, it has been shown that it is true only
on the value the Bond Work Index value
for an ‘ideal Bond material” (Austin and Luckie, obtained from Eq. (2) can have significant error
1972; Herbst and Fuerstenau, 1980). A more (note that the error will be zero if = 0.5).
general energy-size relationship derived by
Kapur (1972) and verified by Gupta (2013) is Table 1: Bond grindability test data for
different materials and the work index value.
C C S. No. Material G, g/rev X 80 (f), µm X 80 (p), µm Wi, kWh/t
E
(4)
x ( p ) x80 ( f )
80
1 Anthracite 0.156 1866 121 105.2
2 Nut coke 0.415 1720 125 48.7
3 Pyroxinite 1.123 1949 123 20.8
where C is a mill-material constant, and á is 4 Olivine 1.553 1359 116 16.4
the exponent of particle size v in the following 5 Iron ore 1.602 1925 110 14.5
6 Limestone-1 1.662 2220 110 13.8
expression for the grinding rate parameter k
7 Dolomite 1.860 1964 110 12.8
k( ) A (5) 8 Limestone-2 1.971 1971 113 12.4
9 Iron ore-1 2.260 1185 114 12.1
10 Iron ore-2 3.003 1180 108 9.4
where A is a mill-material constant. The value
11 Iron ore-3 4.830 1510 95 4.3
of á has been found to vary in the range of 0 to 2 12 Chromite-1 3.780 1569 80 6.0
(Gupta, 2013). 13 Chromite-2 4.730 792 92 6.3
14 Chromite-3 5.742 1690 125 5.7
In Eq. (4) if C is replaced by (10 Wi) and á is
assigned a value of 0.5, we obtain Eq. (3) of Bond. It should be pointed out that Eq. (2) was
Thus, we see that an ‘ideal Bond material’ is the developed by Bond using the experimental data
101
MPT-2013
obtained on a 2.44 m diameter wet overflow residence time distribution of the Bond mill
ball mill operated in closed circuit at a 250% used for determination of the grindability
circulating load and the data obtained for same corresponds to plug flow (characterized by a
materials by c arrying out standard zero variance) as it is operated in the batch
grindability tests in the 300 mm x 300 mm size mode; the residence time distribution of a
standard Bond mill. Though it is not known, it production mill is a well distributed function
is likely that the range of X80 and x80 values for for which the variance value is significantly
the two sets of tests conducted in the two mills greater than zero, and (ii) the test sieve used in
were nearly same and similar to those the grindability test acts as a perfect classifier;
mentioned above. If this was really true, then the efficiency of the classifier used in the
the values of X80, x80 and á did not have any industrial grinding circuit is significantly lower
significant effect on the final result, as can be than 100%. For production mills, the value of
seen by substituting for Wi in Eq.(1) from Eq. the normalized variance of the residence time
(2). In fact, for a special case where we have: distribution is typically in the range of 0.3 to
x80(p) = X80(p) and x80(f) = X80(f), substituting for 0.5 (Marchand et al., 1980). In the context of the
Wi in Eq. (1) from Eq. (2) we obtain ‘m perfect mixers in series’ model of the
residence time distribution, a normalized
48.95T
P (6) variance value of 0.5 corresponds to m = 2 and a
S 0.23 G0.82 value of 0.333 corresponds to m = 3 (Austin et
al., 1984). Following the example given by
Thus, we see that for a given S value the power Herbst and Fuerstenau (1980), in Table 2 are
required for the size reduction job is mainly given the values of c orrec tion fac tors
determined by the parameter G if the two sets corresponding to two values of the normalized
of x80 and X80 values are same or nearly same. variance of the RTD and two values of the
But if in any particular case the two sets of x80 c lassifier effic ienc y. If the value of the
and X80 values differ significantly or they lie normalized variance of the RTD for the 2.44 m
outside the range covered by Bond in his test diameter mill used by Bond and the efficiency
work, the power estimates obtained using Bond of the classifier used by Bond were known, we
equation can be in error. could find out the corresponding correction
2.4. Understanding the significance of the factor from Table 1. It should be noted that this
exponent of ‘Grindability’ correction factor is already included in the
c onstant 48.95 of Eq. (2). However, an
Grindability, G, is expressed in grams of the fine appropriate correction factor should be worked
product produced per unit mill revolution. As out for each individual grinding circuit.
energy input to the mill is proportional to Table 2: Correction factor for the work index
grinding time, it follows that the energy value obtained from Eq. (2) as a function of the
required in kWh/ton should be inversely variance of the residence time distribution and
proportional to G. However, in Eq. (2) we notice the classifier efficiency.
that the exponent of G is 0.82 instead of 1. It can S. No. Normalize Number of Correction factor
be shown that this empirical exponent appears d variance perfect Classifier efficiency, %
in Bond’s correlation to account for two main of RTD mixers 100 70 50
1 0.000 ∞ 1.0 1.167 1.546
differences in the grinding operation carried out
in the standard Bond grindability test ball mill 2 0.333 3 1.041 1.235 1.665
3 0.500 2 1.068 1.279 1.757
and an industrial production mill: (i) the
102
MPT-2013
In Eq. (2) the exponent of the grindability has a corresponding to the normal range for the
value 0.82. It will be seen that for G values weight percent solids (60-70%).
greater than 1 g/rev. the calculated work index
References
value will be greater than the one obtained with
a value of 1 for the exponent. For example, for Austin, L.G., Klimpel, R.R., Luckie, P.T., 1984.
the case G = 2 g/rev. an increase of 13.3% is Process Engineering of Size Reduction: Ball
obtained in the calculated work index value as Milling, Society of Mining Engineers, New
compared to the value obtained with a value of York. 341-384.
1.0 for the exponent. However, if the G value is Austin, L.G., Luckie, P.T., 1972. Grinding
lower than 1 g/rev., it results in a decrease in equations and the Bond work index. Trans.
the work index value (a decrease of 11.7% for a SME-AIME. 252, 259-266.
G value of 0.5 g/rev.). Thus, we see that a G value Bond, F.C., 1952. The third theory of
dependent correction factor is not appropriate comminution. Trans. AIME. 193, 484-494.
in the Bond model. Bond, F.C., 1960. Confirmation of the third
theory. Trans. AIME 217. 139-153.
2.5. Effect of the operating and design variables Bond, F.C., 1960. Crushing and grinding
on energy requirement calculations. Brit. Chem. Eng. 6, 378-391.
Gupta, V.K, 2013. Validation of an energy-size
A major criticism of the Bond model is its
relationship obtained from a similarity
inability to account for the effect of operating
solution to the batch grinding equation.
variables such as the ball size distribution, mill
Powder Technol. 249, 396-402.
speed, ball load and slurry density on the
Gupta, V.K., Sharma, S., 2013. Analysis of ball
specific energy consumption. It has been
mill grinding operation using mill power
recently shown (Gupta and Sharma, 2013) that
specific kinetic parameters. Adv. Powder
there can be up to 40% variation in the specific
Technol. (in press).
energy consumption on account of these
Herbst, J.A., Fuerstenau, D.W., 1980. Scale-up
variables. An analysis of the effect of the
procedure for continuous grinding mill
operating variables in terms of the work index
design using population balance models.
of the Bond model is beyond the scope of this
Int. J. Miner. Process. 1, 1-31.
paper.
Kapur, P.C., 1972. Self-preserving size spectra
3. Conclusions of comminuted particles. Chem. Eng. Sci.
27, 425-431.
Based on the discussion of the Bond model Kick, F., 1885. Das Gesetz der proporionalen
presented above, in conclusion it can be said Widerstande und siene Anwendung,
that though the Bond model gives reasonably Arthur Felix, Leipzig, 118.
good estimates of the power requirements in a Marchand, J.C., Hodouin, D., Everell, M.D., 1980.
number of cases, there is a considerable scope Residence time distribution and mass
for improving the accuracy of the energy Transport c harac teristic s of large
estimates by using the size-mass balance industrial grinding mills. O’Shea, J., Polis,
mathematical modelling approach (Herbst and M. (Eds.), Proceedings Automation in
Fuerstenau, 1980; Austin et al.; 1984; Gupta, Mining, Mineral and Metal Processing, 3rd
2013; Gupta and Sharma, 2013). In our opinion, IFAC Symposium, Montreal, Canada,
this is partic ularly true for materials Pergamon Press. 295-302.
characterized by a grindability value less than Von Rittinger, P.R., 1867. Lehrbuc k der
1.0 and more than 3.0 g/rev., and for those Aufbereitungskunde, Ernst und. Korn,
grinding operations where the slurry density Berlin, 595.
is significantly lower or higher than the value
*******
103
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
As the Coal is mined from the seam, the breakage of coal starts and continues till the end utilization
of coal. During the breakage process all reduced or broken coal does not have the same size and
same percentage of each fraction. The characteristics of coal also may not be the same for all size
fractions. They may vary with the each size fraction; thereby it is important to understand how
these characteristics are varying with different size fraction. In the present context breakage
study adopting the simple drop test was conducted to investigate the changes in various properties
like ash content, volatile matter, ultimate analysis, HGI, CSN and caking index. The study has
been made using the two low volatile medium ash medium caking coal. From the study it was
observed that in a particular size fraction there is considerable improvement in almost all the
properties viz. ash from 24.30% to 18.07 % and 27.76% to 21.91 %, volatile matter from 19.08 to
21.25 % and 19.05 to 21.35 %, HGI from 56.13% to 61.71 and 64.98 to 81.51, CSN from 1.5 to 4.5 in
both cases and caking index from 16 to 18 & 19 respectively. Calorific values also show improvement
in both cases.
104
MPT-2013
105
MPT-2013
106
MPT-2013
107
MPT-2013
References
Fig. 7: Gross Calorific Value of Different ASTM D440-86, Standard Test Methods of Drop
Fractions of Coal Samples & Feed Shatter Test for Coal.
4. Conclusions IS 1350 Part 1 – 1984 (Reaffirmed 1996) Methods
of Test for Coal and Coke Part 1 Proximate
Study revealed that there is marked Analysis
improvement in basic characteristics of coal, IS 1353: 1993, Methods of Test for Coal
when larger size of coal subjected to drop test, Carbonization -Caking Index, Swelling
in particular, ash content, volatile matter Number and (LT) Gray-King Assay
content, free swelling index, calorific value and IS 4433: 1979 (Reaffirmed 1994), Methods for
hardgrove grindabilty index of both coal determination of Hardgrove
Grinadability Index of coal
*******
108
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
109
MPT-2013
highlighted. This paper specifically focuses on deduced from the PSD is ~0.1 m2/g. BET specific
the changes in particulate characteristics of a surface area, on the other hand, has been found
high surface area boehmite during high energy to be exceptionally large, ~264 m2/g compared
ball milling. to that reported in many studies (~1 m2/g). Such
a large difference is attributed to the difference
2. Materials and Methods in the preparation process. Most of the low
2.1. Boehmite surface area boehmites described in earlier
studies have been prepared by hydrothermal
Details of the preparation and characterization
methods whereas boehmite used in this study
of boehmite used in this study have been
has been prepared by thermal decomposition
reported earlier [Alex et al., 2013]. Detailed
of gibbsite. Constitutional water released
characterisation using X-ray diffraction (XRD),
during thermal decomposition of gibbsite
Fourier Transform Infrared (FTIR) and thermal
creates large number of slit shaped pores, as
analysis studies has shown that the test sample
shown in Fig. 1, for their exit and thereby
is phase-pure boehmite.
resulting in a highly porous boehmite. XRD
2.2. Mechanical Activation (JCPDS No. 83-2384) and FTIR studies have
A batch type planetary mill (Pulverisette P6, shown that the synthesized material is phase
Fritsch GmbH, Germany) has been used for pure boehmite.
mechanical activation (MA). Milling conditions
are: ball to powder ratio =30:1, rotational speed
=400 rpm, milling time 0-240 min.
2.3.Characterization
Particle size distributions (PSD) of milled and
unmilled boehmite samples have been
determined using a particle size analyzer based
on laser diffraction (Model: Mastersizer,
Malvern, UK). Micromeritics ASAP2020 surface
area analyser has been used to measure the BET
specific surface area and pore size distributions.
Fig. 1: SEM micrographs of boehmite showing
Geometric specific surface area has been
slit like pores on the surface
deduc ed from the PSD distribution.
Morphological features are studied using a 2.3. Particle size distribution of milled
scanning electron microscope (SEM) (Model: boehmite
840A, Hitachi, Japan). Particle size data of milled boehmite obtained
from the sizer are presented in Fig. 2 in terms of
3. Results and Discussions
reduction ratio of median size; i.e. the ratio of
3.3. Boehmite used median size at any milling time, d (50, t) and
Boehmite used in this study has been found to median size of unmilled sample, d(50, 0) is plotted
as a function of milling time. High milling
have a monomodal distribution with a median
efficiency of planetary milling is evident in Fig.
size, d 50 of 110 mm. Other charac teristic
2; particle size (median size) shows ~60 times
diameters, d10 and d90 are 77 mm and 153 mm, reduction in just 15 min of milling. Beyond 15
respectively. Geometric specific surface area min of milling, however, the reduction ratio is
110
MPT-2013
111
MPT-2013
the influence of planetary milling have been structural changes offset (and surpass) the effect
studied using a SEM; SEM micrographs of of 75% reduction in specific surface area.
particles milled for 3 min and 60 min and are 3. Conclusions
presented in Fig. 4 (a) and Fig. 4(b), respectively.
Disjointing of the platelets (of initial unmilled Conc lusions drawn from the study is
boehmite) oc c urs during early stages of summarised below:
milling. Images at higher magnification show Sharp size reduction in early stages of
smaller particles sticking to the larger particles planetary milling shows high milling
even for 3 min milled samples as seen in Fig. efficiency
4(a). As the milling time is increased to 60 min, Aggregation of particles as a result of
the smaller particle sticking to the bigger ones particle-particle interactions
diminishes almost completely, and aggregation Anomalous decrease in BET specific surface
of smaller elongated particles is observed in the area of boehmite with milling time
sample [Fig. 4(b)]. Such severe aggregation is Changes in pore characteristics leads to the
responsible for the annihilation of micropores decrease in specific surface area
and decrease in specific surface area, in turn. Despite the anomalous decrease in specific
surface area, reactivity increases with
(a) (b) milling
References
Alex, T. C., Kumar, R., Roy and S. K., Mehrotra,
S.P., 2013. Leaching behaviour of high
surface area synthetic boehmite in
Fig. 4: SEM images of milled boehmite: (a) 3 NaOH solution. Hydrometallurgy. 137,
min (b) 60 min 23–32.
2.3. Reactivity Barret, E. P., Joyner, L. G. and Halenda P. P., 1951.
The determination of pore volume and
Reactivity, in general, is synonymous with area distributions in porous substances.
specific surface area; it increases as the specific I. Computations from nitrogen isotherms.
surface area increases while a decrease occurs J. Am. Chem. Soc. 73, 373-380.
when specific surface area decreases. In spite of Juhasz, Z. and Opoczky, L., 1990. Mechanical
the anomalous decrease in BET specific surface Ac tivation of Minerals by Grinding:
area, it is observed that that the reactivity of Pulverizing and Morphology of Particles.
boehmite in terms of alkali dissolution and Akademiai kiado, Budapest.
thermal transformation (details are not covered Pawlek, F., Kheiri, M. J. and Kammel, R., 1992.
here) increases with the milling time. It is the The leaching behaviour of bauxite during
struc tural c hanges suc h as inc rease in mec hano-c hemic al treatment, in:
microstrain, dec rease in microc rystallite Cutshall, E. R. (Ed.), Light Metals. The
dimension etc. (not detailed here) that are Minerals, Metals & Materials Society,
responsible for the enhanced the reactivity; Warrendale, US. 91-95.
Taskin, E., Yidiz, K. and Alp, A., 2009. Direct
alkaline leac hing of mec hanic ally
activated diasporic bauxite. Miner. Metall.
Process. 26(4), 222-225.
*******
112
MPT-2013
GRAVITY SEPARATION
113
MPT-2013
114
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Jig testing is a widely accepted method for determining the amenability of an ore to gravity
separation at relatively coarse sizes of up to 25 mm. However, this type of test often requires a
relatively large sample size of up to 500 kilograms or more. This sample requirement can be
problematic for new projects in the exploration and early development stage when only limited
amounts of expensive drill core are available. A relatively simple laboratory test using
approximately 200 individual pieces of suitably crushed sample will be described. The procedure
usually requires less than 5 kilograms of representative sample and measures the specific gravity
of each numbered piece using a simple “Jolley” balance. The “Jolley” balance data is then corrected
against the actual specific gravity using the LeChatlier flask method. The corrected data is used to
construct a yield curve graph of weight vs. specific gravity. Several examples of this method are
provided for Barite ores and a comparison of the yield curve with an actual operating plant are
provided.
1. Introduction
Gravity testing coarse samples of Barite, iron requires equipment with a minimum bed
ore, or coal with particle sizes greater than 12.5 surface area of 650 mm2 and a continuous test
millimeters is usually limited to either heavy can often require up to 500 kilograms or more
liquid — heavy media techniques or continuous of sample. These relatively large test units are
jigging techniques. Heavy media or jig testing required to ensure that the three principles of
is preferred due to the toxic nature of several jigging, namely differential acceleration,
organic heavy liquids and the limited specific hindered settling, and consolidated tricking, are
gravity ranges of the new inorganic heavy met on the large particles to be tested.
liquids. Heavy media testing usually requires a An alternative to the large scale expensive
large scale continuous test unit to keep the media jigging tests was developed by Dawson
in suspension and this in turn requires large Metallurgical Laboratories to evaluate the
amounts of sample. Jig testing of coarse material response of samples from several Barite
exploration projects. Limited amounts of
* Correspending Author: Philip Thompson*
expensive drill core were available for this work
Senior Mineral Processing Advisor,
Dawson Metallurgical Laboratories—FLSmidth, Inc. and full scale jigging tests were not an option.
7158 S. FLSmidth Drive The alternative technique developed consisted
Midvale, Utah 84047-5559 USA of specific gravity determinations of many
philip.thompson@flsmidth.com
115
MPT-2013
individual particles and the construction of a gravity due to the fact that the piece may not
product yield curve from these individual be c ompletely wetted throughout. This
particle measurements. correction factor varies from approximately
1.00 to 1.09 as indicated in Figure 2.
2. Test procedures and materials
Only two pieces of laboratory equipment are Weight in Air Weight in Water
required for the alternative technique—a
Balance Balance
“Jolley” Balanc e for measurement of the
apparent specific gravities of individual sample
Fishing line Fishing line
pieces, and a Le Chatlier specific gravity
volumetric flask for accurate determination of
the true specific gravity of the pieces. A
sample sample
schematic of the “Jolley” Balance is presented Beaker with water
in Figure 1.
The test procedure consists of crushing a
representative sample, usually 10 to 20
Beaker with water
kilograms, to an appropriate jig feed size, Figure 1. Schematic of “Jolley” Balance
usually minus 25 mm. It should be emphasized
that the appropriate weight of sample to be 3. Calculations and data manipulation
crushed will be determined by appropriate The data obtained by the procedure described
sampling protocols The 1.7 mm (10 Tyler mesh) in the previous section is used to generate a
material is screened off and, depending upon graph of product yield vs. product specific
the weight on minus 10 mesh, this fraction can gravity using the apparent specific gravities
be tested separately by spirals, or discarded calculated from the “Jolley” Balance. The
depending upon its specific gravity. Two apparent specific gravity is the weight of
hundred (200) individual pieces of +1.7 mm sample piece in air divided by water volume
sample are then selected at random and displaced (sample weight in air minus sample
numbered from 1 to 200 with a magic marker weight in water). These apparent specific
or other suitable waterproof ink. The total gravities are then correc ted against the
weight of these selected pieces is approximately LeChatlier true specific gravities by the factor
2 kilograms and each individual piece usually illustrated on the next page.
weighs between 3 and 15 grams. The apparent Specific Gravity Correction Factor
specific gravity of each piece is then determined Le Chatlier/Jolley Balance
1.10
using the “Jolley” Balance. The 200 pieces are
Correction factor, Le Chatlier/Jolley Balance
be noted that the apparent specific gravity by Figure 2. LeChatlier vs.“Jolley” Balanc e
“Jolley” Balance is lower than the true specific Correction
116
MPT-2013
A summary of the calc ulations and data Table 1: Variation of Product Yield with
manipulations are presented in the following Sample Population
bullets.
Database Product Yield, wt%
Calculate the specific gravity of each # of pieces at 4.2 g/cc
individual piece based upon the weights
100 66.3
in air and water.
200 63.2
Arrange the data in descending order of
300 63.1
specific gravity (highest to lowest).
Calculate individual and cumulative Product yield curves for three different Barite
weights, cumulative weight percentage of ores are illustrated in figure 3 on the following
all samples, individual sample volumes, page. Inspection of these results indicate that
and cumulative volume of all samples. samples A and C are not suitable for coarse (25
Apply the LeChatlier/”Jolley” Balance mm) jigging due to low product yields at Barite
correction factor to every specific gravity market specifications of 4.2 gm/cc specific
value using the appropriate factor for each gravity. These two samples were exploration
group. Adjust the weight in water and drill core from a potential Barite deposit in Asia.
the corresponding volume for each piece Sample B was crushed ore feed to an operating
in accordance with the corrected specific Barite jigging plant in North America. This
gravity. sample has a relatively high 4.2 gm/cc product
Re-arrange the adjusted data in yield of 63% of plant feed. The laboratory-
descending order of corrected specific generated yield curve for sample B was
gravity. compared with actual jig plant performance
Calculate the cumulative product specific over a period of several days. Results, presented
gravity by dividing the c umulative in figure 4, indicate excellent agreement
product weight by the cumulative product between plant performance and laboratory
volume for the entire data set of 200 results.
samples.
Graph the cumulative product yield vs. the
cumulative corrected (true) specific gravity. Yeild Curves for 3 Barite Ores
100
4. Results 90
70 4.2 gm/cc
determine the minimum number of individual
60
sample pieces that would be required. Sample 50 Sample A
10
difference in the product yield at 4.2 gm/cc 0
specific gravity was obtained between 100 and 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 4.0 4.1
Product Specific Gravity, gm/cc
4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5
117
MPT-2013
5. Discussion Comp arison of Laboratory Generated Yeild Curve with Actual Plant
Production
The relatively simple laboratory procedure 100
30
therefore ideally suited to projects where only 20 Lab Generated Yeild Curve
*******
118
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Misplacement of Particles in Liquid Solid Fluidization
Abstract
Liquid solid fluidization principle is used for particle separation in mineral processing based on
size, shape and density. Different particles have different terminal velocities which affects the
expansion of these particles under the action of liquid velocity in liquid solid fluidization. Generally
heavier particles report to bottom of the bed and lighter particles report to top of the bed. However,
due to wide size distribution of feed layer inversion happens which allows lighter particles to
report to bottom of column and heavier particles to report to top of column. This phenomenon
misplaces the particles. In addition to this presence of near gravity materials and flaky particles
also contribute to the misplacement of particles. The present work aims at understanding the
misplacement of particles in liquid solid fluidization. In present work synthetic mixture of high
grade iron ore and quartz was used to study the misplacement of particles in separation. For the
quantification of particle misplacement an index was introduced called misplacement index.
119
MPT-2013
equipment which can be used for beneficiation Synthetic mixture of high grade iron ore
of finer size particles. Among these separators particles and high grade quartz particles were
flotex density separator and allflux mineral used for the present study. The particle size of
separators uses the principle of fluidization for iron ore sample used was -150+75 micron and
separation of particles. that of quartz particles was -100+75. The true
density of the iron ore sample used was 4.6 and
Use of fluidization princ iple in mineral
that of the quartz was 2.63. For eac h
processing is gaining importance day by day.
experimental run pressure drop and expanded
Wet beneficiation method uses liquid-solid
bed height was noted down. Initially
fluidization principle for particle separation.
fluidization of only iron ore particles were
These liquid-solid fluidized bed separator uses
carried out; then fluidization of only quartz
physical characteristics of particles i.e., size,
particles was carried out. After the two initial
shape, and density for beneficiation of ores.
experimental runs all experiments were
Extensive research had been carried out to
performed using synthetic mixtures of iron ore
understand liquid-solid fluidization (Asif, 1997,
and quartz in weight ratio of 7:3 (iron ore :
2002; Barghi, et al. 2003; Funamizu and
quartz). For understanding the partic le
Takakuwa 1996; Moritomi et al., 1986,
misplac ement in every experiment with
Mukherjee and Mishra 2007; Qian, et al., 1993;
synthetic mixture samples were collected at five
Tripathy et al., 2013). However, the
different points along the axis of the column at a
understanding of particle misplacement in these
given superficial velocity. The collected sample
fluidized bed density separators is still limited,
was then analyzed for iron ore and quartz content.
because the ore feed to these fluidized bed
separators have wide size distribution, wide
density distribution and are highly irregular
shape particles. A liquid-solid fluidized bed
density separator is considered to be efficient if
it separates particles based on their difference
in specific gravity.
The aim of the present study would be to
understand the misplacement of particles in a
fluidized bed separator at a fundamental level
and quantify this misplacement. In addition to
this effect of different parameters on the
misplacement of particles would also be studied. Fig. 1: Schematic diagram of experimental setup
2. Materials and Methods (Tripathy et al. 2013)
The schematic diagram of the experimental set- The hydrodynamics of mixing and segregation
up is shown in Fig. 6. The experimental set-up were normally quantified with mixing index and
consists of a fluidization column of 100 mm segregation index. However these indexes are not
diameter having a plenum chamber. The plenum effective in quantifying the particle misplacement
chamber is filled with glass balls for uniform in fluidized bed density separator. When liquid
distribution of the water into the column. The solid fluidized bed is used as density separator
pressure difference in the fluidized column was in mineral processing, it is desired that lighter
measured using mercury manometer and particle should be completely segregated from
flowrate of the water was measured using heavier partic les. Two extreme state of
rotameter. A centrifugal pump was used for segregation may occur in such density separators
pumping the water (Tripathy et al. 2013). depending on the particle sizes of the lighter and
heavier particles as given below:
120
MPT-2013
a) extreme stages. The indexes mentioned above pressure drop across fludized bed. Fig. 2 shows
gives different index values for When all the the pressure drop across the fluidized bed at
heavier particles are at the bottom and all different superficial velocity. From Fig. 2 it was
the lighter particles are at the top part of the observed that all the plots follow the standard
fluidized bed column. graph of fluidization. It was also observed from
b) When all the lighter particles are at the Fig. 2 that pressure drop for iron ore bed
bottom and all the heavier particles are at particles was more compared to the quartz and
the top part of the fluidized bed column synthetic mixture bed of particles. The result is
(complete stage of layer inversion). natural as iron particles are heavier compared
The second type (i.e. b) of extreme segregation to others. Yet another observation from Fig. 2
occurs when size of the lighter particles are was that the pressure drop across synthetic
sufficiently larger than the heavier particles. The mixture (iron ore + quartz) was in between the
stage of completely mixed fluidized bed is an pressure drop across iron ore and quartz. The
intermediate stage between these both the order of pressure drop across the fluidized bed
extremes of segregation mentioned above. This for different materials is given below.
sometimes does not give clear picture of the
Iron ore > Synthetic mixture (iron ore + quartz)
particle misplacement. Because of which in
> Quartz
present work for quantification of particle
misplacement an index called “misplacement
index” was proposed. The misplacement index 12000
can be calculated as given below:
10000
x x LP
Pressure drop, N/m2
121
MPT-2013
125
The values of fraction of iron ore or quartz
Expanded bed height, cm
60
50
110 lph 70 lph
considered underflow material. It was observed
40 that all the values of index are negative. It was
30 also observed that with the increase of overflow
20
height the misplacement index value increases
10
or in other wards the index values are more near
0
to zero (as all the misplacement index values
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 are negative). This means as the overflow height
Bed height, cm
is less (from bottom of the column) particle
Fig. 4: Solid concentration profile of the separation is better and misplacement is less
fluidized bed column with respect to iron ore.
122
MPT-2013
120 120
100 100
80 80
Percentage
Percentage
60
a Iron ore %
60 b Iron ore %
Quaetz % Quaetz %
40 40
20
20
0
0
0 20 40 60 80 100 120
0 20 40 60 80 100
Bed height, cm
Bed height, cm
120 120
100 100
80 80
Percentage
Percentage
60 c Iron ore %
60 d Iron ore %
Quaetz % Quaetz %
40 40
20 20
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40
Bed height, cm Bed height, cm
Fig. 5: Variation of iron ore and quartz concentration with the bed height for different superficial
velocities a) 0.0672 cm/s, b) 0.0531 cm/s, c) 0.0389 cm/s, and d) 0.0248 cm/s
-0.85
-0.9
superficial velocity.
-0.95
-0.7
-1
0 0.01 0.02 0.03 0.04 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.08
-1.05 -0.8
-1.1
-0.9
Misplacement Index
-1.15
Overflow height, cm -1
-1.1
Fig. 6: Variation of misplacement index with
respect to overflow height -1.2
-1.3
Similar to Fig. 6 the variation of misplacement
index with the change of superficial velocity was -1.4
123
MPT-2013
*******
124
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Floatex density separator is a new generation classifier making use of different particle settling rates
to segregate particles based on size shape and density. To understand the process dynamics, various
studies have been carried out in floatex density separator while treating different minerals like coal,
silica, chromite and iron ore. Most of these studies have focussed on the application of this unit at
different scale of operation. For better control a deeper insight to understandthe separation phenomena,
one has to study the effect of process parameters like teeter water flowrate, bed pressure, pulp density
and feed rates on the segregation of minerals. Present study deals with thestudy on effects of these
process parameters on the partition of minerals. Synthetic mixture of magnetite and silica was used
for the experimentation in the floatex density separator and the results are analysed statistically to
understand the influence of these process parameters on partition of minerals. Further, main effects
has been analysed in terms of analysis of variance and regression analysis followed by study of
interactional effects byusing response surface plots. It is observed that in case of magnetite partition/
recovery, teeter water flow rate and bed pressure has played a vital role.
Keywords: Floatex density separator; advanced gravity separator, hindered settling, Fine particle
processing.
literature [Sarkar et al. (2008), Kumar et al.
1. Introduction
(2011), Tripathy et al. (2008)]. There
Floatex Density Separator (FDS) is an advanced areseveralpublished literature explaining
hindered settling classifier, also called as process dynamics incurred with respect to
counter-current and autogenous teetered bed classification as well as the concentration
separator, which makes use of particle settling operation and on its performance evaluation.
rates to segregate particles according to size, In the present study, an attempt has been made
shape and density. The basic working principle to understand the effect of process variables on
of FDS has been explained in detail in the segregation of minerals.
* Correspending Author: SHARATH KUMAR BHOJA, 2. Materials and methods
Manager, Mineral and Ferro Alloys Technology, Raw Material
and Iron Ma king Tech nology Group ,Ta ta Steel Ltd .,
2.1 Magnetite:
Ja msh edp ur- 83 1 0 07, INDIA. Co nta ct No.: + 91 About 600 kg of magnetite was processed
7763807445, E-mail:sharath.bhoja@tatasteel.com locally and the sample was beneficiated with
125
MPT-2013
the scheme mentioned in Figure 1 to obtain the variables on classification performance. The
maximum possible purity. The obtained variables and their levels are given in Table 3.
magnetic product from LIMS is the pure Experiments were carried out using a lab model
magnetite sample (99.6 % purity when Floatex Density Separator of 230 mm X 230 mm
measured using Davis Tube magnetic X 530 mm size (Outokumpu make). The
separator) for subsequent use in the FDS. The schematic diagram of the experimental setup
partial chemical analysisis tabulated in Table used for the present study is shown in Figure 3.
1 While conducting experiments, the feed slurry
was first pumped to the FDS at a desired flow
2.2. Silica
rate with the help of the pump while the
About 2 tons of heavy mineral sand tailings equipment was in operation. Samples from the
was received from Sathankulam, Tamil Nadu, overflow and underflow streams were collected
India for the experimental work. The after attainment of the steady stat only. The
representative sample analysed 99.5% Silica samples from the overflow and underflow
when tested using heavy liquid; Bromofrom; of streams were collected at steady state, dried,
density 2.86 kg/m3. This sample was then size weighed and analyzed for granulometry. The
reduced to <1mm (100% passing); in the results were then used calculate the Magnetite
laboratory roll crusher; which was used in the recovery (%), Silica recovery (%). Regression
entire experimental work. The partial chemical equations were developed for predicting the
analysis is tabulated in Table 2. response at different levels of variables by using
The size analysis of the magnetite and silica Design Experts®software. These equations were
sample is shown in Figure 2. The D80% passing then used to analyze the effect of process
size of the magnetite is 300 µm and Silica is 297 variables, viz. teeter water flow rate, set point,
µm. During material preparation the material feed rate and pulp density.
was made to pass through 1.0mm sieve to make Table 2: Chemical analysis of the silica sand
sure that the feed does not contain any particle
larger than 1 mm. Constituent Weight (%)
SiO2 97.48
Na 2O 0.05
K2O 0.13
MgO 0.12
CaO 0.01
FeO 0.74
Specific gravity 2.6
F eed inlet
line
Floatex
Overflow
density
discharge
separator
water
tank Underflo w
discharge
126
MPT-2013
Sl No Variables
Level Regression analysis was carried out and the
Min Max
model equations to predict the performance in
1 Teeter water (lpm) 10 16
2 Bed Pressure (bars) 6.7 7.9
terms of recovery to underflow fraction (%)
3 Feed rate (kg/h) 100 120 were generated. Further,to understand the
4 Feed Pup Density(% sol) 30 50 interactional effect of the parameters, response
4. Results and Discussion surface graphs were plotted and analysed for
the interactional effect of significant parameter
The test results were analysedusing the on the responses.
statistical techniques to understand the effect Regression equation:
of each variable, their interactional effects and
the significant variables were ascertained. The
results of the statistical analysis are presented
in Figure 4 and the main findings are described
in the following sections.
4.1. ANOVA
4.3. Magnetite recovery
It can be observed from the Figure 4 that in case
of primary effects, the Teeter water and Bed Figure from 5 to 7shows the effect of teeter water
pressure has major influence on magnetite and bed pressure atdifferent level of pulp
recovery to underflow fraction whereas, for density and feed rate. From Figure 5, it may be
silica recovery the pulp density also has major observed that the maximum recovery was
influence. In the binary effect, Feed rate x Bed obtained by operating the floatex at lower
pressure is significant in case of Silica recovery teeter water and bed pressure. At this
to underflow. The order of significance for the condition, the hindrance to the settling particles
responses are shown below is muc h low and the voidage will be
high[Kumar et al (2011)]. Hence the higher yield
to under flow fraction is expected [Raghu et al
(2010b) Kumar et al (20011)].Gradually by
increasing the teeter water and bed pressure
the magnetite recovery to underflow fraction
decreases.
Design-Expert® Software
Factor Coding: Actual
Magnetite Recovery
76
60
X1 = A: BP 80
X2 = B: TW
Magnetite recovery(%)
Actual Factors 75
C: PD = 30.27
D: FR = 100.54 70
60
significance of variables 55
Main effects: 16
15
14 7.9
Magnetite rec overy: Teeter water > Bed Teeter water flowrate(lpm) 12
13
7.3
7.6
pressure
11 7.0
127
MPT-2013
Similarly Figure 6shows the interactional effect rate and pulp density levels (Raghu et al (2010a).
at intermediate level of teeter water and bed Basically the silica particle reporting here may
pressure. It may be noticed here that with be of coarser size whic h has reported to
increasing the feed rate and pulp density to underflowdue to higher settling velocity.More
c entre level the magnetite rec overy to over the bed formed in this condition is having
underflow fraction decreases. more coarser silica particles which results in
the lower bed density.
Design-Expert® Software
Factor Coding: Actual
Magnetite Recovery
76 Design-Expert® Software
Factor Coding: Actual
60 Silica Recovery
37.8049
X1 = A: BP 80
X2 = B: TW 4.47531
Magnetite recovery(%)
Actual Factors 75 50
X1 = A: BP
C: PD = 40.27 X2 = B: TW
D: FR = 120.00 70 40
Actual Factors
Silica recovery(%)
65 C: PD = 30.27
30
D: FR = 100.00
60
20
55
10
0
16
15
7.9 16
14
15
13 7.6
14
7.3
Teeter water flowrate(lpm) 12 13
7.90
11 7.0 7.60
Teeter water(lpm) 12
7.30
10 6.7 Bed pressure (bars) 11 7.00
10 6.70
Bed pressure(bars)
X2 = B: TW C: PD = 40.00
30
Magnetite recovery(%)
75 D: FR = 120.00
Actual Factors
C: PD = 50.00 20
D: FR = 138.92 70
10
65
0
60
55
16
15
16 14
7.90
15 13
7.60
14 7.9
Teeter water(lpm) 12
7.30
11 7.00
13 7.6
10 6.70
7.3 Bed pressure(bars)
Teeter water flowrate(lpm) 12
11 7.0
128
MPT-2013
4.47531
50
separator in processing iron ore fines — a
X1 = A: BP
X2 = B: TW
Actual Factors
40
relative veloc ity approac h. Mineral
Silica recovery(%)
C: PD = 50.00
30
D: FR = 139.98
0
(2), 78–84.
16
Kumar C R, M. Srijith a, Tripathy, S K,
15
14
7.90
Ramamurthy Y, Venugopalan T, Suresh N,
13
Teeter water(lpm) 12
11 7.00
7.30
7.60
Prediction of process input interactions of
10 6.70
Bed pressure(bars) Floatex Density Separator performance for
separating medium density particles.,
Figure 10:Effect of teeter water flowrate and International Journal of Mineral
bed pressure on Silica recovery at higher level Processing 100 (2011) 136–141.
of Pulp density and Feed rate. Raghu Kumar, C., Rama Murthy, Y., Tripathy,
5. Conclusions Sunil, 2010. Application of floatex density
For deeper understanding of process variables separator for Prec onc entration of
effect/impac t on segregation of mineral Chromite from COB tailings, TATA Search
particles in (terms of recovery) using FDS an 2010b.
experimental campaign was carried out using Raghu Kumar, C., Tripathy, Sunil Kr., Mohanan,
synthetic mixture of magnetite and silica sand. Srijith, Venugopalan, T., and Nikkam
The following are the important conclusion. Suresh, 2010. Evaluation offloatex density
1. Teeter water flowrate and bed pressure separator performanc e using silic a
are the main parameter from which the sand,Proceedings of the XI International
Magnetite recovery to underflow can Seminar on Mineral Proc essing
be c ontrolled whereas for silic a Technology (MPT-2010a),pp. 701–706.
recovery the pulp density also plays a Sarkar B, Das A, Roy S, Rai SK. In depth analysis
significant role. of alumina removal from iron ore fines
2. The silica recovery to underflow can be using teetered bed gravity separator.
brought down by operating the floatex Miner Process Ext Met (Trans Inst Min
density separator at higher teeter Metall C) 2008; 1:117.
water flowrate, bed pressure and feed Tripathy S.K., Mallick M.K., Singh V., Rama
rate. Murthy, Y., 2013. Preliminary studies on
Acknowledgements teeter bed separator for separation of
The authors are thankful to Tata Steel Ltd., manganese fines. - Powder Technology,
management for all the support, encouragement
and permission to publish the paper
*******
129
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
The availability of high grade chrome ore resources in India is limited to Sukinda region of Odisha
state. Several beneficiation plants are operating in this region to beneficiate the low to medium
grade chrome ore. These beneficiation plants incorporate gravity concentration techniques for
the recovery of chromites values to make it suitable for different end user applications. The
performance of these gravity circuits need to be evaluated on timely basis so that they can perform
with peak efficiencies. Mineral engineers are required to modify the critical operating process
parameters on continuous basis which is very difficult and tiresome. Better control of grade and
recovery with minimum loss of value is the focus of such plants. In the present investigation the
results obtained on the performance evaluation studies carried out on a gravity concentration
plant, Sukinda has been discussed. Based on the systematic approach followed by analysis of the
data the performance of the circuit has been evaluated specifically in terms of SiO2. The results of
plant trials based on the above methodology has shown that the SiO2 in the ultrafine concentrate
has reduced to <4% from 6%.
1. Introduction
with expectation of increase in stainless steel
Chrome ore demand is driven by ferrochrome demand, demand for ferrochrome is expected
market as ~95% of the chrome ore is used for to increase. The consumption is expected to
the metallurgical purpose. Two percent of the reach ~11Mt by 2013 (Figure 1, 2) at a CAGR of
demand comes from chemical industry and rest 7% per annum. South Africa plays a significant
from refractory and foundry industry. Stainless role in the world’s output of ferrochrome
steel is the largest consumer of ferrochrome and contributing around 38% of the total in 2011.
as such a change in the dynamics of the India, the number three producer of chrome ore,
stainless steel industry has impact on the with only 1% of the global resources, has only
ferrochrome industry. In the long run, in line ~17 years of production life left at the current
level of production (1).
* Correspending Author: yrama.murthy@tatasteel.com
130
MPT-2013
131
MPT-2013
132
MPT-2013
1994,Sönmez and Turgut, 1998).A comparison present study initially the samples were
of the peak efficiencies cannot be made based collected from the classifying units such as
on the effect of operating conditions alone. The hydrocyclone and spirals and were analysed
research works of Pascoe, et al., 2007, Ozdag, et for size and chemical analysis. The variation of
al., 1994, shows that it is possible to make a Cr 2O3 and SiO2 were also measured at the
sensible selection of gravity separation from existing operating parameters.
information on particle size and the mineralogy 5. Results and Discussion
of the ore. The present work is carried in an
5.1. Mineralogical studies of circuit
operating chromite ore beneficiation plant,
Sukinda, with an objec tive to develop a Sink and float analysis using heavy liquids and
monitoring system / data base to improve the liberation and mineralogic al studies by
quality of the product. QEM*SEM (Quantitative Evaluation of
Materials by Scanning Electron Microscopy)
4. Methodology was carried out for characterizing samples
Accurate data collection and proper data collected from individual unit operations of the
circuit. The product grade was contaminated
interpretation followed by making necessary
by the siliceous gangue minerals. Hence in the
change which is implementable in an operating
c harac terization studies analysis was
plant play very critical role in performance of
primarily done for siliceous gangue phases and
the circuit.There are many causes of the data was discussed.
variability, including both error (sampling and
assay), and real variation in performance due 5.1.1. Feed circuit analysis
to changes in ore mineralogy, operating The liberation analysis of the feed to ultrafine
conditions and other factors. The methodology circuit is presented in Figure.6. It is observed
adopted is outlined in the Figure 5. from the characterization studies that silica
deportment is either from quartz or from Fe
Silicate (Mg & Al). Free quartz is majorly
contributed by flaotex density separator as is
visible from the float fractions of sink and float
analysis whereas the other form (fine Fe Silicate)
is c ontributed through c lassifiers i.e.
hydrocyclone. The liberation analysis shows
that 50% (mass)of the quartz is fully liberated.
Liberatio
n of
Quartz
Liberati
on of
Quartz
(d) Mineral Mass percent of Scavenger circuit (b) Overall effect on circuit (SiO2)
(c)Liberation of quartz Figure 8: Results of plant trials
Following observations were made from the
Figure 7: Liberation studies of SiO2 and results obtained from plant trials under the
Cr2O3 rougher, cleaner and scavenger optimised conditions:
circuit The average size of the cyclone under flow
wasreduc ed to 40 µm and 30 µm
5.2. PlantCircuit performance analysis respectively as shown in Figure 8 (a).
In a continuously operating gravity based A considerable reduction (<12% Cr2O3) in
beneficiation plant it is always very critical and the Cr 2 O 3 losses into the tailings was
cumbersome to carry out real time trials. observed in all the hydrocyclone overflow
Monitoring numerous parameters of beneficiation circuit, which are earlier
simultaneously and analyzing the data without reporting to the tailing stream.
hampering the day to day plant process is a The overall silica in the ultrafine
challenging job. Keeping this in view for the concentrate under optimized conditions
first campaign hydrocyclone spigot diameters has reduced to 3.27% from the audited
were varied between 33mm to 35mm at a value of 6.94%.
134
MPT-2013
6. Conclusions References
Following conclusions were drawn from the Atalay, U., Ozbayoglu, G., 1992. Beneficiation
performance evaluation studies carried on the and agglomeration of c hromite–its
ultra-fine beneficiation circuit of chrome ore application in Turkey. Mineral Processing
beneficiation plant, Sukinda: and Extractive Metallurgy Review 9,185–
Literature review revealed that unsteady 194.
operation of beneficiation units in the Cicek, T., Cocen, I., 2002. Applicability of Mozley
proc ess circ uits, espec ially gravity gravity separator (MGS) to fine chromite
operated circuits and qualitative changes tailings of Turkish chromite concentrating
in the feed (ROM) to the plant affects the plants. Minerals Engineering 15, 91–93.
overall performance of the beneficiation Gu, F., Wills, B.A., 1988. Chromite–mineralogy
circuit. Thus the efforts and solutions were and processing. Minerals Engineering 1 (3),
also unique and tailor-made for the P -235–240.
problems at hand. Guney, A. et al., 1994. Flotation of fine chromite
The results obtained from the tailings using novel tec hniques. In:
characterization studies of the circuit Demirel, H., Ersayin, S. (Eds.), Progress in
samples revealed that: Mineral Processing Technology. Balkema,
The silica deportment is from two Rotterdam, The Netherlands, P- 473–477.
minerals - free silica i.e., quartz and Guney, A., 1990. Concentration of fine sized
locked silicates i.e., Fe (Mg &Al) c hromite from the wastes of
silicates. EtibankUckopru chromite concentration
In most of the samples major plant. Ph.D. Thesis, Istanbul Technical
dominance is of Fe (Mg& Al) silicates University, Istanbul, Turkey.
was observed. Guney, A., Onal, G., Atmaca, T., 2001. New
Continuous evaluation of the process aspec t of c hromite gravity tailings
circuit helps in improving the performance reprocessing.Minerals Engineering 14,
of the any gravity circuit and helps in 1527–1530 http://www.kpmg.c om/
achieving required target of the product by Global/en/IssuesAndInsights/
making changes in the operating parameter A r t i c l e s P u b l i c a t i o n s / c o m m o d i t y-
of existing units. insights-bulletin/Documents/c hrome-
The overall silica in the ultrafine and-ferrochrome-april-2012.pdf).
concentrate under optimized conditions Li, X, McKee, D J, Horberry.T, Powell, M S, 2011.
has reduced to The control room operator: The forgotten
3.27% from 6.94% followed by reduction element in mineral proc ess c ontrol,
(<12% Cr 2O 3) in the Cr 2O 3 losses into Minerals Engineering (24) 894–902.
tailings. Ozdag, H., Ucbas, Y., Koca, S., 1994. Recovery of
Acknowledgements chromite from slime and table tailings by
multi gravity separator. In: Innovations
The authors are thankful to Tata Steel
in Mineral Processing. Sudbury, Canada,
management for their encouragement, support
P- 267.
and permission to publish the paper. Thanks
Pascoe, R.D., Power, M.R., Simpson, B., 2007.
are also due to all team members and
QEMSCAN analysis as a tool for improved
supporting staff of FAMD and R&D and SS for
their support and throughout the work.
135
MPT-2013
understanding of gravity separator Sahoo, R.K., Mohanty, J.K., Das, S.K., and Paul,
performance. Minerals Engineering 20, P- A.K., 2009. Chromites of India Their
487–49520. Textural and Mineralogic al
Rama Murthy Y, S.K.Tripathy, Raghu Kumar. C Characteristics. International seminar on
2011. Chrome ore beneficiation challenges magmatic ore deposits ( ISMO 2009).
& opportunities - A Review, International Sönmez, E., Turgut, B., 1998. Enrichment of low-
Journal Minerals Engineering. Minerals grade Karaburhan chromite ores by
Engineering 24, P-375–380. gravitational methods. In: Atak, S., Onal,
Rama Murthy Y, Sunil K Tripathy, Veerendra G., Celik, T. (Eds.), Innovation in Mineral
Singh, Vilas D Tathavadkar and A Ranjan and Coal Processing. Balkema, Rotterdam,
2012. Studies on reduction in chromite The Netherlands, pp. 723–726.
losses in tailing in an operating plant. Xxvi Sunil Kumar Tripathy, Y.Rama Murthy,
International Mineral Proc essing Veerendera Singh 2013. Characterization
Congress(IMPC) 2012 proceedings / New and separation studies of Indian chromite
Delhi, India / 24 - 28 September 2012. 4377- beneficiation plant tailing. International
4385. Journal of Mineral Processing 122, P- 47–
53.
*******
136
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
The utilization of low grade fine iron ores and tailings can help maintain a sustainable supply of
minerals to meet the need of the steel industry. There have been recent developments in Spiral
technology that has enhanced recovery and grade in many mineral processing plants in India.
This paper highlights the development and use of fine mineral spirals for the beneficiation of low
grade iron ore and rejected plant tailings with case studies discussed and presented.
Keywords: Mineral processing; gravity separation; spirals; spiral separators; iron ore tailing
recovery; fine mineral beneficiation.
1. Introduction
Flow sheet of the existing processing plant in
The use of spiral separators in mineral
India reveal that fine-grained iron minerals are
processing is an old concept which has recently
present in the process stream due to the natural
been used widely to process iron ore. The
fine content of the ore and those produce in the
inc rease in pric e of iron ore fines and
process of crushing screening, grinding,
simultaneous depletion of ore bodies has
stacking and reclamation from the blending
prompted the adoption of new methods and
yard. Traditional mineral dressing techniques
technologies in mineral processing. Mineral
such as selective classification and magnetic
processing plants are affected by many factors
separation may not entirely concentrate the
among which are grain size ranges, liberation
recoverable iron units. The use of a gravity
size of the ore, the percentage of natural fines in
separation technique with the fine mineral
the ore, etc these factors present new challenges
spiral can be complimentary and thus to
and directly affects recovery and concentrate
enhanc e overall iron rec overy. This
grades.
methodology of process design has also been
* Correspending Author: Glen D Costa, proven to be a cost effective. Another challenge
Email :glendcosta@gmail.com Ph :+ 91982 38 97911 that is put forward by the industry is the
processing of low grade ore (BHQ/BMQ) and
137
MPT-2013
the need to retreat plant tailings that have been separate minerals based on their respective
rejected over the years. These low grade fine densities and have proven to be metallurgically
ores and tailings c an help maintain a effic ient and c ost effec tive sinc e their
sustainable supply of minerals to meet the need widespread commercial introduction more
of the industry if processed with the right than 50 years ago.
equipment and techniques. Another aspect is The general principle of spiral are that high
the price of iron ore fines has increased density particles rapidly settle in the pulp
significantly in recent times, pressure for stream, contact spiral profile and slow down
environmental remediation of mine sites , the and then move towards the centre. Splitters
shortage of suitable or available sites on current divert high density partic les into the
leases, has made iron ore dump reclamation concentrate channel while the fine particles
more attractive for both proc essors and tend to centre and the low density particles are
regulators. Resourc e c onservation, held up in the pulp flow. Centrifugal forces hold
environmental engineering demands and particles and water in outer trough where as
competitive pricing for high quality fine the coarse or high density particles tend to the
concentrate, have seen a range of dumps and inner trough. Low density fines (silica ,alumina
pond reclamation projects initiated in Brazil, and clays) reports with the fluid, the primary
Australia, South Africa and most recently India. flow transports slurry and allows settling and
This paper makes an effort to showcase that stratification where as the secondary flow is
iron ore tailings can be processed economically brought about by centrifugal forces and causes
and efficiently by using low capital cost, low shearing of the strata. This is unique to spirals.
operational and low maintenance equipment
like gravity spiral concentrators. The majority
Primary
of the metallurgical information contained in (down trough)
this paper come from data recently gathered flow
Secondary flow
from Mineral Technologies pilot testing and Primary flow
Middlings band
High density band Inner zone Transition zone Outer (recovery) zone
Spiral separators principles
Gravity c onc entration of minerals has Fig. 1: Primary and secondary flow patterns
traditionally been recognised as a low cost and on a spiral separator
environmentally friendly process for the Considerable effort has been expended on the
separation of minerals. In recent years a development of new gravity separators in an
number of new process technologies have effort to achieve separations at finer sizes and
emerged allowing ever-finer materials to be more discreet proc essing c apabilities to
successfully processed. Fine mineral spirals accommodate such difficulties as smaller
separators are just one of these new emerging particle density differences. The greatest efforts
tec hnologies that have the potential to appear to have been reserved for high gravity
efficiently separate mineral species down to 20 devices with new machines such as the Kelsey
micrometres in size. Spirals separators are jig, the continuous Falcon separator and the
simple, low energy consuming devices that Mozely MGS. These devices generally provide
138
MPT-2013
greatly enhanced “gravity” forces that are Con Fe Tails Fe Con Wt Fe rec’y
generated in a drum type mechanism rotating Source/Stream Fe% Feed % % % %
56.5 45.1 34.4 39.7
at high speed around a central axis. Size Tailing pond 49.0
56.7 46.0 28.2 32.6
separations down to less than 10 micrometres
are ac hievable and good metallurgic al CASE 2: Fine iron ore sample taken from a tail-
performance on minerals with small density ing pond.
differences is achievable in some circumstances.
Con Fe Tails Fe Con Fe rec’y
However, all of these enhanc ed gravity Source/Stream Fe% Feed % % Wt% %
mac hines are mec hanic al in nature and 51.0 32.9 22.7 31.2
generally have higher costs both from a capital Tailings pond 37.0 51.2 32.5 24.1 33.3
and operating perspective. They also require D50=45 micron
48.9 35.3 12.5 16.5
significantly higher level of technical expertise
in operations and maintenance. Case 3: Fine iron ore sample taken from a
A recent development is the FM1 spiral 6.5 turn
tailing pond (D50=45 micron)
separator; designed to operate down to 20
micrometres whilst ac hieving acceptable Fe
Con Fe Tails Fe Con WT rec’y
mineral recoveries and upgrade ratios. This Source/Stream Fe% Feed % % % %
updated model of the spiral separator is aimed Primary U/F 48.0 60.0 35.3 51.4 64.3
48.8 60.9 36.4 50.6 63.2
at both roughing and cleaning applications.
50.7 61.7 38.6 52.4 63.7
The need to recover fine heavy particles from Case 4: Fine iron ore sample taken from a pri-
process streams is becoming increasingly mary cyclone underflow.
necessary in the mineral processing industry
Fe
as a number of the potential reserves available Tails Fe Con WT rec’y
Source/Stream Fe% Feed Con Fe % % % %
for future mining contain finer minerals than
Ball Mill cyclone 52.6 59.0 43.1 59.7 67.0
those being treated currently. Many of these fine underflow
60.3 42.5 56.7 65.0
grained deposits have been found in the iron
62.1 48.3 41.3 47.5
ore and mineral sands industry of India. As the 54.0
61.2 48.6 42.9 48.6
development of the deposits within this sector
is currently being pursued in India, recent Case 5: Ball mill ground cyclone underflow.
testing of fine products has been carried out on
Con WT Fe rec’y %
the FM1 spiral in out test rig facility in India Source/Stream Fe% Feed Con Fe % Tails Fe % %
Cleaner Stage 63.7 53.5 39.0 43.2
with improvements in Fe grade in only one 57.5
64.7 53.4 36.0 40.6
stage of spiral separation 62.9 54.9 74.7 77.2
60.9
Test work was carried using various ores from 63.5 54.7 70.2 73.2
different part of the country and also using both CASE 6: Fine iron ore sample Cleaner stage.
natural fines and tailings.
During the pilot plants tests the feed conditions
Con Fe Tails Fe Con Wt Fe rec’y
Source/Stream Fe% Feed % % % % of the spiral were maintained at 35-40 % solids
53.4 24.2 65.4 80.7
Tailing pond 43.3 w/w pulp density with a solids loading per
52.6 24.7 66.7 81.0
start feed ranging from 0.8 tph to 1.1 tph.
CASE 1: Fine iron ore sample taken from a tail- The particle size distribution of the test work
ing pond. samples were predominantly in the sub -150
139
MPT-2013
micron range. Samples that were taken from of the classified streams. This approach proved
the tailing ponds (Case 1 to 3) had naturally to be very successful particularly in the tin
occurring fines where as the samples taken industry, and although since these times there
from the low grade dumps (Case 4 to 6) were has been movement towards reducing the
ground to minus 50-60 micron in order to number of classified parallel streams, the
liberate the mineral and then passed onto the concept remains valid. The availability of spiral
spiral. separator models that can effectively process
Close considerations of the case studies show material down to below 20 micrometres in size
effective recovery and upgrade of fine iron ore provides a means to design flow sheets that
into a final concentrate in a single spiral pass. conform to the traditional concepts of gravity
The iron ores used in the study were taken from separation of parallel classified streams.
various tailing ponds and low grade iron ore The utilisation of FM spiral separators to treat
dumps around India. Based on the results it is material in the size range below 0.15
clear that an effec tive flow sheet c an be millimetres and conventional spiral separators
developed for the recovery of fine iron ore with to process material above say 0.15 millimetres,
a final concentrate that can be used as a feed provides a low cost option for a number of likely
product to the steel plant. proc essing systems; inc luding those
The benefits of using the FM1 spiral for the applications in Mineral Sands, Tin, Chromites,
treatment of fine iron ore has been proven and Iron ore.
through this test work data. Other potential In some applications, such as fine iron ore
applications for the use of fine spiral technology upgrading or tailings re-treatment, the
include operations that currently grind their required separation can be satisfied with a
feed material to 50-60 m to ac hieve single stage circuit and this is confirmed by
satisfactory liberation especially in BHQ and some extensive test work in the Hospet-Bellary
BHJ ores. While the use of traditional spiral region.
separation technology to treat this material has Whether single or multi-stage spiral circuits
historically been ineffective at this size range, are utilised, the availability of the FM model
the use of FM1 type spirals may enable a spiral will enable the benefits of spiral
reduction in the amount of material treated separators to be extended to encompass a wider
through subsequent processing stages by the size range of the total ore treated. Subsequent
rejection of fine liberated gangue material after cost reductions will result from:
grinding. For example in the preparation of • Simplified operational requirements
material for flotation, significant recovery can • Lower capital costs
be made by introducing a gravity stage prior • Reduced operating costs
to the flotation stage, hence reducing the size of • Improved overall recoveries
the flotation circuit and therefore reducing • Greater versatility to handle variability of
capital and operating expenses. ore type and associated
changes to size consist of ground (or
3. Process Implications naturally occurring) ores
The c lassic al approac h to fine gravity • Reduced water demand
separation of ores involved classification of the • Improved plant control.
feed into a number of relatively narrow size Competing equipment is generally
ranges followed by separate parallel treatment mechanically and operationally more complex,
140
MPT-2013
and invariably involves higher capital and using FM1 spirals it is possible to recover a
operating costs compared to spiral separators. significant quantity of fine iron into a saleable
Any metallurgical performance gains must product. Analysis has also demonstrated that
therefore be weighed against these cost and the value generated from the additional
operational benefits. recovery outweighs the cost of the additional
plant and equipment.
4. Conclusions
Acknowledgements
With the need for better grade and recoveries
We take the opportunity to acknowledge the
in mineral process plants, spiral separation
opportunities to discuss and interact with the
technologies have been shown to provide cost
people of various mining companies who have
effective and eco-efficient mineral processing
provided the means to conduct test work by
solutions. Fine mineral (FM1) spiral separators
which our solutions and experience have been
extend the cost effective size range for gravity
developed. We also thank the management of
separation using this technology down to well
Mineral Technologies for permission to publish
below that previously considered technically
this paper.
feasible using spiral separators.
The focus in spiral plant design in recent years References
has been to not only improve separation
Richards, R. G., Machunter, D., Gates ,M. P. J. ,
efficiencies, but significantly increase feed
Palmer ,M. K., Gravity Separation of Ultra-fine
capacities using cost effective and eco friendly
(- 0.1mm) Minerals using spiral separators. MD
equipment.
mineral technologies, P.O. B ox 2569, Nerang
The results obtained from the test work
Mail Delivery Centre, Queensland 4211,
undertaken in these case studies has shown that
Australia.
*******
141
MPT-2013
142
MPT-2013
FLOTATION
143
MPT-2013
144
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Generally, diesel and frother are used as reagents in graphite flotation. With the escalating cost of
petroleum products and their negative impact on environment, attempts are made to formulate
an eco-friendly single reagent to replace the diesel-frother system without affecting the flotation
performance. CSIR-NML Madras Centre in collaboration with M/s Somu Organo Chem Pvt Ltd.,
India, has worked out the formulation and evaluation of single reagent on a low grade graphite
ore sourced from eastern India. The petrography studies indicate that the ore primarily consists
of quartz and graphite with minor quantity of mica and analyzing 87.85% ash content. The ore is
crushed in stages followed by primary coarse wet grinding to 242 µm (d80). Rougher flotation is
carried out in Denver flotation cell with a view to eliminate gangue as much as possible in the
form of primary tailings with minimal loss of carbon. Regrinding of rougher concentrate to 216
µm (d80) is opted to improve the liberation of graphite values. This approach involving a primary
coarse grinding and regrinding of rougher float followed by multi-stage cleaning using this single
reagent is found to yield better recovery and grade when compared with that of the dual reagent
system. A final concentrate of 12.03% weight recovery with 3.22% ash could be achieved. Based
on encouraging laboratory studies using the single reagent, plant trials were carried out. From
the cost benefit analysis, this single reagent proves to be an economically viable in place of diesel-
frother for processing low grade graphite.
Keywords: Low grade graphite; liberation; froth flotation; single reagent; diesel.
145
MPT-2013
is classified based on the size of the crystal flakes (Grabowski and Drzymala 2008). T he
and graded according to their graphitic carbon polyethylene oxide type of frothers like
content and particle size. Microcrystalline polyoxypropylene glycol butyl ether was also
graphite is commercially called as amorphous studied as a replacement for MIBC in graphite
graphite. The r.o.m ore of low grade, containing flotation (Pugh, 2000). Major studies on
about 10% fixed c arbon (FC), has to be collectors and frothers other than diesel/
invariably beneficiated before marketing. kerosene and MIBC/pine oil respectively were
Processes for graphite beneficiation depend found much in graphite flotation literatures.
upon the nature and association of gangue Hence in this present investigation, eco-friendly
minerals present. Graphite can be enriched single reagent was developed as a replacement
easily by flotation because of its natural for diesel-frother system. This single reagent
hydrophobicity (Kaya et al, 2007 and Acharya developed was tested for its efficiency at
et al, 1996). Froth flotation process is used laboratory scale. After encouraging results are
widely as it helps in producing a high-grade obtained at laboratory sc ale, trials were
graphite concentrate (Kim et al, 2003) which undertaken at industrial scale in a graphite
finds applications in refractories, batteries and beneficiation plant with 5.0 t/h flotation circuit.
high temperature lubricants (Mitchell, 1993). Also the cost benefit analysis was carried out
Flotation utilizes the differences in the surface to study the economic feasibility of the single
properties mainly the hydrophobic ity of reagent developed with that of diesel-frother
graphite (Chau et al, 2009; Kim et al 2002 and system.
Deryagin et al, 1982) which is one of the main 2. Materials and methods
factors in determining the separation efficiency
by flotation. Beneficiation of low grade graphite 2.1. Materialsa low grade run-of-mine graphite
ore using mechanical cell and column flotation ore was received from Jharkhand state of India.
cell were studied (Bhaskar Raju et al, 2000; El- The ore is crushed in stages followed by mixing
Raheim, 2004 and Narasimhan et al, 1972) by thoroughly. A representative sample was
using conventional hydroc arbon oils as drawn for size and chemical analysis (Reddy
collectors. et al, 1997) and the results are shown in Table 1.
In froth flotation, graphite ores are often
subjec ted to a suitable hydroc arbon oil Table 1: Analysis of graphite ore.
treatment to alter their hydrophobic ity, Sample Ash, % Moisture, % Volatile Matter, % Fixed Carbon, %
enhance recovery, and / or improve selectivity Graphite ore 87.80 0.12 3.49 8.59
(Patil et al, 2000). Conventionally, the collectors
used in most of the graphite flotation studies 2.2. Size analysis
are diesel, kerosene, petrol in combination with
pine oil as frother (Didolkar et al, 1997). Various The particle size distribution of the stage-
combinations of these conventional reagents crushed graphite ore was carried out using
namely kerosene collector in combination with B.S.S sieves and the weight percentage retained
90:10 ratio of methyl isobutyl carbinol (MIBC) on each screen along with their ash values are
and ethyl alcohol were studied in graphite tabulated in Table 2. The calculated d80 of this
flotation (Ravichandran et al, 2012). Also graphite sample was found to be 605 µm.
commercial grade frothers such as pine oil, Table 2: Size & Ash Analysis of stage-crushed
MIBC, eucalyptus oil and ethyl alcohol with graphite.
kerosene and diesel oil as collectors were used
in graphite flotation (Ravichandran et al, 2013).
Flotation studies of graphite in aqueous salt
solution using sodium acetate were carried out
146
MPT-2013
147
MPT-2013
to ash analysis. The combustible recovery (CR), 3.1. Effect of primary grind time
ash rejection (AR) and efficiency index (EI) were Flotation tests for primary grind optimization
calculated from the weight recovery / yield and studies were carried out using single reagent,
ash values for each test using the following Sokem 705C. Sodium silicate (3.0 kg/t) was used
equations respectively. as depressant for silica bearing minerals during
M C (100 A C ) grinding. The graphite ore was subjected to
%CR x100 primary wet grinding in a ball mill for different
M f 100 A f periods of grinding time. Each time the ground
sample was subjected for size analyses to find
M A out d80 of it. The grinding media used was 3.5 kg
%AR 1 C C x100
Mf Af of steel balls and grinding was carried out at
65% solids by weight. After primary grinding,
EI CR AR ) 100 0.137 kg/t Sokem 705C was added as collector
where, for graphite flotation and this same dosage was
Ac = ash content in concentrate, % maintained for all the grind variation studies.
Af = ash content in feed, % The concentrate and tailing obtained were
Mc = Mass of concentrate, g dried and subjected to ash analysis and
Mf = Mass of feed, g tabulated as shown in Table 3.
Also plant trials were conducted at a graphite Table 3. Effect of primary grind variation on
flotation plant circuit of 5.0 t/hr capacity using flotation Sodium silicate: 3.0 kg/t; Sokem
Sokem 705C for validating the findings obtained 705C: 0.137 kg/t; Ash of Head sample: 87.85%
from the laboratory flotation studies.
2.6. Plant trails Primary grind
time, minutes
d80 size, µm Products Yield, % Ash, %
CR,
%
AR,
%
EI
148
MPT-2013
coarsest possible primary grind. It is essential Table 5: Effect of Sokem 705C at primary grind
to keep the graphite flake size as big as possible on graphite flotation Primary grind d80: 242 µm;
which is the criteria for its value/price. Hence, Sodium silicate: 3.0 kg/t; Ash of Head sample:
the d80 of 242 µm obtained at 9 minutes primary 87.85%
grind was found to be optimum and all Sokem 705C Products Wt., Ash, Ash CR, AR, EI
dosage, kg/t % % Distribution, % % %
subsequent flotation tests were conducted at 0.110 Concentrate 14.92 25.02 4.29 85.90 95.71 81.61
µm. After primary grind variation studies, Tailing 82.35 98.12 93.07
sodium silicate dosage optimization was 0.195 Concentrate 18.56 38.49 8.20 88.58 91.80 80.38
0.198 Concentrate
%
13.88
%
34.42
Distribution, %
5.45
%
73.81
%
94.55 68.36
silicate dosage (3 kg/t) were optimized. Further Tailing 85.48 96.58 93.67
dosage variation were carried out to study its 0.330 Concentrate 15.00 38.00 6.51 75.12 93.49 68.61
149
MPT-2013
From the results, the diesel dosage is optimized Table 8: Comparison of reagents
at 0.198 kg/t as the ash rejection is maximum in consumption at rougher flotation of graphite
the tailings at 94.55% with relatively good Reagent dosage, Products Wt., Ash, Ash CR, AR, EI
efficiency index of 68.36 at relatively lower kg/t % % Distribution, % % %
The primary grind (d80: 242 µm), sodium silicate From the above table, it can be observed that
dosage (3.0 kg/t) and diesel (0.198 kg/t) were the consumption of single reagent Sokem 705C
maintained the same. Flotation experiments on is relatively less as compared to diesel-pine oil
variation of pine oil dosage to study its effect system. The cost benefit analysis is given in the
were carried out and the results are given in following discussion. Also, the performance of
Table 7. Sokem 705C is superior to that of diesel-pine oil
Table 7. Effect of pine oil at primary grind on system as evident from the efficiency index
graphite flotation, Primary grind d80: 242 µm; values.
Sodium silicate: 3.0 kg/t; Diesel: 0.198 kg/t,
3.7 Regrinding of rougher concentrate
Ash of Head sample: 87.85%
followed by 5-stage cleaner flotation
Pine oil
dosage,
Products Wt.,
%
Ash,
%
Ash
Distribution, %
CR,
%
AR,
%
EI In the rougher flotation, it was seen that much
kg/t
of the gangue is rejected at the coarsest possible
0.154 Concentrate 13.88 34.42 5.45 73.81 94.55 68.36
size in the form of primary tailings. In order to
Tailing 86.12 96.25 94.55
150
MPT-2013
Table 9: Cleaner flotation of reground rougher The results of the plant trails indicates that the
concentrate efficiency of separation using single reagent
Products Yield, % Ash, % Sokem 705C is comparable in terms of yield and
Final. Conc. 12.03 3.22
ash content in the final concentrate. The
consumption of Sokem 705C is 266 cc/t of feed
Cleaner-V Tails 0.23 26.51
which is much less compared to that when
Cleaner-IV Tails 0.20 58.38
diesel and pine oil are being used in the plant.
Cleaner-III Tails 0.34 80.79
This single reagent doesn’t have adverse effect
Cleaner-II Tails 1.00 92.76 on the downstream operations in the plant such
Cleaner-I Tails 3.88 97.28 as thickener water quality. Also, the addition
Primary Tails 82.32 97.48 of this reagent also makes the operation easier.
From the above results, final concentrate of 4.1 Cost benefit analysis
12.03% yield with 3.22% ash content was
obtained after 5-stage cleaning of reground The cost and benefits analysis was carried out
rougher c onc entrate. The c ombustibles to compare the economic viability in using
recovery was found to be 82.03% and the single reagent in place of diesel-frother (pine
separation efficiency index of 81.58. oil) system. The throughput capacity of the
After the encouraging results on using single flotation circuit in the plant where trials were
reagent Sokem 705C in place of the dual reagent c arried out is 5.0 t/h. The reagents c ost
system at laboratory scale studies, it was estimation comparison for treating one tonne
thought prudent to test the same at commercial of graphite is given in Table 11.
plant level. Table 11: Cost benefit analysis for single
4. Plant trials using Sokem 705C reagent, Sokem 705C and diesel-frother system
After ensuring that the efficacy of single reagent
Sokem 705C is not inferior to that of the diesel- Parameters Values Cost (INR)
pine oil system in graphite flotation, trials were Feed rate (tonne/hour) 5.0 --
capacity involves multistage grinding-cum- Sokem 705C consumption (cc/t) 266 66.50
flotation. In this plant, diesel and pine oil are
being used as collector and frother respectively.
Plant trials were conducted using Sokem 705C It is evident that the cost of single reagent is
in this plant flotation circuit. The results of cheaper by half of the dual reagent cost per tonne
conventional plant practice with diesel and of feed. The reagent cost per day for Sokem 705C
pine oil system and single reagent Sokem 705C would be 7980 INR while that of diesel-pine oil
are comparable as shown in Table 10. system would be 15156 INR. This is over and
Table 10. Results of plant trials conducted above the reduced capital expenditure and
using single reagent Sokem 705C operational simplicity.
Yield, %
Reagent Dosage, cc/t Feed Ash, %
Final
Ash, %
Conc. Tailings Ash,
%
(graphite 5. Conclusion
recovery)
Sokem 705C
Diesel & pine
266 87.50 3.95 94.40 10.90
11.08
The single reagent Sokem 705C was evaluated
225 & 758 87.50 3.90 94.00
oil for its efficiency on graphite flotation both in
151
MPT-2013
laboratory benc h scale studies and in an Deryagin, B.V., Dukhin, S.S., Rulev, N.N., 1982.
operating graphite beneficiation plant. It was Kinetic theory of the flotation of small
found that single reagent was superior to the particles. Russian Chemical Reviews, 51,
conventional diesel-frother system, in terms of No. 1, pp.92-118.
cost benefit analysis. Flotation results also Dey, S., Pathak, P.N., 2005. Comparative studies
indicate that the single reagent Sokem 705C is of amenability to processing of graphite
superior to diesel-pine oil system. Considering from different sources. Transac tions
the plant operation point of view, handling Indian Institute of Metals, 58, No. 5,
single reagent system is much easier than pp.905-910.
compared to dual reagent system. This single Didolkar, V.K., Asok Kumar, V., Pathak, S.U.,
reagent Sokem 705C proves to be economical Tupkary, R.H., 1997. Beneficiation of low
compared to diesel-frother system. Moreover, grade graphite ore from Multai area, Betul
it is biodegradable and environmental friendly. Distric t, M.P, India. Proc eedings of
Processing of fines, Jhamshedpur, India,
Acknowledgements
pp.177-188.
The authors wish to thank The Director, CSIR- Grabowski, B., Drzymala, J., 2008. Graphite
NML for his support and permission to publish flotation in the presence of sodium acetate.
this work. Annales Universitatis Mariae Curie,
Sklodowska Lublin, Polonia, Section AA,
References
63, No. 6, pp.68-72.
Abd EL-Rahiem, F.H., 2004. Application of Kaya, O., Canbazoglu, M.E., 2007. A study on
column flotation for Egyptian graphite. the floatability of graphite ore from Yozgat
Tenside Surfactants Detergents, 41, No. 3, Akdagmadeni (Turkey). The Journal of Ore
pp.104-109. Dressing, 9, No. 17, 40-44.
Acharya, B.C., Rao, D.S., Prakash, S., Reddy, Kim Byoung, G., Choi Sang, K., Chung Hun, S.,
P.S.R., Biswal, S.K., 1996. Processing of low Lee Jae, J., 2002. Dispersing characteristics
grade graphite ores of Orissa, India. of graphite suspension by surfac e
Minerals Engineering, 9, No. 11, pp.1165- modification with ABDM. Particulate
1169. Science and Technology, 20, pp.95-107.
Bhaskar Raju, G., Prabhakar, S., 2000. Kim Byoung, G., Choi Sang, K., Park Chong, L.,
Beneficiation of fluorspar by column Chung Hun, S., Jeon Ho, S., 2003. Inclusion
flotation Minerals Metallurgic al of graphite mineral and its mechanical
processing. Minerals and Metallurgical separation from expanded graphite.
Processing, 17, No.3, pp.126-132. Particulate Science and Technology, 21,pp.
Chau, T.T., Bruckard, W.J., Koh, P.T.L., Nguyen, 341-351.
A.V., 2009. A review of factors that affect Li, Z.Q., Lu, C.J., Xia, Z.P., Zhou, Y., Luo, Z., 2007.
contact angle and implications for flotation X-ray diffraction patterns of graphite and
prac tic e. Advances in Colloid and turbostratic carbon. Carbon, 45, pp.1686-
Interface Science, 150, pp.106-115. 1695.
Delviller, R., Finch, J.A., Gomez, C.O., Espinosa, Mitchell, C.J., 1993. Technical report WG/92/30
G., 1992. Flotation column amenability on Flake Graphite. British Geological
and scale up parameters estimation tests. Survey, Natrual Environment Research
Minerals Engineering, No.5, pp.169-182. Council, Nottingham, pp.1-31.
152
MPT-2013
Narasimhan, K.S., Rao, S.B., Choudhury, G.S., graphite ore deposits of Tamilnadu (India).
1972. Column flotation improves graphite Ultra Chemistry, 8, No. 2, pp.159-168.
recovery. Engineering Mining Journal, 173, Ravichandran, V., Eswaraiah, C., Sakthivel, R.,
No. 5, pp.84-89. Biswal, S.K., Manisankar, P., 2013. Gas
Patil, M.R., Shivakumar, K.S., Rudramuniyappa, dispersion characteristics of flotation
M.V., Bhima Rao, R., 2000. Flotation studies reagents. Powder Technology, 235, pp.329-
on graphite ores of Shivaganga area, 355.
Madurai district, Tamilnadu (India). Reddy, P.S.R., Prakash, S., Biswal, S.K., 1977.
Metallurgy and Materials Science, 42, No. Column flotation for low grade graphite
4, pp.233-241. of India. Proceeding of International con-
Pugh, R.J., 2000. Non-ionic polyethylene oxide ference on advances in metallurgical pro-
frothers in graphite flotation. Minerals cess, Bangalore, India, pp.71-76.
Engineering, 13, No. 2, pp.151-162. Wakamatsu, T., Numata, Y., 1991. Flotation of
Ravichandran, V., Eswaraiah, C., Manisankar, graphite. Minerals Engineering, 4, No. 7-
P., 2012. Benefic iation of low grade 11, pp.975-982.
*******
153
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
In the ore of base metal sulfides (such as CuFeS2, PbS and ZnS), carbonaceous gangue is often
present. Relevantly, Rampura Agucha is a major Lead – Zinc deposit having 1.5-2.5% Lead, 10-
15% Zinc and 4-6% Graphitic Carbon and mineralogically fine liberated. Carbonaceous and
micaceous Gangue minerals tend to float along with the galena, during selective flotation of galena.
Graphitic Carbon has a property of floating independently of physico chemical conditions of the
pulp (Eh, Ph,..), which leads to the contamination of mineral concentrates. Therefore, to avoid this
inadvertent flotation, it is possible to separate graphite or carbonaceous minerals from the ores
by flotation at the conditions at which the valuable ore fractions do not float or to depress them
with a suitable reagent. The earlier case is not suitable for the RAM, as there is a slight loss in the
recovery of valuable metal sulphides into the concentrate. So, Nigrosene is used as the reagent to
depress the free carbonaceous matter. However, after being known the ability of Reagent X as
graphite depressant, we tested it on the Rampura Agucha ore and it worked instantly. This paper
deals with the lab scale test results and reagent’s performance in plant scale.
154
MPT-2013
1.1 Mechanisms of the interactions of organic plants were like Nigrosine, Reagent X, Aero 633
compounds with the graphitic carbon: (a spec ialist reagent produc ed by Cytec
industries), etc.,
The theory which explains the adsorption of At the benefic iation operations in the
the aqueous phases on the activated carbon is Hindustan zinc limited’s mining site, the
Polanyi theory. Ac cording to the theory, conventional graphite depressant used since
adsorption of an adsorbate by adsorbents ages is nigrosine. The Reagent X is found as
should be described in two aspects: adsorption another graphite depressant from the literature
capacity and affinity. Adsorption capacity is survey.
limited by the potential space of a sorbent The possible c hemical structures of the
available for adsorption of a given adsorbate, Nigrosine and Reagent X are as follows.
while adsorption affinity is dependent on the
strength of the attractive forces between
adsorbate and adsorbent.
The net attractive forces involving the solute,
solvent, and the adsorbent are assumed to be
responsible for the solute adsorption by
sorbents suc h as Graphitic c arbon and
activated carbon. Among these forces, Vander
Waals force is normally the dominant force for
gas or vapor adsorption onto a hydrophobic
adsorbent, which may also be significant for
adsorption from the aqueous phase. Figure 1: Chemical Structure of Nigrosine
Considering only vander Waals forc es,
2. Experimental Procedure
however, may not be applicable in cases when
dipole-dipole, induced-dipole, and hydrogen- The experimental testing is done in two
bonding donor-acceptor interactions exist, conditions, open cycle batch flotation & closed
typically in aqueous phase, where these forces cycle batch flotation conditions.
can be important especially for chemicals with The experimental proc edure for testing
c ertain func tional groups. Five possible conditions consists of 1. Sample preparation for
interactions including hydrophobic effect, ð-ð the flotation (c rushing & grinding), 2.
bonds, hydrogen bonds, and covalent and Differential flotation (open cycle batch flotation
electrostatic interactions have been observed & closed cycle batch flotation), 3. Generated
and are responsible for the adsorption of sample preparation for the chemical analysis.
organic chemicals on Graphitic Carbon surface Flotation kinetics tests were conducted in the
(Yang, and Xing 2010). These interactions, their lead flotation. The rougher concentrates of lead
strengths, and contribution to the overall were collected in time interval of 20 sec for about
sorption are a function of the properties of both one minute.
organic chemicals and Graphitic Carbon. The tec hnic al c onditions whic h were
1.2 Graphitic carbon depressants in the maintained in the testing procedure are
conventional flotation: 1. Specific gravity of the slurry : 1.3-1.32
2. % passing 80 through 240# (mesh) or
The graphitic carbon depressants those are 63 microns.
been used in the mineral beneficiation flotation 3. Ore type (three ore types of RAM ore).
155
MPT-2013
3. Results and Discussion The above plots depict the grade recovery
curves of the graphite with the Nigrosine and
3.1. Open cycle batch flotation with first and Reagent X. The grade recovery curves of both
second ore types the reagents were found to be of similar nature
The reagent combination for the lead and zinc in the first ore type, which indicates the
flotation is as follows. The regent combination depression mechanism performance of the both
is the optimized combination. the reagents is at par. i.e, for any particular
Table 1: Reagent combination for the lead and grade of graphite in the lead concentrate the
zinc flotation for the first and Second ore types recovery of the graphite is same with both the
reagents.
In the subsequent plot, the grade recovery curve
of the graphite with Nigrosine as depressant is
clearly above the grade recovery curve with
the Reagent X as graphite depressant. This
Table 2: Results with Nigrosine & Reagent X informs that for any arbitrary grade of the
for the first ore type graphite in the lead concentrate the graphite
recovery is less in case of the Reagent X to that
of Nigrosine
Figure 2: The grade-recovery curves of the Figure 4: The Lead grade- recovery curves in
graphite in lead flotation with Nigrosine and lead flotation with Nigrosine and Reagent X
Reagent X graphite depressants graphite depressants
156
MPT-2013
157
MPT-2013
The graphitic carbon recovery trend with that For any partic ular zinc grade in zinc
of its grade is very similar in the both cases. concentrate the recovery of the iron (pyrite/
Where as its recovery with respect to the time pyrrotite) is more in case of the Nigrosine. The
is low in case of the Reagent X with comparison reason behind this is to be explored thoroughly.
with that of the Nigrosine. But in case of the graphite the recovery of the
During this test work emphasis was on the graphite is low even in zinc flotation in case of
characteristics of the zinc flotation in both the the Reagent X for any particular zinc rougher
cases of the Nigrosine and Reagent X. So, grade.
flotation kinetics tests were conducted in the
3.3. Closed cycle batch flotation
zinc flotation also. The rougher concentrates of
zinc were collected in time interval of 30 sec for We have a mini closed cycle batch flotation
about two minutes. The following graphs and system facility at our laboratory which consists
plots will describe the effect of both the reagents of two flotation cell banks. One bank can be used
in zinc flotation post dosage. for the rougher and scavenging flotation and
the other bank as a cleaner flotation cell bank.
The system also contains a conditioning tank
which holds the slurry through constant
agitation. The slurry is transported to the cells
through peristaltic pumps.
The electricity supplied to the cells is Direct
Current which is transformed by the control
Figure 8: Zinc & graphite grade – recovery
panel associated with the system. The launder
plots during the Zinc flotation in both control
water addition is done manually with the wash
and tests with Reagent X
bottles.
The grade vs. recovery trend line of zinc in case
The cell selection for the roughing stages and
of the Reagent X is slightly over the trend line
the scavenging is very simple.
of the Nigrosine. Which indicates the effect of
For the present study, for lead flotation the
both the reagents is one and the same with
rougher were 4 and scavengers were 2. And
neglisable deviation. Also the grade recovery
two stage cleaning was done. 1st stage cleaning
c urve of the graphite with Nigrosine as
is of two cells and the second stage comprises
graphite depressant in the zinc flotation is over
of single cell. Similarly cell arrangement is for
the trend line of the Reagent X which informs
the zinc flotation also.
that for any graphite grade the graphite
Below is the picture of the mini closed cycle
recovery is more in case of the Nigrosine when
batch flotation system facility.
compared with that of the Reagent X.
158
MPT-2013
Table 5: The reagent scheme for the closed streams was started. The hourly sample cuts
cycle flotation testing. were made in to two shifts composites samples
(1.00 PM to 8.00 PM) and (8.00 PM to 2.00 AM).
Table 8: The mass balance results for the circuit
during the shift (1.00 PM to 8.00 PM)
Table 7: Closed Cycle Tests Results: With The samples thus c ollec ted were shift
Reagent X @ 250 gpt in Lead Flotation composites and they were dried and then sent
for the chemical analysis. The analytical results
were then reconciled in the JK SimMet. The
reconciled data is tabulated in the above
displayed tables.
Observations: During plant trial, Reagent X &
Observations Nigrosine were run for 16 & 8 hrs respectively.
Lead Flotation: The day average of lead concentrate is 55.6%
From the results the graphite grade and Pb (daily assay report), whereas with Reagent
recovery in the lead concentrate is 5 & 2.86% in X it is 56%. Similarly, the day average graphite
Control Tests whereas with Reagent X tests 3.95 content in lead concentrate is 10%, where as
& 2.56%. The lead concentrate Grade and with naphthalene it is 8%. So graphite is
Recovery in control tests are 56.88% & 55.26%, effectively depressed with Reagent X with no
whereas in tests with Reagent X 53.25% & significant deterioration in Pb Conc. grade.
56.25%. 4. Conclusion
Zinc Flotation: From the results the graphite From the open, closed cycle batch flotation test
grade and recovery in the Zinc concentrate is work results & one day plant trial results it
1.53 & 9.12% in Control Tests whereas with was observed that the Reagent X is an efficient
Reagent X tests 1.5 & 8.73%. The Zinc graphitic carbon depressant which can be used
concentrate Grade and Recovery in control tests in the plant scale in place of the conventional
are 48.13% & 87.93%, whereas in tests with graphite depressant Nigrosine. The Reagent X
Reagent X 49% & 89.16%. is cost effective when compared to that of the
3.4. Plant trial with the reagent Nigrosine.
Plant trial was done with Reagent X in one of References
our c irc uits at RAM. Initially, after the Yang, K., and Xing, B., (2010), Adsorption of
introduction of the reagent into the circuit, we Organic Compounds by Carbon Nanomaterials
left a period of about three hrs to get rid of the in Aqueous Phase: Polanyi Theory and Its
effect of Nigrosine, after then sampling of the Application ,Chem. Rev.
*******
159
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Recent research progress in mineral flotation in mechanical cell shows that flotation rate depends
on bubble surface area flux (Sb), which is defined by the total bubble surface area flows through
column cross sectional area per unit time, and that flux has strong correlation with gas holdup
(åg). Yet no experimental work on Sb has been made to sphalarite flotation in column cell. This
paper studies the hydro-dynamical effects on the flotation behavior of sphalerite in terms of gas
holdup, bubble size (db) and bubble surface area flux which are considered to be variables directly
associated with flotation kinetics and examines the link between them. A series of experiments
have been conducted using a laboratory flotation column (height 1.66 m, diameter 0.1 m) at
various slurry concentration, slurry flow rate, gas flow rate, etc. Experimental results obtained
in the column operating with three phases (slurry-gas) and a two phase (water-gas) systems has
been presented and discussed. Results indicate that åg and Sb increases with gas flow rate while
increase in slurry rate, slurry concentration and collection zone height inhibit these parameters.
Slurry flow rate enhances db which is also reduced at higher slurry concentration. A strong
correlation has been found between as holdup and bubble surface area flux.
Keywords: Flotation column; gas holdup; bubble surface area flux; sphalerite flotation.
160
MPT-2013
6Ug
P = Ek/4 (6)
Sb (1) where P (-) is the floatability factor of mineral
db
particles.
Superficial gas velocity is the ratio of gas flow (Gorain et al., 1998 and Hernandez et al., 2003)
rate measured by gas flow meter to the cross have reviewed effect of gas dispersion on
sectional area of column presented in Eq 2. flotation rate (k). The study by (Massinaei et al.,
Qg 2009) is an example of the application of gas
Ug (2) dispersion analysis in industrial flotation
Ac
process. Many researchers have performed
It has been demonstrated that Sb (s-1) describes experiments to establish k-Sb relationship in
the hydrodunamic condition of the flotation different flotation cells (Gorain et al., 1997;
cells (both mechanical and column) (Xu et al., Heiskanen, 2000; Hernández et al., 2003;
1991). Hernandez-Aguilar et al., 2005; Kracht et al.,
Several works have been conducted to study 2005; Massinaei et al., 2009). The authors have
the effect of bubble size on flotation efficiency. used the drift-flax model to estimate the average
Equation (3) describes the classical model for bubble size in order to calculate Sb (s-1). Hence,
kinetic rate constants in flotation systems Sb (s-1) is an important parameter for flotation
(Ahmed and Jameson, 1985; Dobby and Finch, process. In addition, (Yianatos and Contreras,
1986; Jameson et al., 1977; Yoon and Luttrell, 2010) have reported that S b (s -1) is a key
1989). parameter for carrying capacity evaluation in
3 Ug flotation equipment.
k . .E C .E A (3)
2 db Therefore, it is essential to study the
hydrodynamic characteristics of column.
This equation indicates that the gas dispersion
Besides bubble surface area flux, gas holdup is
plays a role in flotation rate through both the
also an important parameter that determines
mec hanic al proc esses (U g/d b) and the
the circulation and mixing patterns of gas
elementary processes of particle collection.
slurry dispersions. Therefore, it determines the
Collection efficiency (Ek), which describes the
flotation efficiency and affects the residence
partic le– bubble interac tions, has been
time of materials in the flotation system.(
represented as the produc t between the
Ahmed and Johnson 1989) have reported that
collision efficiency EC (-) and the attachment
gas holdup favors flotation kinetics because it
efficiency EA (-) (Duan et al., 2003).
increases the number of bubbles, and therefore
In case of flotation column, the recovery of
the superficial area available for particle
mineral has been estimated using both the axial
collection. (Barigou and Greaves et al., 1992)
dispersion model and the tank in series model.
have found that the presence of electrolytes give
Both models indicate that recovery enhances
rise to a considerable bubble coalescence
with increasing rate constant k (s -1) and
retardation which reflects the reduction of
residence time (s) and decreasing cell
bubble size and more uniform dispersions.
mixing. So, recovery can be represented as
Bubble size strongly depends on the surface
R = f (k, , cell mixing) (4) tension of the used slurry and the utilized
Equation 5 describes kinetic rate constant (k) in bubble generation system (Chamarasa et al.,
terms of Sb using Eqs. (1) and (3). 1999). It has been found that the bubble size in
bubbly flow zone of a flotation column increase
k = P.S (5) with increasing distance from the bottom due
161
MPT-2013
to coalescence, which in turn, indicates that the rate. Likewise, changing slurry concentration
characteristics of gas dispersion depend on the may lead to a change in recovery. However,
axial position (Majumdar et al., 2006). In another very limited information is available in the
investigation, (Zhou et al. 1993). have reported literature regarding bubble surface area flux in
that a hydrophobic characteristic of particle flotation column. Also, there are no literatures
affects the gas holdup in flotation column. A available on sphalarite flotation. Therefore, this
study on axial gas holdup profile in flotation study has been devoted to analyze this effect
column has also been tested by (Zhou and on laboratory flotation column using Indian
Egiebor 1993). sphalerite ore. This paper will also focus on
Henc e, it c an be seen that the overall bubble size and gas holdup as well as bubble
performance of a flotation process is affected surface area flux and gas holdup relationship.
by the gas dispersion characteristics and
physicochemical characteristics of the system. 2. Methods and materials
As a research focus, gas dispersion is also closely Flotation was carried out in the Perspex column
related to fluid dynamics. Changing one whic h is shown in Fig. 1. The detailed
condition in flotation operation (e.g., gas specifications of the experimental column are
velocity) may lead to a significant change in given in Table 1. Air compressor was used to
rate constant and c onsequently flotation produce compressed air (at about 5 kg.cm -2)
recovery. Thus, it is concluded that the gas which was passed through a c ylindrical
velocity has a significant effect on the flotation ceramic porous sparger (S, pore diameter of 0.9-
W
MF
M2 ST
FT
M1 S
BV
SLP
T
A
CP
SV
AR AC
162
MPT-2013
1.5 µm) producing air bubbles at the bottom of sparger by switching on the air compressor
the column. The feed flow rate was measured before sending the feed to the column. The
by Magnetic flowmeter (MF). A calibrated gas column was operated continuously for about
flowmeter and controller were used to measure 30 min to reach steady state, which was
and control the air flow rate respectively. The confirmed by constant flow of tailings and
liquid level in the column was controlled by froth. Wash water was not used to avoid
adjusting the tailings flow rate using butterfly diluting the slurry. Moreover, the objective of
valve. Piezometers (M1 & M2) have been the work was focused on the phenomena
provided at the lower portion of column for occurring in the collection zone, hence the role
pressure drop studies. A butterfly valve (BV) is and performance of the cleaning zone was not
also installed in the tailing line of column for of partic ular interest. All the tests were
gas holdup study. Sphalerite from Hindustan performed at room temperature (25 - 30oC). The
Zinc Ltd. (India) was used to prepare slurry for ranges of operating variables utilized in
flotation experiment. The size of the particles is experiment are listed in Table 3. Phase
given in Table 2. The density of sphalerite was separation method was used to measure gas
3.16 gm/c m 3 , as determined by a gas holdup in the flotation column. Before gas
pycnometer. holdup measurement, sparger performance
was conducted using air-water and air-slurry
Table 1: Laboratory columns specifications
system. This test shows that there is no settling
Parameters Column or clogging of sparger. It is obvious that sparger
Diameter (m) 0.1 pore is much smaller than the solid particle (8-
Height (m) 1.68 15 µm). So, there was no possibility to clog the
Gas sparger type Internal-porous ceramic sparger. Bubble surface area flux in various
experiments was calculated from Equation 1.
Feed point from sparger (m) 1.3
Bubble size was estimated using drift flux
Table 2 :Particle size distribution of sample analysis. This technique has been used to
estimate mean bubble size in flotation columns
Size (µm) Wt % (Banisi and Finch, 1994; Dobby et al., 1998; Li et
al., 2004; Xu and Finch, 1990; Yianatos et al.,
+150 1 1988).
-150 +106 1 Table 3: Operating variables of column
-106 +75 7 experiments
-75 +53 26 Parameters Column
163
MPT-2013
coal by (Shukla et al. 2010), and they have Fig. 3 Effect of slurry flow rate on bubble
reported the opposite effect of slurry flow rate diameter
on gas holdup. This fact can be attributed to Figure 4 indicates the effect of gas velocity on
the specific gravity of coal (1.6) being much less
bubble surface area flux. The relationship
than sphalerite (3.6). So, less dense mineralized between Sb and Ug has been investigated for
bubble present in column and slightly increase mechanical cells and tank cells with the aim of
gas holdup in case of coal. identifying the maximum value of Sb (Nesset et
0.18 al., 2006). In addition, Finch et al. reported that
0.16 Sb has a maximum value of about 110s-1 for gas
0.14 water system and 88 s-1 for slurry system (Finch
as
(-)
ol
G
u
p
0.12
80
)
70
Bubble surface area flux (s
40
been shown in Fig. 3. This figure shows that
30
bubble size slightly increases with increase in 20
gas velocity due to the higher probability of 10
164
MPT-2013
Another issue to address is collection zone Figure 7 presents the effec t of slurry
height. There is no publication on the effect of concentration on gas holdup. From the results
collection zone height on gas holdup and bubble shown in Fig. 7, a strong dependence between
surface area flux which have been presented in
the gas holdup and slurry concentration has
Figs 5 and 6 respectively. Decrease in gas holdup
and also Sb with increase in collection zone been observed. The result also shows that it
height was observed within the operating range decreases linearly with slurry concentration at
of gas velocity (Figs 5 and 6). In addition, about the partic ular gas flow rate. A physic al
14-20 % decrease in gas holdup has also been explanation for lowering gas holdup can be
found with increasing collection zone height by explained by the following phenomena.
38 cm. Gas holdup reduction can be attributed Bubbles in c olumn at higher slurry
to the fact that the gas distribution has concentration get more solid particles which
considerable effect on bubble behavior in imply more bubble-particle aggregate density.
column. The size of the bubble generated at the As a result of more bubble particle density, some
sparger is not equal to the equilibrium size in of the bubbles travel to the tailing stream which
the collection zone. Bubbles experience more
indicates the reduction of bubble concentration
hydrostatic pressure and forms smaller bubble
in collection zone. It has also been found that
size in case of higher collection zone height. The
probability of bubble coalescence also increases bubble size increases with slurry concentration
with increasing pressure as height of the column due to coalescence (Fig. 8). So, the residence time
increases. Therefore, coalescence effect produces of bubbles decrease and consequently rising
larger bubbles. The larger bubbles travel up velocity increases. Bubbles escape the column
faster through the column and results in which results in the lowering of gas holdup.
lowering of gas holdup. 0.2
0.18
0.18
0.16
0.16
Hc = 1.28 m 0.14 Ug = 0.64 cm/s
0.14
Gas holdup (-)
Hc = 1.66 m
0.12 Ug = 1.06 cm/s
0.12
Gas hold-up (-)
Ug = 1.48 cm/s
0.1
0.1 Ug = 1.91 cm/s
0.08 Ug = 2.33 cm/s
0.08
0.06 ug = 2.76 cm/s
0.06
0.04
0.04
0.02
0.02
0
0
0 5 10 15
0 1 2 3
-2
Slurry concentration (wt %)
Superficial gas velocity X 10 (m/s)
Fig. 5 Effect of gas collection zone height on Fig. 7 Effect of solid concentration on gas holdup
90 2.5
gas holdup 80
Bubble diameter (mm)
90
Bubble surface area flux (s )
2
-1
70
80 Hc=1.66 m
Bubble surface area flux (s -1)
60
70 Hc=1.28 m 1.5
50
60
40
50 1
30 Cs=5 wt%
40
Cs=10 wt%
20 0.5
30 Cs = 5 wt%
10
20 Cs = 10 wt%
0 0
10
0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3
0 Gas velocity X 10-2 (m/s)
0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3
Fig. 8 Effect of solid concentration on bubble size
Gas velocity X 10-2 (m/s)
Fig. 6 Effect of collection zone height on bubble and bubble surface area flux
surface area flux
165
MPT-2013
20
for pulp and paper slurry and in mechanical
10
cell (Grau, and Heiskanen, 2005; Reese et al.,
0
1996). 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2
3.4 Bubble surface area flux and gas holdup Fig. 9 Bubble surface area flux and gas holdup
relationship relationship
4. Conclusions
All the above plots suggest that there exists a
Fac tors that affec t the gas dispersion
relationship between gas holdup and bubble
surface area flux. Figure 9 shows that gas characteristics are superficial gas velocity
holdup and bubble surfac e area flux for determined by air flow rate, collection zone
sphalerite flotation in column over a wide range height and slurry concentration quantified by
mass of solid per unit volume of water. These
of operating conditions are linearly related
properties of flotation column have been
which was shown by the work performed by
Finch et al., (2000) for pilot scale flotation cell studied using sphalerite ore. Observed results
for gas holdup, bubble surface area flux and
and mainly mechanical flotation cell. The figure
indicates that the data are correlated by a bubble size are from 4 % to 17 %, from 15 s-1 to
straight line presented in equation (7). 85 s -1and from 1.6 to 2.6 mm respectively,
within the operating range of gas velocity from
Sb 519. g (7) 0.64 cm/s to 2.76 cm/s. Results also show that
-1
The slope of the above equation is 519 s , which bubble surface area flux is a function of gas
is nearly similar to the slope that reported by holdup through a linear relationship, which is
(Finch et al. 2000) based on the analysis of the consistent with other studies. This linear
166
MPT-2013
equation can be used to estimate flotation rate Yoon, R., Luttrell, G., 1989. The effect of bubble
constant using experimental gas holdup. The size on fine particle flotation. Miner. Process.
identification of gas dispersion is useful for Extr. M., 5, 101–122.
process modeling and process control criteria Duan, J., Fornasiero, D., Ralston, J., 2003.
for industrial cells. Calculation of the flotation rate constant of
chalcopyrite particles in an ore. Int. J. Miner.
Acknowledgements
Process., 72, 227–237.
The authors would like to thank the Indian Gorain, B. K., Napier-Munn, T. J., Franzidis, J. P.,
Institute of Tec hnology, Kharagpur for Manlapig, E. V., 1998. Studies on impeller
supporting this research. type, impeller speed and air flow rate in an
industrial scale flotation c ell. Part 5:
References validation of k-Sb relationship and effect of
Vinnett, L., Contreras, F., Yianatos, J., 2012. Gas froth depth. Miner. Eng., 11, (7), 615–626.
dispersion pattern in mec hanic al Hernandez, H., Gomez, C. O., Finch, J. A., 2003.
flotationcells. Miner. Eng., 26, 80–85. Gas dispersion and de-inking in a flotation
Nesset, J. E., Hernandez-Aguilar, J. R., Acuna, column. Miner. Eng., 16, 739–744.
C., Gomez C. O., Finch J. A., 2006. Some gas Massinaei, M., Kolahdoozan, M., Noaparast, M.,
dispersion characteristics of mechanical Oliazadeh, M., Yianatos, J., Shamsadini, R.,
flotation machines. Miner. Eng., 19, 807–815. Yarahmadi, M., 2009. Hydrodynamic and
Schwarz, S., Alexander, D., 2006. Gas dispersion kinetic c harac terization of industrial
measurements in industrial flotation cells. columns in rougher circuit. Miner. Eng., 22,
Miner. Eng., 19, 554–560. (4), 357–365.
Yianatos, J., Bergh, L., Condori, P., Aguilera, J., Hernandez-Aguilar, J.R., Rao, S.R., Finch, J.A.,
2001. Hydrodynamic and metallurgical 2005. Testing the k–Sb relationship at the
characterization of industrial flotation microscale. Miner. Eng., 18, 591–598.
banks for control purposes. Miner. Eng., 14, Kracht, W., Vallebuona, G., Casali, A., 2005. Rate
1033–1046. constant modelling for batch flotation, as a
Xu, M.Q., Finch, J.A., Uribe-Salas, A., 1991. function of gas dispersion properties. Miner.
Maximum gas and bubble surface rates in Eng., 18, 1067–1076.
flotation columns. Int. J. Miner. Process., 32, Hernández, H., Gómez, C.O., Finch, J.A.,
233-250. 2003.Gas dispersion and de-inking in a
Jameson, G., Nam, S., Young, M., 1977. Physical flotation Column. Miner. Eng., 16, 739–744.
factors affecting recovery rates in flotation. Heiskanen, K., 2000. On the relationship
Miner. Sci. Eng., 9(3), 103–118. between flotation rate and bubble surface
Ahmed, N., Jameson, G., 1985. The effect of area flux. Miner. Eng., 13(2), 141–149.
bubble size on the rate of flotation of fine Gorain, B.K., Franzidis, J.P., Manlapig, E.V., 1997.
particles. Int. J. Miner. Process., 14, 196–215. Studies on impeller type, impeller speed and
Dobby, G.S., Finch, J.A., 1986. Particle collection air flowrate in an industrial scale flotation
in columns – gas rate and bubble size effects’. cell. Part 4: effect of bubble surface area flux
Can. Metal. Quart., 25, (1), pp.9–13. on flotation performance. Miner. Eng., 10(4),
367–379.
167
MPT-2013
Yianatos, J.B., Contreras, F.A., 2010. On the Xu, M., Finch, J.A., 1990. Simplification of bubble
c arrying c apac ity limitation in large size estimation in a bubble swarm. J. Colloid.
flotation cells. Can. Metal. Quart. 49, (4), Interf. Sci. 140, 298–299.
345–352. Banisi, S., Finch, J.A., 1994. Reconciliation of
Ahmed, N., Johnson, G.J., 1989. Flotation bubble size estimation methods using drift
kinetics. Miner. Process. Extr. M. Rev., 5, 77– flux analysis. Miner. Eng., 7, (12), 1555–1559.
99. Li, H., Del Villar, R., Gomez, C.O., 2004.
Baringou, M., Greaves, M., 1992. Bubble-size Reviewing the experimental procedure to
distributions in a mechanically agitated determine the carrying capacity in flotation
gas—liquid contactor. Chem. Eng. Sci, 47, columns. Can. Metal. Quart., 43(4), 513–520.
2009-2025. Shukla, S.C., Kundu, G., Mukherjee, D., 2010.
Chamarasa, E., Vial, C., Poncin, S., Wild, G., Study of gas holdup and pressure
Midoux, N., Bouillard, J., 1999. Influence of characteristics in a column flotation cell
coalescence behaviour of the liquid and of using coal. Miner. Eng., 23(8), 636-642.
gas sparging on hydrodynamic s and Finch, J.A., Xiao, J., Hardie, C., Gomez, C., 2000.
bubble characteristics in a bubble column. Gas dispersion properties: bubble surface
Chem. Eng. Process, 38, 329-344. area flux and gas holdup. Miner. Eng., 13(14),
Majumdar, S., kundu, G., mukherjee, D., 2006. 365–372.
Bubble size distribution and gas-ligquid Yianatos, J.B., Henriquez, F., 2007. Boundary
interfacial area in a modified downflow conditions for gas rate and
bubble column. Chem. Eng. j, 122, 1-10.
bubble size at the pulp-froth interface in
Zhou, Z.A., Egiebor, N.O., Plitt, L.R., 1993. flotation. Miner. Eng., 20,pp. 625-628.
Frother effects on bubble size estimation in
Reese, J., Jiang, P., Fan, L.S., 1996. Bubble
a flotation column. Miner. Eng., 6, (3), 291-
characteristics in three-phase systems used
306.
for pulp and paper processing. Chem. Eng.
Zhou, Z.A., Egiebor, N.O., 1993. Prediction of Sci., 51, (10), 2501–2510.
Axial Gas Holdup Profiles in Flotation
Grau, R.A., Heiskanen, K., 2005. Bubble size
Columns. Miner. Eng., 6, (3), 307-312.
distribution in laboratory scale flotation
Dobby, G.S., Yianatos, J.B., Finch, J.A., 1998. cells. Miner. Eng., 18, 1164–1172.
Estimation of bubble diameter in flotation
Szatkowski, M., 1987. Technical note: Effects of
columns from drift flux analysis. Can. Metal.
air usage on flotation of coal.
Quart. 27(2), 85–90.
Miner. Metal. Proces., 4, pp.37-39.
Yianatos, J.B., Finch, J.A., Dobby, G.S., Xu, M.,
1988. Bubble size estimation in a bubble Gomez, C.O., Cortes-Lopez, F., Finch, J.A., 2003.
swarm. J. Colloid. Interf. Sci. 126, 37–44. Industrial testing of a gas
holdup sensor for flotation systems. Miner. Eng.,
16, 493–501.
*******
168
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
169
MPT-2013
of H2O2 production also corroborate with the rest potential of the sulphide minerals; higher the
rest potential more is the formation of H2O2. Most likely H2O2 is responsible for the oxidation of
sulphide minerals and dissolution of non-ferrous metal sulphides in the presence of ferrous
sulphide besides the galvanic interactions.
This study highlights the necessity of revisiting the electrochemical and/or galvanic interactions
between the grinding medium and sulphide minerals, and interaction mechanisms between
pyrite and other sulphide minerals in terms of their flotation behaviour in the context of the
inevitable existence of H2O2 in the pulp liquid.
170
MPT-2013
2012). In an attempt to fill the gap, we have Fe, 1.26% Zn, 0.2% Cu and some silica (quartz)
estimated the concentration of H2O2 in pulp impurity. Pyrite contains 44.4% Fe, 50.9% S, and
liquid during different times of grinding and in 0.2% Cu, and chalcopyrite contains 29% Fe,
different grinding environments. The effects of 29.5% S, 25.8% Cu, 0.54% Zn, and 0.22% Pb. The
pH, type of grinding (wet or dry grinding), and XRD analyses of the samples showed that the
varying proportion of pyrite, chalcopyrite and main mineral phases present were pyrite (Fig.
galena mixed with sphalerite on the formation 1a), chalcopyrite (Fig. 1b), sphalerite (Fig. 1c),
of hydrogen peroxide were investigated and the and galena (Fig. 1d) in the respective mineral
results have been presented and discussed in samples. All the mineral samples used in this
this paper in the context of flotation and leaching study were separately crushed through a jaw
phenomena of sulphide minerals. crusher and then screened to collect the –3.35
mm particle size fraction. The homogenized
2. Experimental sample was then sealed in polyethylene bags.
2.1 Materials and reagents Potassium amyl xanthate (KAX) was used as
collector and the frother was MIBC in flotation
Crystalline pure sphalerite (Sp), galena (Ga), tests. Solutions of sodium hydroxide (AR grade)
pyrite (Py) and chalcopyrite(Cp) minerals used and HCl (1 M) were added to maintain the pH
in this study were procured from Gregory, at the targeted value during flotation. Deionised
Bottley& Lloyd Ltd., UK. Sphalerite contains water was used in both grinding and flotation
39.92% Zn, 20.7% S, 4.2% Fe, 1.32% Pb and 0.17% processes. Solutions of 2, 9-dimethyl-1, 10-
Cu. Galena contains 73.69% Pb, 13.5% S, 1.38% phenanthroline (DMP),copper (II) (0.01 M), and
Fig. 1. XRD analysis of the sample (a) pyrite (1- pyrite). (b) chalcopyrite (1- chalcopyrite and 2-
pyrrhotite 3- sphalerite) (c) sphalerite (1- sphalerite 2- galena 3- quartz), (d) galena (1- galena 2-
sphalerite 3- quartz).
171
MPT-2013
phosphate buffer (pH 7.0) were used for Scanning Spectrophotometer. The blank
estimating the amount of H2O2 in the pulp liquid solution was prepared in the same manner but
by UV-Visible spectrophotometer (Baga et al., without H2O2.
1988). Zinc sulphate, copper sulphate, lead
nitrate, ferrous sulphate and ferric sulphate 3. Results and discussion
chemicals were also used to investigate the 3.1 Formation of hydrogen peroxide (H 2O2)
effect of metal ions (Zn2+, Cu2+, Pb2+, Fe2+ and Fe3+) after dry grinding and mixing with water
on the formation of H2O2.
Formation of hydrogen peroxide was observed
2.2 Dry grinding when the freshly dry-ground solids were mixed
in water. The effect of pH of the mineral
100 g of –3.35 mm size fraction of pure suspension on the formation of hydrogen
sphalerite, pyrite, galena and chalcopyrite peroxide is shown in Fig. 2. It can be seen that
minerals in each grinding test were separately for pyrite, chalcopyrite and sphalerite with an
ground in a laboratory stainless steel ball mill increase in pH, the concentration of H 2O2is
(Model 2VS, CAPCO Test Equipment, Suffolk, decreased up to pH 8 and then is increased
UK) with stainless steel medium for 60 min. 5 g above this pH, but in the case of galena, H2O2is
of sphalerite, galena, pyrite or chalcopyrite generated at pH <4.5 only. Further, pyrite
single mineral and 12.5 g of mineral mixture generates more H2O2 than the other minerals.
either sphalerite-pyrite or sphalerite- Kocabag et al. (1990) using the Eh-pH diagram
chalcopyrite or sphalerite-galena or galena- (Fig. 3a) of pyrite showed that oxidation of
pyrite or galena-chalcopyrite or chalcopyrite- pyrite yields S°, Fe 2+, Fe (OH)2+ species in the
pyrite that was < 106 µm was mixed with 50 solution for pH < 6 and Fe (OH)2 ,Fe (OH)3 species
cm3 water using magnetic stirrer and then the in the solution for pH > 6. At pH < 6, Fe2+ ions are
slurry sample was collected at 0.5, 5 and 11 min, increased with decreasing pH and therefore, in
filtered and was analysed for hydrogen the presence of dissolved molecular oxygen,
peroxide. The pH was regulated with HCl and ferrous iron associated with pyrite can form
NaOH solutions. superoxide anion (O2•)” (eq. 1), which reacts
with ferrous iron to form H2O2 (eq. 2) as shown
2.3 Estimation of hydrogen peroxide
in Fig. 4a (Cohn et al., 2006).
The spectrophotometric method of using FeII(pyrite) + O2’ FeIII(pyrite) + (O2•) (1)
copper (II) ions and DMP has been found to be
FeII(pyrite) + (O2•) + 2H+’ FeIII(pyrite) + H2O2 (2)
reasonably sensitive when applied to advanced
oxidation processes (Kosaka et al., 1998).For
DMP method (Baga et al., 1988), 1 mL each of 1%
DMP in ethanol, 0.01M c opper (II), and
phosphate buffer (pH 7.0) solutions were added
to a 10 mL volumetric flask and mixed. A
measured volume of liquid (filtrate) sample was
added to the volumetric flask, and then the flask
was filled up with ultrapure water. After
mixing, the absorbance of the sample at 454 nm Fig. 2. Effect of pH on production of H2O2 after 5
was measured with DU ® Series 700 UV/Vis min mixing of dry ground solids with water.
172
MPT-2013
Fe (III) can also generate H2O2in such a way that O2 +Fe2+ ’ Fe3++ (O2•) “ (5)
an electron is extracted from water and a
(O2•) “ + Fe2+ + 2H+’Fe 3++H2O2 (6)
hydroxyl radical is formed (eq. 3).Combining
2+ 3+ • ”
two hydroxyl radicals leads to the formation Fe + H2O2’ Fe + OH + OH (7)
of H2O2 (eq. 4) (Borda et al., 2003): 2•OH ’ H2O2 (8)
III + II
Fe + H2O’OH + H + Fe (3) Above pH 5, the stability diagram shows the
•
2 OH ’ H2O2 (4) Fe2O3 solid phase, that also generates hydrogen
peroxide. This is in agreement with other
Fairthorne at al. (1997) using the Eh–pH stability
studies where hematite and magnetite solids
diagram of chalcopyrite (Fig. 3a) exemplified the
in water were shown to induce H2O2 formation
formation of insoluble ferric oxide/hydroxide
(Cohn et al., 2006).Fig. 4b exhibits that copper
at neutral and basic pH values but also in acidic
ions also generate hydrogen peroxide. The metal
conditions at high E hvalues. Notably the
ions induced formation of hydroxyl free radical
divalent Fe and Cu ions exist at low pH values
has been established, where copper ions
from negative to high Eh values. These divalent
generate the superoxide and hydroxyl radical
ions are reported to aid the formation of H2O2
(eqs. 9-12) (Valko et al., 2005).
(Valko et al., 2005; Jones et al., 2011; Jones et al.,
2012) from water and our present results shown O2 + e”’! O2•– (9)
in Table 1 demonstrate that Fe2+ ions generate 2O2•– + 2H+ ’ H2O2 +O2 (10)
substantial H2O2 followed by Fe3+ and Cu2+ ions.
Fig. 3b displays that the concentration of ferrous Cu++ H2O2=Cu2++ •OH + OH– (11)
ions decreases at the expense of ferric oxide/ 2•OH ’ H2O2 (12)
hydroxides at higher pH and Eh values (oxygen
conditioning).The schematic diagram of H2O2 In acidic pH, the formation of higher amounts
formation in the presenc e of dissolved of hydrogen peroxide compared to that at
molecular oxygen is shown in Fig. 4b, where at alkaline pH is due to the presence of copper and
acidic pH (pH < 5) superoxide anion (O2•) “ (eq. 5) ferrous ions in acidic pH, which are capable to
is formed, which reacts with ferrous iron to generate hydrogen peroxide (Table 1).
form H2O2 (eqs. 6-8). This is in agreement with Huai Su(1981) showed by the Eh-pH diagram
other studies where it was observed that metal of sphalerite that at pH < 6, Zn2+ and Fe2+are
ions-induced formation of free radical has been formed (Fig. 3c). Table 1 show that Zn2+ and Fe2+
evidenced and that ferrous ion generates ions generated H2O2. In the presence of dissolved
superoxide and hydroxyl radical (Valko et al., molecular oxygen, ferrous iron can form
2005; Jones et al., 2011). superoxide anion (O2•) “ (eq. 5), which reacts
with ferrous iron to form H2O2 (eq. 6). Also Zn2+
Table 1. H2O2 generation in the presence of
ions can form superoxide anion (O2•) “ to form
metal ions at natural pH and at 22 °C.
H2O2 (eq. 13) as shown in Fig. 4c .
H2O 2 (mM)
Concentration of 2(O2•) +2H+’H2O2+O2 (13)
ions 1 mM 10 mM
water 0 0 Woods (1981) by the Eh-pH diagram (Fig. 3d) of
Fe 2+ 0.552 4.656
galena showed that at pH < 4, Pb2+ ions exist.
Fe 3+ 0.004 0.059
Cu 2+ 0 0.015 Fig. 4d shows that in the presence of dissolved
Pb2+ 0.013 0.096 molecular oxygen and in acidic pH (pH < 4), lead
Zn 2+ 0.004 0.088
ions can form superoxide anion (O2•)” which
173
MPT-2013
reacts with H+ to form H2O2 (Eqs. 14-17). It can generate superoxide and hydroxyl radical
be seen from Table 1 that Pb 2+ ions generate (Ahlberg and Broo, 1996a; 1996b; 1996c).
H2O2 (Blokhina et al. 2001; Ni et al. 2004). This is O2 + e”’ (O2•) “ (14)
in agreement with other studies where metal 2(O2•) “ + 2H+’ H2O2+O2 (15)
ions induced formation of free radicals has been PbS + H2O2’ Pb2+ +S0+2e”+2 •OH (16)
significantly evidenced for Pb 2+ ions that 2•OH= H2O2 (17)
(a) (b)
(d)
(c)
Fig. 3. a)Eh–pH stability diagram for the Cu–Fe–S–H2O system with the preponderant copper
and iron species shown in each domain (Fairthorne et al. 1997) b)Eh–pH diagram for FeS2–H2O
system at 25 0C and for 10-5M dissolved species (Kocabag et al. 1990). c)Eh–pH stability diagram
for the sphalerite–H2O system (Huai Su, 1981)d) Eh–pH diagram for the Pb–S–H2O system
where [Pb] =10-3 M (Woods, 1981).
174
MPT-2013
(a) (b)
(c)
(d)
175
MPT-2013
peroxide at pH 4.5. Fig. 7a shows the effect of increasing pyrite proportion (Harvey and Yen,
pyrite or sphaleritepercent in sphalerite–pyrite 1998). This is in agreement with other studies
mixture on the formation of hydrogen peroxide. where it was shown that the oxidation of
It can be seen that with an increase in pyrite sphalerite increases with increasing hydrogen
percent, the concentration of H2O2is increased peroxide concentration (Adebayo et al., 2006;
but with an increase in sphalerite percent, the Aydogan, 2006).
concentration of H2O2is decreased. This result Fig. 7b shows the effect of chalcopyrite or
of non-ferrous metal sulphide oxidation with sphalerite percent in sphalerite–chalcopyrite
increasing pyrite fraction could be due to the mixture on the formation of hydrogen peroxide
increased H 2O 2 generation and that of an where an increase in chalcopyrite percent
increase in the rate of sphalerite leaching with increases the concentration of H2O2 but with
176
MPT-2013
an increasing sphalerite percent in the mixture, amount of pyrite in contact with chalcopyrite
the concentration of H 2O2is decreased. This increases, the leaching rate of chalcopyrite
result of increasing chalcopyrite proportion increases (Koleini et al. 2010;Koleini et al.
leading to an increase in the formation of 2011;Dixon and Tshilombo, 2005;Mehta, and
H2O2can be explained by the observation of Murr 1983;Holmes and Crundwell, 1995).
increased leaching rate of sphalerite with an Fig. 8 shows the effect of single or mixture of
increase in chalcopyrite proportion (Harvey minerals on the formation of hydrogen peroxide
and Yen, 1998). at pH 4.5. It can be seen that pyrite and a mixture
Fig. 7c shows the effect of galena or sphalerite of pyrite and other sulphide minerals generated
percent in sphalerite–galenamixture on the more H2O2. This is in agreement with other
formation of hydrogen peroxide. It can be seen studies where it was noticed when pyrite was
that with an increase in galena percent, the mixed with a second sulphide mineral, the
concentration of H2O2is decreased but with an second mineral oxidized more rapidly (Buehler
increase in sphalerite percent, the concentration and Gottschalk, 1910). The formation of higher
of H 2O 2is increased. This result could be amounts of H2O2 when pyrite was mixed with
attributed to a decrease in the rate of sphalerite a second sulphide mineral may explain the effect
leaching with increasing galena proportion of interaction between pyrite and second
(Harvey and Yen, 1998). sulphide mineral on flotation, leac hing,
Fig. 7d shows the effect of pyrite or galena environment governance and geochemical
perc ent in galena–pyrite mixture on the processes while the entire literature describes
formation of hydrogen peroxide. It can be seen so far of galvanic interaction between two
that with an increase in pyrite percent, the contacting sulphide minerals and electron
c onc entration of H 2O 2 inc reases but by transfer from one to the other (Rao and Finch,
increasing galena percent, the concentration of 1988; Kelebek et al. 1996; Zhang et al. 1997;
H2O2 decreases. Ekmekçi and Demirel, 1997; Huang and Grano,
Fig. 7e shows the effect of chalcopyrite or galena 2005; Mehta and Murr, 1983; Abraitis et al.
percent in galena–chalcopyrite mixture on the 2003;Akcil and Ciftci, 2003; Thornber, 1975; Sato,
formation of hydrogen peroxide. It is evident 1992;Alpers and Blowes, 1994; Sikka et al. 1991;
that by increasing chalcopyrite percent, the Banfield and Nealson, 1997).
concentration of H2O2 increases. However, by
an increase in galena percent in the mixture,
the production of H2O2 decreases. This result
could perhaps explain that galena has no effect
on the kinetics of chalcopyrite leaching (Nazari
et al. 2012).
Fig. 7f shows the effect of pyrite or chalcopyrite
percent in chalcopyrite–pyrite mixture on
formation of hydrogen peroxide that with an
increase in pyrite percent, the concentration of
H 2 O 2 inc reases but with an inc rease in
chalcopyrite percent, the concentration of H2O2 Fig. 8. Effect of minerals either individually or
decreases. The increase in the concentration of in their mixture on H2O2 formation with 12.5 g
H2O2due to the increase in pyrite proportion blend sample after 5 min conditioning in water
could be explained by the fact that as the at pH 4.5.
177
MPT-2013
So far two mechanisms have been proposed for 2Fe2++ (1/2) O2+2H+’2Fe3++H2O (22)
the action of microorganisms that increases the
ZnS+2Fe3+’Zn2++S0+2Fe2+ (23)
leaching rate of metals from ores over that due
to purely physico-chemical processes. In direct Sand et al. (1995) suggested that bacterial
action, microorganisms will directly oxidize leac hing of metal sulphides proc eeds
minerals and solubilize metals (eqs. 18-19) (Fig. essentially by indirect mechanism initiated by
9a): ferric ion, Fe3+. Sand and colleagues (Gehrke et
al. 1998;Sand et al. 1995;Sand et al.
MS+H2SO4+ (1/2) O2’MSO4+S0+H2O (18)
1999;Schippers and Sand, 1999) consider all of
S0+ (3/2) O2+H2O’H2SO4 (19) these bacterial contributions as ‘indirect.’ It is
c urrently believed that the leac hing of
Where M is a divalent metal. In indirect action
sphalerite proceeds according to an indirect
of microorganisms, ferric ion (Fe 3+) is the
mechanism (Boon et al. 1998; Fowler and
oxidizing agent for minerals and the role of
Crundwell, 1998), and it has been postulated
organisms is simply regeneration of Fe3+ from
that this mechanism is applicable to all other
Fe2+ (eqs. 20-21)(Fig. 9b):
sulphide minerals of the form Me2+S2"(Boon and
MS+2Fe3+’M2++2Fe2++S0 (20) Heijnen, 1993), such as galena. Using these
routes, bacteria are thought to accelerate the
2Fe2++ (1/2) O2+2H+’2Fe3++H2O (21) reaction rate by oxidizing the elemental
In the actual microbial leaching of metals, both sulphur product layer (Boon et al. 1998).
direct and indirect leaching as well as physico- It is worth mentioning that H2O2 could also be
chemical reactions can contribute (Suzuki, the oxidizing agent for minerals and the role of
2001). (Ehrlich,1999) mentions a number of organisms is simply generation of Fe3+ ions, and
studies in support of the direct cell attachment Fe2+ ions can generate H2O2 as shown in Fig. 9c .
on the surface of minerals and the role of The concentration of H 2O2 generated from
Fe3+bound on the cell surface for sulphide contacting Fe 2+ ion with water for 1 h, is
oxidation. Fowler and Crundwell (1998) presented as a function of Fe2+ concentration in
concluded that the leaching of zinc from Table 1. This is in agreement with other studies
sphalerite (ZnS) by T. ferrooxidans was strictly where the dissolved ferrous iron concentration
by indirect mechanism and the only bacterial was found to be an important secondary factor
contribution was the regeneration of Fe3+ from contributing towards ROS generation (Jones
Fe2+ (eqs. 22-23): et al. 2012).
Fig. 9. Proposed mechanisms of microorganisms for oxidize minerals by a) direct action b) indirect
action c) both indirect action and formation of H2O2.
178
MPT-2013
179
MPT-2013
reduction at pyrite, Int. J. Miner. Process, 47(1- Borda, M., Elsetinow A., Schoonen M., Strongin
2), 49-60. D., 2001, Pyrite-induc ed hydrogen
Akcil, A., Ciftci, H., 2003.Metals recovery from peroxide formation as a driving force in the
multimetal sulphide c onc entrates evolution of photosynthetic organisms on
(CuFeS2–PbS–ZnS): c ombination of an early Earth. Astrobiology, 1:283–288.
thermal process and pressure leaching, Int. Borda, M.J., Elsetinow, A.R., Strongin, D.R.,
J. Miner. Process. 71, 233–246. Schoonen, M.A., 2003. A mechanism for the
Alpers, C.N., Blowes, D.W., 1994. Secondary production of hydroxyl radical at surface
iron-sulphate minerals as sources of defec t sites on
sulphate and acidity. Environmental pyrite.GeochimicaetCosmochimicaActa,
Geochemistry of Sulphide Oxidation, C.N. 67, 935 -939.
Alpers and D.W. Blowes (Eds.), Am. Chem. Buehler, H. A., Gottschalk, V. H. 1910. Oxidation
Soc.Series 550, 345-364. of sulfides. Econ. Geology, 5, 28-35, 1.
Aydogan, S., 2006.Dissolution kinetics of Cohn, C.A.; Laffers, R.; Schoonen, M.A.A.,
sphalerite with hydrogen peroxide in 2006.Using yeast RNA as a probe for
sulphuric ac id medium, Chemic al generation of hydroxyl radicals by earth
Engineering Journal 123, 65–70. materials. Environ. Sci. Technol.40, 2838-
Baga,A.N.,Johnson G.R. A., Nazhat, N.B., 2843.
Saadalla- Nazhat, R.A.,1988. Cohn, C.A., Mueller, S., Wimmer, E., Leifer, N.,
Anal.Chim.Acta, 204, 349-353. Greenbaum, S., Strongin, D.R., Schoonen,
Banfield, J. F., and K. H. Nealson (ed.). 1997. M.A.A., 2006.Pyrite-induced hydroxyl
Geomicrobiology: interactions between radical formation and its effect on nucleic
mic robes and minerals, pp. 448. acids, Geochemical Transactions 7, 1.
Mineralogic al Soc iety of Americ a, Dixon, D.G., Tshilombo, A.F., 2005. Leaching
Washington, DC. Process for Copper Concentrates, US
Blokhina,O.B.,Chirkova, T.V., Fagerstedt, K.V., Patent, Pub No.: US2005/0269208Al.
2001. Anoxic stress leads to hydrogen Ehrlich, H.L., 1999. Past, present and future of
peroxide formation in plant cells, J. biohydrometallurgy.In: Amils R, Ballester
Experimental Botany 52, 1179-1190. A, editors. Biohydrometallurgy and the
Boon M., Heijnen J.J. 1993.Mechanisms and environment toward the mining of the 21st
rate limiting steps in bioleaching of century PT-A- 1999, vol. 9. New York: Wiley,
sphalerite,chalcopyrite and pyrite with 51-60.
thiobacillusferrooxidans. Ekmekçi, Z., Demirel, H., 1997. Effects of galvanic
Biohydrometallurgical Technologies Vol I, interaction on c ollec torless flotation
A.E.Torma, J.E.Wey and V.L.Lakshmanan behaviour of chalcopyrite and pyrite.
(Eds.). The Minerals, Metals and Materials International Journal of Mineral Processing
Society, Warrendale , PA (1993). Proc. Int. 52, 31–48.
Biohydrometallurgy Symposium, Fairthorne, G., Fornasiero, D., Ralston, J., 1997.
Jackson, Wyoming, USA , (August), pp. Effect of oxidation on the collectorless
217-236. flotation of chalcopyrite. International
Boon, M., Snijder, M., Hansford, G.S., Heijnen, Journal of Mineral Processing, 49, 31-48.
J.J., 1998. The oxidation kinetics of zinc Fowler, T.A., Crundwell, F.K., 1998.Leaching of
sulphide with T. ferroxidans. zinc sulfide by Thiobacillusferrooxidans:
Hydrometallurgy, pp.48 (2), 171"186. experiments with a c ontrolled redox
180
MPT-2013
potential indicate no direct bac terial Kelebek, S., Wells, P.F., Fekete, S.O.,
mechanism Appl. Environ.Microbiol. 64, 1996.Differential flotation of chalcopyrite,
3570–3575. pentlandite and pyrrhotite in Ni-Cu
Gehrke, T., Telegdi, J., Thierry, D., Sand, W., sulfide ores,Canadian Metallurgic al
1998.Importance of extracellular polymeric Quarterly, Volume 35, 329-336.
substances from Thiobacillusferrooxidans Kocabag, D., Shergold, H.L., Kelsall, G.H., 1990.
for bioleaching. Appl Environ Microbiol Natural oleophilicity /hydrophobicity of
64, 2743-2747. sulfide minerals, II.Pyrite. Int. J. Miner.
Harvey, T.J., Yen, W.T., 1998. Influence of Process.,.29, 211-219.
chalcopyrite, galena and pyrite on the Koleini, S.M.J., Aghazadeh, V., Sandström, Å.
selective extraction of zinc from base metal 2011.Ac idic sulphate leac hing of
sulphide c onc entrates, Minerals chalcopyrite concentrates in presence of
Engineering, 11, 1-21. pyrite, J. Minerals Engineering 24,381
Holmes, P.R., Crundwell, F.K., 1995. Kinetic Koleini, S.M.J., Jafarian, M., Abdollahy, M.,
aspects of galvanic interactions between Aghazadeh, V., 2010. Galvanic leaching of
minerals during dissolution. chalcopyrite in atmospheric pressure and
Hydrometallurgy 39, 353–375. sulphate media: kinetic and surface study.
Huai, Su., 1981. Dissolution of Sphalerite in Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 49, 5997–6002
Ferric Chloride Solution, Open-File Report Kosaka, K., Yamada H., Matsui S., Echigo S.,
81-609. http://download.egi.utah.edu/ Shishida K., 1998. A Comparison among the
geothermal/GL00457/GL00457.pdf Methods for Hydrogen Peroxide
Huang, G., and Grano, S., 2005. Galvanic Measurements To Evaluate Advanced
interaction of grinding media with pyrite Oxidation Processes: Application of a
and its effec t on flotation.Minerals Spec trophotometric Method Using
Engineering, 18, 1152-1163. Copper(II) Ion and 2,9-Dimethyl-1,10-
Ikumapayi, F., Sis, H., Johansson, B., phenanthroline, Environ. Sci. Technol., 32,
Hanumantha Rao K.,2012.Rec yc ling 3821-3824.
process water in sulfide flotation, Part B: Mehta, A.P., Murr, L.E., 1983. Fundamental
Effec t of H 2 O 2 and proc ess water studies of the contribution of galvanic
components on sphalerite flotation from interaction to acid-bacterial leaching of
complex sulfide J. Miner. Metall. Process. mixed metal sulfides. Hydrometallurgy 9,
29(4) 192–198. 235–256.
Jones, G., van Hille, R.P., Harrison, S.T.L., Nazari, G., Dixon D., Dreisinger, D., 2012. The
2012.Reactive oxygen species generated in role of galena associated with silver-
the presence of fine pyrite particles and its enhanc ed pyrite in the kinetic s of
implic ation in thermophilic mineral c halc opyrite leac hing during the
bioleachingAppl. Micrbiol. Biotechnol.doi: Galvanox™ process, Hydrometallurgy,
10.1007/s00253-012-4116-y. 111-112, 35–45.
Jones, G.C., Corin, K.C., van Hille, R.P., Harrison, Ni, Z., Hou, S., Barton, C.H., Vaziri, N.D., 2004.
S.T.L., 2011. The generation of toxic reactive Lead exposure raises superoxide and
oxygen species (ROS) from mechanically hydrogen peroxide in human endothelial
activated sulphide concentrates and its and vascular smooth muscle cells, J.
effec t on thermophilic bioleac hing. Kidney Int. 66(6):2329-2336.
Minerals Engineering 24, 1198"1208.
181
MPT-2013
Rao, S.R., Finch, J.A., 1988. Galvanic interaction minerals from a Proterozoic porphyry
studies on sulfide minerals. Canadian copper deposit, Malanjkhand, India. In
Metallurgical Quarterly 27, 253–259. Applied Mineralogy in Exploration, W.
Sand, W., Gehrke, T., Hallmann, R., Schippers, Petruk, A.H. Vassiliou and D.H. Hausen,
A., 1995. Sulphur chemistry, biofilm, and editors, Ore Geology Reviews 6, 257-290.
the (in)direct attack mechanism Ð acritical Suzuki, I., 2001. Microbial leaching of metals
evaluation of bac terial leac hing. from sulphide minerals, Biotechnology
ApplMicrobiolBiotechnol 43, 961-966. Advances 19, 119-132.
Sand, W., Gehrke, T., Jozsa, P.G., Schippers, A., Thornber, M. R., 1975. Supergene alteration of
1999. Direct versus indirect bioleaching. In: sulfides, I. A chemical model based on
Amils R, Ballester A, editors. massive nic kel sulfide deposits at
Biohydrometallurgy-and-the- Kambalda, Western Australia. Chemical
environment-toward-the-mining-of-the- Geology, 15, 1-14.
21st-century-PT-A-1999, vol. 9. New York: Valko, M., Morris, H., Cronin, M.T.D,
Wiley, 27-49. 2005.Metals,Toxicity and Oxidative Stress,
Sato, M.,1992. Persistency-field Eh-pH diagrams Current Medicinal Chemistry 12,1161-
for sulfides and their applic ation to 1208.
supergene oxidation and enrichment of Woods,R.,1981. Mineral flotation in
sulfide ore bodies. Geochim.Cosmochim. c omprehensive treatise on
Acta 56, 3133-3156. electrochemistry. (Edited by: Bockris, J.
Schippers, A., Sand, W., 1999. Bacterial leaching O.M., Conway, B.E., Yeager, E., White, and
of metal sulphides proceeds by two indirect R.E.) Volume 2, Electrochemical Processing.
mec hanisms via thiosulphate or via (New York: Plenum Press.), pp.571-595.
polysulphides and sulphur. Appl Environ Zhang, Q., Xu, Z., Bozkurt, V., Finch, J.A., 1997.
Microbiol 65, 319-321. Pyrite flotation in the presence of metal
Sikka, D.B., Petruk, W., Nehru, C.E., Zhang, Z. ions and sphalerite, International Journal
1991. Geochemistry of secondary copper of Mineral Processing, 52, 187-201.
*******
182
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Gravity concentration was the only process for the beneficiation of tin ores till 1970s. Later,
introduction of chemical reagents such as sulphosuccinamates, phosphonic acid and arsonic
acid for collection of cassiterite mineral lead to the introduction of flotation. Nowadays, gravity
concentrators and flotation cells became prime beneficiation units in many tin plants in the
world.
Flotation is a physico-chemical process of separation of hydrophobic particles from hydrophilics.
The hydrophobic particles collected at the froth phase whereas the hydrophilic remained in the
pulp. In the present investigation cassiterite sample containing 6.39 % Sn, 59.1 % SiO2, 13.4 %
Al2O3, 5.2 % Fe was collected from Uljin deposit, South Korea. The feed material has been subjected
to X-ray diffraction and analysed that the tin mineral present in the ore is cassiterite, which is
assaying about 7.2 %. The gangue minerals present in the sample are quartz, albite, biotite,
hornblend, and chlorites. Batch flotation experiments were performed on a self-aerated laboratory
Denver flotation machine by varying different types of collectors, collector dosage, slurry pH,
dispersant dosage etc. the results indicate that a product grade of 44-45 % Sn with recovery of 93-
94 % could be recovered at optimized levels of operating parameters.
183
MPT-2013
alloys and scraps. The demand for tin is present in the ore are quartz, albite, biotite,
increasing day-by-day due to increased end hornblend, and chlorites.
uses of the metal. Table 2. X-ray Diffraction analysis of the feed
The cassiterite ore beneficiation flowsheet material
mostly incorporates the combination of gravity
concentrators and flotation cells (Falcon, 1982). Mineral Chemical formula Weight %
The coarse particles would be recovered using Quartz SiO2 37.5
jigs while the fines recovered by spirals, gravity NaAlSi3O8
tables and flotation cells. In the present Albite or 22.1
Na1.0-0.9 Ca0.0-0.1 Al1.0-1.1 Si3.0-2.9 O8
investigation cassiterite ore containing 6.39 %
Biotite K(Mg,Fe)3(AlSi3O10)(F,OH)2 17.7
Sn collected from Uljin deposit, South Korea has
Hornblend Ca2(Mg, Fe, Al)5 (Al, Si)8O22(OH)2 13.6
been subjected for flotation studies to enrich Denver
Cassiterite SnO2 7.2
the tin content.
Chlorite (Fe, Mg, Al)6 (Si, Al)4 O10 (OH)8 1.9
2. Materials and Methods 100
The cassiterite sample collected from Uljin
mine, South Korea for the present research sub-aeration flotation machine was used in the
work. The tin occurrence is a hard rock deposit investigations. The cell capacity of 2 lit was used
along with pegmatite host rocks. As collected in all optimization and rougher flotation
sample was subjected to Jaw crusher followed studies, whereas, cleaning operation has been
by cone crusher to reduce the particle size. carried out in 1.2 lit capacity cell. Different
Hence produced material has been sampled and operating variables and reagents and their
was used for the following characterization levels studied are also summarized in the
studies. succeeding section. Following chemicals are
The chemical analysis of the cassiterite feed used in the investigation.
material is presented in Table 1. It can be AERO-6493
observed from the table that the feed material Cytec’s alkyl hydroxamate-based collector, the
contains about 6.4 % Sn, 59.0% SiO2, 13.4 % Al2O3, AERO® 6493 promoter, is used in the flotation
5.2 % Fe2O3. of a cassiterite ores. It is more selective, easier
Table 1: Chemical analysis of the feed material to use, and provide better yields than
Chemicalconstituents, % commonly used fatty acids, with which they
Sn SiO2 Al2O3 Fe2O3 CaO MgO K2O Na2O TiO2 MnO P2O5 LOI share a similar structure.
6.39 59.06 13.41 5.17 2.72 2.22 2.36 2.0 0.43 0.10 0.20 1.80
184
MPT-2013
to the conditioners. They perform well in a pH Many new reagents have been introduced for
range of 7.0 to 9.0. The optimum pH range for tin flotation over the past four dec ades
oxide mineral flotation is 8.5 to 10.0. These (Bulatovic, 2010). The toxic reagents like arsonic
reagents have frothing characteristics, which acid, phosphonic acid etc are replaced by oleic
c an be regulated through c ontrolled acid, sodium oleate, alkyl phosphoric acid and
manufacturing processes. AERO 6494 promoter hydroxamates. In the present investigations an
produces more froth than AERO 6493 promoter, attempt has been made to study the flotation
and may be preferred where this quality is performance with oleic acid and AERO 6493
desirable. (hydroxamate supplied by Cytec, US).
Oleic Acid
Table 3: Influence of oleic acid and AERO 6493
Oleic acid is a member of carboxylate group of
on flotation of cassiterite
collectors generally used in oxide mineral
Flotation constant parameters
flotation. Oleic acid is an unsaturated fatty acid
d80 particle size : 180 microns
bearing a chemical formula
Feed % solids :5
CH3(CH2)7CH = CH(CH2)7COOH
Dispersant dosage : 150 g/t Sodium silicate,
[molecular weight 282.47]
conditioning time – 5 min
Sodium Silicate
pH : 8.5-9.0
Sodium silicate is widely used in mineral
Collector dosage : 750 g/t, conditioning time
flotation as a depressant of silicate minerals and
– 15 min
dispersant of slimes coating on the valuable
Flotation time : 3 min
mineral particles. It has general formula
Na2SiO3. Recovery of
Collector type Products Wt., % Sn, %
Sn, %
3. Results and Discussion
F 23.5 19.30
Flotation is a physico-chemical process for the AERO - 6493 NF 76.5 0.62 90.5
collected at the froth phase whereas the Oleic Acid NF 75.1 2.25 66.6
operations hydrophobic particles constitute the The influence of AERO-6493 and oleic acid on
valuable minerals that are embodied in the rougher flotation of cassiterite is presented in
froth phase/zone of the flotation cell, hence Table 3. Both the experiments were carried out
resulted forth product is of prime metallurgical in identical operating conditions like particle
concern. size, feed pulp density, pH, reagent quantity etc.
Batch flotation experiments were performed on It can be observed from the table that AERO-
6493 could enrich Sn values to 19.3 with
a self-aerated laboratory Denver flotation recovery of 90.5 %. The oleic acid at similar
mac hine by varying different operating conditions could produce poor grade and
variables. Following sec tions will give recovery (Sreenivas, 2002). In view of this, it
information about the effect of process variables was decided to carry out all the flotation
on cassiterite flotation. experiments with AERO-6493.
Influence of Dispersant Dosage
Influence of collector type (Oleic Acid and
Sodium silicate was used in the investigations
AERO 6493) to disperse the fine particles from the valuable
mineral particles and depress the silicate
185
MPT-2013
Recpvery of Sn, %
70
depicted in Fig. 1. The results presented in the 60
figure shows that increased sodium silicate 50
40
doses increases quality of the product on the
30
other hand reduces the recovery of tin values. 20
Increase in sodium silicate from 0 to 1500 g/t 10
increases dispersion of fine silicates attached 0
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
with the cassiterite particles as a result grade pH
is improving from 28.8 to 34.3 %. Sodium silicate Fig. 2: Influence of pH on cassiterite flotation
is also responsible for depression of silicate (d80 particle size 180 microns; Feed % solids 5;
particles; few un-liberated (cassiterite-silicates) Sodium silicate 500g/t, Collector dosage 2000
particles are depressed as a result recovery of g/t AERO-6493)
tin values is decreasing from 78 to 72 %.
Influence of collector dosage
Influence of collector dosage on the flotation of
79 35
Recovery of Sn, %
78
34
cassiterite can be seen from Fig. 3. Generally,
Sn, %
77
1500-2000 g/t of hydroxamates (AERO-6493)
Recpvery of Sn, %
76 33
75 are used in flotation of oxide minerals. An
Sn, %
32
74
73 31 attempt has been made to estimate optimum
72 30 quantity of AERO-6493 required for the flotation
71
70
29 of cassiterite ore. It can be observed from the
69 28
0 500 1000 1500 2000
figure that increased AERO-6493 dosage from
Sodium silicate dosage, g/t
1400 to 2200 g/t decreases product grade from
39.10 to 13.3 % and subsequently recovery
Fig. 1: Influence of sodium silicate on values are increasing from 73.4 to 88.7 %. Similar
cassiterite flotation (d 80 particle size 180 results are evident from the literature (Trahar,
microns; Feed % solids 5; pH 8 . 5 - 9 . 0 ; 1981).
Collector dosage 2000 g/t AERO-6493) 100 45
90 40
Influence of pH 80 35
Recovery of Sn, %
Pulp pH play very important role in flotation.
Recpvery of Sn, %
70
30
60 Sn, %
The selec tivity of partic ular mineral in
Sn, %
25
50
suspension is dependent on a delicate balance 40
20
15
between reagent concentrations and pH. Most 30
20 10
hydroxamates require alkaline pH for the 10 5
successful adsorption to the mineral phases. 0 0
1200 1400 1600 1800 2000 2200 2400
They are effectinve in the pH range 8.5 to 9.5.
Collector dosage, g/t
Increase pH from 4 to 11 increases recovery of
Fig. 3: Influence of collector dosage on
tin values up to pH 9 thereafter again decreases.
cassiterite flotation (d 80 particle size 180
microns; Feed % solids 5; Sodium silicate 500g/
t, pH 8.6)
186
MPT-2013
*******
187
MPT-2013
188
MPT-2013
189
MPT-2013
190
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Human activities like mining, construction and agriculture contribute markedly to the
contamination of water which is globally jeopardizing the ecosystem. In mining industry, the
tailings generated from the coal preparation plants contain fine solid particles which present
many environmental and economic challenges to the society and industry. This also results in
toxicity problems due to the stable presence of soluble materials which have significant adverse
effect on aquatic life, agriculture, plant and animal. The present study intend to show the settling
characteristics of tailing generated from coal preparation plants using different flocculants, dosing
rate, pH of slurry etc. This will improve the basis for the selection of dewatering equipments such
as thickener and filter for tailing dewatering purpose.
191
MPT-2013
parameters and to find the options for molecular weight polymeric flocculants (Götz,
enhancing the water recovery from the plant Bickert., 2004). The thickener underflow is
tailings. either dewatered further or disposed of.
Disposal is either in fine tailings ponds or
2. Area description together with coarse reject by co-disposal.
2.1 Practices abroad Commonly belt press filters are used if
thickener underflow has to be dewatered
South Africa has large coal reserves, and is one further. Decanter centrifuges are no longer
of the world’s leading producers and exporters common, while membrane filter presses have
of c oal. The c ountry c urrently produc es just been introduced at Dartbrook due to the
approximately 290 Mt of ROM coal per annum, high clay content and the need to achieve
out of which about 14% is believed to be finer consistent dry cakes for co-disposal.
than 500 micron (fine coal) and 2–3% finer than For the United States of America, it is forecasted
100 micron (ultra-fine coal) (Le Roux et al, 2005). that coal will constitute a principal source of
The fines c ontent in the ROM had been energy for the next several decades. A typical
increasing in recent years. Coal producers have coal preparation plant produces about 20
a few options as to what to do with the fines. percent of the mined coal as minus 0.5 mm (28
Initially, fines and ultra-fines were dumped mesh). Generally, this fine fraction is discarded
with the discard streams or tailings ponds, but due to its high cost of processing. One of the
sinc e the value of these fines had been biggest hurdles in utilization of fine coal
recognized, it was either added to the product cleaning technology by the coal industry is the
streams as it is, or alternatively, upgraded and economic dewatering of the fine clean coal
sold. The main reason for not fully exploiting product. Until an economical and practical
this energy source is the high levels of moisture solution to dewatering of fine clean coal is
associated with the fines fraction of coal. achieved, the efforts devoted to developing fine
Efficient removal of this moisture will yield clean coal technology will be wasted (Parekh,
definite benefits in finances and handling of the B. K., 2009).
fine coal, while it will also have a positive
impact on the environment. A 2001 survey of 2.2 Characterization studies of plant tailings
South African coal beneficiation plants showed
Dewatering process is known to depend largely
that of the then 24 operations, some 18 plants
on physico-chemical properties of the coal
employed processes for fine coal beneficiation.
particle surface, and is substantially related to
At seven of these plants, the ultra-fine slurries
the rank, mineral matter, size distribution and
were dewatered using centrifuges or filters.
oxidation of the coal (Rong, and Hitchins, 1995).
With Tao et al. (2000) showing that a 1%
The rate of settling of any given particle
decrease in the final moisture of 3 Mt of clean
depends on its size, its density relative to that
coal can lead to a saving of US$ 300,000. These
of the suspending medium, the viscosity of the
amounts of moisture left in the fines are adding
medium, and the interactive forces between the
up to become a big financial liability.
medium and other suspended particles. The
In Australia, c urrent prac tic e at c oal degree of diffic ulties assoc iated with
preparation plants is to thicken fine coal tailings mechanical dewatering increases as the surface
with high-rate thic keners utilizing high area of the particles increases. Solid
192
MPT-2013
concentrations of slurry also pay a role on aggregation and settling of the much larger
settling behavior. As these increase, the settling aggregates will take place. Hence the aim is to
rate progressively slows and above a critical reduce the repulsive force between the particles
solids concentration known as the gel point, the so that the attractive force will dominate. This
slurry exhibits a network structure and forms will accelerate to make large aggregate of fine
a bed at the base of the vessel. The design solids, so as to be settled at faster rate. Such
considerations of dewatering equipments such process of aggregation of fine particles to make
as thickeners are based on the settling rates of large flocs using chemicals is called flocculation.
the slowest settling particles and conditions for Zeta potential is has significant role in the
minimum disturbance of the medium (water) stability of very fine particles. The zeta potential
through which the solid particles are allowed indicates the degree of repulsion between
to settle ( Gupta and Yan 2006). adjacent, similarly charged particles in a
In the coal preparation plants, the desliming at suspension. For molecules and particles that are
500 micron of the crushed coal produces fine small enough, a high zeta potential will confer
coal slurry which is sent to the fine coal stability, i.e., the partic les will resist
treatment circuit. The size analysis of the aggregation. The stability behavior of a
tailings generated from the fine coal treatment colloidal solution, as reported in literature, can
circuit indicate that the amount of particles be understood from the following value of zeta
which are below 44 micron is in the range of 18 potential mentioned in Table 1.
percent. These ultrafine particles are mostly
Table 1: Stability change with respect to zeta
responsible for the poor performance of the
potential of particles.
solid liquid separation circuit, because it has
been found in the settling jar test that a major Zeta potential [mV] Stability behavior of the colloid
portion of the solid settles without use of any
from 0 to ±5, Rapid coagulation or flocculation
flocculants. The size analysis of the plant tailing
from ±10 to ±30 Incipient instability
particles in slurry was also carried out for those
from ±30 to ±40 Moderate stability
particles which are not settling after 5 minutes,
10 minutes and 15 minutes respectively by from ±40 to ±60 Good stability
using Malvern mastersizer. The result shows more than ±61 Excellent stability
that the particles which remain in suspension
even after considerable amount of time are Most of the aqueous solutions are either neutral
about -10 micron in size. or basic and hence the particles are negatively
charged. To reduce the repulsive force between
2.3 Flocculation and zeta potential two particles due to presence of negative
charges on them it is essentially required to add
The major interac tive forc es between
some elec trolytes whic h have opposite
suspended solids are of two kinds - attractive
(positive) charge to cause charge neutralization.
and repulsive. The attractive forces arise from
Such electrolytes are called coagulants. If the
short-range Vander Waals’ forces, which is
aqueous solution is acidic in nature i.e. particles
c ounter balanced by the repulsive forc e
are positively charged then electrolytes with
between the particles due to the presence of negative charges are to be added.
electrical charge on them. If a repulsive force Coagulants could be either from inorganic or
dominates, particle aggregation cannot occur, organic sources. The commonly used inorganic
whereas, if attrac tive forc es take over,
193
MPT-2013
coagulants used for wastewater treatments are The preliminary settling studies on this plant
alum, ferrous sulphate, ferric chloride. On the tailing slurry were c arried out using
other hand the organic coagulants may be polyacrylamide at very dilute condition. A good
either synthetic of natural flocculants. The settling rate was obtained at floc c ulant
major drawback of inorganic coagulants is the consumption of 16 gpt. The operating condition
huge requirement of coagulant for achieving a
for the settling test are mentioned in Table 2.
effective settling rate causing a huge sludge
Table 2: Operating condition for the settling test.
volume which creates disposal problem. On
Solid concentration : 5% (w/w)
the other hand organic flocculants are highly :
Flocculant added Polyacrylamide
efficient flocculant though both the synthetic PH of slurry : 8.2 (Natural pH of slurry)
and natural ones have some advantages and Flocculant concentration : 0.1% (w/w)
some limitations. Synthetic polymers are Dosing rate, gpt : 16
194
MPT-2013
Raw Coal
3. Conclusion
Fresh Water
Coarse Middling/Tailing
the particles below of 44 micron size contribute
Recycled Water
Dewatering of Clean
Coal Fines Fine Clean Coal
significantly to the separation of solid and
liquid. The zeta potential has its peak value at
Tailing Thickener To Tailing Pond
around 9.2 pH which is close to the natural pH
of the slurry. The settling behavior can be
improved appreciably at neutral pH by the
Figure 3: A schematic illustration of a coal addition of some acidic chemicals such as HCL
preparation plant to the slurry, because at neutral pH the value of
zeta potential is very low in comparison to its
The loss of water results in higher rate of
natural pH value.
makeup water to the plant. So it becomes
essential to improve the efficiency of tailing References
thickener. The tailing received from the fine coal
treatment circuit shows the concentration of Tao, D., Groppo, J.G., Parekh, B.K., 2000.
solid is about 8 percent (weight / weight). This Enhanced ultrafine coal dewatering using
dilute slurry is generally sent to the tailing flocculation filtration processes. Minerals
thickener which produces the final plant Engineering, 13(2), 163-171.
tailings at the solid concentration of about 28 Götz, Bickert., 2004. http://www.acarp.com.au/
percent (weight / weight). In terms of total solid, abstracts.aspx?repId=C14012
about 6-8 percent of run of mine coal is disposed Parekh, B. K., 2009. Dewatering of fine coal and
to tailing dam at very low pulp density as refuse slurries problems and possibilities.
mentioned above. This clearly shows that we Procedia Earth and Planetary Science 1, 621-
have to enhance the performance of solid liquid 626.
separation equipment which is generally a Rong, R.X., Hitchins, J., 1995. Preliminary Study
thickener. of Correlations between Fine Coal
The thickening process, although operated Characteristics and Properties and their
successfully in a large range of sites around the Dewatering behavior. Minerals
world, is poorly understood and predictive Engineering, 8(3), 293-309.
design of thickening equipment is still empirical Gupta, A., Yan, D.S., 2006. Introduction to
(Gupta and Yan 2006). The performance can be Mineral Processing Design and Operation,
enhanced through improved design of the First Edition
circuit along with the correct selection of the Gladman, B.J., Usher, S.P., Scales, P.J., 2006.
flocculants. Understanding of Thickening Process.
Keynote Address, Australian Centre for
Geomechanics, Perth, ISBN 0-9756756-5-6.
*******
195
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Beneficiation of the Run-of-mines is utmost essential because of stringent quality requirements of
the customer. In the process of beneficiation, there is a considerable amount of slime generated,
and needs to be disposed. At Noamundi Iron Mines, the Wet Processing Plant uses a High Rate
Thickener (HRT) as an integral part of its slurry disposal system for maximising the flocculation
efficiency of flocculants used in the slurry disposal system. As a consequence, change in the solids
feed rate or the settling characteristics of the solids will change the sludge level much more
rapidly, therefore, high rate thickeners require someform of automatic control. The control pa-
rameters used to maintain stable operation in high rate thickeners are underflow solids density,
underflow withdrawal rate, flocculants dosage, solids inventory in the tank, solids feed rate, and
mechanical torque limit restriction of rotating rake arm mechanism. In order to improve the
reliability of the HRT, it was important to understand the behaviour of HRT process parameters
with respect to material feed (ROM- Run-of-mines). Strategic parameters were analysed in order
to find out which input parameters affected the nature of slime generated and thereby affect the
process parameters of HRT. Based on the analysis, it is observed that the process parameters of
HRT bear a direct co-relation to the feed rate of the processing plant and the flocculent dosage rate
in the HRT. Thickener overflow at Normandy Processing Plant is recirculated and used as process
water. A very integral role of HRT is in providing greater clarity of overflow water so that
beneficiation process quality is not hampered. On analysis, it is observed that the clarity of water
bears a direct correlation with the dosing rate of flocculent at HRT.
Keywords: High-Rate thickener; run-of-mines; slurry handling system; flocculation.
196
MPT-2013
cut-off grade on the alumina content in ROM 3. Slurry Handling System at Noamundi Wet
combined with physical characteristics such Circuit Plant
as lump yield and strength defines the Dry (high 3.1. Conventional Slurry Handling System
grade) and Wet (low grade) crusher feed. The Clear water
Dry processing plant is quite simple, compris- Slurry
ing crushing and dry screening with no tail- Slurry formed during the beneficiation process
ings. Low grade material is concentrated
in the wet processing plant and jig plant is col-
through primary and secondary crushing fol-
lected in the Annex Pit (Fig. 1). Two negative
lowed by screening and oversize crushing and
re-screening, washing and sizing, scrubbing, suction pumps are operated in parallel to pump
classifying, jigging and passing through this slurry into the distribution tank. The role
hydrocyclone, with overall recovery of ~80%. of the distribution tank is to channel the flow of
In the process of beneficiation slurry generated the slurry into two separate identical thicken-
is disposed into tailing pond by a Slurry Han- ers. Each thickener receives the slurry centrally
dling System. and the slurry is allowed to settle in the thick-
ener. The rake arm of the thickener moves at a
2. Background
very low rpm raking the slime from the sides
The disposition of ore types, like many other
to the centre of the thickener. At the central cone
iron ore deposits across the globe records hard
of each thickener there are three bypass lines
formation at the top with occurrence of ore
which carry the compacted slime into the un-
type e.g. friable and blue dust towards bottom
derflow pump house pit. Two underflow
of the deposit. With time, as the mine pro-
pumps with a capacity of 250 m 3each,pump
gressed deeper into the ore body availability of
slime from the pit into the tailing pond. The
hard ore became limited resulting in lesser
line diagram of the conventional slurry han-
hard ore feed to the Wet Circuit plant with in-
dling system is shown in Fig 1.
crease in friable-soft/lateritic ore proportions
in recent years posing challenges to the plant
operators as the change in feed mix not only
resulted imbalance in lump:fines recovery pat-
tern but also led to increase in slime loss sub-
stantially. The situation became worse with
mine having patches of bluedust/powdery ore
within friable ore, quality of which did not al-
low to process them in dry circuit plant. Ma-
jority of the cases ore types such blue dust and
powdery ore having high content of super-fines
(<100 mesh) in-situ, tend to report to slime
making slurry handing and recovery of Fe-val-
ues further through hydrocylone, more diffi-
cult. Subsequently it was required to relook into
the conventional slurry handling system of the
plant and to make it suitable with change it
feed grade and ore mix.
197
MPT-2013
198
MPT-2013
The Annex Pumps referred to in Section 3.1 The correlation observed between the Bed Mass
pump the slurry collected from the Process- and the Feed Rate (measured in TPH) is given in
ing plant into the HRT via a sky-launder Fig 3(a).
chute (shown in Fig 2). The slime entering
HRT gets mixed with the flocculants dozed
in the Settlement Zone of the HRT. Once the
reaction between the flocculants and the
slime particles is complete, the heavier slime
particles settle into the consolidation zone.
Twosets of three underflow pumps each (one
set in standby; specifications are mentioned
in Table 2) get their suction from the central
cone of the HRT and discharge the slime
formed into the slime dam (also referred to as Fig 3(a) Relation between the Bed Mass and
Tailing Pond). the Feed Rate
199
MPT-2013
Acknowledgement
The authors are thankful to the management of
Tata Steel Limited who have provided us their
complete co-operation and guidance. We are ex-
tremely thankful to the employees of Process-
ing Plant, Noamundi who have contributed
Fig 3(c) Relation between the Bed Level and
significantly to the success of this research. We
the Dosing Rate
are thankful to Mineral Processing Technology
2013 for giving us an opportunity to publish
our field work.
200
MPT-2013
*******
201
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
The demand for iron ore has increased drastically in the last few years and is forecast to remain on
a stable high production level for years to come. It is expected that the existing and known high
grade ore resources will decline, and the iron ore industry will be forced to implement more and
more advanced beneficiation plants in which filtration is one of the important stages. The filtration
of fine particles derived from iron ore processing is a topic of increasing importance to mineral
industries. With little previous published work in this area, it is difficult to predict how these
materials will behave during filtration, in particular during vacuum filtration. Conventional
vacuum filtration methods have been the most prevalent in fine iron ore dewatering. This paper
describes effects of different parameters (pulp density of the slurry, particle size distribution of the
feed, rotation of ceramic disc and Basin number) on filtration process. Performance of advanced
filtration technology (Ceramic Disc Filtration) for iron ore applications have been studied, and the
findings are based on day to day plant operation data and laboratory reports.
202
MPT-2013
With high-grade Iron ore rapidly depleting, the and the residual moisture of the filter cake is
necessity of Iron ore beneficiation is becoming a higher than that obtained with pressure filters.
reality. Beneficiation of Iron ore is much more
Pressure filters in turn are preferred when the
economical than getting rid of gangue at higher
product must be kept in a closed system for
end of value chain like in BF or BOF / Electric
safety reasons, or if the residual moisture
furnace. It is believed that it will cost 5 to 10
content is important. The handling of the filter
times more to remove gangue in BF / BOF or
cake is obviously more difficult in a pressure
Electric arc furnace than in beneficiation plant.
filters. Filtration by centrifugal force requires
In order to beneficiate, the Iron ore is needed to
more expensive technical equipment, but as a
be crushed to the liberation size to maximize
general rule it yields solids with lower residual
the benefits from the process. Typically Iron ore
moisture
is liberated when the ore is ground to sub micron
size. Apart from the operating functions of the
filtration system, the speed of filtration depend
Up-gradation of lower grade ores/fines
on many factors of the slurry being filtered viz.
necessitates beneficiation for making of sinter
amount of ultra fines, slime content like kaolinite
and pellet. Any iron ore beneficiation process
especially alumina content etc.
primarily is governed by grinding, gravity
separation, and filtration processes. The present investigation deals with the
investigations carried out on high grade iron
The purpose of filtration is either clarification
ore samples for filtration by ceramic filter. The
of liquids or solids recovery. In clarification the
results obtained from the experiments were
liquid is typically the valuable product and the
compared and presented in this paper.
solids are of minor quantity and are often
discarded with out any further treatment. If 2. Results and Discussion
however the solids are to be recovered, they very Nowadays pellets are frequently used as raw
often have to be washed, deliquored and dried. materials for iron making. The parameters
In this article, washing means the cleaning of needed for proper pellet making needs to be
the product (filter cake) and is distinguished identified and studied for optimum productivity
from cleaning parts of the filter itself, which will and desired quality. The important part of
be called rinsing (like rinsing a filter screen/filter pelletization is green ball formation, and the
disc or a filter cloth by jets of water). formation of green ball is interrelated with
The filter cake thus obtained need to have various parameters viz. properties of filter cake,
optimum moisture content for proper green ball types of additives, inclination and RPM of
formation and needs to be dewatered. balling disc, water addition for maintaining
Generally, the term drying means thermal proper moisture etc. The properties of filter cake
drying, but the elimination of liquid from the for perfect ball formation have been discussed.
filter cake by mechanical forces is called
Major properties of filter cake of iron oxide for
deliquoring or dewatering. Filtration is effected
proper green ball formation for subsequent
by application of capillary, vacuum, pressure,
pellet formation are:
or centrifugal force.
1. Moisture %
Vacuum filters have the great advantage that 2. % of -10µ (slimes)
the cake is freely accessible. This facilitates 3. % of -45µ
automatic cake handling. However, vacuum 4. % of +150 (coarser grinding)
filters cannot handle hot liquids, or solvents 5. Blaine Number
with high vapor pressure. Also, the pressure
difference across vacuum filters is very limited,
203
MPT-2013
The table below shows the physical & chemical and higher -10 micron will give satisfactory
parameter of filter cake & its range for getting Blaine number which will still be problematic
the best quality green ball. for settling and filtration and would have bad
balling characteristics. Determination of Particle
Table 1: OMML Filter cake specification
Size Analysis (PSA) along with Blaine number
will actually represent the grinding and the
Chemical& Physical properties
suitability of the filter cake for the filter cake
Parameter Range produced.
Fe( Total ) 62.80 – 63.50 % It is observed that as we increase the Blaine of
SiO2 3.00 – 4.00 % filter cake the moisture in filter cake also
increaseswhichisshowninFigure-2
Al2O3 1.90 - 2.50 %
LOI 2.70 - 3.50 %
+150 µ 5.00 % max.
-10 µ 20 – 25%
-45 µ 60 to 65%
Moisture 9.0 – 10.0%
Blaine Number (cm2/gm) 1800 – 2200
204
MPT-2013
micron particle did not exceed 60 percent. Drop 2.2. Coarse grinding
number as shown in Figure 4 depicts similar
The coarse grinding will lead to ease of filtration
trend.
and decrease in moisture content but will
adversely affect the balling behaviour. The plot
below (Figure 6) shows the variation of
moisture with increasing +150 micron size
fraction present in the filter cake:
205
MPT-2013
206
MPT-2013
Figure 11 illustrates that as the solid moisture cake but at the same time the GCS
concentration increases the moisture content of of green ball decreases which results in poor
the filter cake also increases. This shows that CCS. Hence, for the good ball the +150µ
increasing the solid percent the moisture and should be less than 3%.
filter capacity will move in opposite direction. C. High dosage of Flocculants will result in poor
Thus needs to optimised in such a way that the quality of filter cake i.e. when used to make
productivity increases but the moisture content pellets, the green pellets become plastic in
is within a controllable value. nature thus rather than breaking they tend
to change their shape.
D. Increase in moisture in filter cake leads to
formation of uneven ball with low GCS
leading to low CCS. So for proper balling the
moisture should be in the range of 8-10 %.
Table 2 indicates the optimized parameters
to be achieved for better balling.
Table 2. Parameters and their Optimum points
Figure 11: Moisture of filter cake with solid Sl. No. Parameters Optimum Point
concentration 1 Blaine Number and Grind (-45 Micron %) 2000 cm2/gm & 60-65%
2 Coarse Grinding (+150 Micron %) Should be <5%
3. Conclusions 3 Flocculant 5gm/ton ()
4 Filter cake moisture 9-10%
From the above experimental data & analysis it
5 Filter feed density 60% (w/w)
can be concluded that the filtration process is
affected by so many factors and getting all the
parameter in one plane is a difficult task but by Acknowledgement
controlling major factors we can achieve our The authors gratefully acknowledge the help,
desirable result in industry. Since our aim is the encouragement, guidance received from Mr.
formation of metallurgical grade pellet which Manoj Agarwal, MD, Adhunik Group of
can be achieved by proper proportioning of raw Industries for the paper.
material (i.e. filter cake, lime, bentonite & coke).
References
To understand the effect all the parameters of
http://ibm.nic.in/ch4.pdf
filter cake viz. the Blaine number (degree of
fineness), Presence of +150µ, Moisture, and Pulp htt p://www.im-m ining. c om/wp -c ontent/
Density on green ball formation were studied themes/immining/pdfs/Larox DewateringTech-
and the following conclusions are drawn from 20100615.pdf
the test results:
h t t p : / / w w w. i n d i a s t e e l e x p o . i n /
A. Increasing the Blaine Number of cake the IndustryOverview.php
moisture content increases. This is due to
Laboratory procedures to measure green pellets
generation of ultrafine during grinding. Thus,
and fired pellets properties by “pellet plant lab
to maintain optimum moisture the Blaine no.
procedure manual”.
should be around 2000.
B. On increasing the fraction of +150µ the OMML Laboratories Report.
moisture decreases and we get optimized
*******
207
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
At Tata Steel Washery, fine clean coal from froth flotation cell is usually dewatered in screen bowl
centrifuge. The tailings of froth flotation process is taken to thickener for concentrating the slurry
suspension as well as to recover clarified water for re-use in the plant. One of the limitations of the
centrifuge is the loss of ultrafine coal as centrifuge centrate. This complete dewatering process
needs to be improved by developing suitable technique for preventing the escape of carbon values
into the tailings pond with the application of reagents.
Due to presence of high amount of ultra-fine coal (0.038 mm) in feed to flotation circuit, dewatering
process is not working well at Tata Steel washery. Different reagents are tried in laboratory to
reduce moisture content of fine clean coal. Among these reagents surfactants are found superior in
reducing moisture content of fine clean coal compared to application coagulant and flocculant. It is
observed that there is a potential in reducing moisture content of fine clean coal by about 23% from
current moisture level observed in the plant at moderate dosage of 0.25 kg/t. Coagulant application
is found to be more effective in vacuum filtration though at higher dosage of 0.5 kg/t with reduction
in moisture content of about 17% from base level. Moisture content of fine clean coal was reduced
by 15.3% from base level by application of another surfactant at low dosage of 0.1 kg/t.
208
MPT-2013
Froth coming out of froth flotation cell is treated Both in centrifuge and filtration, cake bed is
in screen bowl centrifuge to reduce its moisture formed which imparts resistance to the passage
content. Tailings from froth flotation cell is of water. The cake bed can be considered as
treated in thickener for recovering clear process complete packed bed with parallel capillaries
water for reuse in the washery and to settle which vary in size. Moisture in small pores is
agglomerated coal particles with the addition difficult to remove due to high capillary
of flocculant, before final dewatering in high pressure as determined by the Laplace equation.
frequency screens. Dewatering of froth as well (Tao et al, 1999) estimated that, for coal with a
as flocculation of tailings is not efficient in the contact angle of 600, a vacuum of 25 in. Hg or 85
washery. Moisture content of dewatered froth KPa will be unable to remove the capillary
is around 24% whereas clarified water coming water from pores smaller than 0.87 µm (Tao et
out from the overflow launder of thickener al, 1999).It was reported in the literature that a
contains high ppm of suspended solids. Due to linear relationship exist between cake moisture
flooding condition at the entry part of screen and the average feed particle size with solid and
bowl centrifuge, coal slurry with very fine coal screen bowl centrifuges (Sargent et al, 1979)
particles (<0.038 mm) overflows into the effluent another factor, which affects both fine and
pond. This stream is called centrifuge centrate coarse particles, is the size distribution of pores
and it accounts for considerable loss of low ash in a packed bed (Hogg, 1995). Within a packed
coal particles into tailings. Sometimes, this low bed is where surface properties such as contact
ash material also get mixed with the feed to angle and surface tension affect dewatering. The
flotation cell which results in increase of size distribution of the pores in a packed bed is
consumption of reagents as well as reduction of directly related to the size distribution of
throughput to the cell. particles within the feed.
Fig. 1 shows a schematic diagram of fine coal Vacuum filtration is one of the dewatering
dewatering circuit of the washery. As explained processes widely used in the coal industry. It
above, the performanc e of the fine c oal has some substantial advantages, e.g., low cost
dewatering circuit is not entirely satisfactory. and easy to design and maintain, over
An effort is therefore, essential to investigate the hyperbaric filtration and centrifugal filtration
causes of the poor performance of the fine coal (Parkh et al, 1988). The most significant
dewatering process and to find out the ways advantage is that of continuous operation under
for improving the recovery of clean coal from relatively simple mechanical conditions.
the fines. The major concerned area is to reduce Continuous vac uum filter mac hines,
the fine clean coal moisture. particularly rotary drum filters and rotary disc
filters, have long proved themselves to be
Fine clean coal from screen bowl centrifuge
capable of producing satisfactory performance
generally contains about 24% moisture. The
in various commercial applications.
high moisture content in the coal reduces its
heating value, creates shipping and handling Efforts for enhanced fine coal dewatering were
problems, increases transportation cost, and presently focused on using chemical reagents
reduces the input and coke yield of metallurgical to alter coal surface characteristics and slurry
charges. The effective dewatering of fine and rheology for favorable dewatering conditions.
ultrafine coal is bec oming inc reasingly It has been demonstrated that enhanced fine
important for the coal industry. Even relatively coal dewatering can be achieved by a number
modest reductions in product moisture will lead of different approaches such as the use of
to large financial savings in an output of flocc ulants and surfactants (Palmes and
hundreds of millions of tons per year. Laskowski, 1993). This has also been
demonstrated in another research work for
209
MPT-2013
ultra-fine coal dewatering (Groppo and Parekh, filtration tests were performed with filter cloth
1996).The same trend also found in works of as medium. Some of the tests were also
Tata Steel professionals (Banerjee et al, 1998 and conducted with the froth generated in the
Mukherjee et al 2003). Flocculants have been laboratory froth flotation cell to control the pulp
used in vacuum filtration to decrease the density (PD) of the feed. The PD of fine clean coal
was varied between 15 and 20%. Moisture in
moisture of the product cake. This has been tried
the clean coal before and after centrifuging as
in centrifuges with minimal results, due to the well as filtration was determined as per the
weakness of the long polymer chain present in standard procedure.
flocculants and the strong forces occurring in a
centrifuge (Mishra, 1988). These strong forces 3. Results and Discussion
break apart flocculants before they can aid in 3.1. Assessment of Present condition of
dewatering. Even though flocculants cannot be Dewatering of fine clean coal
effectively used in centrifuges, fuel oil has been
well known to aid in dewatering which lowers The plant moisture data have been collected
interfacial tension results in lower pressure from washery of West Bokaro periodically. The
differences needed to dewater. Surfactants and salient points of fine clean coal moisture content
coagulant can also be used for dewatering of and froth flotation cell load are summarized
coal fines in centrifuge. Different combination below
of reagents can also be used for reduction of · Moisture content of clean coal fines primarily
moisture of fine as well as ultrafine coal in varies between 21-26%. Sometimes it went
filtration. beyond this range.
Coagulants are electrolytes having an opposite · Fines (-0.5 mm fraction) treated in West
charge to the particle thus causing charge Bokaro vary around 20% of ROM. Sometimes
neutralization, when dispersed in the system this fraction went up to 25%.
and overcoming their resistance to approach 3.2. Laboratory dewatering tests with froth
each other and form large aggregate upto 1mm samples of washery
in size. Alum (Aluminium sulphate), ferric salt,
lime and sulfuric acid are commonly used The granulometry of fine clean coal samples was
coagulants. Flocculants are high molecular given in Table 2. It was observed that mean size
weight, water soluble, long chain organic distribution of the coal is about 0.05 mm. High
polymers known as polyacrylamides and are ultrafine fraction present in froth was actually
very effective in producing large, rapidly settling responsible for poor dewatering characteristics
flocs upto 1mm size. of this coal.
2. Experimentation 3.2.1. Tests with coal fines in centrifuge
The froth samples were collected from washery The preliminary test was conducted with
of West Bokaro. The slurry contains about 12- flocculant F1 in lab centrifuge at 15 % PD. Table
15% solids. The granulometry tests were 3 showed the moisture retention by fine coal
conducted with these samples. In dewatering after centrifuging in presence of this reagent. For
study, a batch centrifuge, simulating the plant making comparison to the same base level, tests
centrifuge, was used for experimentations.
Different flocculants (F), surfactants (S) and were also c onduc ted without using any
coagulant (C) were studied for reduction of fine flocculants. It was observed that with increase
clean coal moisture as given in Table No.1. The in this flocculant addition, moisture retention
reagents used in this study were procured from in solids increases. This increase in moisture can
suppliers M/s. Daiichi Chemicals, M/s. Suyog be attributed to the entrapped moisture within
Chemicals, M/s SNF India Pvt. Ltd., M/s. Nalco the flocs formed due to addition of flocculant.
Chemicals, M/s Tel Labs Chemicals. To study the This entrapped moisture could not be taken out
filtration performance of fine clean coal, vacuum
210
MPT-2013
by centrifuging and this resulted in increase in also tried out to enhance dewatering process of
moisture of fine coal. coal. In this context, dewatering tests were
conducted without any reagent addition to
Tests with surfactants and coagulant were also
assess filtration behaviour of fine clean coal
carried out in batch centrifuge as shown in Table
under vacuum condition with laboratory
4. The surfactants S2, S3, S4 and C had shown
Buchner funnel fitted with filter cloth. The
reduction in fine clean coal moisture while the
performance of this blank test was compared
reagent S1 had shown negative impact on
with tests at various dosage of dewatering aids
moisture reduction of fine coal. Out of these
(flocculant, coagulant and surfactant). The
surfactants tried in the laboratory, S2is found
results of vacuum filtration at 15% PD are
to be most effective on fine coal moisture
summarized in Table 6. Flocculant behaved in
reduction. The reduction in moisture content
the same way as that observed in batc h
was found to be about 23% for S2 at dosage of
centrifuge tests. Encouraging results were
0.25 kg/t. The required higher dosage of
observed at high dosage of 0.5 kg/t for
surfactant for fines was attributed for the higher
c oagulantC. Dewatering process is also
surface area of coal particles, (since the material
enhanced with surfactant addition also. The
was finer and c ontribution of -0.038 mm
results indic ated about 15.3% moisture
fraction was about 43%), where surfactants
reduction from base level at low dosage of 0.1
primarily adsorbed on the surface of the coal
kg/t of surfactant S4. This may be caused by
particles and drained out the surface adsorbed
formation of smaller agglomeration of coal fines
moisture and pore moisture.
as compared to that produced with flocculants.
Another set of tests were performed with These agglomerations, due to their smaller size
surfactants S2, S4 and coagulantC at higher and characteristics did not entrap much
density of froth (20% PD) to study the effect of moisture.
pulp density of froth on dewatering process. For
4. Conclusions
making comparison to the same base level, tests
were also c onduc ted without using any Among the various reagents tried for
reagents. It was observed that the moisture dewatering of fine coal slurry, the
content of dewatered cake in batch centrifuge surfactantS2was found to be best among the
was 21.8% which was lower than that obtained dewatering aids tried for reduction of moisture
in tests with PD of 15%. The results were in centrifuge. The reduction of moisture was
summarized in Table 5. It was observed that found to be good with lowering of moisture by
effectiveness of the reagents was reduced at 23% from the present level of moisture of fine
higher concentration of solid in froth. It was clean coal (24%). Flocculants and coagulant were
found that the moisture content reduced by 13% not found effective in reducing the moisture level
from the base level of 21.8% for surfactant S4. in centrifuge.
As the tests with batch centrifuge did not yield As centrifuge is not effective in retaining low
expected results, filtration tests with coal fines ash containing ultra-fine coal, vacuum filtration
from both the washeries were explored under is tried for enhancing dewatering process of fine
vacuum condition. The tests were performed at coal. In vacuum filtration, coagulant C was
vacuum condition to obtain faster kinetics in a found to be most efficient among different
generally slow filtration process. dewatering aids used. However to achieve this
reduction in fine coal moisture, consumption of
3.2.2. Tests with coal fines in vacuum
coagulant C will be higher at 0.5 kg/t. Whereas,
filtration
almost same reduction in moisture is observed
Since centrifuge is not effective is arresting for surfactant S4 at a relatively lower dosage of
escape of ultra-fine coal particles, filtration is
211
MPT-2013
0.1 kg/t. The maximum reduction in moisture Ultrafine Clean Coal, Coal Preparation, 17,
was found to be 16.8 % for C and 15.2% for S4. 61.
Banerjee, P.K., Chakraborty, D.S., Choudhury,
The findings of the laboratory experimentations
B.R., Rao P.V.T., 1998. Reduction in Moistureof
tried at plant level in a planned manner and
Composite Clean Coal of West Bokaro and
shown encouraging results. The potential of the
Jharia, Report No. R&D-RAP-003/96-01-14/
above mentioned reagents will help to enhance
98, R&D Division, Tata Steel.
the current dewatering practices employed in
Mukherjee, A.K., Banerjee, P.K., Bhatnagar, A.K.,
West Bokaro washery and composite clean coal
Dutta, A., Prasad, S., 2003. Strategy to
with lower moisture content from the current
Improve Fine Clean Coal Yield at West
level could be produced in a continuous basis.
Bokaro, Tata Search, 57.
Acknowledgements Mishra, S.K., 1988. Princ iples of
The authors are thankful to Tata Steel Dewatering,Industrial Practice of Fine Coal
Management and R&D support staff for their Processing: Proceedings of the Conference at
active involvement for carrying out the plant Hidden Valley, Somerset, Pa, Klimpel and
trials and laboratory studies. Luckie, pp. 213.
212
MPT-2013
Table 4: Tests with Surfactants and coagulants Table 6: Tests with different reagents at various
for coal fines at PD 15% in batch centrifuge dosages with coal fines at 15% PD in Vacuum
filtration
Sl. No. Dosage, kg/t Moisture content
in fines, %
Sl. No. Reagent Dose, kg/t Moisture, Reduction
With S1 added % in
moisture,
1 0 24.2 %
2 0.0625 27.6
1 Blank - 23.1 -
3 0.125 28.2
4 0.250 28.2 4 C 0.06 22.3 3.5
5 0.500 29.5 5 -do- 0.35 21.7 6.1
With S2
6 -do- 0.50 19.2 16.8
6 0.0625 19.3 7 S3 0.05 22.1 4.3
7 0.125 18.6
8 -do- 0.1 21.6 6.5
8 0.250 18.6
9 0.500 19.9 9 -do- 0.3 21.3 7.8
With S3
10 S3 0.05 22.2 3.9
10 0.0625 21.9
11 -do- 0.10 21.8 5.6
11 0.125 20.5 12 -do- 0.3 21.4 7.4
12 0.25 21.1
13 S4 0.050 21.4 7.4
13 0.5 21.2
With S4 14 -do- 0.1 19.6 15.2
15 -do- 0.50 19.6 15.2
14 0.125 20.9
15 0.25 20.5
Fine clean coal
16 0.5 19.8
With C
Froth Screen
Bowl
Centrifuge
17 0.125 22.4
Centrate
18 0.250 21.4
Thickener
19 0.50 20.8 Flotation feed
Flotation
Cle a r wa te r
Overflow (Re circula te d in
Table 5: Tests with Surfactants and Coagulants Tailings
pla nt)
High
Underflow frequency Ta ilings
Sl. No. Dosage, kg/t Moisture content screen
in fines, %
With S2
Fig. 1: Generalized flow diagram of fine coal
1 0 21.8 dewatering circuit
2 0.0375 20.9
3 0.0625 19.5
4 0.125 19.8
5 0.250 18.9
6 0.500 20.0
With S4
7 0.0375 20.8
8 0.0625 20.4
9 0.125 20.1
10 0.250 19.4
11 0.500 19.8
With C
12 0.125 20.7
13 0.250 20.2
14 0.500 20.6
213
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
The Indian non-coking coal deposits are characterized as high ash and difficult-to-wash. Quality
improvement by beneficiation is almost mandatory due to MoEF notification to use < 34% ash coal
for all power plants except those located at pithead. With the ambitious target of adding another
2,00,000 MW of power generation by the year 2017 in India the demand for coal is bound to grow
and washing capacity is to be increased. The coal washeries will require to handle about 25 to 30
mt of coal fine (– 0.5mm). Waste waters produced from coal preparation plants contain high
percentages of ultrafine particles and inorganic impurities, which are composed of clay minerals
such as kaolinite, illite, muscovite, quartz, and coal particles. The natural sedimentation rate of
these particles present in colloidal and finely divided suspended form is very slow. To enhance the
settling rate a few flocculants were applied to a Non – Coking coal collected from an operating coal
washery. The main objective of clarification is to obtain clear water with a low turbidity value. It
is important to produce good quality recirculation water for the smooth operation of the plant;
otherwise the presence of suspended and dissolved solids in the wastewater can lead to a reduction
in the efficiency of the washing process. The paper discusses the details of studies and its observation
on the settling behavior of non-coking coal fines suspension by using different commercial
flocculants.
Keywords: Coal fines; thermal coal; sedimentation; flocculation.
214
MPT-2013
The coal fines are usually fed to thickeners to Table 1: size analysis data of all the coal fines
recover the water and depending upon the ash with determined ash and moisture
content of these fines, they are either mixed with
JSW -1 JSW -2 Washery ‘J’ Washery ‘K’
the clean coal or sent as rejects. The heavy and
large particles of effluent are allowed to settle Size μm
Wt
%
M
%
Ash
%
Wt
%
M
%
Ash
%
Wt
%
M
%
Ash
%
Wt
%
M
%
Ash
%
automatically, but the fine and c olloidal 500-250 45.8 1.7 34.8 48.4 1.7 33.5 44.7 3.6 56.5 21.9 1.6 52.0
250-125 21.8 1.4 33.2 19.3 1.7 33.0 15.2 3.9 51.0 37.0 1.3 38.9
particles remain suspended due to high surface 125-63 12.0 1.4 34.1 9.7 1.8 32.7 6.1 3.8 51.3 5.0 1.5 44.2
area to mass ratio and electrical charge between -63 20.4 1.4 41.4 22.6 1.8 42.5 34.0 3.0 67.6 36.1 1.8 51.5
related parameters in the process of settling. An 1 SUPERFLOC16 (off white granular solid) Cytec Industries Inc, USA
attempted was made to understand the settling
LABUFLOCC 300 (off white granular B.K. Giulini Gmbh,Giulini
behavior of thermal coal fines suspension using 2 solid) Str.2
industrial polymers. LABUFLOC N 036 (off white granular B.K. Giulini Gmbh,Giulini
3 solid) Str.2
2. Experimental
4 LABUFLOC C 301(off white granular
solid)
B.K. Giulini
Str.2
Gmbh,Giulini
215
MPT-2013
The experiment on sedimentation/ Flocculation The contact angles of the sample were studies
study was also carried out using the DCAT 11 to know the hydrophobicity of the coal fines
instruments with an attac hment of a (Arnold, B J, and Aplan, F F, 1989; Singh, K M P,
sedimentation cone. The whole experiments Udayabhanu, G, Gouri Charan, T and Haldar D
were carried out at 5 % solid concentration of D, 20; Singh, K M P, Udayabhanu, G and Gouri
coal sample. The repeatability of the experiment Charan, T; 2013). It was determined by powder
was assured for every test run. method using the instrument DCAT-11 and
noted that the coal is very hard to float rather
3. Result and Discussion
not to float. It was in the order of ‘K’ > ‘JSWA’ ³
The wet screen analysis reflect that the ‘JSWB’ > ‘J’.
laboratory crushed coal and the coal under
Petrography reflectance ‘Ro’ value is in the order
actual plant run condition -63 ìm size particle
of; ‘K’ > ‘JSW-1’³ ‘JSW-2’ > ‘J’
varies significantly as depicted in the Table 1.
The coal slurry even at 5% of solid contain is
The ash and moisture analysis of the
very difficult to study the sedimentation rate
representative coal slurry sample confirms that
without using any floc culent under
the coal fines are non-coking, medium coking
c onventional jar test method. The
coal and c oking in nature it was further
sedimentation studies with & without
confirmed by pertographic reflectance.
flocculent were carried out using DCAT-11 this
It may be seen from the size analysis data as inc lude c ontact angle determination.
presented in Table 1, that 34.0 % is of – 240 mesh Repeatability of the experimental results
size for both the washery slurry and about 20 confirmed in all the cases (Singh et all 2013 in
percent is for the laboratory crushed coal press).
sample. For both the laboratory crushed coal
Coal is a multi-c omponent system, the
the ash of the below – 0.5 mm is about 35 percent
associated gangue (clay, mineral matter, etc.) and
while ash of the two washery varies from 46.7
the nature of exposed outer coal surface varying
to 59.1 percent.
extensively. The polymeric flocculent were used
Figures 1: XRD Graphs of -0.5 mm coal sample the coal A & B ‘JSW-1’ & ‘JSW-2’ from laboratory
crushed and the two coal C & D, ‘J’ & ‘K’ from coal washery
216
MPT-2013
for faster settling rate to recover the coal slurry present in the coal. The ICP analysis data revels
and recirculation water in the coal washing that all though the two laboratory crushed coal
plant. having almost similar ash contain but differ
significantly in minerals containing Al, Na and
The XRD analysis suggests that the minerals
Ba as recorded higher for JSW-1 with respect to
present in the coal fines are almost in similar
JSW-2.
phase but differ in percentage for the laboratory
crushed coal while the two coal washery slurry The coal washery slurry fines ‘J’ having higher
sample the phase and percentage also differ. The elemental concentration of Al, Mn, Na, Pb and
figures 1 (A, B, C & D) of the XRD of coal slurry Zn for all the tested coal minerals, while the Fe
sample are as below: Ca and Mg is recorded higher for the washery
Table 3: ICP result of the – 500 µm for all the coal ‘K’. This may also be observed in the XRD
four coal fines (concentrations in ppm). graphs for the coal fines which have altered the
sedimentation behavior markably.
Where, BDL= below detection limit
The figure. 2 shows the sedimentation results of
Wt % J JSW A JSW B K
coal slurry at 5 % solid concentration recorded
AI 20.275 13.243 12.351 14.684
Fe 6.653 6.101 6.444 9.764
through instrument for two laboratory crushed
As BDL BDL BDL BDL
coal size -500 µm. Initially the larger size heavier
Ba 0.071 0.133 0.118 0.085 particle settles faster than the colloidal particle
Ca 0.233 0.452 0.445 0.652 without using any flocculent. The anionic floc
Cd 0.0004 0.0002 0.0003 0.0004
at 20 gm/t of dosages, there is about only 3-4
Co 0.005 0.004 0.004 0.005
Cr 0.023 0.017 0.016 0.022
times increase in settling rate for the coal larger
Cu 0.011 0.01 0.009 0.013 size particle, but for the colloidal particle the
K 1.313 1.546 1.835 1.604 increase in sedimentation rate recorded to about
Li 0.010 0.005 0.005 0.005 15 times of the natural sedimentation rate.
Mg 0.469 0.376 0.424 0.542
Mn 0.152 0.081 0.116 0.118 Further in Figure 3 at similar solid concentration
Na 0.211 0.135 0.096 0.194 of coal slurry but higher presentation of colloidal
Ni 0.005 0.005 0.005 0.008
particle settle slower and for complete settling
Pb 0.034 0.016 0.016 0.017
Sr 0.008 0.019 0.015 0.021
takes longer time with respect to the laboratory
Zn 0.076 0.028 0.027 0.025 crushed coal.
The mineral present in the coal slurry sample Retarded flocculation/ sedimentation were also
were studied by Inductively Coupled Plasma- observed in some cases, even from the normal
Optical Emission System (ICP – OES), model sedimentation rate, i.e. having negative effect on
ICAP-6300 Duo of M/S Thermo Fisher Scientific. the sedimentation rate during the experiment.
The samples for ICP analysis were prepared
followed by the ASTM standard (D6357)
Standard Test Methods for Determination of
Trace Elements in Coal, Coke, and Combustion
Residues from Coal Utilization Processes by
Inductively Coupled Plasma Atomic Emission
Spectrometry, Inductively Coupled Plasma
Mass Spectrometry, and Graphite Furnace
Atomic Absorption Spectrometry. Figure 2: Natural Sedimentation behavior of -
.5 mm two laboratory crushed coal fines at 5
The instrument ICAP-6300 Duo of M/S Thermo percent of slurry solid concentration (without
Fisher Scientific used to determine minerals any flocculent)
217
MPT-2013
218
MPT-2013
Arnold, B.J., Aplan, F.F., 1989. The Singh, K.M.P., Udayabhanu, G., Gouri Charan,
hydrophobicity of coal macerals. Fuel, 68, T., 2013. Sedimentation Studies on an Indian
651-658. Singh, K.M.P., Udayabhanu, G., Non-Coking Coal Washery Fines; XVII ICPC
Gouri Charan, T., Haldar, D D., 2011. Settling 01-06 Oct, 2013, Istanbul, Turkey.
Characteristic of Indian Non-Coking Coal Singh, K.M.P., Udayabhanu, G., Gouri Charan,
fines of Different Size Fraction Using Various T., Comparative Studies on the settling
Flocculent;, XII International Seminar on behavior of Indian non-coking coal fines by
Mineral Processing Technology, 20-22 standard Jar test and Instrument,
November MPT-2011, Udaipur; CP10. International Journal of Coal Preparation
and Utilization, in press. DOI:10.1080/
19392699.2013.853663
*******
219
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
The technology to ‘engineer mining waste’ is now available. As we are very much aware there are
many burning issues now in India related to the Mining Industry - such as land availability for
surface storage of the waste, environmental and social impacts, health and safety demands,
utilization of mine waste products, backfill with adequate strength to restrict surface subsidence
and to improve productivity etc. A solution for sustainable development of mining in India calls
for Paste and Thickened Tailings Technology.
This paper examines the importance and positive impact the development of Paste and Thick-
ened Tailings technology has brought to the worldwide mining industry. It examines the technol-
ogy and via examples also presents the challenges, broad environmentalbenefits it can bring and
finally, lists some recommendations. The technology enables maximum water recycling, limits
fresh water usage, requires smaller surface footprints for waste storage, reduces risks of dam
failures, reduces likelihood of seepage from waste facilities, ensures faster reclamation etc. The
major recommendation for sustainable development in mining is to maximize the return of
tailings underground as paste backfill and for the rest -the elimination or conversion of tradi-
tional tailings dams and opting for thickened tailings disposal facilities. Reclamation can and
should then occur concurrently with the tailings placement. Similarly, Paste / Thickened Tailings
Technology enables remote filling of abandoned and working underground mines or naturally
occurring voids below surface in order to mitigate the risk of collapse or neutralize subsidence
issues. The advantages include direct and indirect benefits to the mining operation which create
opportunities to improve key aspects such as stope cycle time, production scheduling, water
consumption and re-handling, mine environment and many other factors.
This paper intends to describe the properties of an “engineered waste” and illustrate some of the
environmental and economic benefits of using paste thickened tailings technology. The objective
of this paper is to introduce the concept and disposal of mine waste in the form of paste or
thickened tailings to outline the potential improvements to underground mining and surface
mineral waste management.
1. Introduction India. This paper presents some specific ex-
amples where a new tailings disposal technol-
Availability and permitting of land for disposal ogy- dewatered or “thickened tailings”- is prov-
of mine wastes and tailings is an increasing
ing to be advantageous over “conventional
problem in many parts of the world, including
220
MPT-2013
slurry” impoundmentsin regions of the world As with any new technology, there has been
where space limitations and/or water scarcity some tendency to overstate its potential ben-
are dominant factors in determining the feasi- efits. This paper reflects on whether or not the
bility of mining projects. Additional examples potential benefits ascribed to the new paste and
of studies which compared “conventional thickened tailings technology some years ago
slurry” and “thickened tailings” that favoured have been realised. It is suggested that the key
the “thickened tailings” alternative for new or proven benefits appear to be reduced operat-
existing Tailings Storage Facilities (TSF) due to ing costs in some cases, reduced wall-building
significant gains in storage capacity are also de- costs and reductions in water consumption.
scribed. One key potential benefit that has not been uni-
versally achieved is a reduction in the footprint
The dewatering process is the primary method
of the tailings facility. Reports in the literature
of producing high solids slurries for the miner-
highlight the sometimes confusing nature of
als industry. Thickener outputs can produce a
trade-off studies. Unless full life-of-mine costs
range of tailings consistencies for surface dis-
are considered, these studies can be mislead-
posal options from low to moderate yield
ing and incorrect. The need is to establish a con-
stresses, easily pumpable using either centrifu-
sistent basis for comparative studies.
gal or positive displacement pumps. When
thickeners are combined with filtration equip-
2. Background of underground Mine
ment they can produce more concentrated slur-
Backfill and Surface Disposal
ries for delivery to ‘dry disposal’ and./or back-
fill applications. The thickening process, al- Underground Mine Backfill
though operated successfully in a large range of The use of paste for backfill purposes was con-
sites around the world, is poorly understood ceived in the early 1970s. The Bad Grund Mine
and predictive design of thickening devices is in Germany applied concrete mix design and
still empirical. Although predictive models of pumping know-how to continuously deliver a
thickening do exist, the correlation to reality is paste backfill mixture of tailings, coarse rejects
often poor and there is a desperate need to bring and cement underground. During the 1980s,
the two together to make rational improve- cycloned tailings, further processed in a thick-
ments to thickener design and operation. There- ener and drum filter, was combined with ce-
fore, whilst some would dismiss the models as ment and water in a batch mixer to deliver
being unacceptable for predictive design, they paste backfill underground at Lucky Friday
are very useful in formulating expected opera- Mine in the United States. These two systems
tional trends and providing an understanding represent some of the first approaches to paste
of the directions one should take in improving backfill processes (Ahmed et. al., 2010). Paral-
operational performance. lel studies taking place during the 1980s and
Interest in the potential use of high density, early 1990s in South Africa and Canada have
thickened tailings has recently increased signifi- collectively led to a greater understanding of
cantly. Reasons for considering this new tech- paste backfill operations and system require-
nology vary across projects, but commonly in- ments. The research work performed in the
clude the need to conserve water, to lower risk South African mines illustrated that mix de-
of TSF dam failure, to facilitate closure and site signs — varying the coarse and fine solid frac-
rehabilitation and to even reduce overall costs. tions — plays an important role for pipeline
221
MPT-2013
flow resistance and eventual strength gain for we will see in the next section it is clear that
ground support. paste technology has evolved from its main use
as backfill for underground mining applica-
In Canada, much of the research was gener-
tions to find further uses in the mining indus-
ated from the Sudbury area. Here, substantial
try and beyond. The reasons for adopting its
insight was gained in understanding paste rhe-
use are evident in the inherent benefits it pos-
ology and preparing the mix recipe (Ahmed et.
sesses both operationally and environmentally
al. 2010). It is very important to understand
(Ahmed et. al. 2010). In the Indian coal mining
the tailings material which is used to prepare
industry the hydraulic sand stowing method
the paste and to control the addition of the
for the underground mines has been predomi-
recipe constituents with proper proportions.
nant for the past few decades. However, the
The idea of paste preparation is to develop a
scarcity of river sand is resulting in the need to
composition which is flowable and at the same
search for other appropriate backfill materials
time can provide good backfill strength while
for the sustainable and complete extraction of
minimizing cement addition. An appreciation
future resources. In the Indian metal mining
of the colloidal properties in paste backfill re-
industry, cemented hydraulic fill has been in
vealed that it was generally necessary that the
use at many mines and due to its own safety
fines portion (less than 20 microns) be at least
related problems a better alternative is being
15 weight % (wt%) of the solids. These fines
looked into by the mining industry.
enable a suitable level of water retention, coarse
Surface disposal
suspension and lubrication that assists with
In the early 1970s the idea of thickening metal
pipeline transport. Further testing showed that
mine tailings for surface disposal was also be-
the coarse fraction (greater than 20 microns)
ing developed and this strategy was first em-
could be varied significantly without adversely
ployed at the Kidd Creek mill site located in
affecting the paste backfill’s flow properties.
northern Ontario (Robinsky 1999). However,
This in turn has allowed mines to optimize their
paste concepts for surface disposal gained in-
solids particle size distribution to allow for the
creasing acceptance in the metal mining in-
disposal of a variety of solid wastes (such as
dustry in the year 2000 with the success of
acid generating rock). Balancing the need for
Bulyanhulu in Tanzania (Landriault 2006).
backfill strength gain against the blending of
Bulyanhulu became the first mine/mill com-
coarser solids combined with lower water con-
plex to incorporate both surface and under-
tent allows the mine to custom design “engi-
ground paste disposal techniques for the com-
neer” their paste backfill. Another important
plete treatment of mill tailings (Landriault et
aspect stemming from this research was that
al. 2001). Concurrently, other factors such as
paste backfill could, in some instances be de-
improvements in dewatering/thickening tech-
livered in a controlled manner underground
nologies, mounting government pressure for
by gravity alone, without pump assistance, by
operations to reduce their environmental im-
varying the viscosity (water content) of the
pact as well as the realization of the true ben-
paste.
efits of paste for surface disposal drove mining
Paste backfill has its origins in the mining in- companies to consider and adopt this means of
dustry. A robust paste backfill mix design tak- tailings management. The co-disposal of mine
ing into consideration the underground envi- waste rock with paste is also gaining momen-
ronment is critical to operational success. As
222
MPT-2013
tum under the premise that reactivity (acid where they will form a homogeneous non-seg-
generation) of the waste rock containing regated mass when deposited from the end of a
sulphides is greatly reduced if enveloped by pipe (Welch 2003). They are not to be confused
paste (Wilson 2001). with paste tailings which are a higher (and
more expensive) degree of dewatering o pro-
Surface disposal of tailings is also a major area
duce very dense slurry that is often pumped to
of concern in India. The main challenges faced
its final storage facility using positive displace-
by the mine management are the land and en-
ment pumps (however, centrifugal pumps can
vironmental issues, practical problems in tail-
be used to pump paste where the tailings prop-
ings transportation and water handling. The
erties are favourable). HDTT is often defined in
Indian mining industry can therefore look into
industry where the tailings have a high yield
the introduction of paste technology not only
stress (typically higher than 20 Pa but no higher
for underground backfilling but also for sur-
than 100 Pa) and typically do not require deep
face disposal which is currently being prac-
cone or paste thickening technology. The bleed
ticed successfully in various countries. In 1973
water from the thickened tailings released upon
the Falconbridge owned Kidd Creek Metal-
deposition can be collected and transported
lurgy Plant in the town of Timmins, Ontario,
using conventional centrifugal pumping.
Canada was the first site to utilize disposal of
thickened tailings (Engels and Dixon-Hardy The idea of HDTT is to stack the pulp to form a
2004). The conventional storage facility was self-supporting conical pile thus reducing the
converted to High Density Thickened Tailings height and retention forces of the containing
(HDTT) to eliminate further raising of the tra- perimeter embankments. Increasing the con-
ditional retaining embankments that were situ- sistency (thickness) of the tailings pulp (i.e. in-
ated on very soft and sensitive clay founda- creasing the %solid concentration) creates
tions (ICOLD and UNEP 2001). The tailings are higher beach slopes angles in comparison to
discharged from spigots on a central ramp that tailings discharged as a slurry The tailings are
as of 2005 was 20m in height. At the base of generally discharged from topographical high
this ramp is the 32 m diameter, high compres- points within the tailings storage facility or by
sion thickener that produces a slurry density riser towers or central ramps (ICOLD and
of 60 – 65% solids (Golder 2005). UNEP 2001). Liberated water after deposition
and any surface runoff is collected in a pond at
3. Understanding slurry, thickened tailings the toe of the pile. Typical slope angles of 1 – 3.5
and paste degrees can be achieved to form a self-draining
easy reclaimable shape (ICOLD and UNEP
The tailings or the waste mixed with water to 2001). Paste tailings disposal often achieve
allow the mixture to flow is termed “slurry”. higher beach slope angles compared to HDTT.
“Thickened Tailings”, as the name suggests, in-
volves the mechanical process of dewatering A “Paste”is”tailing slurry” that is sufficiently
low solids concentrated slurry (Fourie 2003). dewatered or a dry granular material which is
This is normally achieved by using compres- mixed with sufficient water to fill the interstices
sion (or high rate) thickeners or a combination between the particles so that the material be-
of thickeners and filters. High Density Thick- haves as a fluid. The material retains all the
ened Tailings (HDTT) is defined as tailings that water between the particles because of colloi-
have been significantly dewatered to a point dal electrical particle charge of the fines which
223
MPT-2013
bonds the solid particles to the water mol- alogical make up is very important as not all
ecules. In this state, the paste can be trans- materials even within the outlined size distri-
ported through a pipeline but has no critical bution may make a paste. Different mineral
flow velocity, i.e., the velocity at which the solid types have different tendencies to retain col-
and liquid components separate into two dis- loidal water. A fundamental paste property is
tinct phases. If more water than can be held its non-segregating nature, i.e., the ability to
between the particles is added to the paste, it retain water. From a backfill perspective some
becomes slurry and the material does have a minerals may be inherently weak while oth-
critical flow velocity. In this state, the mate- ers may react with components (including
rial will flow through the pipeline but will sepa- binder) in the paste matrix to produce poor
rate out (segregate) into two distinct phases if strengths.
the velocity in the pipeline drops below the
Mathematically, the behavior of paste can gen-
critical value (Landriault 1998).
erally be described using the Bingham plastic
In general, a material with less than 15 wt% of model, where the material possesses a defined
fines (20 microns or less) will typically not pos- minimum shear stress (or yield stress) to ini-
sess the colloidal properties to form a paste and tiate flow. Once this is overcome, the paste be-
cannot be transported as such. However, the haves like a fluid exhibiting a linear shear rate
colloidal properties of the material are gov- to shear stress relationship and can be de-
erned not only by the size but also by the scribed by the following equation (Ahmed et.
chemical content and mineralogical composi- al. 2010):
tion of the particles. This means that different
materials will form a paste with different size
τ = τy+ηγ
distributions. Each granular material must be
tested independently to determine its proper- Where,
ties and its behaviour as a paste (Landriault
1998). Both the production plant and the pipe- τ = shear stress [Pa]
line distribution system have to be designed τy = yield stress [Pa]
with these specific properties in mind.
η = plastic viscosity [Pa s]
“Paste” is a densified uniform material of such
mineralogical makeup and particle size distri- γ = shear rate [1/s]
bution, that it will bleed only minor quantities
of water when at rest, experience minimum In practice, many parameters contribute to the
segregation and can be moved in a pipeline at rheological behavior of paste, including par-
velocities well below that of critical velocities ticle size distribution, particle angularity, sol-
for similar sized materials at lower pulp or ids density, mineralogy and the general nature
solids densities (Ahmed et. al. 2010). Pastes can of the suspension (colloidal chemistry). There-
remain sitting in a pipeline for extended peri- fore, rheological testing is integral to examin-
ods of time when no cementitious material is ing a material’s paste-making properties. Once
present. The slump is normally measured us- defined for a particular material, its rheologi-
ing an American Society for Testing and Mate- cal profile (Equation 1) can be established to
rials (ASTM) 30.5 cm (12 in.) slump cone, a stan- predict pipeline friction loss or pressure drop.
dard tool used in the concrete industry. Miner- In paste processes, one of the key items to un-
224
MPT-2013
derstand is its rheological behavior as it dic- vide an important means of providing support
tates pipe and pump sizing. One of the funda- to the surrounding rockmass.
mental prerequisites for the design and imple-
mentation of a successful thickened tailings or The following are the underground backfills
paste systems is a comprehensive [1]understand- used in the mines (Grice 1998):
ing of the rheological characteristics of the ma-
terial. Although rheological characterisation is · Hydraulic backfill
often out-sourced, it is essential that design Deslimed mill tailings slurries, with average
engineers and plant operators have a grasp of densities 70%Cw (solids by weight). The coarser
the variables which must be considered, the fractions are placed underground as hydraulic
questions that need to be addressed and famil- backfill and the slimes rejected to the surface
iarity with rheological assessment principles dam.
in order to determine the validity of data pro-
vided for the purpose intended. Good rheologi- · Paste backfill
cal data for one particular sample under one Total mill tailings filtered or thickened to around
specific set of testing conditions is generally 75-80%Cw to which cement and water is then
insufficient for design and/or optimisation of added to achieve the required rheological and
entire processing systems and the related strength characteristics. Any rejects to the dam
equipment. An ‘up-front’ understanding of how are at the full tailings sizing range.
rheological parameters affect and influence op-
· Rock backfill
erations will result in more efficient and sus-
Waste rock from surface or underground and
tainable plant performance and can mitigate
crushed or screened to a specified top size. This
many potential problematic issues.
can be placed as is or with cemented hydraulic
4. Type of backfill methods& thickened backfill slurry or cement water slurry. Crushed
tailings disposal rock with cement slurry is typically called ce-
mented aggregate fill (CAF) while waste rock
Historically backfill has tended to be sand (or
with cement slurry is typically called cemented
coarse tailings) and cement placed as a slurry
rock fill (CRF).
into the mined stope. This is often referred to as
cemented hydraulic fill (CHF). This method is Backfill source materials are largely made up
used in many operations today. Variants on this from the tailings waste generated due to min-
are also used including the placement of aggre- ing and mineral processing operations. The
gate or rock into the stope with the cemented hydraulic fill uses the coarse tailings (sands)
fill, such as those described by Bloss et al. (1993). from cyclone underflow, whereas paste gener-
The application of paste backfill is used in many ally includes the full mill tailings, though varia-
operations and in many cases it is the preferred tions on this do exist. While this differentiates
choice of backfill to use in an underground mine the two fills from a perspective of particle gra-
for a variety of reasons addressed in this pa- dation, the major aspect for the performance
per. Backfill has two functions in underground differs is that paste has a reduction of excess
mining. The first is as a construction material water, modified pipeline rheology (or pipeline
that is used to create a floor to mine on top of, a flow), greater consistency as an engineered
wall to mine next to, and a roof or head-cover backfill and the ability to be placed in the stope
to mine under. The second function is to pro- at a faster delivery rate. This thereby results in
225
MPT-2013
Properties CAF/CRF CHF Paste Fill
generating significant opportunities for in- PlacementState Dry (90-95% solids) 60-73wt%solids 65-85wt%solids
(Slade 2010). In CHF there are basically two sig- Cementedvs.UncementedCementedoruncemented Cementedoruncemented Cementedonly
nificant disadvantages. The first is to design Water/Cement(w/c)Ratio Low w/c ratio, high
binder strength
High w/c ratio, very low
binder strength
Lowtohighw/cratio,lowto
highbinderstrength
and construct permeable barricades to retain Segregation Stockpile segregation, Slurry settlement segregation, Nosegregation
reduced strength&stiffness low strengths in areas
the backfill and permit the free drainage of ex- Stiffness High stiffness if Lowstiffness Lowtohighstiffness
226
MPT-2013
Figure 1 shows what the slump looks like for period of time than would otherwise occur
the differing natures of material and as this is (Slade 2010).
the most simple and common test for evalua- In other situations the use of a paste backfill in
tion. combination with changes to a mining method
in an underground mine can also provide op-
portunities to an operation that may not have
been achieved by the use of a paste backfill alone
(Li et al. 2002).
227
MPT-2013
releases very littlebleed water, there is virtu- 4. Smaller space used up by ponded water in
ally no particle segregation down the beach and the impoundment and reduced impacts of
the material exhibits a finite, measureable yield seepagewater on the surrounding envi-
stress. One of the key potential advantages of ronment and lower risks to the contain-
TT is the reduction in the volume of water de- ment structures
posited in the TSF that needs to be managed. 5. Non-segregation of particle sizes upon
deposition, resulting in lower average
As an example, increasing the solids content permeability of the tailings deposit ,
from 32% (a common value for conventional increased resistance to surface erosion and
tailings) to 60% (noting that values in excess of reduced loss of tailings-contact water
70% have been achieved (McPhail et al., 2004)), through seepage
1.35 m3 less water per dry tonne is transported 6. Higher saturation level of tailings in the
to the TSF. This additional water is recovered long term, post-closure scenario, which
during the thickening process and is potentially reduces the oxidation rate and rate of acid
available for re-use. Upon deposition at the TSF, drainage production from acid generating
very little bleed water is usually released, un- tailings
like conventional tailings, where some of the 7. Easier access conditions to the deposit
additional water transported to the TSF is po- surface allowing easier on-going monitor-
tentially recoverable from the TSF. There is no ing and progressive closure activities
agreement on whether these potential water 8. Easier land reclamation and environmen-
savings are real or not; indeed, Lyell et al. (2008) tal restoration
argued that, as long as the TSF is operated at a
high rate of rise, it acts like a very large gravity The surface disposal of tailings in the form of
thickener and just as much water can be re- paste has its own advantages over the conven-
tional approach of slurried tailings disposal.
covered as is possible with in-plant thicken-
Subject to any particular case, this is likely to
ers. However, data emerging from field imple-
afford some gains for the operation and indeed
mentation of TT, as discussed later, contradicts
this view and shows that water savings are if tailings are deposited as a paste may well
very real. yield significant gains for the mining business
in the following aspects as summarised by
Some of the characteristics of thickened tail- Slade et al. (2009):
ings which contribute to the successes are: 1. smaller tailings disposal footprint with a
1. Higher average consolidated density of steeper beach angle
thickened tailings resulting in lower overall 2. smaller dam engineering
volume of impoundment and related foot- 3. lower water consumption
print 4. negligible bleed water release
2. Higher angle of repose of thickened tailings, 5. no critical velocity required to avoid set-
result in lower required perimeter contain- tling in transportation to discharge
ment dams and smaller footprint 6. reduced closure cost depending on the
3. Higher % recovery of process water used characteristics of the waste
in tailings transport, with associated 7. reduced operating risk liability
reduction in fresh water needs for the
milling process
228
MPT-2013
The table below elaborates the features and Paste Production wet m3/h 240 160
manner for the industry. Mining method SLOS (sub level open stoping) LHOS (long hole open stoping)
Feature Economic/Engineering Benefits Environmental/Social Benefits • Yield strength – static Pa 223 125 400 200
2. Costs accrued during Reduced requirement for bonds Costs met by operator, no long
Operations and provisioning term liability to community
Target UCS strength 1.1 MPa 0.75 MPa
3. Increased deposit Strength Reduced risk of facility failure Avoids offsite environmental and Thickener underflow % wt 70% 65%
safety impacts
Flocculent dosage 20 g/ t 40 g/t
4. Decreased land footprint by at Reduced land purchase cost Reduced sterilisation of
least doubling practical stacking productive land, reduced clearing Filter cake solid % wt 83% 81%
height
Paste Solid content % wt 79% 75%
5. Decreased demand for borrow Less transport and construction Reduced clearing for borrow Tailings slurry Conc. wt % 45 – 50% 58 – 65%
materials for construction materials, reduced greenhouse
gas production in construction
6. Reduced risk of leachate Better leachate and reagent Reduced risk of ground and
seepage recovery surface water contamination
8. Conclusions
7. Reduces or eliminates ponding Increased surface accessibility Reduced fauna injury, increased
and low strength mud deposits operator safety The future demands paste and thickened tail-
8. Prompt creation of firm, convex
draining surface at completion
Early creation of trafficable
surface
Progressive or more rapid
rehabilitation
ings for the sustainability for the Indian Min-
9. Earlier, better surface leaching Early leaching of toxicants from More rapid establishment of ing Industry. The technology for producing and
and drainage surface vegetation, reduced duration of
dust generation transporting paste is now well established
10. Potentially large reductions in
water use
Reduced need for water collection
and supply facilities, pumping
Reduced footprint from water
collection structures or impacts
worldwide and is in the process of being intro-
energy savings from diversion or abstraction
duced in a few Indian mines. Paste is being
11. Reduced potential for Deposit remains firm and will not Reduced offsite environmental
liquefaction flow and safety impacts used as backfill and ground support at many
12. Potentially reduced heating,
lower water demand
Reduced energy use, cost savings Lower greenhouse gas emissions underground mines around the world. The next
13. Reduced reagent requirements Potential operating cost savings Reduced pollution risk
step is to apply this technology to surface dis-
posal in India and make use of the many benefi-
7. Installations in India cial characteristics of paste.
The Paste-backfill technology has arrived in
The discussion in this paper demonstrates ar-
India, with the first two plants being con-
eas of improvement that can be achieved in an
underground mine by backfilling with paste
rather than CHF or CRF/CAF and also the ad-
vantages of tailings disposal as Paste or Thick-
ened tailings. The advantages include direct
benefits and indirect benefits to the mining op-
eration which create opportunities to improve
key aspects such as stope cycle time, produc-
tion scheduling, water consumption and re-
handling, mine environment, footprint require-
ment and many other factors. These all com-
229
MPT-2013
bine to counter the additional capital cost as- Development, Helsinki and Espoo, Finland,
sociated with the design and constructionof a June 8-10, 2004:. 13
paste backfill plant or a thickened tailings dis- Engels, J., and Dixon-Hardy, D., (2004). Tailings
posal plant and lend themselves to creating a disposal - Today’s storage of high volumes
higher NPV for the mining operation. of waste from mines. JKMRC Conference
It is recommended to follow a systematic ap- 2004, Brisbane, Australia:. 13.
proach for the application of paste technology Fourie, A. B., 2003. In Search of the Sustainable
and thickened tailings for any Indian mining Tailings Dam: Do High-Density Thickened
scenario beginning with material testing and Tailings Provide the Solution, School of
feasibility studies to investigate the potential Civil and Environmental Engineering,
benefits paste and/or thickened tailings tech- University of the Witwaterstrand, South
nology can successfully bring to a given project. Africa:: 12.
A case by case analysis is recommended for Grice, T., 1998. Underground Mining with Back-
every underground mine or surface disposal fill. The 2nd Annual Summit – Mine Tail-
application as the scale of gains may differ de- ings Disposal Systems, Brisbane 24-25
pending on the nature and type of the mining November 1998.
method.
ICOLD and UNEP, 2001. Bulletin 121: Tailings
Dams - Risk of Dangerous Occurrences,
Acknowledgements
Lessons learnt from practical experiences.
The authors express thanks to Golder Associ- Paris.144
ates for the support in developing this paper Landriault, D., 1998. Short Course Notes: Back-
and the opportunity to publish it at this con- fill Technology and Practice – Paste Tech-
ference. nology for Underground Backfill, Austra-
References lian Mineral Foundation, Glenside, South
Australia, June 28–29.
Ahmed, I., Francoeur, R., Anderson, J., and
Brown, R., 2010. Paste benefits and appli- Landriault, D., 2006. They Said It Will Never
cations from the mining industry to land Work – 25 Years of Paste Backfill 1981–
reclamation. International Solidification- 2006, 9th International Seminar on Paste
Stabilization Technology Forum 2010, S/S and Thickened Tailings, Limerick, Repub-
Tech, GPTL, Paterson & Cooke, pp. 153- lic of Ireland, April 3–7, Australian Cen-
159. tre for Geomechanics.
Bloss, M.L., Cowling, R., and Meek, J.L. 1993. A Landriault, D., D, Welch., and Frostiak, J., 2001.
procedure for the design of stable cemented Bulyanhulu Mine: Blended Paste Backfill
fill exposures, in Proceedings Minefill 93, and Surface Paste Deposition / The State
South African Institute of Mining and Met- of the Art in Paste Technology, Minefill
allurgy, Johannesburg, South Africa. 2001: Proceedings of the 7th International
Symposium on Mining with Backfill, So-
Engels, J., and D. Dixon-Hardy., 2004. Tailings
ciety for Mining, Metallurgy and Explora-
disposal - Managing increasing higher vol-
tion (SME), Seattle, Washington, USA, Sept
umes of waste from mines. 7th Interna-
17–19.
tional Symposium on Environmental
Geotechnology and Global Sustainable
230
MPT-2013
Lyell, K.A., Copeland, A.M., and Blight, G.E., Slade, N.M., Guilfoyle, K., and Kropp, W., 2006.
2008. Alternatives to paste disposal with Strategic and tactical mine planning in
lower water consumption. Proceedings of Enterprise Mine, Mount Isa Copper Op-
the 11th International Seminar on Paste erations, in Proceedings Strategic ver-
and Thickened Tailings (Paste08), Kasane, sus Tactical Approaches in Mining,
Botswana, 5–9 May 2008. Fourie, A.B., Australian Centre for Geomechanics,
Jewell, R.J., Slatter, P., and Paterson, A. Perth, Australia, Section 39.
(eds.). Australian Centre for TACEY, W. and RUSE, B. 2006. Making tailings
Geomechanics, Perth. pp. 171–178. disposal sustainable; a key business issue.
Li, T., Singh, U., Coxon, J., Grice, T., and Paste and Thickened Tailings – A Guide.
Sainsbury, D., 2002. Development and ap- 2nd edn. Jewell, R.J. and Fourie, A.B. (eds.).
plication of paste fill using dry tailings, in Australian Centre for Geomechanics,
Proceedings First International Seminar Perth. Ch. 2.
on Deep and High Stress Mining, Austra- Welch, D., 2003. Advantages of Tailings Thick-
lian Centre for Geomechanics, Perth, Aus- ening and Paste Technology, Responding
tralia, Section 12. to Change - Issues and Trends in Tailings
McPhail, G., Noble, A., Papageorgiou, G., and Management - Golder Associates Report:.5
Wilkinson, D., 2004. Development and Wilson, W. 2001. Co-Disposal of Tailings
implementation of thickened tailings dis- and Waste Rock, Geotechnical News: 44–
charge at Osborne Mine, Queensland, 49.
Australia. Proceedings of the International
Seminar on Paste and Thickened Tailings
(Paste 2004), Cape Town, South Africa, 31
March – 2 April 2004. Australian Centre
for Geomechanics, Perth. p. 33.
Robinsky, E.I., 1999. Tailings Dam Failures Need
Not Be Disasters – The Thickened Tailings
Disposal (TTD) System, CIM Bulletin, vol-
ume 92 (1028), 140–142.
Slade, N.M., 2010. Paste backfill — adding value
to underground mining. Paste 2010, Pro-
ceedings of the 13th International Semi-
nar on Paste and Thickened Tailings, 3–6
May 2010, Toronto, Canada, pp. 99-110.
Slade, N.M., Felipe, F., Wilson, S., and Palkovits,
F., 2009. Increasing Value in Mining Op-
erations through the Application of Paste,
in Proceedings 13th AusIMM Mill Opera-
tors Conference, Australian Institute for
Mining and Metallurgy, Adelaide, Austra-
lia.
231
MPT-2013
232
MPT-2013
233
MPT-2013
234
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
The industrial applications of fluidization technology (Coal gasification, power granulation etc.)
involve solid mixtures of particles which have differed in size, density and both. The fluidization
of binary mixture of solids occurs in a definite velocity interval, which is the beginning and
complete fluidization velocity of the mixture. The beginning fluidization velocity is where pressure
drop line deviates from fixed bed behavior and the complete fluidization velocity is the ultimate
value of the bed (i.e. whole bed is at fluidization mode). The beginning fluidization velocity does
not dependent on the initial arrangement of bed, however, the complete fluidization velocity
dependent on the physical properties of solids, composition of mixture and the level of segregation.
Using the fundamental theoretical considerations and force balances between the different
segregated layers, the beginning and complete fluidization velocities of mixture are calculated.
The calculation of complete fluidization velocity is being studied because of the lack of knowledge
between particle suspension and segregation at full fluidization condition. Using the empirical
correlations available in literature, the complete fluidization velocity is found by fitting the
unknown parameters determined by experimental results. The model predicted values are
validated with experimental data.
235
MPT-2013
2. Methodology
180 g ubf , m (1 m ) 2
Formisani et al., 2008 developed a model for ( g )(1 m ) g (3)
segregating binary mixtures of solids, where d avg 2 m3
total fluidization occurs in a specific velocity
interval i.e. ubf and ucf. Here, the mixture voidage ( g ) gd 2f , p m3
is calculated from experimental results but
uf ,p (4)
180 g (1 m )
calculation of the voidage is important at well
mixed conditions. Cheung et al., 1974 proposed (1 f ) (1 p )
the following correlation which is valid for u f hm x f 3 2
u p ho (1 x f )
different sized particles with the limitation of ( d ) f f ( 3p d p2 )
ucf ,m
size ratio not more than 3.. (1 m ) (1 ) (5)
3 2
hm 3 2p (ho hm )(1 x f )
(1 x f )2
( m d avg ) ( p d p )
um u p
(1) There is no relationship between progress
u f u f fluidization and segregation phenomena, an
After obtaining the um from the above equation, empirical correlation which is valid for specific
the mixture voidage can be obtained using mixtures only was proposed by Formisani et
Cozney-Karman equation and from this the al., 2008. This is valid for above three
beginning fluidization veloc ity c an be combinations (size or density or both).
calculated. For calc ulating the c omplete 3
fluidization velocity, the progress of component hm (1 m ) p
k x f (1 x f ) (6)
segregation and fluidization phenomena at ho (1 p ) m3
complete fluidization conditions are required.
The beginning fluidization at segregated
From the mass balance between three layers
conditions can be calculated as,
(packing layer, mixing layer, and fluidized
layer), one interaction parameter, k, which will ( g )g
u bf , s
account for above phenomena is defined. The x (1 ) (1 x f )(1 p )
model parameter ‘k’ is a fitting parameter and 180 g f 3 2 f 3 2 (7)
f d p d
is independent of composition and is obtained
by comparing with experimental results. In the For density segregating binary mixtures at well
present work, one k value applicable to many mixed conditions, a correlation is proposed in
literature experimental data is obtained. the present study to calculate the minimum
For different sized particles, Equation (1) fluidization of the binary mixture as shown
satisfactorily fits not only the data due to below.
Formisani et al., 2008 data but also other
experimental literature data up to diameter
p
xf f (1 x f )
ratio of 4. For well mixed conditions, the 1
avg avg (8)
expressions for calculating the values of davg,
um uf up
ubf,m, uf,p, and ucf,m are given in the equations
2,3,4 and 5 respectively.( Formisani et al., 2012, For density segregated mixtures, ubf , ucf can be
2011, 2008), calculated by,
1 xf (1 x f )
180g ubf ,m (1 m ) 2
d avg df dp (2) ( f g ) x f ( p g )(1 x f ) (1 m ) g (9)
d2 m3
236
MPT-2013
0.25
0.2
0.15
0.2
Experimental data of Rao et al., 2011
0.18
Experimental data of Rao et al., 2011
0.1
Experimental data of Nienow et al., 1978 Experimental data of Nienow et al., 1978
0.16
0.05
0.14
Theoretical u bf,m (m/sec)
0
0.12 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.3 0.35
Experimental ubf,s (m/sec)
0.1
0.08
0.06
0.04
Fig. 3 Comparison between experimental and
0.02
calculated values of beginning fluidization
0
0 0.02 0.04 0.06 0.08 0.1 0.12
0.25
Theoretical ubf,s (m/sec)
0.4
0.2
0.35 Experimental data of Rao et al., 2011
0.25 0.1
Experimental data of Rao et al., 2011
0.2
0.05 Experimental data of Nienow et al., 1978
0.15
0
0.1 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.3 0.35
Experimental u bf,s (m/sec)
0.05
0
0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.25
237
MPT-2013
0.2
Greek Letters
0.5
voidage, -
Theoretical u cf,m (m/sec)
0.4
238
MPT-2013
*******
239
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
The Bond grindability test developed by F.C. Bond in the middle of twentieth century gives the
Bond’s Work Index, an important engineering parameter for design of industrial closed circuit
grinding mills. The work index is an empirical measure of the energy input required for grinding
ores from a specific particle size to the design particle size. Bond designed the work index ball mill
with strict dimensional and functional specifications and developed the experimental methodology
for determining the Work Index in a laboratory. The method has become so popular that even
today project engineers use this parameter for design of grinding circuits, even though a lot of
improvements have been reported in the literature with better understanding of the energy-size
reduction relationships.
In this paper, an effort has been carried out to present and review the literature on important
simulation models and applicability of these simulations has been proved on our ore sample.
240
MPT-2013
R n rM k Φ t i
k 1 i k n
(2)
R n K 2fn N n
where, Zn is the amount of product from fresh
(7)
241
MPT-2013
*******
243
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
244
MPT-2013
pyrite. This is the major gangue mineral in the stopped and a sample was taken by removing
ore. The optimum P80 maintained is 80% material over a two-meter length. Operating
passing 63microns. conditions during sampling was recorded. Steps
The ROM is initially crushed and the product involved in the present study are:
is sent to a grinding circuit which consists of a 1. Sampling through the circuit survey,
combination of rod mill operating in open 2. Sizing analysis of the samples
circuit and a ball mill operating in a closed 3. Mass Balance.
circuit milling processes. The combined mill 4. Model Development
discharges were sent to the hydro cyclone 5. Model Validation
classification whose over flow is a feed to the 6. Simulation studies.
downstream differential froth flotation process. The sampling was done at the six points of the
In this scenario, grinding optimization studies circuit. The sampling points are
were done with the objective of increasing the 1. Rod Mill Feed (P80:20mm)
throughput to the rod mill of grinding circuit 2. Rod Mill Discharge (P80:1mm)
under the same current capacity. Process 3. Cyclone Feed
modeling and simulation approach was used 4. Cyclone Underflow
to find optimization solutions considering the 5. Cyclone Overflow
requirements of downstream Flotation process. 6. Ball Mill discharge
The aim of the study was to develop 3. Mass Balance Studies
mathematical models of rod mills, ball mills and
classifiers used in the grinding circuit and to The samples thus collected were dried for the
investigate the effec ts of the proposed pulp density calculations. Thus obtained
modifications on the circuit performance using samples were wet sieved for the size analysis
simulation. of samples. The sizing data and the pulp density
data were used in the mass balance studies on
2. Sampling Campaign of the Circuit the circuit with the JK SimMet 5.1 software.
Sampling campaign from grinding circuit was Mass balancing includes reconciliation of
planned to assess its performance under the survey data to minimize sampling & sizing
current operating conditions. errors; also provides missing stream data.
Table 1: Mass balance Studies results
Liqui Pulp Vol. 80%
Solid %
d SG Flow passes
Equipment Port s (t/h) Solids
(t/h) (t/m³) (m³/h) (mm)
Combin
Feeder 142 1.46 98.98 2.845 50.43 17.9
er
Combin
345.6 119.8 74.26 1.947 239 0.363
Ball Mill er
Combin
487.6 302.3 61.73 1.679 470.4 0.206
er
Figure 1: Flow sheet of the mineral grinding Hydro-cyclone
U/F 345.6 119.8 74.26 1.947 239 0.363
and classification circuit of S. K. Mines O/F 142 182.5 43.76 1.402 231.5 0.0607
then dried for the % solids calculations. To *Estimated SSQ: 12.5 (lower the value indicates better
the data quality)
sample Rod mill fresh feed, belt conveyor was
245
MPT-2013
Thus the obtained reconciled data was used in the 4.3. Model validation
development of the models for the individual equipments
in the grinding & classification circuit. The specifications The obtained fitted model parameters thus
& details of the equipments that were used in the make the model development of the individual
development of the models are as follows. equipments. The developed models are to be
Table 2: The details of the equipments that were used in validated with another set of the process data
the development of the models for getting acquainted with the precision of
prediction of the developed models. Validation
Rod mill Ball mill Hydro cyclone
Ore Work
this purpose, a circuit survey campaign was
Spigot - Du
Load Fraction 0.3 Index
(kWh/t)
9.5
(m)
0.09
conducted on the same grinding & classification
Ore Work Index (kWh/t) 9.5
Original Mill
Ball Top Size 40
Cylinder Length - Lc (m)
0.59 circuit whose throughput was step increased
4
(mm)
to 150 tph from 140 tph. The corresponding
Cone Angle - Theta (deg) 10
Feed 90% Passing Size
(mm)
20
No of cyclones
water addition to the circuit was also increased
4
to maintain the desired pulp density of the
slurry at the respec tive points. Proc ess
4. Model Development variables subjec ted to step-c hange for
The empirical models that were used in the validation are as follows.
development of the individual quipments of Table 4: Process variables subjected to step-
this case study were as follows. change for validation
1. Rod Mill (Lynch – Kavetsky Model) Process variable Model
Development
Model Validation
2. Ball Mill (perfect mixed ball mill model) Circuit Feed rate (TPH)
32
150
38
cyclones)
Thus using the software, the models (model The process data after getting reconciled
(through mass balance studies) was used for
parameters) were developed by fitting the
the validation. The validation is, using the
reconciled data obtained from the mass balance developed model for simulating the equipment
studies. to get its virtual response for the given step
Table 3: The fitted model parameters which change in the process variable. The models were
were used in the development of the models validated at the given step change in the process
Model Guessed Fitted Fit
variable. The validation results at increased
Equipment
Parameter Value Value SD
throughput were as follows.
Mill Const 1500 983.1 34.52
246
MPT-2013
Table 5: The comparison of the results obtained result in serious problems in the recoveries of
after the simulation studies (model validation) the metals. In order to maintain the same cut
with the results obtained with the data size of the hydro cyclone and increasing the
reconciliation (mass balance studies) recirculation load, the only way is to increase
the throughput and by maintaining same pulp
density of the slurry (feed to cyclone). So, in order
to see its feasibility the circuit was simulated
at increased throughput i.e. @ 160 TPH to the
rod mill with appropriate increase in the water
addition to the circuit. The results are tabulated
below.
Table 6: The results obtained after the
Figure 2: Size analysis comparison of the simulation studies at increased throughput to
various points in both the data reconciled case the grinding circuit @ 160 TPH.
and the simulated case
From the above results it is quite evident that Sol
ids Liqui
%
Pulp Vol.
%Pass
es 80 %
Equipment Port d SG Flow
Solids 1.00 passes
the response of the models for a given step (t/h
)
(t/h) (t/m³) (m³/h)
mm
the actual response of the circuit. The hydro Prod 160 38 80.81 2.125 93.17 70.4 1.5
First stage
Prod 537 308.8 63.49 1.712 494 90.03 0.362
cyclone over flow which is nothing but the feed sump
Combine
377 120.8 75.73 1.985 250.9 85.8 0.657
to flotation was very same in both the cases Ball Mill r
difference between the two cases. Also the O/F 160 188 45.98 1.431 243.2 99.95 0.0671
247
MPT-2013
Through reducing the fines recycling to the The authors would like to thank Hindustan Zinc
ball mill, which is an unnecessary load on Limited – S. K. Mines proc essing plant
the ball mill causing increment in COP and administration for supporting this research
recovery losses.
and sincere cooperation of plant personnel for
Thus The Grinding Circuit is able to handle
making this happen.
increased throughput. However aspects like
pumping capacities / limitations, electric drive References
capacities of the mills need to be verified. Napier–Munn, T. J., Morrell, S., Morrison, R. D.
Acknowledgment and Kojovic, T., 1996, “Mineral Comminution
Circuits”, JKMRC, Australia, pp. 318-320, 332.
*******
248
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
This article presents a mathematical model for solidification of two-dimensional semitransparent
material. The medium is considered absorbing, emitting and scattering. The radiation field is
obtained by solving the equation of transfer. The temperature field is predicted by solving the
energy equation with a volumetric radiation source. The finite volume method is adopted to
discretize both the equations: the equation of transfer and the energy equation. The enthalpy
formulation is used to capture the continuously evolving solid-liquid interface during phase
change. The thermo physical properties are taken different for different phases. The results are
validated with those available in the literature. The effect of important parameters such as the
scattering albedo and the conduction-radiation parameter on the liquid fractions and the
temperature distributions in the medium are studied. It is observed that with lower value of the
scattering albedo and lower value of conduction-radiation parameter, the solidified region is
more. It is also found that the mushy-zone thickness becomes less with radiation dominated
phase change process.
249
MPT-2013
method (Mitra et al., 1997), the integral equation signific ant effec t on the predic tion of
solution (Tan and Hsu, 2001), the finite volume temperature distribution and liquid fraction in
method (FVM) (Chai et al., 1994), the radiation the medium. They used the FVM method to
element method (REM) (Guo et al., 2001) and obtain the radiative information. Most of the
the lattice Boltzmann method (LBM) (Mishra authors have used two different methods to
and Roy, 2007). solve the energy equation and radiative
Chan et al., (1983) suggested a model of melting transfer equation. So, the present paper focuses
and solidification of semitransparent material on solving both the energy equation and the
involving internal thermal radiation. They radiative transfer equation using one method
concluded that radiative heating or cooling i.e. FVM to perform a parametric study for two-
causes internal melting and solidification. They dimensional transient solidific ation of
presented an exact and two approximate semitransparent binary materials.
solutions to three simple solidific ation This article is divided into five sections. In the
problems and discussed the effect of the two- next section, the physical problem is defined
phase zone on the solidification of semi- followed by formulation of the phase change
transparent materials. Lapka and Furmanski, process. The overall solution procedure is
(2008) proposed a numeric al model of discussed next. The results of the chosen
solidification of a semitransparent material and problem are discussed in the results and
discussed the effect of different parameters such discussion section followed by conclusion.
as conduction-radiation parameter, scattering
2. Physical Model
albedo, optical thickness on the temperature 500 K
distribution in the medium. They investigated 1000 K 1000 K
different cases taking different relationships
between liquid fraction and temperature
Y
during the solidification processes. Yi et al.,
(2011) analyzed a numeric al model of y
solidification of semitransparent material
x
having graded index. They used Galerkin finite
element method to solve the energy equation of 1000 K
250
MPT-2013
north boundary and the solid-liquid interface The radiation information can be obtained by
is captured by enthalpy based approach (Voller solving the radiative transfer equation given
et al., 1988). The enthalpy based energy equation as
taking into consideration the volumetric l M
radiation can be written as 1 I l ll l
I 1 I b I
l
(7)
s 4 l l
Energy Equation
T T 3. Formulation
H q qr k k qr (1)
t
c
x x y y 3.1. Radiative transfer equation
The inscattering term in Eq. (7) is summed over
H g S
H S gL H L all the control angles used to discretize the
t t
domain under construction. For the present
case, an isotropic scattering is considered for
t
g C S PS
T g L C PLT L f which the phase function l’l = 1. Under this
assumption Eq. (7), the linearized RTE can be
g L written as
C pmix
T Lf (2)
t t l
1 I l l l
qr 4 I b G m I Sm (8)
s
1 4 T G 4
(3a)
where, lm and Slm are the modified extinction
ˆ )d coefficient and the modified source term
where G( r ,t ) I( r ,s,t (3b)
respectively which can be represented as
4
T 4 l
m 1
l
(9a)
and I b (3c) 4
The energy equation (Eq. (1)) can be written in M
l l
Sm 1 I b
l
dimensionless spatial coordinates as
4
I (9b)
l 1
l l
C pmix
T
2
k T 1 k T
1
mix 2 mix
t X x x Y y y Integrating Eq. (8) over a typical 2-D control
g L volume and a control angle within a specified
1 4T 4 G Lf t
(4) time step, the RTE becomes
where, x*= x/X, y* = y/Y 1 I
l
l l l
Initial Condition
V t s
dvd m
I Sm dvd (10)
V t
T(x , y , 0) T0 (5)
Applying divergence theorem to the 2nd term of
Boundary Conditions Eq. (10), assuming the magnitude of intensity
T(x , 0, t) T0 (6) to be constant over the control volume and a
control angle, Eq. (10) can be written as
T(0, y , t) T0 n
1 l
i
ˆ ˆ d
I A s.n i
l l
m P
l
I Sm V (11)
l
l
T(X, y , t) T0 i 1
I l
n
l
I s A y D cy
l
(12) In the present method, an iterarive update
procedure is developed to update the liquid
l
m ,P I P Sm ,P
l l
V
l
fraction in each control volume. The iterative
update relation is given as
where D cxe sˆ nˆ x d D cxw
l l l
a p t
g Ln 1 g Ln
L f V P
T p
n
g Ln T L T s T s (16)
sˆ nˆ d
l l l
D cyn y
D cys
To avoid overshooting and undershooting
l
d , A x
A y problem during computation, following
conditions are set.
To relate the boundary intensities to the nodal
(a) If g L < 0, then g L is set to zero.
intensities, the STEP spatial difference scheme
(b) If g L > 1, then g L is set to 1.
(Chai et al., 1994) is used. In the step or upwind
A control volume can be said to solidify
scheme the downstream boundary intensities
completely when, g L = 0. Thus it can implicitly
are set equal to the upstream nodal intensities
capture the solid-liquid front in the domain at
as follows.
any time instant. The tolerance limit for
convergence of the iterative solution is set to
I1e I1p , I1w I1W , I1n I1p , I1s I1S (13)
10-7 in the present simulation.
Applying the STEP scheme, Eq. (12) becomes. 3.3. Overall solution procedure
l
Ax D l
Ay D cy
Ax D I l l
The Overall solution procedure for the present
cx
ml , P Vl I Pl cx W
252
MPT-2013
Temperature (K)
reached. 0.8
Temperature (K)
0.8
volume sizes. Fig. 2a shows the effect of control
0.7
volume size and Figure 2b shows the effect of 6x3
0.6 8x4
control angle size on temperature distribution 12 x 6
0.5
at the centre line at t = 5 secs. It is found that the 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1
Distance, y/Y
control angle size of 8 ´ 4 (8 divisions of
azimuthal angle and 4 divisions of polar angle) Fig. 2: Grid independence test: (a) effect of
and control volume size of 21 ´ 21 gives the grid control angle size and (b) effect of control
independent results. Although not shown, it is volume size on centerline temperature
distribution
found that beyond a time step size Dt = 0.001,
there is no change in the results. Hence, the 1
0.8
1.72368 W/m-K
k mz Fig. 3: Validation with available results at t =
kL 1.3608 W/m-K 5 secs
1.0 J/Kg-K
Fig. 3 shows the temperature distribution at
C ps the centerline (x/X = 0.5) of the medium at t = 5
C mz 1.12 J/Kg-K secs. It is observed that the present results agree
1.2 J/Kg-K well with the available result from the
C pL
literature.
s = L 1000 Kg/m3
1
Lf 1000 J/kg
0.9
600 K
TS
Temperature
0.8
800 K 0.7
TL N = 0.01
0.6 N = 0.1
2793 K
Tb N=1
0.5
To 300 K 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1
Distance (y/Y)
5.67 10-8 Wm?2 K-4
Fig. 4a :Centre line temperature distribution
(T/Tref) at t = 5secs for different conduction-
radiation parameters
253
MPT-2013
0.8
0.6
more energy as the value of the scattering albedo
0.4
N = 0.01 increases and the effect of radiation on the phase
0.2 N = 0.1
N=1 change process decreases.
0
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1
Distance, y/Y
0.9
Temperature
0.8
? = 0.0
0.7 ? = 0.4
? = 0.8
0.6
0.5
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1
Distance, y/Y
0.8
0.6
the medium at t= 5sec s. It is seen that
0.4
? = 0.0
? = 0.4
solidification starts from the north boundary.
0.2
? = 0.8
It is found that the temperature gradient
0
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1
decreases from the solid-mushy interface to
Distance, y/Y
mushy-liquid interface.
Fig. 5b: Centre line liquid fraction distribution
5. Conclusion
at t = 5secs for different scattering-albedos
Fig. 5a and 5b shows the variation in A numerical model of solidification of 2-D square
temperature and liquid fraction along the center semitransparent medium was discussed. The
254
MPT-2013
Guo, Z., and Kumar, S., 2001. Discrete-ordinates enclosure. AIAA J Thermophys Heat
solution of short-pulsed laser transport in Transfer. 11, 409-414.
two-dimensional turbid media. A p p l Modest, M. F., 2003. Radiative Heat Transfer,
Optics. 40, 3156-3163. second edition. Elsevier, New York.
Guo, Z., Kumar, S., and Maruyama, S., 2001. Patankar, S. V., 1980. Numerical Heat Transfer
Transient radiation element method for and Fluid Flow, Hemisphere.
three-dimensional scattering, absorbing Parida P. R., Raj. R., Prasad A. and Mishra, S. C.,
and emitting medium. Num. Heat 2007. Solidification of a semitransparent
Transfer: PART B. 39, 371- 387. planar layer subjected to radiative and
Lapka. P. and Furmanski, P., 2008. Numerical convective cooling. J. Quant. Spectros.
modelling of solidification processes of Radiative Transfer. 107, 226-235.
semitransparent materials using the Raj, R., Prasad. A, Parida P. R. and Mishra, S. C.,
enthalpy and the finite volume methods. 2006. Analysis of solidific ation of a
Heat Mass Transfer. 44, 937-957. semitransparent planar layer using the
Maroufi, A. and Aghanajafi, C., 2013. Analysis lattice Boltzmann method and the discrete
of conduction-radiation heat transfer transfer method. Numerical Heat Transfer
during phase c hange proc ess of A. 49, 279-299.
semitransparent materials using lattice Sarkar, S., Mohanraj, P., Chakraborty, S. and
Boltzmann method. J. Quant. Spectros. Dutta, P., (2002) Three dimensional
Radiative Transfer. 116, 145-155. computational modeling of momentum,
Mishra, S. C., Behera, N. C., Garg, A. K. and heat and mass transfer in laser surface
Mishra, A., 2008. Solidification of a 2-D alloying process, Numerical Heat Transfer.
semitransparent medium using the lattice A, 42, 307-326.
Boltzmann method and the finite volume Tan, Z. M. and Hsu, P. F., 2001. An integral
method. International Journal of Heat and formulation of transient radiative transfer.
MassTransfer. 51, 4447- 4460. ASME J. Heat Transfer. 123, 466-475.
Mishra, S. C., Roy and H. K., 2007. Solving Voller, V. R., 2008. An enthalpy method for
transient conduction-radiation problems modeling dendritic growth in a binary
using the lattice Boltzmann method and alloy. International Journal of Heat and
the finite volume method. J. MassTransfer. 51, 823-834.
Computational Phys. 233, 89- 107. Yi, H., Tan, H. and Zhou, Y., 2011. Coupled
Mitra, K, Lai, M. S., and Kumar, S., 1997. radiation and solidification heat transfer
Transient radiation transport in inside a graded index medium by finite
participating media within a rectangular element method. International Journal of
Heat and MassTransfer. 54, 3090-3095.
*******
256
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Column flotation (CF) is versatile equipment and is being practiced for significant growth in
mineral processing since many years. The flow in column flotation is multiphase transitional/
evolving turbulent flow. The complex multi-phase flow in these columns is far from complete
understanding. The complete understanding of hydrodynamics of column flotation (CF) is essential
to model and develop design criteria. However, its similarity to the bubble columns provides a
basis for improved understanding of fluid flow in CF using the multi-phase CFD methods. This
paper presents a three-dimensional, two-phase, CFD model for numerical simulation of water-air
dispersive flow in column flotation. Eulerian-Eulerian multi-phase (Two-fluid) model with standard
k-å turbulence model has been employed in these simulations. Simulations had been carried out to
predict the time averaged gas hold-up, liquid velocity and turbulence quantities for various gas
superficial velocities. The CFD model was extensively validated against the literature based rectangular
bubble columns in terms of gas-holdup and liquid velocities. The model was also validated against the
4 inch laboratory circular column flotation gas-holdup data.
1. Introduction
coalescence of bubbles, which are mainly
Column flotation has been using enormously driven by physic-chemical interactions. All
in mineral process industries to separate many these interac tions well explained by
minerals. Due to its better yield performance hydrodynamics of the process. For the study of
compare (Jena et al., 2008) with conventional hydrodynamics of Column Flotation, Bergh and
flotation cells, it has been attracting academics Yianatos (1995) built an empirical model. A
and mineral separation process industries. number of (Sastry and Lofftus, 1988, Cruz, 1997)
Performance of Column flotation depends on phenomenological models have been developed
bubble-particle interac tions, removal of for analyse the hydrodynamics of Column
particle –bubble aggregates and break-up and Flotation.
* Correspending Author: Balraju Vadlakonda, Department
To understand the c omplexity of
of Chemical Engineering, Indian Institute of hydrodynamics in column flotation, advance
Technology, H yderabad, Ordnance Factory Estate, tools such as computational fluid dynamics
Andhra Pradesh, India-502205, Ph : +91-40-23026086,
(CFD) elucidate clearly. It is very helpful to
ch10p005@iith.ac.in
257
MPT-2013
develop the design criteria (Chakraborty et al., collectively averaging the mass and momentum
2009). Initially two phase flow of conservation equations describes the time
hydrodynamic s had studied in c olumn dependent motion of both phases. Eulerian two
flotation. To analyse the hydrodynamics in fluid model is able to accounts the gas-liquid
column flotation, we considered bubble column interactions in the terms of drag, lift, virtual
CFD methods as basis. mass and induced turbulence etc. The CFD
Many researc hers had c arried out CFD model had validated with literature based
simulations to analyse the hydrodynamics of rectangular bubble column (Buwa, 2006).The
bubble column. Dispersed gas–liquid ûows in resulting set of equations solved by using finite
bubble columns had simulated using volume volume method and applying pressure-velocity
of fluid (VOF), Eulerian–Eulerian and Eulerian– coupling scheme based on SIMPLE algorithm.
Lagrangian approaches. Eulerian–Eulerian In churn turbulent flows Euler-Euler method
simulations can predict the low-frequency usually preferred.
oscillations of the meandering bubble plume k- turbulence model had used in most of
and time-averaged ûow properties in bubble column simulations. It is a two equation
reasonably good agreement with experiments model, which include two extra transport
(Buwa and Ranade, 2002, Rampure et al., 2003). equations to characterize the turbulent flow.
Eulerian–Lagrangian approach could predict Turbulent kinetic energy (k) decides the energy
the time-averaged properties (Delnoij et al., in the turbulence and turbulent dissipation ( )
1999, Lain et al., 2002) defines the scale of the turbulence.
Two phase CFD simulations had carried out
using mixture model previously in column 2.1 Basic model equations
flotation. In this present work, CFD simulations Mass conservation equation
had carried out to explain the time averaged The mass conservation equation for the phase
gas hold-up, liquid velocity and turbulence q can be written as
characteristics of column flotation. The effect of
gas superficial velocities had tested in flow
c haracteristic s of c olumn flotation. CFD
simulations had tested with experimental data Where the velocity of phase q and mass
(Shukla et al, 2010). transfer between phases is not considered and
therefore source term ( ) was set to zero.
2. CFD Model
258
MPT-2013
Where is the qth phase stress-strain tensor gradients. =1.44, =1.92, =0.09,
=1.0, =1.3 are constants.
3. Numerical Simulation
Here and are the shear and bulk viscosity
of phase q, is an external body force, is 3.1. Geometry and grid considerations
a lift force, is a virtual mass force, is Fig. 1 shows the schematic diagram of column
an interaction force between phases, is the flotation with dimensions of 1.68m height and
interphase velocity and p is the pressure shared 0.1m diameter (Satish et al., 2010). Feed pipe is
by all phases. located at 1.3m height of column from base. Air
flow comes through sparger from bottom of
column. Air was supplied at a known velocity
(Ug =1.30, 3.29, and 5.01 cm/s). This prepared
Where, is the interphase momentum ex- feed water was fed to the flotation column at
change coefficient. The schiller Naumann drag desired feed velocity 2.76 cm/s.
law had used in the simulations. The two fluid Eulerian-Eulerian model was ap-
plied for the gas-liquid dispersive flow in column
flotation. This basic CFD model was used to simu-
late the dynamic flow behaviour in column flota-
tion. The k-å turbulence model had been used in
these simulations. Turbulence was considered for
Lift force and virtual mass force didn’t consider both phases. Unstructured computational grid
in simulations. had used.
Turbulence equation Column Flotation has divided into 1, 51,090 cells.
Turbulence can be taken into consideration for The transient simulations were performed and
both phases. k-å turbulence model has been the time step 0.001 s was used for column flota-
used in these simulations. The reference has tion. The velocity–pressure linkage was handled
taken from ANSYS FLUENT 13.0 theory guide through the Phase coupled SIMPLE procedure
(Fluent (2010)). in column flotation. Mass and momentum equa-
The governing equation for the turbulent kinetic tions were solved using higher-order
energy (k) and the turbulent energy dissipation discretization schemes, like QUICK. The gas inlet
rate ([) are given below. was taken as a velocity inlet, with a volume frac-
tion one. The average bubble size used is 5 mm.
At the column outlet, a degassing boundary con-
dition was speciûed as described by Ranade
(1997).
259
MPT-2013
0.1m
4.1. Gas hold-up
Fe e d The effect of air superficial velocity on gas hold-
1.68m up had analysed in Fig 3. The time averaged
gas hold-up values had increased with air
1.3 m superficial velocity. Simulations values had
matched with experimental results (Shukla et
Air
al., 2010).
(a) Ta ilings (b)
Fig. 1: Schematic diagram of Column
Flotation (a) Geometry (b) CFD grid
three air superficial velocities 1.3,3.29,5.01cm/s
and water flow rate 2.76 cm/s. Water had
entered to the column at 1.3m height above the
base. Time averaged flow properties had
analysed through CFD simulations. Simulations
had been carried out to analyse the time averaged
gas hold-up, liquid velocity and turbulence
quantities.
The CFD model had validated with literature
based rectangular bubble column (Buwa, Fig. 3: Effect of air superficial velocity on gas
2006).In rectangular bubble column time hold-up
averaged gas hold-up and time averaged axial 4.2. Liquid velocity
liquid veloc ity had validated with
experimental results. CFD simulations had The liquid velocity has transitional/turbulent
carried out for air superficial velocity 0.14cm/s nature in column flotation.
with 2.25 aspect ratio. The results had shown
in Fig. 2(a) and 2(b).
Fig. 2(b): Time averaged axial liquid velocity (a) Velocity vectors of water (b) Velocity vectors
for column with H/W=2.25 at gas superficial of air
velocity 0.14 m/s
260
MPT-2013
caused by increase the air superficial velocity, kinetic energy and turbulent intensity at
and then as a result more mixing will takes different heights of column. Due to bubble
place in column flotation. interactions with liquid at the above of sparger
the turbulent kinetic energy and intensity
gained maximum. Bubble interaction with
liquid and mixing phenomena leads to change
in the values of turbulent kinetic energy and
intensity.
263
MPT-2013
*******
264
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
In this paper, the effect of inclination on hydrocyclone performance is studied using computational
fluid dynamics technique and experimental methods. Water only experiments and the
corresponding two-phase CFD simulations in 3" and 4" diameter cyclones are carried out at 0, 30,
45, and 60 degrees inclined positions to the vertical plane. The two-phase CFD flow analysis
shows that the water split to underflow decreases as the inclination increases which are consistent
to the experiments. The predicted tangential velocity profiles show mixed behaviour, 45 0
inclinations with high tangential velocity. An increased pressure drop is also observed with the
inclination. The effect of inclination on air-core profiles is minimal. An increase in the inclination
shows an air-core size reduction trend. Experiments at various inclinations on flow split and
classification performance of 3 inch hydrocyclone performed using the silica slurry. The analysis
shows the increased cut-size and the reduced water split with the inclination. Cross validation of
inclined cyclone’s CFD data is attempted with ERT and High speed video imaging experiments.
265
MPT-2013
operation at coarser cut points without varying hydrocyclone for low solids concentration (10%
any other design and operating parameters. wt). Thereafter there was significant increase
Minimizing fines misplacement to underflow in the cut size when cyclone operated beyond
can be achieved with inclination. 45 degrees inclinations for c oncentrated
slurries. Data was tested with the empirical
2. Literature Review model proposed by Asomah and Napier-Munn
Usage of horizontal cyclones in place of vertical and got an error of 6.6% in the predicted cut
cyclones increased the efficiency by reducing size. Either of these studies was not
short circuit flow of fines to underflow hence concentrated on high pressures and high
dec reases c irc ulating loads on ball mill perc entage of feed solids effec t on the
(Hochsheid, 1987, Orwe and Noreen, 1988). performance of hydrocyclone.
Similar observation was found with 45 degree In this paper, the effect of inclination on
inclined cyclones (Johnstone and Rais, 1988). hydrocyclone performance is studied using
There was an improvement in the efficiency of computational fluid dynamics technique and
hydrocyclones when they were operated at low experimental methods. Water only and slurry
pressures in horizontal direction (Bradley, based classification experiments and the
1960) due to reduction of water recovery to corresponding two-phase CFD simulations in
underflow. Asomah and Napier-Munn 3" and 4" diameter cyclones are carried out at
(Asomah and Napier-Munn, 1997) conducted different inclined positions to the vertical plane.
experiments on various hydrocyclones with Inc lination effec t on flow analysis of
different inclinations (0-120), diameters (102- hydrocyclone w.r.t. mean and turbulent flow
508mm). Their results show inclination of 45 field, water split, LZVV, air-core size and
degrees or greater has a significant effect on the position, and particle turbulent dispersion is
performance of large diameter hydrocyclones attempted. Basic reasons behind the cyclone
in low pressure operations. Their observations inclination effect on particle classification
include the increase of cut size with increase in mechanism have been eluded.
inclination. They also developed an empirical
model for hydrocyclones with the inclusion of
feed size, viscosity and inclination. Rong and
Napier-Munn (Rong and Napier-Munn, 2003)
inclination investigations (0-180 degrees) on
200mm JK classifying cyclone reveals, there was
an improvement in sharpness of separation
from vertical to horizontal position; thereafter
it decreases significantly to a low value. Their
inclination results on flow ratio decrement and
Fig.1:Schematic of test rig used for experiments
improvement of solids percentage in the
underflow were similar to the literature 3. Methodology
(Asomah and Napier-Munn, 1996). Inclination
effect on 75mm hydrocyclone has been studied To find out the inc lination effec t on the
by Banisi and Deghan (Banisi and Deghan- performance of hydrocyclone, a test rig with
Nayeri, 2005). They concluded that there won’t 75 mm and 100 mm c onventional
be considerable change in the performance of hydrocyclones was designed and
266
MPT-2013
(a) (b)
269
MPT-2013
viscosity. As result, fine particles can’t be compensating by radial velocities. Which can
effectively transported to the overflow. be seen as sum of the forces is equal. Lower
values of RMS radial velocity refers to minimal
5. Numerical Simulations radial particle dispersion compared to higher
RMS radial velocity. This results to an increased
3 inc h c yc lone whic h is used for the
experimental studies is considered for the cut-size at increased inclination positions,
simulation studies. Sc hematic of the which inherently have higher RMS radial
hydroc yc lone and mesh used for the velocity values. The 450 inclination consistently
simulations is shown in Fig. 2. Grid with have higher tangential velocities and lower
RMS radial component, indicating the better
1,56,060 nodes used in the simulations. Air core
performance of cyclone compared any other
at low pressure centre region is resolved by
volume of fluid (VOF). Turbulence is modelled inclined positions. The basic reason beyond
using large eddy simulation (LES). The model this peculiar behaviour at 450 inclination yet to
equations and strategy for simulating air-core be resolved.
and flow field are similar to Narasimha et al
2006. Inlet is set to velocity and outlet has been
set to pressure boundary condition. A bounded
central differencing scheme is used to discretize
momentum equations. Pressure is solved by
using PRESTO. Quick is used to solve dispersed
phase transport equations. Fixed time step of (a) (b)
270
MPT-2013
the figure, it can be noted that the air-core size acrylic conical section with 16 electrodes
is reducing with respect to inclination. From 0 around the periphery used for the
to 45 degree inclination, air core size is reduced measurements two-phase concentrations, thus
and slight improvement at 60 degree. Air-core estimating the air core profiles and the effect of
position near the vortex finder and spigot inclination on the air core diameter. Qualitative
section is almost constant in all the inclinations. prediction of air-core shape by ERT at different
iii. Axial velocity and LZVV predictions inclinations is shown in Fig. 13.
(a) (b)
(a) (b) (c) (d)
Fig. 14 (a): Air core diameters measured by
Fig.12:CFD predicted (a) Axial velocities; LZVV CFD validated against ERT and Experimental
contours at (b) 00 (c) 300 (d) 450 (e) 600 inclinations video data (b) CFD predicted water split ratio
Axial velocities, LZVV contours predicted by compared to experimental data at different
CFD are shown in figure 12. From fig 12 (a) one inclinations
can observe that axial velocities predicted by Alternative technique used for the air core
LES-VOF model at 0 0 inclination is having diameter measurement is capturing a video and
higher veloc ities c ompared to other analysis through images. A digital camera,
inclinations. Sudden decrement is observed at having 14.1 mega pixel resolutions with 10X
300 and further increment up to 600 inclination. optical zoom (a Sony-G lens) at 30 fps at
From Fig. 12 (b, c, d, e) peculiar behaviour is 1280x720 pixels, is used for air-c ore
observed at 450 i.e. from 0 degree inclination visualization. A total of minimum 10 seconds
there is a lateral shift towards the centre. At (nearly 300 frames) air-core recorded video is
450 inclination the shift is towards the wall. converted into a number of images. Nearly 30
images are averaged (per sec basis) then
analyzed for air-core occupied diameters. The
averaged air-core diameter and its associated
(a) (b) (c) (d)
standard deviations are reported in Fig. 14 a.
Another validation is with respect to water
Fig. 13: Conductivity profiles of reconstructive split to underflow (Rf) is given in Fig. 14 b. From
images (Total Variation algorithm) at (a) 0 (b) the figure it can be observed that CFD predicted
30 (c) 45 (d) 60 degrees water split is following experimental trend
with small deviation.
6. Cross Validation
a. Radial dispersion Vs inclination
The simulation studies are validated against Roco demonstrated the significance of turbulent
Electrical Resistance Tomography (ERT) data, dispersion force in turbulent transportation of
High speed image analysis data. ITOMS ERT particles (Roco, 1996). This technique quantifies
271
MPT-2013
the importance of turbulent dispersion force of From the Fig. 15 a, it can be noted that fine
particles to motion of particles by gravitational particles (4m) are dominated by dispersion
force. He also defined dispersion index which is force. Therefore, the dispersion index of the fine
the ratio of dispersion to agglomeration energy particles is above 1 at all inclinations. As the
per unit time. In the hydrocyclone perspective particle size increases, separation is dominated
agglomeration energy c an be taken as by centrifugal forces (Fig. 13 b, c). Inclination
c lassification energy per unit time. 450 has peculiar effect i.e. dispersion is very low
Classification energy further can be expressed for all the particle sizes from fine to coarse. This
as classification force multiplied by particle is due to low RMS radial velocities (10 b).
diameter. Dispersion index can be defined as
7. Conclusions
2
u* r The effect of inclination on hydrocyclone
v i
I dis i performance is studied using CFD technique
d p ( m ) and experimental methods. Water only and
slurry based classification experiments and the
Where u* is RMS radial velocity, v i is mean
corresponding two-phase CFD simulations in
tangential velocity at a radius ri, dp is particle
3" and 4" diameter cyclones are carried out at
diameter, r, rm is particle and mixture density.
different inclined positions to the vertical plane.
Inc lination effec t on flow analysis of
Dispersion index hydrocyclone w.r.to mean and turbulent flow
S.No Remarks
value (Idis)
Separation is dominated field, water split, LZVV, air-core size and
1 Idis 1
by centrifugal forces position, and particle turbulent dispersion is
Particles are dispersed in made in detail. Water only, slurry volumetric
2 1 Idis 10
fluid
flow rates variation with inclination presented.
3 Idis > 10 Dispersion is main force
An improvement in the cut size with inclination
is observed at high feed solid concentrations
Dispersion index calculated for 4m, 28.29m, (28.76%, 50%). Enhancement of cut size is higher
63m particles is given in Fig. 13. From the Fig. with high pressures c ompared to low
15 a, b, c, it can infer that, separation is pressures. Inclination has very minimal effect
dominated by centrifugal forces towards the on the cut size at low concentrations. Dispersion
wall. Hence, there is reduction in the dispersion index is defined and the effect of inclination is
index.
(a) (b) (c )
Fig. 15: Dispersion index variation with inclinations for (a) 4m (b) 28.29m (c) 63m particles
272
MPT-2013
explained for fine to coarse particles. Peculiar Bradley, D., 1960. The Hydroc yc lones.
effect of 450 inclinations due to the low predicted Pergamon Press.
radial RMS veloc ities is responsible for Hochsheid, R. E., 1987. Horizontal Cyclone in
improved performance and lower cut-size Closed-Circ uit Grinding. Mining
compared any other inclined cyclone positions. Engineering. 262-266.
Air core size predic ted by CFD is cross- Johnstone, R. H., Rais, S. A., 1988. Increased
validated against image analysis data with a Performance Through Flash Flotation and
recorded video through plexiglass and ERT Cyclone Optimization, In 3rd Mill Ops.
data. Conf. Aus. Inst. Min. Met., Cobar. 79-84.
Narasimha, M., Brennan, M., Holtham, P. N.,
Reference 2006. Large eddy simulation of
Asomah, A. K., Napier-Munn, T. J., 1997. An hydrocyclone - prediction of air-core
Empiric al Model of Hydroc yc olnes, diameter and shape. International Journal
Inc orporating Angle of Cyc lone of Mineral Processing. 80 (1), 1-14.
Inclination. Minerals Engineering. 10(3), Orwe, D., Noreen, D., 1988. Horizontal Cyclone
339-347. Plant Trials at Bougainville, In 3rd Mill
Asomah, A.K., Napier-Munn, T. J., 1996. The Ops. Conf., Cobar, Aus. Inst. Min. Met. 71-
Performance of Inclined Hydrocyclones in 77.
Mineral Proc essing. In Proc . Roco, M. C., 1996. One equation turbulence
Hydrocycolnes ’96, ed. Claxton, S.a.T., eds. modelling of incompressible mixtures. N.P.
Mech. Eng. Pubs., Cambridge, London. 273- Cheremisinoff (Ed.), Encyclopedia of Fluid
287. Mechanics. 10, 1-68.
Banisi, S., Deghan-Nayeri, H., 2005. Effect of Rong, R., Napier-Munn, T. J., 2003. Development
angle of hydrocyclone inclination on cut of a More Efficient Classifying Cyclone.
size. Canadian Metallurgical Quarterly. Coal Preparation. 23(4), 149-165.
44(1), 79-84.
*******
273
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Sweta Kumari, V.K. Kalyani*, T. Gouri Charan, G.S. Jha and Amalendu Sinha
Central Institute of Mining & Fuel Research, Dhanbad – 826015, Jharkhand, INDIA
Abstract
In India, coal will continue to be the primary energy resource. Coal, the abundant fossil fuel, met
nearly the sixty percent of India’s total energy requirements. Because of high ash contained, Indian
coal reserved is mostly low quality with less calorific value and hence these coals are not much
suitable for utilization in steel industries. Due to mechanization of coalmines, the quantity of fine
coal generated has increased exponentially. Most effective method of removing inorganic impurities
from fine coals based on the concept of difference between the surface property of organic and
inorganic particles is oil agglomeration
Reported in the present paper are the results of the tests performed on finely ground middling’s of
coking coal using oil-agglomeration process in respect of the quantity and quality of the
agglomerates. The effects of important process variables of conditioning viz., conditioning time,
pH of pulp during conditioning and percent solids by weight in the pulp on the yield percent of
agglomerates were investigated in detail. On the basis of experimental data generated in respect
of all the above parameters, an attempt has been made to implement a three layer feed forward
artificial neural network (ANN) technique to simulate the process. The results indicate that
prediction from ANN model are in good qualitative and quantitative agreement with the
experimental results, thereby validating the accuracy of the developed model.
Keywords: Coal fines, Beneficiation, Oil agglomeration, Neural network, Back propagation
algorithm
1. Introduction promising method of “oil-agglomeration” has
been touted as a potentially effective method
Of the known processes for beneficiation of fine for agglomerating the coal fines, which is
coals below 500 microns is froth flotation. finding much wider applications now. In oil-
However, it suffers from some basic short agglomeration method, inorganic impurities
comings also, most important ones among are removed from fine coals based on the
which are comparatively lower yield and high concept of difference between the surface
moisture content of the beneficiated product property of organic and inorganic particles.
when most of the fines treated are below 76 Since the process of oil-agglomeration came
microns with high ash. Furthermore, the lower into the commerc ial applications, many
rank coal and also oxidized coal surfaces are improvements have been made to optimize the
unsuitable for flotation. In such cases, a very process parameters. Recently, Aslan ( 2009 ) has
improved the process by optimizing the
* Correspending Author:vkkalyani@yahoo.com
parameters that affect the agglomeration
274
MPT-2013
performance in the oil agglomeration process remarkable ability to derive meaning from
for whic h he used response surfac e complicated or imprecise data can be used to
methodology and quadratic programming and extract patterns and detect trends that are too
Kalyani, V.K.,et. al.,(2005) have reported the complex to be noticed by either humans or other
Optimization of a laboratory sc ale froth computer techniques.
flotation proc ess using response surface In the present paper, the effects of important
methodology. process variables viz., conditioning time, pH of
In yet another study, Aktas (2002) has studied pulp during conditioning and percent solids by
different fac tors effec ting spheric al weight in the pulp on the yield percent of
agglomeration performance of coal fines and agglomerates were investigated in detail using
Chary et al. (2010) have reported their findings three layer feed forward ANN technique. The
based on experimental conditions for recovery results indicate that predictions from ANN
of coking coal fines by oil agglomeration model are in good qualitative and quantitative
method. However, Valdes et al. (2007) have agreement with the experimental results,
proposed a method for prediction of the thereby validating the ac c urac y of the
agglomeration capability of waste vegetable developed model.
oils in relation to the recovery of coal from coal
fines cleaning waste. In recent years, Cebeci and 2. Experimental
Sonmez (2006) employed Box-Wilson 2.1. Materials used
experimental design method to evaluate the The following materials have been used during
effec ts of proc ess parameters on the the experimentation:
agglomeration of bituminous coal. Panda et al., 1. Middlings (-0.5mm) as basic raw
(2012) successfully applied ANN technique to materials having an ash content of 38.7
study the performance of jig for beneficiation percent.
of non-coking coal. The recent trend in the study 2. Diesel oil (sp. gr. 0.84) for conditioning the
of oil agglomeration technique is to model and pulp.
optimize process and design parameters of the 3. Furnace oil (sp. gr. 0.95) as agglomerating
agglomeration method. Of late, a powerful reagent of the conditioned pulp.
tec hnique used for modeling of oil 4. Petroleum ether to deoil the agglomerates
agglomeration process is artificial neural prior to ash determination.
network (ANN).
ANN has been used widely for dynamic process 2.2. Machine used
modeling where the development of i) Vertical cylindrical stirring vessel of 150
phenomenological or the empirical models mm diameter and 600 mm height equipped
either becomes impractical or cumbersome. with four longitudinal baffles of 12.5 mm
Neural Networks have recently become the width for conditioning.
center of interest largely due to their wide ii) Bench scale horizontal cell of 114 mm
domain of applications in highly nonlinear diameter and 920 mm length for
dataset (Kalyani, V.K., et al, 2008). Neural agglomeration.
network technique is highly suitable in solving
complex problems of mineral processing 2.3. Procedure
industry. ANN’s are based on the concept of The representative sample of middlings was
interconnected system of simple processing subjected to wet grinding in a batch ball mill.
elements (called neurons) that can develop The top size of the ground middlings for all the
c omplex nonlinear relationship between experiments was kept the same, at 100 meshes
independent and dependent variables (Kalyani, B. S. (152 microns). Pulp of 40 percent solids by
V.K., et al, 2008). Neural Networks with weight in the slurry was prepared. The pH of
275
MPT-2013
the pulp was adjusted to 8.5 and 2.0 percent possible from the historic process data only, i.e.,
diesel oil by weight of coal fines was added to without having the knowledge of process
the pulp, which was then thoroughly mixed phenomenology; approximation of even the
(conditioned) for 300 seconds in the vertical nonlinear, multiple input–multiple output
stirring vessel. The conditioned pulp was relationships can be simultaneously performed;
diluted to 20 percent solids by weight by adding
the model possesses a good generalization
water. The diluted conditioned pulp was then
ability, by the virtue of which it is possible to
agglomerated in a bench scale agglomeration
cell with the addition of 10 percent furnace oil precisely predict the outputs corresponding to
by weight of coal and stirring was continued a new set of process parameters which were
for another 300 seconds at 2100 rpm and then earlier not part of the data used for developing
stopped. The agglomerated products were the ANN model; and finally, even when any
separated from the unagglomerated residue relationship between the process parameters
using a sieve. The agglomerates thus obtained does not exist, the ANN has the capacity to
were dried and sized. A portion of agglomerates generate the relationship by ‘training’ the model.
was deoiled by petroleum ether. Ash percent of Because of these advantages, ANN models are
the oil free agglomerates were determined. being preferred over c onventional
Different tests were performed to find the effect mathematical techniques. The most widely used
of process variables of conditioning on the yield
neural network topology is the multilayer
of agglomerates at different levels of process
‘perceptron’ (MLP), which, by definition, is a
variables, which are listed in Table 1.
simple neural network consisting of input layer,
Table 1: Effect of process variables of condi-
output layer, and possibly one or more
tioning on the yield of agglomerates
intermediate layers of neurons. The perceptual
schematic s of multilayer perceptron are
Variables Levels Yield % of Agglomerates
Levels of conditioning oil dosage, depicted in Fig.1.
percent by weight of coal
1.5 2.0 2.5
Conditioning 60 45.9 47.83 47.73 y1 y2 yk yK
time (seconds) 180 54.67 58.20 58.59
300 58.45 63.24 63.41
420 59.07 63.28 63.72
1 2 k K Output layer
PH of pulp maintained 7.5 46.69 53.00 52.93
during conditioning 8.0 52.09 58.23 58.27
8.5 58.45 63.24 63.41
9.0 58.56 63.60 63.65
Percent solids by weight 20 50.92 56.86 56.57 Bias-2
in the pulp, (percent) 25 53.07 58.29 58.36 1 2 L Hidden layer
30 55.07 59.87 59.92
35 57.15 61.27 61.33
Bias nodes
40 58.45 63.24 63.41
Bias-1
45 58.53 63.65 63.69
1 2 n N Input layer
276
MPT-2013
transfer functions are used in neural network It is seen from this table that an optimal MLP
analysis. In the present study, the sigmoidal architecture obtained has three input nodes
function [28], represented by the equation (N=3), six hidden layer nodes (L=6), and two-
below, has been used: output layer node (K=2). A general and usual
1 dy feature of an MLP network with good function
y ( 0 ,1 ) ; y( 1 y ) (1)
1 exp( x ) dx approximation and generalization abilities is
Thus, in a multilayered ANN, each layer that it results in small but comparable root
consists of a number of neurons. Each neuron is mean squared error (RMSE) values for both the
connected to the neurons of the next layer by training set (Etrn) as well as the test set (Etst). The
‘weights’, which is simply defined as the MLP network developed in the present work is
strength of connection of one unit to another. in consonance with this characteristic feature,
The weights for each connection are initially as evidenced by the obtained small values of
assumed as random numbers. Once the ANN the ‘train’ and ‘test’ error.
structure is defined, the network goes to
‘training phase’ to obtain the relationship 72
67
between input and output variables through
62
57
26
25
25
24
24
23
22
277
MPT-2013
3. The c orrelation coeffic ient between Cebeci, Y., Sonmez, I., 2006. Application of the
predicted ash% and actual ash% is 0.95, box-wilson experimental design method for
which indicates that the ANN model has the spherical oil agglomeration of coal. Fuel,
the ability to explain the 95% of the total 85, 289-297.
variations of the system in case of ash%. Chary, G.H.V.C., Dastidar, M.G., 2010.
Optimization of experimental conditions for
5. Conclusions
rec overy of c oking c oal fines by oil
In this study, a three layer feed forward agglomeration technique. Fuel 89, 2317-2322.
artificial neural network model, which is Freeman, J.A., Skapura, D.M 1991. Neural
trained using back propagation algorithms has network algorithms. Applic ation and
been employed for modeling three process programming techniques, addition wisely,
parameters of the highly c omplex oil reading, M.A.
agglomeration process for beneficiation of fine Hagan, M.T., Demuth, H.B., Beale, M.H., 1996.
coals. Present work indicated that neural Neural network. PWS publishing, Boston
network could be successfully applied to the Hornik, K., Stinchcombe, M., White, H., 1989.
highly complex oil agglomeration process Multilayer feed forward networks are
incorporating three important variables, universal approximation . Neural network
which govern the oil agglomeration process. 2, 359-366.
Various network structures were tested to Kalyani V K , Pallavika, Gouri Charan T and
evaluate the predictive capabilities of the Choudhury S. 2005. Optimization of a
artificial neural network. The study indicates laboratory scale froth flotation process
that the artificial neural network having one using response surface methodology. 25,
hidden layer consisting of six neurons is the 141-153.
best network for prediction of the response Kalyani, V.K., Gouri Charan, T., Haldar DD,
variables. It is observed that the predicted Sinha A. Suresh N. 2008. Coal-fine
values obtained using ANN model are in very beneficiation studies of a bench-scale water
good agreement with the experimental values only cyclone using artificial neural network.
(R2 = 0.99 for yield % and R2 = 0.95 for ash %). As Int. J Coal Preparation and utilization. 28.
such the ANN modeling has great potential in 94-114.
Kalyani, V.K., Pallavika et al., 2008. Study of
significantly improving the oil agglomeration
laboratory scale froth flotation process
process performance. The present modeling of
using artificial neural networks. Miner.
oil agglomeration process for beneficiation of
Process. Extract. Metall. Rev.. 29, 130-142
fine coals has reaffirmed the excellent validity
Panda, L., Sahoo, A.K., Tripathy, A., Biswal, S.K.,
of ANN model of coal beneficiation in respect of
Sahu, A.K., 2012. Application of artificial
different variables, in that it has greatly help in
neural network to study the performance of
optimizing the process parameters for highest jig for beneficiation of non-coking coal. Fuel
yield%. 97, 151-156.
References Tholudur, A., Ramirez, W.F., 1998. System
modeling using neural network parameters
Aktas, Z., 2002. Some factors affecting spherical func tions. Applied mathematic s and
oil agglomeration performance of coal fines. computer science 8, 887-897.
Int. j. Miner. Process. 65, 177-190. Valdes, A.F., Azpiroz, M.D.G., Blanco, C.G.,
Aslan, N., Unal, I., 2009. Optimization of some Garcia, A.B., 2007. Experimental prediction
parameters on agglomeration performance of the agglomeration capability of waste
of Zonguldak bituminous c oal by oil vegetable oils (WVO) in relation to the
agglomeration. Fuel 88, 490-496. recovery of coal from coal fines cleaning
wastes (CFCW). Fuel 86, 1345-1350.
*******
278
MPT-2013
COAL PREPARATION
279
MPT-2013
280
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Keywords: Indian coal; sulphur; desulphurization; alkaline oxidation; ariel oxidation; FTIR-XRD.
281
MPT-2013
processes also increase the calorific value of 3286 (Table 6). The trace elements in coal and
coals. alkaline leachates were determined by Atomic
The main objective of this experiment is to Absorption Spectrophotometer (Model: Perkin
remove sulfur from high sulfur bearing coals Elmer; Analyst-700) (Table 5). The combustion
from Assam NE India by using atmospheric effic ienc y and energy of ac tivation was
oxidation in alkali medium. In this study, the calculated by using the method as reported
atmospheric air was used during alkaline (Table 4) (Khare et al., 2011).
oxidation of high sulphur coals. The effect of Table1: Physico- chemical characteristics of raw
time on the extent of organic and inorganic and oxidized coals (as received wt%)
sulfur removal was also determined. Sample M VM Ash FC TS PS SS OS
% Removals
Ash TS PS SS OS
Raw 2.49 43.08 3.27 51.16 3.43 0.47 0.56 2.39 -- -- -- -- --
AO-1hr 0.87 42.04 2.12 54.97 2.79 0.41 0.00 2.38 35.16 18.65 12.76 99.52 0.41
282
MPT-2013
The physico-chemical characteristics of the coal samples (Table 2 and Figure 2). The
raw and alkaline oxidized coal samples are absorption band in the region of 550 cm -1 is
given in Table 1. The ash removal of 35.16, 47.40, observed due to the stretching vibration of S-S
36.39 and 37.30% were observed for 1, 4, 5, and bonds of sulfide and C-S bonds in primary and
secondary thiols. However, the peak intensity
6 hrs respectively in the process. The effects of
is reduced for treated coal samples, which
alkaline oxidation on the removal of total sulfur
indicate the elimination of these groups. The
and forms of sulphur c ontents are also
bands at 3324, 1190, 1100- 400 cm-1 are assigned
presented in Table 1. It shows that alkaline to mineral matter present in these coals. The
oxidation leads to removal of considerable vibration bands in the region of 1415-1380 cm -
amount of total sulfur from these coal samples. 1
and 1200-1185 cm-1 are observed due to the
The total sulfur removals were 18.65, 29.15, presence of organic sulfur in coal. The stretching
30.61and 32.94 % respectively at 1, 4, 5 and 6 vibration in sulfoxides generally occurs in the
hrs. Moreover, the process could remove a range of 1070-1030 cm-1. The absorption band
maximum of 99.41, 59.57 and 11.71 % sulphate, for -SO2 in sulfones occur at 1350-1300 cm-1 for
pyritic, organic sulphur respectively from the asymmetrical vibration and at 1160-1120 cm -1
coal samples at different time intervals. for symmetric al vibration respec tively.
Thus, alkali oxidation in air has been observed Moreover, the intensity of S=O peak of the
to be a cost effective process for removal of all oxidized samples was found to be slightly
the forms of sulphur from coals and can be higher that of the raw coal sample indicating
utilized for low organic sulphur coals. The their participation during oxidation.
possible reactions behind the pyritic sulphur
and organic sulphur are as suggested [Baruah
and Khare, 2006; Fridman et al., 1977;
Mukharjee, 2003].
2NaOH + FeS2 Na2S + Fe OH2+S
Na2S+ 2H2O 2NaOH + H2S
RCH 2SCH 2R+2NaOH RCH 2O+R’
CH2O+Na2S+H2O 2RSSR + 4OH- 3RS- +
RSO2 +2H2O Figure 2: FT-IR Spectra of T2-Raw and oxidized
RSH +2NaOH Na2S +2H2O +R’CH=CH2O coals
Álkali may also react with sulfoxides and Table 2: FTIR peak assignment of coals
sulfones formed during oxidation as follows:
Wave No cm-1 Assignments Wave No cm- Assignment
1
283
MPT-2013
Table 4: Activation energy (Ea) and Table 6: CV and AFT of raw and treated coal
combustion efficiency (S) of raw and oxidized samples
coal samples Sample CV AFT0C
Kcal/kg
IDT HT FFT
Samples Ea KJ/mol S
T2- raw 7810 1210 1360 1460
AO-6hr -287.20 1.29645 x10-05 * CV: c alorific value; AFT: ash fusion
temperature; IDT: initial deformation
3.5 Trace element analysis of leachates temperature; HT: hemispherical temperature;
The trace elements in the final leachates were FFT: final flow temperature.
determined and shown in Table 5. It is observed
3.7 Effect of time
that the leachates contain the high amounts of
As with 0.070 ppm and 0.024 ppm respectively. The alkaline oxidization in air at different time
Arsenic are harmful and undesirable, which intervals (1, 4, 5 and 6hrs) shows that total
must be taken care before implementation of sulphur removal was increased with time. On
the process in industries. the other hand, the removals of other
Table 5: Trace element in alkali oxidized coal components remain more or less same with time
leachates (in ppm) (Table1).
Sample Al As Fe Cd Pb V K Mg Zn
AO-1hr 6.9 0.070 BDL BDL BDL 0.0097 0.00345 BDL 0.11
AO-4hr 9.4 0.024 BDL BDL BDL 0.0073 0.0013 BDL 0.05
3. Conclusions
3.6 Determination of calorific value and ash The results obtained explores the possibility
fusion temperature of removing sulphur from the North-Eastern
high sulphur coals in a low cost process by
The calorific values (CV) and ash fusion using the atmospheric oxygen and dilutes
temperature ranges (AFT) are very important NaOH solutions. The atmospheric oxygen is
indexes of any coal characteristics. The CV of inexpensive, so it is highly promising. The
the alkali oxidized coals were determined and proposed method is an effec tive way of
observed to be appreciably increased with the removing organic sulphur from any high
removal of sulphur components (Table 6). Ash organic sulphur coals. The TGA-DTG curve
with low fusion temperature causes serious indicates that burning quality of the coals is
problems during combustion in power plant. improved. The quality of coal is suitable for
The AFT of the alkali oxidized coals is also using in various industries like c ement
slightly increased from 1450 to 1500ºC during industries, steel industries, textile industries,
the process. Thus, qualities of the coals were railway industries, thermal plant etc. However,
found to be enhanced by the present process the disposal of liquid waste should be taken care
and it could be considered for application in of.
thermal plants. The difference in AFT could be Acknowledgements
attributed by these reasons: (a) –C-C- bond was
oxidized during the treatment; (b) part of the Authors are thankful to Director, CSIR-NEIST,
soluble organic was washed away when the Jorhat for giving permission to report the works.
coal was treated. Authors are also thankful to CSIR, New Delhi
for funding.
285
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
287
MPT-2013
to <50µm size for further benc h sc ale Rhodococcus rhodochrous and Pseudomonas
experiments. This coal sample was also tested aeruginosa were adapted on various
for pyritic sulphur, sulphate sulphur, organic concentrations of DBT and PDS in the range of
sulphur and total sulphur using the ASTM 1-75mM. Nutrient broth media were prepared
(D2492) method as depicted in Table-1. with DBT and PDS of different concentration as
Table 1: Sulfur content in Meghalaya coal a substrate for bacteria; the growth was then
quantified by cell growth.
Pyritic sulfur 0.15%
2.6. Biodesulfurization experiments
Organic Sulfur 1.69%
Sulfate Sulfur 0.40% Bio-desulfurization experiments were carried
Total Sulfur 2.25% separately to remove pyritic sulfur with
Meghalaya coal sample (size <50mm) as
2.3. Medium and chemicals substrate using L.ferrooxidans. Batch experiment
9K media used for isolation and cultivation of was performed in 9K media in respective to
pyrite degrading bacteria. Nutrient broth their growth using 10% (v/v) inoculum at 10%
medium (HIMEDIA) used for isolation and (w/v) pulp density of coal at 40ºC,unless stated
cultivation of organic sulfur utilizing bacteria. otherwise. Meghalaya coal of (size <50mm) was
Dibenzothiophene (DBT), Phenyl disulphide also subjected for bioremoval of organic sulfur
(PDS), was purchased from Sigma-Aldrich and at varying condition of pH 4-8, temperature 30-
Folin-Cioc alteau from Sisc o researc h 45oC and 10-30% pulp densities by using the
laboratories Pvt. Ltd. All chemicals were of pre-adapted strains. The flasks were incubated
analytical grade and commercially available. in a shaker at 100rpm at 40oC for 72 hours.
After 72 hours, solution in each flask is filtered
2.4. Optimization of growth parameters of
using a vacuum filtration unit. The leached
isolates
residue in the form of coal was washed 5 times
To determine the effect of pH and temperature using distilled water. The washed residue is
on bacterial growth, pH values was adjusted then dried at room temperature. This dried
to 1-10 and temperature was varied in range residue is then tested for pyritic sulphur,
30-45oC. Each medium was inoculated with an sulphate sulphur, organic sulphur and total
overnight c ulture (1% v/v) of the sulphur using the ASTM (2492) method.
microorganism and incubated in a shaker at
100rpm at 37oC for 48 h. At an interval of 24h, 3. Results and Discussion
representative aliquot of sample was collected 3.1. Optimization of growth parameters
from each flask and their O.D (Optical Density) It was observed that the amount of protein
was measured using spec trophotometer increased as their optical density increased after
followed by protein estimation. Lowry method 48 hours of incubation at different pH. After
was used to determine amount of protein inoculation of Pseudomonas aeruginosa, different
produced by the bacteria at different pH and optic al density values and protein
temperatures. concentration values were recorded at different
2.5. Adaptation of bacteria in different pH using UV-VIS spectrophotometer for 48h
concentration of various organosulfur and showed that the optical density and protein
compounds concentration were higher at pH 6.0. After 48h,
the optical density rose to 2.201 and protein
289
MPT-2013
290
MPT-2013
3.2. Adaptation of bacteria on organosulfur 3.3.2. Experiment for removal of organic sulfur
compounds
Pseudomonas aeruginosa adapted on 75 mM PDS
Bacterial strains were grown and maintained and Rhodococcus rhodochrous adapted on 75 mM
in nutrient broth medium. To show their of DBT were tested to remove organic sulfur
activity in presence of organic sulfur, the from coal on varying pH in range of 4-7, at 40oC
microorganisms were grown in nutrient broth temperature, 10% (w/v) pulp density.
medium in presence of synthetic organic sulfur Pseudomonas aeruginosa was able to remove 52%
compounds as substrate. Dibenzothiophene of organic sulfur from Meghalaya coal at pH
and phenyl disulphide were provided as sulfur 6.0. Other bacteria Rhodococcus rhodochrous was
source in the medium. Microorganisms were also able to remove 51% organic sulfur from
adapted on different concentration of these feed coal sample of Meghalaya at pH 6.0. The
organic sulfur c ompounds. Rhodococcus result for effect of variation of pH is shown in
rhodochrous was adapted up to 75mM Fig.8.
concentration of DBT and Pseudomonas aeruginosa While studying the effect of temperature (30-
was adapted up to 75mM concentration of PDS. 45oC), it was clearly seen that Pseudomonas
The adapted strains are currently being tested aeruginosa was able to desulfurize 19%, 36%, 52%,
for their potential ability to remove organic and 23% of organic sulfur at 30oC, 35oC, 40oC
sulfur from the coal. Adaptation efficiencies of and 45oC respectively. Whereas, Rhodococcus
microorganisms on different concentration of rhodochrous was able to desulfurize 23%, 37%,
organosulfur derivatives are depicted in Table- 50.66% and 24% of organic sulfur from 10% (w/
2. v) Meghalaya coal (size<50mm) at pH 6.0 in 3
days. The result of variation in temperature in
3.3. Results of bio desulfurization experiment desulfurization illustrated in Fig.9.
3.3.1. Removal of pyrite sulfur Mic roorganisms were also tested for
Bacterial strain L.ferrooxidans isolated from coal desulfurization at various pulp densities in
mines able to remove 51.4 % of pyritic sulfur range of 10-30% at 40oC, pH 6.0. Pseudomonas
from 10% (w/v) feed sample of Meghalaya coal aeruginosa could remove 52%, 22%, 18.19% of
(size<50mm) in presence of 9K medium at 40oC, organic sulfur by using 10gm, 20gm, and 30gm
in 3 days. of coal sample. Whilst Rhodococcus rhodochrous
Table 2: Growth of the bacteria on various could desulfurize 50.66%, 29.31%, 26.76% of
substrates as a sulfur source organic sulfur from 10gm, 20gm, and 30gm of
Meghalaya coal sample. It showed that as the
Substrate Rhodococcus Pseudomonas pulp density increases, the desulfurization
Concentration rhodochrous aeruginosa
efficiency decreased. At 10 % pulp density, the
DBT PDS DBT PDS
1 mM +++++ ++++ ++++ +++++ sulfur removal was maximum by using both
10 mM ++++ ++ ++ ++++ of the microorganisms separately are showed
50 mM ++ + + ++
in Fig.10. The final and best optimized results
75mM ++ - - ++
were obtained by using the all bacteria are
showed in Table 3.
+ indic ates extent of growth of bac teria
observed under microscope (1000X).
- indicates absence of growth of bacteria
observed under microscope (1000X).
291
MPT-2013
4. Conclusions
Fig. 8: Desulfurization of Meghalaya coal Newly isolated strain L.ferrooxidans was able
(size<50mm) from 10% (w/v) pulp density at to desulfurize the coal sample by degrading
various pH using PDS adapted Pseudomonas the pyrite. This strain was isolated and
aeruginosa and DBT adapted Rhodococcus grown in acidic medium and the metabolite
rhodochrous at 40oC in 3 days produced by this microorganism helps the
medium to keep its pH very low. Acidic
condition favored the breakdown of pyrite
from coal. L.ferrooxidans showed 51.4 % of
pyritic sulfur removal from feed coal
sample (<50m) at 400 C, pH 1.6-1.8 in 3
days.
Two microorganisms Pseudomonas aeruginosa
and Rhodococcus rhodochrous are already
established for desulfurization of organic
sulfur. Microorganisms were adapted to
Fig. 9: Desulfurization of Meghalaya coal
high concentration of different organic
(size<50mm) from 10% (w/v) pulp density at
sulfur compounds and then used for
various temperatures using PDS adapted
desulfurization was different in this
Pseudomonas aeruginosa and DBT adapted
approach. Both microorganisms could
Rhodococcus rhodochrous in 3 days at pH 6.0
tolerate high concentration of organosulfur
compound and also efficient to remove the
organic sulfur at their optimized condition.
Pseudomonas aeruginosa adapted in 75mM of
PDS and Rhodococcus rhodochrous adapted in
75mM of DBT were able to remove 52% and
51% of organic sulfur from 10% (w/v)
Meghalaya coal (size<50m) at 400 C, pH-
6. Adaptation in high sulfur compound
showed the efficiency of sulfur removal
from high sulfur coal of Meghalaya.
Fig. 10: Desulfurization of Meghalaya coal Testing the batch optimization studies in
(size<50mm) at various pulp densities using tandem as c ontinuous process could
PDS adapted Pseudomonas aeruginosa and DBT improve the overall efficiency of sulfur
adapted Rhodococcus rhodochrous at 40oC in 3 removal.
days at pH 6.0
292
MPT-2013
*******
293
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
294
MPT-2013
(a) any standalone thermal power plant located 2. Area description/ materials and methods
beyond 500km from pit-head;
2.1. Washability
(b)any captive thermal power plant with
installed capacity of 100 MW or above, and The washability is the ease of washing of coal. A
located beyond 500km from pit-head series of sink float test is carried out for
generating washability data. The washability
(c) any captive power plant above 100MW or
of a given coal sample is then determined with
standalone thermal power plant located in
the help of a series of curves showing the result
urban area or ecologically sensitive area notified
of sink float test. These are the curves providing
by Central Government or critically industrially
information about the easiness of washing of
polluted cluster or area irrespective of its
coal. Generally washability curves are used to
distance from pit-head expect any pit-head
determine washability characteristics of a given
power plant. Above mentioned draft further
coal sample.
strengthens the critical role of coal preparation
in thermal power industry. Coal is also an Washability Curves composed of following
essential input in the production of steel. India curves
has very limited reserves of coking coal which
1. Float/Yield Curve
is a key raw material for the production of steel.
2. Sink Curve
Coking coal accounts for only 15% of the
3. Characteristic Curve
country’s overall proven coal reserves. The
4. Densimetric Curve
Indian steel industry has been facing acute
5. NGM Curve
shortage of coal for the last several years.
Acceptable ash content in steel grade coal is 18% With the help of these curves, washability
which is much lower than the ash content of characteristics of a given sample of coal can be
Indian coking coal. So coal preparation is very c alc ulated. Washability c urves provide
critical for Steel Industry and Thermal Power information such as yield at a particular density,
Industry. Coal preparation is a technique to yield at a particular ash percent, cut density for
remove undesired inorganic matter from coal a particular yield and NGM. Washability data
by deploying various separation/up gradation also helps in estimating washability index,
processes, after communition which is able to washability number etc. which are indications
differentiate between the physical and surface of easiness of washing.
properties of the coal and the gangue. Hence coal 2.2. Mayer’s curve
preparation improves the productivity and
efficiency in the downstream processes. The Washability characteristics can also be
selection of the logical separation process for determined with the help of M- Curve. M- Curve
coal preparation is based upon sink float study is developed as an alternative to washability
on feed coal which is done at the laboratory curves which is less time intensive and fewer
scale. Through sink float study, washability calc ulations are involved. Mayer ’s Curve
characteristics of coal are being estimated by comprises of curve between cumulative weight
developing various washability c urves. percent of float and cumulative weight percent
Washability data gives basic information for of ash. M-Curve provides information such as
equipment/technology selection. Developing yield at a particular ash percent, middling ash
washability curves and other parameters etc. M-Curve can also provide information like
involves a lot of calculation and are time yield at a particular density, cut density for a
intensive. Therefore, Mayer’s curve, which is particular yield and NGM when cumulative
less time and calculation intensive, is introduced weight percent is plotted against specific gravity.
as an alternative to washability curves. Fundamentals of co-ordinate geometry are
required for Mayer’s Curve as interpretation
295
MPT-2013
from Mayer’s curve requires plotting different 2.2.2. Use of m-curve for the blended coal
straight lines and parallel lines.
For plotting the curve for blended coal and
2.2.1. Construction of the m-curve determining the separation density at which
For plotting M-Curve, the ash content of different two raw coals should be washed, these steps
gravimetric fraction in the sink and float test should be followed:
(Table-1) can be changed to the average ash
1. Connect equal density points on curves of
content of the coal sample to use in the “mean
raw coal samples A and B.
value polygon or M-Curve” (Fig: 1). This change
2. Divide the connected lines according to the
is done graphically or simply through use of
ratio of blending (blending point)
coordinates. The coordinates of different points
3. Connect the point of blending of connected
at the angle of the polygon can be calculated in
lines by a curve that represents the curve
Table-1. In Table-1, columns 1 and 2 present the
for 40:60 mixture of coal A and coal B.
weights (%) and ash content of different
4. Determine the separation density on blended
gravimetric fraction in the sink float tests. The
curve of A and B coals as well as the yield of
entries in column 9 are mathematical products
coal A and coal B at the separation density.
that result when values in column 1 and 2 are
multiplied and then divided by 100. Column 3 2.3. Comaprative study: washability curves
and 10 are cumulative of the values of column 1 versus m-curve
and 9, respectively. Columns 3 and 10 present
2.3.1. Detrmination of washability
coordinates of the angle point of the mean value
characterisitcs
polygon (Fig: 1). Usually, a centimetre scale should
be selected, so 1 cm is equal to 1% ash. When A comparative study is c arried out for
table-1 is constructed, the whole mathematical determining washability characteristics of a
basis for the M-Curve (Fig: 1) is available. given coal sample by washability curves and
Table 1: Washability data for three product M-Curve for a sink float data of a particular
washability studies sample. The aim is to determine washability
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
characteristics of a given coal sample subjected
Sp. Gravity
Sink Float
Differential %
Wt % Ash%
Cum. Float
Wt.% Ash%
Cum. Sink Cum. Float
Wt% Ash% Midpoint
NGM
Ash
wt%
Cum
ash
for three products washing i.e. clean coal,
1.30 0.93 4.79 0.93 4.79 99.07 38.28 0.47 0.04 0.04 middling and rejects. M-Curve (Fig: 1) and
1.30 1.35 7.42 8.14 8.35 7.77 91.65 40.73 4.64 0.60 0.65
1.35 1.40 10.36 12.18 18.71 10.21 81.29 44.36 13.53 39.58 1.26 1.91 washability curves (Fig: 2) are constructed using
1.40 1.45
1.45 1.50
10.91 17.73
10.89 22.72
29.62 12.98
40.51 15.60
70.38 48.49 24.17
59.49 53.21 35.07
39.37
35.09
1.93
2.47
3.84
6.32
given sink float data (Table-1). The desired ash
1.50 1.55 7.21 26.83 47.72 17.30 52.28 56.85 44.12 28.25 1.93 8.25 for clean coal is 20% and that of reject is 75%.
1.55 1.60 6.08 30.82 53.80 18.82 46.20 60.27 50.76 20.89 1.87 10.13
1.60 1.65 4.07 34.97 57.87 19.96 42.13 62.72 55.84 - 1.42 11.55 The yields of individual fractions i.e. clean coal,
1.65 1.70 3.53 40.44 61.40 21.14 38.60 64.76 59.64 13.87 1.43 12.98
1.70 1.80 6.27 46.95 67.67 23.53 32.33 68.21 64.54 13.47 2.94 15.92 middling and rejects and ash content of
1.80 1.90
1.90 2.00
7.20 52.02
4.70 59.05
74.87 26.27
79.57 28.20
25.13 72.85 71.27
20.43 76.02 77.22
11.90
25.13
3.75
2.78
19.67
22.44
middling are determined with the help of both
2.00 20.43 76.02 100.00 37.97 0.00 89.79 15.53 37.97 the curves. The ease of determining washability
characteristics and other parameters like yield,
middling ash are compared for the two curves.
Figure: 1 M-curve for three product washability Figure 2: Washability curve for three product
studies washability studies
296
MPT-2013
2.3.2 Washability characteristics of blended coal Table 2: Washability data for Coal-A
Coal A
Sp. Gr. Float Cum. Float Cum. Sink Cum. Float Cum.ash
Washability characteristics of sample obtained Sink Float Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Midpoint
NGM Ash wt%
Wt.%
1.40 11.00 12.72 11.00 12.72 89.00 52.26 5.50 1.40 1.40
from blending of two different coal samples are 1.40 1.50 14.05 27.65 25.05 21.09 74.95 56.88 18.03 32.45 3.89 5.28
1.50 1.60 18.40 37.62 43.45 28.09 56.55 63.15 34.25 24.25 6.92 12.21
also determined by using both washability 1.60 1.70 5.79 44.59 49.30 30.00 50.76 65.27 46.35 17.40 2.58 14.79
11.61 49.48 60.85 33.74 39.15 69.94 55.10 18.90 5.74 20.53
curves and M-Curve. The aim is to compare the 1.70
1.80
1.80
1.90 7.28 57.09 68.20 36.20 31.87 72.88 64.49 13.95 4.16 24.69
shows the M-curve for two raw coal samples A Table 3: Washability data for Coal-B
and B. These coals were washed separately to a Sp. Gr. Float Cum. Float Cum. Sink Cum. Cum.ash
NGM Ash wt%
required clean coal ash percent (29%) in a Sink Float Wt.%
20.01
Ash%
12.34
Wt.% Ash%
20.01 12.34
Wt.% Ash%
79.99 40.32
Float
10.00 2.47
Wt.%
2.47
1.40
separate washing system. The curves, A and B, 1.40 1.50 25.28 25.40 45.28 19.63 54.72 47.22 32.64 47.76 6.42 8.89
1.50 1.60 22.48 36.03 67.77 25.07 32.23 55.02 56.52 28.92 8.10 16.99
are intersected by reading line at 29% ash. The 1.60 1.70 6.38 42.16 74.20 26.52 25.80 58.31 70.96 14.61 2.69 19.68
1.70 1.80 8.23 49.01 82.37 28.79 17.63 62.48 78.31 12.27 4.03 23.71
intersection point indicates the relative yields 1.80 1.90 4.09 54.34 86.47 30.00 13.53 64.94 84.42 7.99 2.22 25.94
of 46.2% and 83.35%, respectively. With an 1.90
2.00
2.00
2.10
3.90
1.89
60.40
64.96
90.37
92.26
31.31
32.00
9.63
7.74
66.79
67.23
88.42
91.31
5.79
4.19
2.36
1.23
28.29
29.52
assumed mixture ratio of two raw feed coals 2.10 2.20 2.30
5.43
65.80
67.91
94.56
100.00
32.82
34.72
5.44 67.84 93.41
97.28
7.74 1.51
3.69
31.04
34.72
2.20
A:B = 40:60, a total yield of 68.9% can be
Table 4: Washability Data for blended coal
achieved. The separation density and relative
Sp. Gr. Float Cum. Float Cum. Sink Cum. Float Cum.ash
yields of both blended coal determined at ash Sink Float Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Midpoint
NGM Ash wt%
Wt.%
1.40 16.40 12.44 16.40 12.44 83.60 45.40 8.20 2.04 2.04
point of 29% with the help of M-curve and 1.40 1.50 20.79 26.01 37.19 20.02 62.81 51.84 26.80 41.64 5.41 7.45
washability curve ( Figure 3 and Figure 4) are 1.50
1.60
1.60
1.70
20.85
6.15
36.59
43.07
58.04
64.18
25.98
27.61
41.96
35.82
59.42
62.23
47.61
61.11
27.00
15.72
7.63
2.65
15.08
17.72
shown in table 6. The ease of determining 1.70 1.80 9.58 49.24 73.76 30.42 26.24 66.97 68.97 14.95 4.72 22.44
1.80 1.90 5.37 55.83 79.13 32.14 20.87 69.84 76.45 10.35 3.00 25.44
washability characteristics for blended coal is 1.90 2.00 4.99 61.43 84.12 33.88 15.88 72.48 81.63 8.16 3.06 28.50
2.00 2.10 3.17 67.37 87.29 35.10 12.71 73.75 85.71 6.05 2.14 30.64
compared for both the curves. 2.10 2.20 2.87 68.83 90.17 36.17 9.83 75.19 88.73 12.71 1.98 32.62
2.20 9.83 75.20 100.00 40.01 0.00 95.08 7.39 40.01
3. Results
3.1. Washability characteristics of a given coal
sample
It is evident from the Table-5 results from both
the c urves are in agreement. However,
developing washability curves require more
data and determining washability
c harac teristic s requires more c urves in
comparison to M-curve (Table-7). Moreover,
Figure 3: M-curves for coal A, coal B and middling ash cannot be read directly from
blended coal washability curves but can be calculated.
Table 5: Comparison of washability curves and
M-curve for washability study of a given coal
sample
297
MPT-2013
3.2. Washability characteristics of blended coal particular coal sample or blended coal sample.
Moreover, M-curve is less calculation intensive
The results shown in table 6 indicate that
and easier to plot whereas plotting washability
washability characteristics determined for
curves is tedious activity and calculation
blended coal from both the curves are in
intensive. M-curve also determines ash percent
agreement. However, washability study for
in middling whic h is not possible with
blended coal involves a lot of data calculation
washability curves. Hence utilising M-curve for
and developing washability curves (for blended
washability studies would be more preferable
coal). On the other hand complete washability
as it is less time consuming and requires fewer
characteristics can be determined with the help
data.
of M-curve which requires fewer curves and
data calculation (table-7). Acknowledgement
Table 6: Comparison of washability curves and The authors are grateful to the SGS management
M-curve for washability study of a blended coal for their encouragement to carry out the work.
sample
References
Results Washability Curves M-Curve Choudhary, A.S., Bhattacharya, S., Kumar, I.N.,
2012. Sink Float Tests of Coal: Sampling and
Clean Coal Yield 69.00 69.05 Washability Data Validation Issues.
International Mineral Processing Congress 2012.
Separation Density 1.63 1.64 Paper no. 240. Page no. 942-951.
Table 7: Comparison between number of curves Habetinejad, Hamidreza., Jorjani, Esmaeil., Sam,
required to predict washability characteristics Abbas., 2011. Evaluation of M-curve validity on
of a given coal sample with the help of feed blending at Zarand Coal Washery plant.
washability curves and M-curve. International Journal of Mining Science and
Washability Curves M-curve Tec hnology 01/2012; DOI:10.1016/
Parameters Curves Required Curves Required
Clean Coal Yield Float Curve M-curve
j.ijmst.2011.07.003
Middling Ash Cannot be directly read but can be calculated M-Curve
Reject Yield Sink Curve M-Curve Ministry of Coal, 2012.Draft notification G.S.R.
Separation density Float Curve, Densimetric Curve M-Curve, Densimetric curve
Boundary Ash Characteristic curve M-Curve
522(E), dated July11, 2012 in respect of use of
washed, blended or beneficiated coal in thermal
power plants for substitution to sub rule 3(8) of
4. Conclusion environment (Protection) Rules, 1986-reg
It is evident from that washability Osborne, D.G., 1988. Coal Preparation
characteristics determined from M-curve is Technology, Vol.1, Graham & Trotman Limited,
always in agreement with those determined London.
from the washability curves whether it is for
*******
298
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Heavy medium separation is a special case of gravity concentration in which a heavy media of
specific gravity between the heavier mineral and lighter mineral is used. The heavy material
sinks into the medium and lighter material floats. The effective separation depends on the various
factors such as concentration criterion, liberation, stability of media, type of separator, etc. Stability
of suspension is very important requirement for efficient separation of minerals and coals in close
specific gravity range. Slight change in the density of the media can lead to inefficiencies resulting
in poor separation of heavy material from the lighter ones thus degrading the grade of the final
product.
The stable composition of suspension is needed to ensure high accuracy heavy medium systems.
Preparation of ultralow-ash coal needs two stage similar density separations, it is necessary to
reduce the suspension condense in cyclone. Factors which affect suspension condense include:
centrifugal factor, suspension concentration, the density and size of heavy media. Various measures
are adopted to maintain the stability of the suspension of the solids. Size of the suspension particles
plays an important role in the stability. Present paper aims at covering various factors affecting
the stability of suspensions. Defining various terms such as stability, critical volumetric
concentration, limiting concentration, stability index, etc. Issues related to magnetite media,
ferrosilicon and other mediums will be discussed. The extent of variation of the density of a fairly
stable medium in different static and dynamic separators will be discussed. Effect of various
contaminants on the stability of the suspension. Various methods adopted at industry for
maintaining the suspension stable.
Keywords: Heavy medium separation; dense medium separation; media stability; stability of
suspension; heavy media; dense media; media stability issues.
299
MPT-2013
300
MPT-2013
Stability index or stability F5 index, also known and the theoretic al density of
as the measure of stability of suspensions, is separation;these influence hydrological
defined as the ratio of the weight of the properties of the partic les and hence
suspension between the first two tapping sharpness of separation and capacity of
points and the weight of the suspension below equipment
the third tapping point, on the standard - The separation density; it fixes the volume
apparatus under standard conditions. (Mikhail concentration of media solids making up
and Osborne, 1990) the suspension, which cannot be altered to
Rheology is the study of deformation and flow improve the stability. The variable with the
of matter. Suspension rheology refers to the operator in such case are limited i.e. mainly
deformation and flow of suspension. The the size, contaminant such as slimes etc.
rheological properties of suspension such as - Size, amount & mineralogy of products of
yield stress, effective viscosity and stability can ore under processing. These products
be inherent or acquired and influence the remain in Dense Media after washing and
hydrodynamics of particles to be separated and influence its rheology
hence influence the sharpness of separation. - Both adhesive properties of medium to
(Wikipedia)(Burt, 1984) separation products and retention of ore
Sharpness of separation (Ep) is generally fines in dense media separation circuit;
indicated by the tromp curve and is a measure influence medium loss and contamination.
of misplacement of near gravity material at the
specified cut density in the washer. It is also 3.2. Operational factors which influence
known as the probable error which is likely to hydrodynamics of particles and rheology
occur during the separation of material in the of suspension
dense media as result of misplacement, i.e. the o The rate of shear due to flow and
amount of float material reporting to sink and agitation of suspension
vice versa. o Method and rate of feeding
A dilatant (also known as shear thickening) o Method of product discharge
material is the one in which viscosity increases o The applied field of force (gravitational
with the rate of shear strain. A dilatant fluid is and centrifugal)
a non-Newtonian fluid in which the shear 3.3. Physical and mineralogical characteristics
viscosity increases with applied shear stress. of medium (magnetite) which influence
It is controlled by factors such as particle size, suspension rheology, medium recovery
shape and distribution. (Wikipedia) and product contamination
3. Rheology and Dense Medium Separation o Size
o Shape
There are several factors which affect the o Size distribution
rheology of dense medium separation. These o Density of medium
factors can be categorised for simplification.
3.4 Physical properties of medium which
(Burt, 1984)
influence rheology of suspension and
3.1. Feed Characteristics based factors which
recovery of medium (magnetite)
influence rheology
- Liberation size and size range of the feed, - Surface energy; it quantifies the disruption
the density difference between the minerals of intermolecular bonds that occur when a
surface is created or it can also be said that
301
MPT-2013
304
MPT-2013
densities (1400-2000 kg m -3) (Graham and fraction of solids in water to achieve high
Lamb, 1988). densities. The rheology of ferrosilic on
As mentioned earlier, the remnant magnetism suspension c an be best desc ribed by its
in magnetite partic les may result in the visc osity and stability. The visc ous
formation of aggregates. This magnetic characteristics of dense medium are generally
aggregation increases the settling rate of the non-Newtonian and the term apparent
medium. The effect of aggregation depends on viscosity (at defined shear rate) is preferred to
the strength of the magnetic force which is describe it. An ideal medium has low viscosity
specific to the sample. The effect of magnetic to maximise separation and pump efficiency. A
aggregation on the medium stability in higher viscosity is undesirable as it reduces the
dynamic separators is not c lear. Some veloc ity of the mineral partic les being
investigators believe that dynamic separator separated, inc reasing the c hanc e of
will break up the aggregates and reduce such misplacement and reducing the separation
effects. Graham and Lamb, 1988, found that efficiency. A low viscosity is typically obtained
shearing a suspension of magnetic ally for a low medium density, coarse particles,
aggregated partic les had little effec t on smooth rounded partic les, and c lean
subsequent settling results and concluded that uncontaminated medium.
either shearing did not break the aggregates or Ferrosilicon is an alloy if iron and silicon, with
the aggregates quickly reformed. Therefore it is a specific gravity of 6.8-6.9, is widely accepted
highly recommended to install a demagnetizing as most suitable medium for ore separations in
coil after magnetic separation in dynamic the range of 2.5 to 4.0 Kg L-1. Ferrosilicon
process. contains silicon in the range of 14 to 16 % to
The effect of variety of dispersing agents on have the optimum combination of properties.
medium settling properties shows that they did If the silicon content is lower than 14 %, then
not significantly influence the stability of pure the specific gravity and magnetic properties are
suspensions. They have, however, been shown improved, but resistance to corrosion decreases
to affect significantly the settling properties of rapidly. On the other hand, above 16% corrosion
the dense medium containing clays. Aplan and properties are not significantly improved, but
Spedden (1964) found that sodium the magnetic properties and specific gravity
hexametaphposphate was effec tive in deteriorates. (Collins et al. 1974).
dispersing clay which lowered the structure The shape of ferrosilicon particles depends on
and resulted in higher settling rates. The the manufac turing proc ess. There are
dispersant reduce the medium viscosity. Since essentially two forms of ferrosilicon available;
clays such as bentonite and kaolinite can be milled and atomised. Production methodology
added to dense medium to improve stability, for both types are different.
the addition of dispersing agents can be used to Production method of milled ferrosilicon is to melt
control their effects on medium viscosity. steel scrap, quartz & a reductant is submerged
into a sand-bed, allowed to cool and then
8. Stability of Ferrosilicon Dense Medium
broken into lumps. After which it is crushed in
Suspensions
two stages and milled to required size range.
Ferrosilic on is used for high density While, for atomised ferrosilicon, the molten alloy
applications (medium density: 3200-4200 kg m- from the furnace is steam atomised and water
3
). A ferrosilicon suspension must have large quenched. Atomised ferrosilicon consist largely
of round particles & results in lower viscosity
305
MPT-2013
pulps; permitting higher separation densities (magnetite and ferrosilicon). Detailed study
to be obtained. needs to be carried out with generation of
The limiting density of milled ferrosilicon is 3.3 sufficient data on the effects of particle size
kg L-1, whilst that of atomised ferrosilicon can distribution, particle shape, pH or dissolved
be as high as 3.9 Kg L-1 (Voges, 1975). Ferrosilicon ions. To achieve good stability and rheological
can be mixed with magnetite for lower density properties in dense media, it is recommended
separation in the range of 2.2 to 2.9 Kg L-1. to use fine magnetite for low media densities
Corrosion of ferrosilicon can cause high losses and large particles for high media densities.
and degradation of the medium which leads to More detailed information concerning particle
increased viscosity. However, few investigator interaction effect may assist in determining
consider this drawback as advantage when optimum particle sizes for specific media
pure ferrosilicon is used, since the slowly densities.
degrading ferrosilicon makes up for the fine
References
medium particles lost in tailings of magnetic
separation, thus avoiding the need for addition Berghofer, W., 1959, “Konsistenz and
of fresh fine media solids. But Chasten (1973), schwertrubeaufbereitung”,
noted that harder ferrosilicon abrades softer Bergbauwissenschaffen, 6 (20), 493-504,
magnetite, causing more medium loss. The 533-541.
addition of a mixture of borax and sodium Bernhard, Klein, 1985, Rheology and Stability
nitrate to the medium, does, however of Magnetite Dense Media, B. A. Sc., UBC,
essentially overcome the corrosion problem. PhD thesis.
Although atomised ferrosilicon is considered Chasten I.R.M., (1973). Heavy media cyclone
more expensive than milled ferrosilicon, its plant design and practice for diamond
higher density and lower viscosity can result recovery in Africa. 10th Inter. Miner. Proc.
in a more effic ient operation with lower Cong. Inst. Min. & Metall. London 257-276.
medium losses. Collins, B., Napier-Munn, T.J., and sciarone, M.
Stability is related to rheology of solid phase in (1974). The production properties and
an environment constituted by liquid phase. selection of ferrosilicon powders for heavy
The relative movement of solids in liquid phase media separation. J.S.Afr. Inst. Min. & Metall.
under mass and surface forces determines the 74 Dec103-119.
degree of homogeneity of suspension. The De Vaney, F.D., Shelton, S.M., 1940, “Properties
medium stability determines the density of suspension Mediums for Float and Sink
gradient of the medium in the separation zone concentration”, USBM RI-3469R, 66pp.
and thus directly influences the separation Graham, C.C., Lamb,R., 1982. “Coal
sharpness. An ideal medium density has a high Preparation-Dense Media rheology A
stability, which results from high medium review of measurement and control”.
densities, fine medium particles, irregularly ACIRL P.R.-82-3, 53.
shaped particles and presence of low density Greenspan, H.P., Ungarrish, M., 1982, “On
contamination (clay/ ore slimes). hindered settling of particles of different
sizes”, Int. J. Multiphase Flow, 8(6), 587-604.
9. Conclusions
http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/dilatant
For obtaining sharp separation of minerals and
coal using dense media separation it is very http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/
important to maintain the stability of media Newtonian_fluid
306
MPT-2013
*******
307
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
308
MPT-2013
of organic sulphur from coal requires high 2.3. Two-step sequential leaching
temperature and pressure conditions. Such After optimization studies, Meghalaya coal
methods are deficient in selectively and unable were subjected to microbial desulphurization
to preserve the calorific value of coal. in an innovative two-step sequential leaching
The organic sulphur portion of coal is made up method in order enhance desulphurization
from various thiophenes, benzothiphenes, from the coal sample. The same size fractions
thiols sulphides, disulphides and about 70% as used during the preliminary optimization
dibenzothiophene whic h is rec alc itrant. studies were subjected to a two-step sequential
Dibenzothiophene is finely distributed in the microbial treatment. In the first step, the coal
c oal matrix and requires more invasive sample was treated with bacterial isolate
techniques for its removal from coal. In the Sinomonas flava 1C for removal of organic sulfur.
present study, native microbial species were About 30 g of coal was added to 600 ml of MSM
investigated for the removal of sulphur from media at 5% (w/v) pulp density in 1 L flasks.
coal. Coal from Meghalaya region of North After inoculation with 10% (v/v) of overnight
Eastern India have high sulphur content and grown bac terial culture, the flasks were
selected for desulphurization purpose. All the incubated at 35 oC, 150 rpm in an orbital shaker.
native microbial strains were screened for The initial pH of the medium was maintained
dibenzothiophene degradation and the efficient at 6.9±0.2. After 7 days, the coal was recovered
strains were further employed for c oal by filtration. The second step involved the
desulphurization. Various process parameters sequential microbial treatment of the same coal
were optimized for carrying desulphurization sample used in the first step using A. ferrooxidans
experiments and both bacterial and fungal strain for the removal of pyritic sulphur. For
species were used to remove sulphur from coal. the growth of A. ferrooxidans, 9K + medium
2. Materials and Methods containing 3 g/l (NH4)2SO4, 0.1 g/l KCl, 0.5 g/l
MgSO 4.7H 2O, 0.5 g/l KH 2PO 4 and 44.2 g/l
2.1. Coal sample
FeSO4.7H2O was used (Silverman et al., 1959).
Coal sample was collected from Meghalaya Coal For this experiment, the biodesulphurized coal
mine situated in North-eastern region of India. from the first step was added to 600 ml of 9K-
The coal was grinded and sieved to obtain medium (9K media without ferrous sulphate)
different size fractions. The size fractions used inoculated with active A. ferrooxidans culture
in the present study were (a) -1mm + 850 ìm (b) (10% v/v), incubated at 35oC and 150 rpm. The
– 500 ìm + 300 ìm, and (c) -150 ìm. pH of the medium was maintained at 1.8±0.1.
After 7 days, the coal samples were recovered
2.2. Isolation and screening of efficient
by filtration and dried prior to analysis of
microbes
sulphur.
Water and soil samples were collected from
various coal contaminated sites of Marghetteta
coal mines. Enrichment of microbes was carried
out using dibenzothiophene as the sole sulphur
and carbon source in MSM media (Mineral Salt
Media) composition. One of the isolate,
identified as Sinomonas flava 1C, showing
maximum desulphurization capabilities was Fig. 1: Two-step sequential leaching using
selected for further study. bacteria 1C and A.ferrooxidans
309
MPT-2013
310
MPT-2013
It was therefore c lear that the two step- from the acidic pH of 2.0 ( used for growth of A.
sequential biodesulphurization method using ferrooxidans).
native bac terial isolate S.flava 1C and Table 3: Coal composition analysis of original
A.ferrooxidans is beneficial towards enhanced and microbially desulphurized coal samples
desulphurization from the coal sample.
Sulphur in coal Original Sulphur in treated coal with ‘S’ ‘S’ Removal %
Table 2: Effect of Sequential Leaching on (%) Coal S. flava 1C S. flava 1C+Af Removal / from total sulphur
microbial desulphurization of coal (conditions Total (ST) 6.17 3.69 3.09 3.08 50
Organic (SO) 4.7 3.04 2.57 2.13 35
- incubation time 6 days; pulp density 5%) Pyritic (SP) 0.35 0.35 0.25 0.1 1.6
Sulphate (SS) 1.12 0.3 0.27 0.85 13.7
Initial
Sulphur content after treatment Table 4: Detailed comparison of original and
Size S. flava1C A. ferrooxidans Total S
fraction
Sulphur
After %S Before After %S Removal microbially desulphurized coal samples
%
Leaching Removal Leaching Leaching removal
-1 mm, % (W/W)
6.9 6.00 13 6.00 5.64 6 18.26
+850 µm Treated coal
Components Original
-500 +300 S. flava 1C+
6.17 3.69 40 3.69 3.08 16.5 50.05 coal S. flava 1C
µm A. ferroxidans
-150 µm 6.8 4.01 41 4.01 3.24 19 53 Proximate analysis of original and treated coal
Ash 7.7 7.43 3.18
Fixed Carbon 37.9 38.95 37.66
3.3. Effect of microbial desulphurization on Moisture 6.53 4.95 4.71
coal characteristics Volatile 47.87 48.67 54.45
towards removal of both organic and pyritic Sulphur 5.52 3.49 2.79
form of sulphur from the coal, whic h is Oxygen 11.26 11.21 10.95
P
A. ferroxidans treated coal valuable information
P Q
were obtained (Table 4). Ash content of 7.7% in P P
Q
C1+ A ferrooxidans
Q
the original sample had marginally reduced Original Meghalaya Coal
311
MPT-2013
environmental threat. After reduc tion of (Project GAP-220). Authors are also grateful to
sulphur the coal may be used for various their respective Head of Departments for their
applications. A native bacteria isolated from cooperation and permission to carry out the
high sulphur coal mines and identified as S. flava study.
1C was capable of removing about 40 % of
sulphur from coal sample bearing 6.17 % total References
Sulphur. A sequential leaching with S. flava 1C Acharya, C. Sukla, L. B., Misra, V. N., 2005.
and A. ferrooxidans was capable of removing Biological elimination of sulphur from
about 50 % of sulphur under optimum condition high sulphur coal by Aspergillus-like fungi.
decreasing the total sulphur content of coal to Fuel. 84, 1597-1600.
about 3.09 %. In the present study calorific Acharya, C., Sukla, L. B., Misra, V. N., 2004.
value of coal increased from 26,208 J/g to 29,481 Review: Biodepyritisation of coal. J. Chem.
J/g which shows that coal energy value is not Technol. Biotechnol. 79, 1-12.
adversely affec ted by the process. It is Achi, O. K., 1994. Growth and coal solubilizing
important to achieve high sulphur reduction activity of Penicillium simplicissimum on coal
keeping intact the combustion parameters. related aromatic compounds. Bioresour
Thus biodesulphurization with bacteria S.flava Technol. 48, 53-57.
1C and A. ferrooxidans may be used for removal Afferden, V. M., Tappe, D., Beyer, M., Truper,
of sulphur from high sulphur Meghalaya coal. H.G., Klein, J., 1993. Biochemical
A biotec hnologic al solution for mechanisms for the desulphurisation of
desulphurization of coal would lead to a green coal relevant organic sulphur
technology with least environmental pollution compounds. Fuel. 72, 635-643.
and availability of low ash -low sulphur coal. Pandey, R. A., Raman, V. K., Bodkhe, S. Y., Handa,
Acknowledgement B. K., Bal, A. S., 2005. Mic robial
desulphurization of c oal c ontaining
Authors are thankful to Ministry of Steel, pyritic sulphur in a continuously operated
Government of India for financial support bench scale coal slurry reactor. Fuel. 84,
81–87.
*******
312
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Normally supervised methods are able to comprehend and classify labelled data which is more
expensive and time consuming than unlabelled ones. Also supervised methods are suitable for
classifying only labelled data but not unlabelled data. Consequently, semi-supervised learning or
classification performs better while learning from a combination of labelled and unlabelled
datathan using the labelled data alone.In this methodunlabelled data is classified by cluster
assumption.So it has attracted many attentions during the last decade.
In this paper semi supervised method has been tested by introducing cluster concept to supervised
methodology of ANFIS. Basically the result of carbonation test of different coal blendhas been
chosen as platform for this study. Functional relationship between input parameters as coal
blend properties and output parameters as CSR has been developed in supervised mode of ANFIS
by taking input and output randomly.Thereafter fuzzy c-means clustering has been invoked for
making a choice of input and output in cluster wise rather than random choice. As far as the
outcome is concerned, correlation coefficient indicates the superiority of clustered choice to random
choice of data.
There are number of techniques prevalent in technical community to optimise number of fuzzy
rules in ANFIS. Singular value decomposition (SVD) has been implemented. Its choice has been
compared to existing manual technique for number of fuzzy rules determination.
314
MPT-2013
2.2. Fuzzy c-means clustering picked up as a test set and remaining fifty
constitute the training set.
A given set of objects characterized by a set of
features are partitioned into a suitable number 2.3. SVD based QR decomposition method
of clusters with a proper distance metric by Singular Value decomposition (Yen and Langari,
c lustering tec hnique. Among different 2003) of matrix of dimension is
clustering techniques Fuzzy c-means used to
obtained as A UV T . QR decomposition
assign crisp membership values to partitioned
with column pivoting factorisation algorithm
objects. The membership value can be anything
between 0 and 1. Fuzzy toolbox of Matlab 7.0 is applied on to keep number of rules by
has been used for said clustering. removing rules. U ltimately
Always number of cluster prevailing in input permutation matrix is computed to select
dataset is one parameter to be known before number rules .
clustering. Among different methods within
3. Results and Discussion
cluster distance along with it’s first, second
order derivative prove to be successful (Hu and Carbonization tests have been conducted under
Dennis, 1994). stamp c harging c onditions on seven kg
Within-cluster distance, WTK is defined as electrically heated laboratory scale test oven
(Dash et al., 2005) by keeping operating
K
1 parameters like bulk density, oven temperature,
WTK
N
D C
k 1 tg k
k , Xt
moisture, granulometry and carbonization
where g1 ,..., g K is a K group (c luster) time constant for all the tests. The different
partition of the full source data set containing c ompositions of c oal blend have been
N objects, C k , is the cluster centre of g k and formulated for each experiment. For each
X t ,is an object in one of the clusters. experiment, ash, volatile matter, average
DC k , X t is the metric measuring the vitrinite reflectance, total reactives, vitrinite
distance between an object and its cluster distribution (V 9 – V 13 ), cruc ible swelling
centre. number, basicity index and the coke CSR
For fixed number of clusters, any clustering properties of differently composed coal blend
method tries to cluster X in K groups by have been recorded.
minimizing WTK . As due to nonlinear nature
of iterative updation process in fuzzy c-means,
global optimum partition may not be
reached(Hu Y. and Dennis T., 1994). The true
cluster number is indicated by the elbow of
WTK/K curve as seen from Figure 2. First and
second difference of WTK/K curve are often used
to ascertain the elbow. From the entire curve as
shown below, true cluster number has been
Cluster numberNumber
determined to be equal to eight.
Followed by clustering the entire data set into Fig. 2: Plot for
WTK versus number of clusters
eight groups, seventeen data sets uniformly K
315
MPT-2013
316
MPT-2013
*******
317
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
India’s energy sector is primarily dependent on coal which is the abundant indigenous resource.
Such dependence on coal is going to continue in the foreseeable future. Indian coals, which are of
Gondwana origin, contain high ash wherein the extraneous material was intimately mixed in the
coal matrix during the formation stage, causing a high level of impurities in the run-of-mine
(ROM) material. These coals possess difficult to very difficult washability characteristics.
Beneficiation of high- ash non-coking coals of India has become the prerequisite for improving the
overall economics and efficiency of power generation. The state of Odisha contains approximately
23% of India’s reserves of non-coking coal. This paper describes the washability characteristics of
non-coking coals from the Ib Valley Coalfields of Odisha aiming at 34% ash level in the clean coal
as per the stipulations laid by environmental gazette notification of Govt. of India. Conventional
float – and - sink testing was carried out to determine the theoretical yield of clean coal at 34% ash
content. The washablity data was used for prediction of practical yield which may be achievable
by using a Jig washer. Based on the simulated results a conceptual flow sheet was developed.
1. Introduction w.e.f. June 2001. Comparatively high levels of
Indian coals are of Gondwana origin, which are ash in Indian coal causes concern both in terms
inferior in quality. The characteristics of these of the high costs of coal movement and the
coals differ significantly from other coals of associated environmental impacts. The high-
Gondwana origin, partic ularly in their ash coals without any beneficiation are directly
chemical and petrographic makeup, which fed to the majority of the power plants in India.
have direct bearing on their utilization The state of Odisha contains approximately
potential. Most of the non-coking coal produced 23% of India’s reserves of non-coking coal, and
in India has high ash content (40-45 percent on the major supplier is Mahanadi Coalfields
an average) and the users are unhappy with limited (MCL). The state has two major
the quality. Govt. of India has promulgated a coalfields, namely Talcher coalfields and Ib
Gazette Notification (GSR 560(E) & 378(E), dated Valley coalfields. The state is the main supplier
September 19, 1997 and June 30, 1998 of coal to the various thermal power stations
respectively) on use of beneficiated/blended in the Southern part of India, which are at a
coal containing ash not more than 34 percent distance upto 1000 kms and in case of some
318
MPT-2013
plants even more. One of the major problems sample was subjected to dry screen analysis at
in the power sector is the varying and high- sizes 50, 25, 13, 6, 3 and 0.5 mm. The size
ash content in the ROM coals averaging above distributions of coal crushed to minus 75 mm
45%. The stipulation laid by the Ministry of are shown in Table 2. The individual size
Environment and Forest (MOEF), is posing fractions were subjected to float – and - sink
problems to MCL for the despatch of its coal to tests, and the relative density range was 1.40
the power plants situated in the Southern part to 2.00. The minus 0.5 mm coal fractions were
of India. The only solution to this problem not subjected to float-and- sink tests
appears to be setting up of coal wasaheries to Table 2: Size analysis of coal crushed to 75mm
reduce the ash content. Keeping this in view, of all the coal samples
detailed investigations on washability
characteristics for Ib Valley coals was carried. Size, mm
IB-SOCP
Wt. % Ash%
IB-BAS
Wt. % Ash%
IB-LAJ
Wt. % Ash%
IB-BEL
Wt. % Ash%
The paper highlights the detailed findings with 75 - 50
50 - 25
32.5
30.8
59.4
56.6
52.9
22.0
54.9
54.7
31.1
32.4
47.5
46.1
34.1
33.4
54.4
54.4
respect to washability tests on coals collected 25 - 13
13 - 6
13.8
9.0
52.1
48.9
11.0
5.5
57.0
56.5
15.3
9.1
44.0
41.4
12.6
7.8
53.0
51.6 1.
6 – 0.5 10.1 46.3 6.3 55.4 9.2 34.0 8.5 49.5
from four major sources. The paper suggests a - 0.5 3.8 55.5 2.3 62.0 2.8 40.0 3.6 54.0
100.0 40.8 100.0 55.4 100.0 44.5 100.0 53.6
suitable flow scheme for beneficiation of the
3. Results and Discussions
non-coking coal.
It may be seen from Table-1 that all the coal
2. Experimental
samples contain very high ash percent. It may
The coal samples were collected from the be seen from Table -2 that when the raw coal
working benches with the help of a Haulpack was crushed at 75 mm, the ash distribution is
and payloader, by scraping the entire cross almost uniform in all the size fractions and
section of the bench at various places from each further is may be noticed that the ash percent
of the collieries. After proper and thorough of the fraction below 6mm is also on the higher
mixing, about 10 tons of sample from each side and hence this fraction also needs washing
colliery were collected and brought to the to the required ash level.
laboratory for further studies.
Source Cut Density Cleans Rejects
Table 1: Proximate analysis of coal crushed to Wt% Ash% Wt% Ash%
IB - LAJ 1.725 54.5 33.8 45.5 57.5
75mm of all the coal samples IB - SOCP 1.785 50.9 33.8 49.1 75.6
IB - BEL 1.675 43.1 33.7 56.9 67.3
Parameters IB-SOCP IB-BAS IB-LAJ IB-BEL IB - BAS 1.725 46.9 34.0 53.1 73.8
Moisture, % 8.2 6.9 7.0 7.5
Ash, % 20.4 19.7 21.5 20.4 Hence for studying the cleaning possibilities for
Volatile Matter, % 50.8 51.8 42.0 49.8 achieving 34% ash content in the clean coal the
Fixed Carbon 20.6 21.6 29.5 22.3
100.0 100.0 100.0 100.0 combined washability data generated for the
dry ash% 55.3 55.6 45.2 53.8 size frac tion 75 – 0.5 mm was used and
The raw coal was taken and first screened at 75 accordingly the theoretical yield% at 34% ash
mm; the plus 75 mm fraction was crushed in a content was estimated and the data is shown
single roll crusher. Representative samples in Table – 3.
from the overall combined fraction of the It may be seen from Table - 3 that the theoretical
product below 75 mm was taken for studies yield at 34% ash content for the coal sample IB-
like raw coal characterization, size analysis and LAJ is 54.5%, for IB-SOCP it is 50.9%, for IB-BEL
size wise float and sink tests. The raw coal was it is 43.1% and for IB-BAS it is 46.9%.
characterized with respect to proximate and The theoretical yields as mentioned above may
the data is shown in Table 1. Representative not be achievable in actual plant practice due
319
MPT-2013
to dynamic system of the washers. The practical a. Run of Mine coal from the open cast mines
yield to be obtained from the commercial plants may be fed to a primary crusher to crush
varies in quality and quantity depending on the ROM coal down to 200 mm. The crushed
the efficiency of the washing system. However, coal – 200 mm may be conveyed for further
it is possible to predict the yield of the clean crushing.
coal at desired quality considering the normal b. The – 200 mm coal may be screened by
efficiency values of the washers by taking the using a vibrating screen of aperture 75 mm.
concept of Gaussian equation. The partition The + 75 mm coal may then be crushed
data represents the fraction of the feed in a down to below 75 mm in a single roll
density interval which goes to the clean coal crusher. The coal of below 75 mm size may
and d50 is the density at which the 50% of the be conveyed to a raw coal surge bin.
feed in that density that goes to the clean coal. c. The fraction i.e., 75 - 0 mm may be washed
The parameters derived from the partition/ in a Jig. The Jig may produce 2 products –
Tromp curves are the a) Relative density at the washed coal and rejects. Rejects will be
cut point ‘d50’; b) Ecarte Probability Moyen dewatered on perforated bucket elevators.
‘Ep’; c) Imperfection T d) Error area. In general Dewatered rejects will be conveyed by
the partition c urves are spec ific to the means of belt conveyor to rejects stockpile.
separation units for which they are established Washed coal from jig shall be dewatered
and are independent of the density and blended with – mm fraction to get total
distributions of the feed and depend on size cleans
composition, feed rate and other operating d. The rejec ts may be used for power
conditions. generation through FBC route.
It was assumed that the quantity of misplaced Fig. 1: Flow Sheet for Beneficiation of IB-SOCP
material decreases exponentially with the
increase in difference between its specific
gravity (X) and the specific gravity of cut (X*).
y(X) = 100-50exp[(X-X*)/Z] for X<X*
y(X) = 50exp[(X*-X)/Z] for X>X*
y(X) = 50
where y(X) is the recovery of component of the
float fraction (%) and Z= Ep/ln0.5
The above three equations can be used for
predic ting the performanc e of washer
considering normal efficiency of the washer
(known Ep).
Taking the washability data of the fraction 75 –
6 mm, the above model, was used to develop a
flow scheme by taking the efficiency values of
the Jig washer.
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
322
MPT-2013
exchange part (ammonium acetate soluble part) fractionation test were of <150µm size. The
includes various salts of alkaline and alkaline samples were then homogenized by quarter
earth metals which are considered to be easily and coning technique to make a representative
decomposed in a high temperature processes. sample.
Carbonate and sulphates are expected to leach
2.2 Chemical Fractionation
out in HCl medium whereas the oxides and
silicates are left as an insoluble residue. Detail In the present study the experimental procedure
knowledge of mineral phases present in coal followed for chemical fractionation test was
and its behaviour during the process of same as reported by Van Dyk et. al., 2005.
c ombustion pose a great importanc e in Briefly, air dried samples from three individual
understanding the fusion characteristics of coal seams identified as seam A, seam B, and seam
and coal ash (Teixeira et. al., 2012 and Pettersson C, of a single coal source (Samaleswari block, Ib
et. al., 2008). river coalfield, Odisha, India) was taken as
The measurement of Ash Fusion Temperature “original” sample. 10 g of original coal sample
(AFT) is one of the major factors to predict the along with 30 ml of water was used for H2O
combustion and gasification behaviour of coal. leaching. The coal-water mixture was mixed
AFT of a coal source gives an indication to the for 18 hr using rotospin (Tarsons, India). After
problem related to slagging and clinckering in 18 hr mixing, the sample was filtered and rinsed
industrial boilers. AFT analysis consists of four with distilled water. The filtrate along with the
temperatures, namely, Initial Deformation rinsed water was collec ted in a 50 ml
Temperature (IDT), Softening Temperature (ST), volumetric flask and kept aside for further
Hemispherical Temperature (HT) and Flow measurements. Similar method was applied for
Temperature (FT). However, investigation on Ammonium Acetate (NH4OAC, 1M) leaching
the relation between mineral species present and HCl (6 N) leaching, sequentially, for every
in coal and AFT are still very limited with sample. In every leaching procedure, the initial
respect to Indian coal. Some information is and final weight of the residue was determined
available on relation between mineral species and properly labelled as “NH4OAC leached”
and AFT on South African coal and Bulgarian and “HCl leached”. The filtrate obtained after
coal (Van Dyk et. al., 2005, Vassileva and each extraction was diluted to 50 ml using
Vassilev, 2002). In this work, effort has been distilled water. All the filtrate containing
made to investigate the mineral phases present leac hed elements were measured by
in different coal seams of Ib valley coalfield, Inductively Coupled Plasma Optical Emission
Odisha and to explore some correlation with Spectrometer (ICP-OES), VISTA MPX, VARIAN.
AFT.
2.3 AFT
2. Materials and Methods
For AFT analysis, the leached residue along
2.1 Sample Preparation
with the original coal samples was ashed at
Three bituminous coal samples having non 815 0C. A melting test to measure initial
coking property from different seams of a single deformation temperature (IDT), softening
coal source of Ib river coalfield was selected for temperature (ST), hemispherical temperature
the chemical fractionation study. The coal (HT) and fluid temperature (FT) was conducted
samples were powdered using jaw crusher and in presenc e of air using Ash Fusion
ball mill. The samples used for chemical Determinator, AF-700, LECO.
323
MPT-2013
P 2 O5 1.57 % -
324
MPT-2013
3.3 Ash Fusion Test leaching behaviour of the coal samples is very
different from each other. Effort was made to
Result of AFT study of the original coal and the establish relation between ash-fusion
coal after leaching is shown in Fig. 2. It indicates temperature (AFT) and chemical fractionation
that HCl leaching removed the mineral elements test. The presence of Ca and Fe based minerals
from the coal that caused the AFT to increase in coal was found to have influence on ash fusion
>1600oC. Very little changes were observed temperatures.
after the removal of mineral elements by
NH4OAC and H2O leach. It appears from the Acknowledgement
Fig. 2 that the presence of Fe and Ca has direct
influences on AFT. The authors gratefully acknowledge Director,
CSIR, National Metallurgical Laboratory for his
kind support and guidance to publish the work.
This work is the part of the ongoing project
sponsored by CMPDIL, Ranchi, India. Special
thanks to CMPDIL, Ranchi for their support in
cola characterization.
References
325
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Coking coal is an essential input for production of Iron & Steel through blast furnace route. To save
steel industry facing acute dependence on imported coking coal, domestic availability of coking
coal in right quality and quantity has become imperative. The good quality coking coals of both
Jharia and Bokaro coalfields are fast depleting leaving behind the inferior quality coals. The
washability characteristics of these coals are poor. This paper presents the laboratory beneficiation
studies on run-off-mine coal crushed to minus 6 mm and suggests a suitable beneficiation route
for the improvement in the quality for steel making reducing ash content. Detailed analysis with
respect to characterization, washability investigations and flotation of coal fines is presented.
The coking propensities and the petrographic analysis of the clean coal strongly support its use
for the metallurgical purposes.
326
MPT-2013
327
MPT-2013
type flotation cell. More water was added to The cleans generated from the coarser fraction
maintain the 33% solid concentration and 10% i.e., 6 – 0.5 mm and the finer fraction below 0.5
solid concentration during floatation at the mm was mixed proportionally and was
neutral pH. In each flotation tests, the pulp is c harac terized to understand its c oking
first agitated in the floatation cell for 3 minutes, properties. The characterization data is shown
after which the collector (diesel oil at three levels in Table 3. The coking properties in terms of
Crucible Swelling Number (CSN) and LTGK coke
1.25 kg/t , 1.50 kg/t and 1.75 kg/t) is added and
type and fluidity show that the clean coal is
the pulp is further conditioned for 2 minutes.
suitable for metallurgical purposes.
MIBC as a frother ( at three levels 0.2 kg/t, 0.4kg/
Table 3 Carbonization properties of clean coal
t and 0.6 kg/t) is then added and the pulp is
further conditioned for 1 minute. The impeller Sl. No Carbonization Characteristics
speed of the flotation machine was 1500 RPM. 1 Crucible Swelling Number 4 1/2
Flotation products were collected for 1 minute; 2 LTGK coke Type G6
the concentrate and tailing were filtered, dried 3 Gieseler Fluidity
and weighed. The ash content of the samples
a. Initial Softening Temperature C (Iddpm) 408
was determined. The data is shown in Table 2.
b. Maximum Fluidity Temperature , C 444
Table 2 Flotation of Coal Fines
c. Solidification Temperature, C 474
Collecto
Test r Frother Concentrate Tailings Feed d. Plastic Range, C 66
dosage, dosage
Wt% Ash% Wt% Ash% Ash% e. Maximum Fluidity, ddpm 750
No kg/t , kg/t
1 1.25 0.2 18.5 14.0 81.5 34.3 30.5
2 1.25 0.4 30.4 13.4 69.6 37.7 30.3 7. Conclusions
3 1.25 0.6 34.1 12.8 65.9 39.7 30.5
4 1.50 0.2 34.3 13.1 65.7 38.5 29.8 The low volatile coking coals from Central
5 1.50 0.4 57.8 12.0 42.2 55.5 30.4
Coalfields may be upgraded to the desired
6 1.50 0.6 56.8 13.6 43.2 53.1 30.7
7 1.75 0.2 59.0 13.5 41.0 55.1 30.6 quality if the coal is judiciously beneficiate.
8 1.75 0.4 59.4 13.7 40.6 53.3 29.8 The washability studies on the fraction 6 –
9 1.75 0.6 64.9 13.8 35.1 59.8 29.9
0.5 mm shows that it is possible to achieve
6. Results and Discussions theoretical yield of 52% at 10% ash content.
The laboratory flotation studies showed
It is seen from Table 1 that about 60.7% of the
that it is possible to recover about 57.8% at
crushed material was above 1 mm and the ash
content being more than 25%. The - 0.5 mm 12% ash content.
fraction is about 23.7%, and its ash percentage The analyses on the clean coal samples in
being 30.6%. terms of coking properties proved that the
From the washability studies on the size qualities of the cleans have improved
fraction 6 – 0.5 mm, the Mayers curve was remarkably and these may be gainfully
drawn and it may be seen from Fig. 1 that the utilized for coke making and metallurgical
theoretical yield% at 10% ash level is about 52%. purposes.
This data was used for generation of bulk cleans A conceptual flow sheet may be developed
for characterization studies. by c onsidering H.M.Cyc lone for
The flotation studies as showed in Table 2 beneficiation of 6 – 0.5 mm fraction, while
indicate that it is possible to obtain an yield of
flotation may be c onsidered for
57.8% at an ash content of 12% at about 1.50 kg/
beneficiation of coal fines.
t of collector dosage and 0.4 kg/t of frother
dosage. Keeping this condition, bulk cleans was
generated for characterization studies.
*******
328
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Production of pig iron from Blast Furnaces in the Integrated Steel Plants requires strong coke for
the purpose of reducing iron oxide to metallic iron. Strength of this coke is assured by its
characteristics such as M10, M40 indices, CSR (Coke Strength after Reaction) and CRI (Coke
Reactivity Index). To produce coke of the required characteristics, bituminous coals (metallurgical
coals) having specified properties such as MMR (Mean Max Reflectance), VM (Volatile Matter),
Fluidity, TMF (Temperature of Maximum fluidity), Ash content, FSI (Free Swelling Index) etc., are
charged in coke ovens and pyrolized up to around 1000oC. This process is known as carbonization.
Since carbonization is a process in which various physico – chemical changes take place at different
temperature levels, thermo analytical techniques such as Differential and Thermo Gravimetric
Analysis (DTG-TGA) can be a very useful experimental tool to detect the changes and also the
degree of changes for the entire temperature range of carbonization as a continuous function.
The present investigation aims at developing additional parameters of coal from their respective
DTG-TGA thermo-grams and also their correlation with the some of the conventional properties
of coals viz: MMR, TMF, VM. Thermo Gravimetric tests on coal samples were carried out on TGA
701 (make - LECO Corporation) at Visakhapatnam Steel Plant, Visakhapatnam. About 12 samples
of indigenous and foreign coals with a spread of MMR from 0.85 to 1.4, VM from 20% to 36%, TMF
from 442 to 472oC have been subjected to thermo gravimetric analysis and correlations were
developed between TG parameters and coal properties.
Keywords: TGA, bituminous coals, characetization.
1. Introduction by blast furnace method and apart its function
as energy source, coke supplies the reducing
Metallurgical coke is one of the principal raw gases which convert iron oxides to iron. It also
materials used in the production of hot metal provides burden permeability necessary for
* Correspending Author: J.V.S. Murty, Associate Professor, blast furnace.
G.V.P. College of Engineering (Autonomous), Madhurawada,
Blast furnace grade coke is produced from
Visakhapatnam-530 048, India, +91-9346694380; Email:
jvsmurty@yahoo.com coking coals by the process of carbonization in
329
MPT-2013
which the coal charge is heated in coke ovens in experimental tool to detect the changes and also
absence of air. Not all coals are suitable for the degree of changes for the entire temperature
carbonization into metallurgical cokes. Only a and time range of carbonization as a continuous
limited range of coals with definite rank (MMR) function. By developing an insight into the
can produce acceptable metallurgical coke. A mechanism of carbonization process one can
characteristic feature of the coking coals is their determine the various correlations between
ability to soften on heating and become fluid/ coal and final coke properties.
plastic, swell with evolution of volatile matter The objective behind undertaking the present
and later shrink on solidification to produce research work on different coal samples using
semi-coke which on further heating undergoes thermo-gravimetry (TG & DTG) is to establish
secondary evolution of volatile matter to give whether it is possible to obtain additional
coke (Murty et al., 2001). parameters for evaluation of the coking
Coal carbonization involves complex physical properties of coal from their thermograms, viz.,
and chemical changes associated with the the temperature of maximum rate of weight
decomposition of the coal macromolecular loss (TMRWL) and % Weight loss (% Wt Loss) to
structure and the formation of the coke by an correlate the same with conventional coking
agglomeration process. The quality of the coke coal evaluation characteristics such as volatile
depends on both the characteristics of the coal matter and rank (VM &MMR) and plastic
and the carbonization conditions. A number of properties (Gieseler Fluidity parameters).
experimental methods have been developed to
measure coal and coke properties: physical, 2. Material and Methods
chemical, rheological and petrographic (Varma, 2.1. Thermo-gravimetric (TG) tests on coal
2002). All these properties have been used with samples
varying degrees of success to predict coke Earlier studies carried out by RDCIS, SAIL
quality which can be expected from coal and (Murty et al. 2001), revealed the possibility of
its potential in formulating a suitable blend. developing c orrelations between TG
The influence of the above quality parameters parameters like TMRWL and % Wt Loss up to
on c oke quality is often not linear and 900oC and the physical properties of cal such as
independent. Therefore, it is necessary to use MMR, VM and TMF. Differential thermal
more number of parameters. Moreover, there analysis is carried out on six foreign and eight
are wide differences of opinions as to which indigenous coals used in SAIL plants.
characteristics or combination of properties In the present study, only thermo gravimetric
determine that coal will be of suitable coking analysis is conducted on a set of five foreign
quality while others are not. Most of the tests coals and another set of 11 foreign coals under
to determine coking properties are essentially inert atmosphere of nitrogen. For the 1st set of
empirical. samples, TG analysis is done under inert
Thermal analysis has been used for a long time atmosphere of nitrogen flow with a
to determine the response of substances to temperature increase at the rate of 10oC/min up
change with temperature. Since carbonization to 1000oC. For the 2nd set of samples the program
is a process in which various physico-chemical is changed as follows:
changes take place at different temperature From ambient to 100oC, the rate of increase is
levels, thermo-analytical techniques such as kept at 15 oC/min and the temperature is
differential thermal and thermo-gravimetric maintained at 100oC without any rise till all
analysis (DTG-TGA) can be a very useful
330
MPT-2013
the moisture is lost. Then, from 100oC to 300oC, TG thermograms showing % Wt Loss versus
the rate of temperature increase is kept at 20oC/ temperature (Fig. 1), it is observed that the
min and the temperature of 300oC is maintained maximum weight loss oc c urs in the
for 7 minutes. A rate of 5oC/min is maintained temperature range of 400-600 0C which is
from 300oC to 1000oC. followed by a gradual weight loss beyond
For the above tests a sample of 0.7 to 1.0 gm 6000C. Derivative thermogravimetry (DTG)
weight and size of -72 mesh is taken. must be used to study the steep decrease in the
weight in the temperature range of 400-6000C.
3. Results and Discussion In all the samples of coal, the temperature of
Table 1 and 2 give conventional characteristics maximum rate of weight loss (TMRWL) lies in the
and TG parameters of 1st set of samples of VSP temperature range of 450-560 0C. It is also
and 2nd set of samples of VSP respectively. observed that with increase in the rank of coal,
Typical thermograms of a coal sample depicting temperature of TMRWL also increases for all the
TG and DTG curve is presented in Fig. 1. coals tested.
331
MPT-2013
%VM = 1.061 * (% Wt Loss) + 0.003 for 1st set of ISO 7404-1994 is 0.08%. An attempt has been
sample coals (1) made to develop correlation between this rank
%VM = 1.190 * (% Wt Loss) -4.748 for 2nd set of parameter and derived characteristics of coal
sample coals (2) from thermograms.
TMRWL vs MMR
%Wt Loss Vs VM Fig. 4 shows straight line relation between
40
20
15
rate: 10 oC/min
MMR=0.006 * (TMRWL) -2.551 for 1st set of samples
10
5
y = 1.061x + 0.003
R² = 0.987 (5)
nd
0 MMR=0.011 * (TMRWL) -4.404 for 2 set of samples
15 20 25 30 35 40
% Wt Loss (6)
VM (5 deg C/min rate) VM (10 deg C/min rate)
TMRWL Vs MMR
TMRWL Vs VM
40
y = -0.240x + 157.7
Fig. 4 :TMRWL vs MMR for two sets of samples
35
R² = 0.866
30
25 Fig 5 shows the relation between % Wt Loss
VM
20
15 y = -0.299x + 176.7 and MMR for both the sets of VSP coals with R2
10
5
R² = 0.871
> 0.94. The equations derived are:
0 MMR = -0.027 * (% Wt Loss) + 1.797 for 1st set of
460 480 500 520 540 560 580
TMRWL
samples (7)
MMR = -0.047 * (% Wt Loss) + 2.352 for 2nd set of
VM (5 deg C/min rate) VM (10 deg C/min rate)
samples (8)
1.2
about 0.87 for both the sets. 1
ra te: 5 o C/m in
y = -0.047x + 2.352
MMR
0.6
coals (3) 0.4
rate: 10 oC/min
y = -0.027x + 1.797
0
sample coals (4) 15 20 25 30 35 40
% Wt Loss
Rank of Coals MMR (5 deg C/min rate) MMR (10 deg C/min rate)
332
MPT-2013
455
450
reasonably well.
445
y = 0.547x + 155.9
440
R² = 0.913
435 Acknowledgements
480 500 520 540 560 580
TMRWL
Authors wish to acknowledge with thanks the
TMF (5 deg C/min rate) TMF (10 deg C/min rate)
Managements of G.V.P. College of Engineering
(Autonomous) and Vishakhapatnam Steel
Fig. 6: TMRWL vs TMF for two sets Plant for their support in carrying out the
Fig. 7 shows the relation between weight loss studies and extending the laboratory facilities
percent with temperature of maximum fluidity for the work.
(TMF) of coals. The equations derived are:
TMF = -2.233 * (% Wt Loss) + 509.9 for 1st set of References
samples with R2 = 0.938 (11)
TMF = -2.817 * (% Wt Loss) + 526.7 for 2nd set of Murty, J. V. S., Amit Parti., 2001. Internal Project
samples with R2 = 0.701 (12) report “Studies on Correlation between
Conventional Characteristics of Coal and
% Wt Loss Vs TMF
Coke with DTA-TG Plots”, Project No:
475 51:04:91, RDCIS, SAIL.
470
465
ra te: 5o C/min
y = -2.817x + 526.7 Ulanvoskii, M. L., Drozdnik, I. D., 1991. Coke &
R² = 0.701
460 chemistry. 1, 4-6.
TMF
455
450
Varma, A. K., 2002. Thermo gravimetric
rate: 10 o C/min
445
y = -2.233x + 509.9 investigations predic tion of c oking
440 R² = 0.938
435 behavior and coke properties derived from
15 20 25 30 35
% Wt Loss
inertinite rich coals. Journal of FUEL. 81,
1321-1334.
TMF (5 deg C/min rate) TMF (10 deg C/min rate)
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Banashree Mahanta, Binoy K Saikia*, Arju Moni Dutta, Prasenjit Saikia and
Bimala P Baruah
Coal Chemistry Division, CSIR-North East Institute of Science & Technology, Jorhat-
785006, Assam, India
Abstract
In this investigation, the Ash Fusion Temperatures (AFTs) ranges of few beneficiated coals have
been reported. Coal sample have been treated by four different methods, i.e, oxidation, alkali
extraction and ultrasonication in presence of alkali. The major oxides of ash in raw and treated
coals are Fe2O3, Al2O3, SiO2, CaO and MgO. Initial Deformation Temperature (IDT) during Ash
Fusion Temperature analysis showed variations with the ash composition in coals and found to
be increased with increase in Fe2O3 contents in ash. The coal samples, characterized by XRD
analysis revealed that the peak intensities for different minerals change with the types of processes
adopted for beneficiation.
Keywords: Ash fusion temperature; ultrasonication; xrd; low rank coal; high sulfur coal.
334
MPT-2013
335
MPT-2013
ash consists of SiO2 followed by Fe2O3. The AFT 3.2. Mineral transformations during various
are ranges from 1020 to 1500 0C. treatments
Table 1: Ash analysis (wt %) The identity of different minerals present in the
raw and treated coal ash and their
transformation during different treatments
AFT(0 C)
Ash SiO2 Fe2 O3 Al2 O3 CaO MgO
IDT HT FT were investigated from their XRD spectra. The
TR 3.51 47.8 28.8 15.7 1.07 0.13 1210 1360 1460
XRD d-values and their assignments are
TOX 2.61 39.07 26.10 12.03 0.05 0.15 1120 1300 1500
TOXA5H 1.62 37.9 9.08 11.4 0.01 0.12 1040 1320 1500 summarized in Table 2.
TA5H 2.02 35.2 20.36 13.5 0.13 0.08 1120 1340 1500
TAU 1.25 34.5 10.71 11.9 0.02 0.11 1060 1300 1480 Table 2: XRD d-values of the coal ash and their
assessment
3.1.1. Effect of Fe2O3 content
As iron in coal is predominantly in the form of S.N. d-spacing values(Å) Possible Assignments
ferric iron in both oxidizing and inert 1. 4.44 Illite(I)
atmosphere (Huffman et al., 1981). It is seen that 2. 4.44 Montmorillonite(M)
the AFT shows a significant change with the 3. 4.29, 3.35,1.81 Quartz(Q)
percentage of Fe2O3. It was reported that the 4. 4.29, 2.96,2.85, 2.67,2.19 Gypsum(G)
oxides that reduce the AFTs of the coal ashes 5. 3.67, 2.23,1.83 Calcite(C)
are in the order SO3>CaO>MgO> Fe2O3 (Li et al., 6. 3.67,2.69,2.51,2.19,1.83,1.69, 1.59,1.45 Hematite(H)
336
MPT-2013
for 5 hours. However, the peak intensity for Feng-hai Li , Jie-jie Huang , Yi-tian Fang, Yang
minerals like Hematite(H), Calc ite(C), Wang, 2011. The effects of leaching and
Gypsum(G), Rutile(R) were enhanced during floatation on the ash fusion temperatures
the extrac tion. Thus, there are drastic of three selected lignites. Fuel 90, 2377–
transformations of minerals during the specific 2383.
treatments as carried out. There is a need of G.W. Himus (Ed.) 1954. Fuel Testing, Laboratory
more in depth studies to follow this Method in Fuel Technology. Penguin,
transformation. London, 67-78.
Huffman, G.P., Huggins, F.E., Dunmyre, G.
4. Conclusions R.,1981. Investigation of the high-
In present investigation, it was found that the temperature behaviour of coal ash in
Ash Fusion Temperature ranges (AFT) generally reducing and oxidizing atmospheres. Fuel
increases with the increase in Fe2O3, CaO, Al2O3 60, 585-597.
contents in coals. The AFTs more or less John Pac ker and Dr Vinc ent Gray with
increases with SiO 2 contents in coals and information from “Coal Researc h
decreases with increase in MgO contents. The Analysis Update”, Coal Researc h
XRD analysis revealed the presence of minerals Association of New Zealand Inc.1998.
inc luding Illite(I), Montmorillonite(M), Song, W. J., Tang, L. H., Zhu, X. D., Wu, Y. Q.,
Quartz(Q), calcite(C), Gypsum(G), Hematite(H), Rong, Y. Q., Zhu, Z. B., Koyama, S. 2009.
Kaolinite(K), Dolomite. It also revealed the Fusibility and flow properties of coal ash
occurrences of mineral transformations during and slag. Fuel 88, 297–304.
their various treatments like oxidation and Takematsu T, Maude C. Coal gasification for
alkali treatments, which in turn affect the AFTs. IGCC power generation 1991. ICEAR/37
IEA Coal Research, London.
Reference
Vogel, A. J., 1969. A Textbook of Quantitative
Clarke, T. M., Evans, B. J., Wynter, C., Pollak, H., Inorganic Analysis, Including Elementary
Taole, S. and Ratc liffe, D., 1998. Analysis, Longman, London.
Investigation of virgin coals subjected to
a mild acid treatment. Hyp. Interact. 112,
227-230.
*******
337
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Arju Moni Dutta, Binoy K Saikia*, Lakshi Saikia and Bimala P Baruah
CSIR-North East Institute of Science and Technology, Assam, Jorhat -785006, India
Abstract
The presence of sulphur and mineral matters (ash) in coal is undesirable for its utilization in the
thermal plants. There are several chemical, physical, biological techniques for removal of sulphur
and ash from coal. Application of ultrasonic energy and ionic liquids has been recently practiced
for beneficiation of coals. Our present investigation reports the ultrasonication (20 kHz) of North
East Indian coals in presence of ILs (Ionic Liquids).The effect of ultrasonication time in
desulphurization and deashing is studied. Desulphurization of Bapung coal is found to increase
from 17.80% to 28.69% by ultrasonication with increasing time from one to three hours. Similarly,
Tipong coal shows an increase from 7.62% to 11.86% with increase in time. Ultrasonication in ILs
is not so effective in deashing of the coals during this study. The XRD and FT-IR analysis of raw
and beneficiated coal samples are also discussed. The peak analyses in FT-IR and XRD spectra
have revealed the removal of sulphur and ash from the coal samples.The ILs could be reused for
subsequently, and the process seems to be environmentally sustainable.
338
MPT-2013
surroundings. This process also requires extra Ultrasound in aqueous medium and ILs as the
investment in chemicals and related apparatus. extractant.
In this present study, the coal samples were Sound waves having frequencies higher than
extracted with ionic liquids (ILs) in presence of those to which human ear can response is called
Ultrasound wave. IL is used here as green ultrasound. Ultrasonic wave can be used for
solvents. the beneficiation of coal by removal sulphur as
well as ash.Ultrasound in the range of 20 to 100
1.2 Ionic liquids: green chemicals
kHz, which produces high energy waves
Ionic liquids are composed solely of anions and sometimes referred to as power ultrasound
cations. These are essentially non-volatile
molten salts with a melting point less than 2. Experimental
100ºC.Ionic liquids come in two main categories, The low to high ash and medium to high
namely simple salts (made of a single anion and sulphur coal samples were collected from
cation) and binary ionic liquids (salts where Assam and Meghalaya states and ground to -
equilibrium is involved). For example, 72 BS. The proximate analysis of coal samples
[EtNH3][NO3] is a simple salt whereas were done by using Thermogravimetric
mixtures of aluminum(III) chloride and 1,3- Analyser (TGA 701; M/S Leco Corporation,
dialkylimidazolium chlorides (a binary ionic USA). Total sulphur was determined by
liquid system) contain several different ionic sulphur determinator (Leco Corporation, USA)
species, and their melting point and properties and the forms of pyritic sulphur and sulphate
depend upon the mole frac tions of the sulphur were determined by standard method
aluminum(III) chloride and 1,3- (ASTM D 2492). The percent organic sulphur
dialkylimidazolium. was calculated by difference. The FT-IR spectra
Ionic liquids (ILs) have been employed of the coals and treated samples were recorded
extensively as Green solvents due to the in Perkin Elmer system 2000, Model 640B
c harac teristic s of nonvolatility, (wavelength 400-4000 cm-1 with an accuracy of
nonflammablity and high thermal stability. +3 to -3) using KBr pellet with same weight of
Thus, these are employed in processes of dried coal samples and KBr. The XRD spectra
catalysis, chemical synthesis and separations. was obtained inX ray Diffractometer (Model:
The use of ILs as extractants to remove aromatic Rigako, ULTIMA IV)
sulfur c ompounds by extrac tive In a Teflon beaker, 20 gm of the coal sample was
desulfurization has been reported in recent mixed with 100 ml H2O and 3 ml IL (1 Butyl -3-
research studies (Bösmann et al 2001; Lo et al methylimidazolium tetrafloroborate) and then
2003; Huang, et al 2004; Zhang et al 2002a; the mixture was exposed to the ultrasound
2004b; Nie et al 2006a, 2007b; Zhao et al 2007;). treatment of frequency 20 kHz in the Ultrasonic
Most of the literatures have described with ILs Processor (Sonapros PR-1000 M) at atmospheric
as simple extractant. The results indicate that pressure. Duration of ultrasonication was
ionic liquids can effectively extract the sulfur increased from 1 hr to to 3 hrs by taking
contents from the oil phase of liquid fuels. Wen- different coal samples, water and IL mixtures.
Hen Lo and coworkers (Lo et al 2003) using H2O2 A sensor was given to the reaction mixture to
- acetic acid as the oxidant in presence of detect the reaction temperature. Then, the each
[BMIM]BF4 and [BMIM]PF6 as the extractant. mixture of coal and water was filtered, washed
Our present investigation inc ludes the until pH becomes neutral.
extraction of sulfur from high sulpur coals using
339
MPT-2013
M: moisture; VM: volatile matter; FC: fixed carbon; SS: sulphate sulphur; TS: total sulphur; OS:
organic sulphur
340
MPT-2013
341
MPT-2013
Fig 4: XRD spectrum of ultrasonicated coal reac tors; Review, analysis and
samples (K: kaolinite, Q: quartz, H: hematite, experimental verification. AIChE J 48,
P: pyrite) 1542–1560.
Henglein, A.,1995. Chemic al effec ts of
Conclusions continuous and pulsed ultrasound in
aqueous solutions. Ultrason Sonochem
The Ultrasound energy can be used for the 2,115–121
beneficiation of high sulphur coals without Hoffmann, M.R., Hua, I., Hochemer, R.,1996.
using hazardous chemicals. The use of ionic Application of ultrasonic irradiation for
liquids (ILs) makes the process more eco- the degradation of chemical contaminants
friendly and safe. in water. Ultrasonic Sonochemistry 3,163–
References 172.
Huang, C.P.,Chen, B.H.,Zhang, J., Liu, Z.C., Li,
Ahnonkitpanit, E., Prasassarakich, P., 1989. Coal Y.X., 2004. Desulfurization of Gasoline by
desulfurization in aqueous hydrogen Extraction with New Ionic Liquids. Energ.
peroxide. Fuel 68,819-824. Fuel. 18, 1862–1864.
Araya, P.E., Ohlbaum, R.B., Droguett, S.E., 1981. Jana, A.K., Chatterjee, S.N.,1995. Estimation of
Study of the treatment of sub-bituminous hydroxyl free radic als produc ed by
coals by NaOH solutions, Fuel 60, 1127- ultrasound in Fricke solution used as a
1130. chemical dosimeter. Ultrason Sonochem
Baruah, B. P. , Khare, P., 2007. Desulphurization 2,87–91
of oxidized coals with Solvent Extraction Kara, H., Ceylan.R.,1988. Removal of sulfur
and alkali treatment. Energy & Fuels, Vol. from four central Anatolian lignite’s by
21, 2156-2164. NaOH, Fuel 67 , 170-172.
Borah, D., Baruah, M. K.; Haque, I., 2001. Fuel, Kumar, A., and Srivastava,S. Pattern of Sulphur
80, 501-50 Borah, D., Borah, M.K., Haque, Functional Groups in High Sulphur Ledo
I., 2005. Oxidation of high sulfur coal. Part Coals of Assam . Journal of Applied
3. Desulphurization of organic sulfur by Chemistry (IOSR-JAC). 4, 01-08.
peroxiacetic acid (produced in situ) in Lo, W.H.; Yang, H.Y.; Wei, G.T., 2003. One-pot
presence of metal ions. Elsevier, Fuel desulfurization of light oils by chemical
Processing Technology 86, 959-976. oxidation and solvent extraction with
Bösmann, A., Datsevich, L., Jess, A., Lauter, A., room temperature ionic liquids. Green
Schmitz, C.,Wasserscheid, P. 2001. Deep Chem. 5, 639–642.
desulfurization of diesel fuel by extraction Luche, J.L., 1994. Effect of ultrasound on
with ionic liquids. Chem. Commun., 2494– heterogeneous system. Ultrason Sonochem
2495. 1,111–11
Christman, C.L., Carmichael A.J., Mossoba MM, Makino, K., Mossoba, M.M., Riesz, P., 1982,
Riesz P., 1987. Evidence for free radicals Chemical effects of ultrasound on aqueous
produc ed in aqueous solutions by solutions evidence for OH- and H+ by spin
diagnostic ultrasound. Ultrasonics 25, 31– trapping. J Am Chem. Soc 104, 3537–3539.
34. Margulis, M.A., 1994. Fundamental problems
Gogate, P.R., Tatake, P.A., Kanthale. P.M., Pandit, of sonoc hemistry and c avitations.
A.B.,2002. Mapping of sonochemical Ultrason Sonochem 1, 87–90.
342
MPT-2013
Misik, V., Riesz, P., 1994. Free radicals formation aqueousand non-aqueous solutions.
by ultrasound in organic liquids: a spin Environ Health Perspect 64,233–252.
trap and EPR study. J Phys Chem 98, 1634– Silverstein, R. M.; Bassler G. C.; Morrill, T.
1640. C.,1981. Spectrometricidentification of
Mukherjee, S., Mahiddin, P., Borthakur, C., organic compounds; Wiley: New York.
2001.Demineralization and Webster, E., 1963. Cavitation. Ultrasonics 1, 39–
Desulphurization of sub bituminous coal 48.
using hydrogen peroxide. Energy Fuels 15 Zhang, S.G.; Zhang, C.Z., 2002 . Novel properties
1418-1424. of ionic liquids in selective sulfur removal
Nayak, S., P,Sing, B. K., 2007.Instrumental from fuels at room temperature. Green
c harac terization of c lay by Chem. 4, 376–379
XRD,XRF,and XRF;Indian Academy of Zhang,S.G., Zhang, Q.L., Zhang, C.Z., 2004 .
Sciences,30 . 235-238. Extrac tive desulfurization and
Nie, Y., Li, C.X.; Wang, Z.H., 2007Extractive denitrogenation of fuels using ionic liquids.
Desulfurization of fuel oil using Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 43, 614–622
alkylimidazole and its mixture with Zhao, D., Wang, Y., and Duan, E.,2009. Oxidative
dialkylphosphate ionic liquids. Ind. Eng. Desulfurization of Fuel Oil by Pyridinium-
Chem. Res. 46, 5108–5112. Based Ionic Liquids. molecules 14, 4351-
Nie, Y.; Li, C.X.; Sun, A.J.; Meng, H.; Wang, Z.H. 4357
2006 . Extrac tive desulfurization of Zhao, D.S.; Wang, J.L.; Zhou, E.P., 2007. Oxidative
gasoline using imidazolium-based desulfurization of diesel fuel using a
phosphoric ionic liquids. Energ. Fuel. 20, Brønsted acid room temperature ionic
2083–2087. liquid in the presence of H2O2. Green
Riesz, P., Berdahl, D., Christman, C.L., 1985. Free Chem. 9, 1219–1222
radical generation by ultrasound in
*******
343
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Son-Mahanadi Valley Coalfields is endowed with vast resources of low grade low rank non coking
coals occurring as very thick and highly inter banded seams. Their near surface occurrence has
imparted additional importance to them as mostly they are exploitable through open cast mining.
Korba is one such coalfield where Kusmunda group of seams, viz. upper and lower Kusmunda,
has become the centre of attraction for its vast thickness and potentiality to be used as a prime
resource for power generation. However throughout its thickness the coal quality is very much
inconsistent due to the presence of dirt bands of varying quality and thickness as also varied
inherent dirt contents of coal bands. As such the coals, due to their poor quality, require
beneficiation before being fed into the pulveriser-boiler system of a power plant. Since the quality
of a thick seam varies from section to section and bench to bench during conventional mining, it
is difficult to predict the washability character of ROM coals from a thick seam in the long range
of time. However, a number of washability studies from ROM samples of different times show
that despite the change of quality of coals they bear some common characteristics those make
them predictable as also easily washable through a single washing system.
The present study encompasses 4 ROM samples from different projects working on Kusmunda
seam with head ash varying from 35.2 to 55.6. It can be observed from the study that specific
gravity cut point around 1.9 produce cleans with around 32 percent ash (suitable target for
power plant use) and the cut point eventually coincides with the lowest NGM level in most of the
cases. It shows that the dirt bands occurring throughout the entire thickness of the seam bear
similar lithological character and their prevalence in any chosen section only affects the head ash
of the ROM and subsequently the yield percentage on washing with very little effect on the
difficulty level of washing.
344
MPT-2013
intra- basinal normal fault. Towards the coal with ash content varying from 35.2 to 55.6
northern side lie the lower Barakars with a set percent. The samples were collected from
of thin seams known Ghordewa or Rajgamar different locations (different mining projects)
group of seams. Towards southern side of the at different times ranging over a period of more
fault, i.e. the down thrown side occurs the than 5 years. Yet the findings show some
Kusmunda group of seams and the satellite remarkable similarity in the washability
seams with formidable thickness of 20 to 75 characteristics of all those coals.
meters and vast reserves of low grade coal of
around 10 billion tons. These coals are extracted 2. Washability Study
through a number of coal India mining projects The four ROM samples, termed as ROM-1,
viz., Kusmunda, Gevra and Dipka. The mining ROM-2, ROM-3 and ROM-4 have been selected
activity is stretched along the east west strike for the study on the basis of their variation in
length of about 16 km with a target output of quality in terms of ash percent and geographic
more than 50 million tons per annum. The coals location. The samples were studied during the
are mostly used in different thermal power time span from 2007 to 2012.
stations including NTPC and State electricity ROM-1 was collected from Kusmunda open cast
board and a number of private power plants. mine. After sc reen analysis, the +50mm
Besides, these coals are also dispatched to other materials were subjected to crushing by
State electricity generation companies of Gujrat, mechanical means and the crushed fractions
Rajasthan etc. were again screened. Both natural size fractions
Throughout its enormous thickness the seams of -50mm materials and the crushed fractions
show different kinds of dirt bands of varying were mixed to get the 50w washability sample.
thickness. Since the whole thickness cannot be The fine size materials below 0.5 mm were left
accessed in single mining operation, the coals unwashed and float and sink tests were done
are used to be mined in different benches. on (50 – 0.5) materials. The head ash of the
Presently the surface miners are also being washability sample was 49.9 percent on dry
used. Thus the mine produce varies widely in basis. ROM-2 was who c ollec ted from
the quality from place to place and bench to Kusmunda OCP and processed in the same
benc h. However, due to Gover nment way. The head ash (dry) in this case is 35.2
stipulation, these coals require beneficiation for percent only. ROM-3 was collected from Gevra
reduction of ash before its use in power plant open cast mine and processed to get (100 – 5)
boilers. A number of coal washeries have come mm size washability sample with head ash
up in this area to cater washed coal to the users, (dry) of 55.6 percent. ROM-4, also processed for
who initially went for laboratory c oal (100 - 5) mm washability sample with 47.0
beneficiation study data to plan their washery percent ash on dry basis was collected from
designs. A number of such studies were done Dipka open cast mine. The detailed washability
by CIMFR (erstwhile CFRI) Bilaspur Unit. The study data are given in Table no. 1-4. Also near
findings of those studies show despite wide gravity materials (NGM) were calculated for
variation in quality, there are some common all specific gravity fractions and incorporated
washability characteristics in Kusmunda coals in the tables. The NGM percent present have
which makes them easily washable through a been used as the main tool for comparison of
single washing system. their washability characteristics.
The present work comprises comparative
study of 4 Lab scale washability studies of ROM
345
MPT-2013
Table 1: ROM-1 Washability studies of ROM Kusmunda Open Cast Mine Korba Coal Field
(Raw Coal x 100 mm) Size:(50-0.5)mm Dry Ash % - 49.9 Wt%= 93.4
Sp. Gr. Fractional Fractional Cumulative Cumulative Near
Dry Floats Sinks Chracteristic Mayer's
Gravity
Wt% pt.value
Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Material
Floats at 1.30 3.2 3.5 3.2 3.5 96.8 51.4 1.6 0.1 15.7
Floats at 1.40 12.5 15.1 15.7 12.7 84.3 56.8 9.5 2.0 25.8
Floats at 1.50 13.3 26.6 29.0 19.1 71.0 62.5 22.4 5.5 23.4
Floats at 1.60 10.1 37.0 39.1 23.7 60.9 66.7 34.1 9.3 21.8
Floats at 1.70 11.7 43.8 50.4 28.3 49.6 71.8 45.0 14.3 20.1
Floats at 1.80 8.4 50.8 59.2 31.5 40.8 76.6 55.0 18.6 13.4
Floats at 1.90 5.0 55.4 64.2 33.4 35.8 79.5 61.7 21.4 10.0
Floats at 2.00 5.0 62.0 69.2 35.5 30.8 81.4 66.7 24.6 35.8
Sinks at 2.00 30.8 81.4 100.0 49.9 84.6 49.9
Table 2: ROM-2 Washability studies of ROM Kusmunda Open Cast Mine Korba Coal Field
(Raw Coal x 100 mm) Size:(50-0.5)mm Dry Ash % - 35.2 Wt%= 93.1
Sp. Gr. Fractional Fractional Cumulative Cumulative
Dry Floats Sinks Near
Characteristic Mayer's
Gravity
Wt% pt. value
Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Material
Floats at 1.30 12.3 6.2 12.3 6.2 87.7 39.3 6.2 0.8 34.7
Floats at 1.40 22.4 16.0 34.7 12.5 65.3 47.3 23.5 4.3 42.7
Floats at 1.50 20.3 28.0 55.0 18.2 45.0 56.0 44.9 10.0 34.0
Floats at 1.60 13.7 38.2 68.7 22.2 31.3 63.7 61.9 15.3 20.7
Floats at 1.70 7.0 46.1 75.7 24.4 24.3 68.8 72.2 18.5 12.3
Floats at 1.80 5.3 52.9 81.0 26.3 19.0 73.1 78.4 21.3 10.1
Floats at 1.90 4.8 59.3 85.8 28.1 14.2 78.1 83.4 24.1 8.0
Floats at 2.00 2.8 63.1 88.6 29.2 11.4 81.8 87.2 25.9 14.2
Sinks at 2.00 11.4 81.7 100.0 35.2 94.3 35.2
Table 3: ROM-3 Washability studies of ROM Gevra Open Cast Mine Korba Coal Field (Raw
Coal x 100 mm) Size:(100-0.5)mm Dry Ash % - 55.6 Wt%= 96.0
Sp. Gr. Fractional Fractional Cumulative Cumulative Mayer's Near
Dry Floats Sinks Characteristic
pt. Gravity
Wt%
Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% value Material
Floats at 1.30 2.9 5.7 2.9 5.7 97.1 57.1 1.5 0.2 16.9
Floats at 1.40 14.0 16.6 16.9 14.7 83.1 63.9 9.9 2.5 31.1
Floats at 1.50 17.1 26.8 34.0 20.8 66.0 73.5 25.5 7.1 24.6
Floats at 1.60 7.5 37.2 41.5 23.8 58.5 78.2 37.8 9.9 12.8
Floats at 1.70 5.3 44.8 46.8 26.1 53.2 81.6 44.2 12.2 9.0
Floats at 1.80 3.7 52.7 50.5 28.1 49.5 83.7 48.7 14.2 6.0
Floats at 1.90 2.3 58.2 52.8 29.4 47.2 84.9 51.7 15.5 3.7
Floats at 2.00 1.4 62.0 54.2 30.2 45.8 85.6 53.5 16.4 47.2
Sinks at 2.00 45.8 85.6 100.0 55.6 77.1 55.6
Table 4: ROM-4 Washability studies of ROM Dipka Open Cast Mine Korba Coal Field (Raw
Coal x 100 mm), Size:(100-0.5)mm Dry Ash % - 47.0 Wt%= 93.5
Sp. Gr. Fractional Fractional Cumulative Cumulative Near
Dry Floats Sinks Characteristic Mayer's
Gravity
Wt% pt. value
Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Wt.% Ash% Material
Floats at 1.30 5.0 4.7 5.0 4.7 95.0 49.2 2.5 0.2 18.0
Floats at 1.40 13.0 15.4 18.0 12.4 82.0 54.6 11.5 2.2 31.1
Floats at 1.50 18.1 26.7 36.1 19.6 63.9 62.5 27.1 7.1 29.4
Floats at 1.60 11.3 36.9 47.4 23.7 52.6 68.1 41.8 11.2 21.4
Floats at 1.70 10.1 44.0 57.5 27.3 42.5 73.8 0.0 15.7 16.3
Floats at 1.80 6.2 51.6 63.7 29.6 36.3 77.6 60.6 18.9 10.1
Floats at 1.90 3.9 58.0 67.6 31.3 32.4 80.0 65.7 21.1 6.0
Floats at 2.00 2.5 61.7 70.1 32.4 29.9 81.4 69.4 22.7 32.4
Sinks at 2.00 29.9 81.4 100.0 47.0 85.1 47.0
346
MPT-2013
*******
347
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Thick interbanded coal seams of Son-Mahanadi Valley coalfields attained tremendous importance
for power generation due to their vast resources and near surface occurrence that imparted easy
minability through open cast mining methods. However, in almost all the cases the ROM coals of
these mining projects, conventional washing before their end use in power plants is almost
imperative due to their poor quality owing to the presence of much external dirt bands within the
seams. It has been seen that all these coals show some characteristic trend in distribution of dirt
particles in different size fractions of the mine produce. The higher size fractions, viz. +200mm/
+100 mm etc. show higher ash due to two reasons. The dirt bands are harder than coals and break
less easily thus gets concentrated in higher size fractions and secondly bigger pieces of coal contain
parts of dirt bands within it which might have liberated on further breaking. It is also seen that
percentage of ash reduces in lower size fractions and below 13 mm size fraction the ash content
becomes 8-10 percent lower than the ROM. On crushing the whole coal for washing these low ash
materials get affected with the finer fragments of higher materials and thus the product of
secondary crushing show marginal difference of ash in crushed size fractions. In the present work
a few cases of laboratory scale coal preparation and washability studies are presented where it
has been observed that separation of lower size slacks through screening followed by crushing of
the higher size materials and their subsequent washing gives good result. Mixing of unwashed
lower ash natural slacks may effectively increase the overall yield and thus the desired beneficiated
product may be obtained at less cost and energy. Case studies from Kusmunda and Lajkura seam
coals have been presented in the paper show though washing of the whole coal crushed to desired
top size (barring -0.5 fraction) gives a slightly better result but cost and energy involved in
crushing, screening and actual washing through the alternative route is much less.
348
MPT-2013
river valley , Mand Raigarh and Korba. Since of ash in successive lower size fractions barring,
the coals occur in thick to very thick seams with sometimes, particles below 0.5 mm size which
wide variation in their quality along their show slightly upward trend of ash content than
thickness due to presence of a number of its immediate higher size. This may be owing
different quality dirt bands and partings, the to infiltration of out of the seam particles during
quality of the mine produc e also vary mining. Usually the dirt bands present in the
considerably. This leads to the necessity of their seam are harder than coal bands and therefore
beneficiation prior to use them as boiler feed. the later tend to break more easily leading to
Thus a number of coal washeries have also their progressively higher concentration in
come up in those areas to ensure consistent lower size fractions. The harder dirt materials
are concentrated in higher size fractions. The
supply of stipulated quality coal to the power
bigger pieces of coals also contain unliberated
plants.
dirt bands within them thereby increasing their
Before setting up a washery, it is necessary to
average ash content.
know the beneficiation potential of the coals
Detailed findings of broad screen analysis of a
concerned by generation of data through
number of ROM samples are presented in Table-
laboratory scale washing. These basic data are
1. The related ROM samples were collected from
of utmost importance for planning, designing
Talcher (seam-II), Ib river valley (Lajkura and
and selection of washer in the washing plant.
Rampur Seams) and Korba (Kusmunda group
Many such studies were undertaken at CSIR-
of seams) coalfields, mostly after the primary
CIMFR (erstwhile CFRI) Bilaspur Unit which
crusher at the Coal Handling Plants. Thus their
show some interesting findings related to
nominal top size of particles is +250 or +200
preparation of coal for washing. The present
mm which may technically be termed as ROM
study aims to highlight some such observations
size. After detailed screen analysis they have
and to suggest their potential use in the scheme
been classified in to 3 groups, viz., (+250/200-
of washing of these coals.
13) mm, (13- 0.5) mm and below 0.5mm. It can
2. Case Studies be seen from the table that (+250/200- 13) mm
It is well known that the concentration of fractions always show higher ash, ranging
mineral matter changes with change in the from 1.5 to4.1 percent (average 2.44) than the
particle size. The screen analyses of ROM coals ROM ash. The (13-0.5) mm fractions, on the
prior to washing almost always show decrease other hand, show consistently lower ash by 5.0
Broad size fractions of some ROM coals from thick seams are given below:
Name of Coalfield/ ROM (250/200 – 13)mm (13 -0.5)mm - 0.5 mm
seam Weight Dry ash Weight Dry Ash Weight Dry Ash Weight Dry Ash
% % % % % % % %
Talcher/ Seam-II 100 44.2 78.1 46.2 18.3 37.6 3.6 40.8
Korba/Lr. kusmunda 100 40.9 77.4 45.0 17.7 26.9 4.9 28.5
Korba/ Up. Kusmunda 100 48.6 73.6 51.8 20.5 36.7 5.9 50.1
Korba/Lr. kusmunda 100 36.4 67.5 39.3 26.3 29.0 6.2 36.5
Korba/Up. kusmunda 100 50.2 64.5 53.2 29.3 45.2 6.2 41.1
Ib valley/ Rampur 100 42.0 85.4 43.5 11.9 33.0 2.7 32.6
Korba/ Lr. kusmunda 100 42.3 71.3 45.5 24.4 34.7 4.3 31.5
Talcher/ Seam-II 100 48.7 83.4 50.4 13.4 39.7 3.2 42.8
Korba/ Lr. kusmunda 100 40.8 82.2 42.9 13.7 29.4 4.1 37.2
Ib valley/ Lajkura 100 41.2 79.0 42.7 18.3 32.8 2.7 51.2
349
MPT-2013
to as high as 14.0 percent, averaging 8.62, with reduces around 20 percent effort of washing
respect to that of the ROM samples. The 0.5 mm that can be proved to be much economic.
fractions, however, show variable result In the case of Lajkura seam ROM detailed in
probably because of contamination from loose table no. 2 it can be seen that 78.9 percent of the
particles from roof or floor materials. The ROM can be obtained as cleans with 36.5
relation between (13 – 0.5) mm and below 0.5 percent dry ash. In the alternative way of
materials also vary due to the same reason. selective washing of (100-0.5) mm part, as
The higher size fractions crushed and mixed shown in Flow diagram-2, cleans of (100-0.5)
with natural size fraction result in increase of mm added to the unwashed (13-0.5)mm fraction
ash content in lower size materials as the can produce a combined product of 82.3 percent
higher ash containing materials are liberated of the whole coal with 37.0 percent ash. Here
and allowed to be mixed with erstwhile low the ash is marginally higher with 3.4 percent
ash containing size fractions. Thus different size increase in clean product. Also the washing of
groups of washability head samples are around 18 percent of the whole coal can be
different from the natural size quality. It can be averted.
postulated that if the higher size fractions are
washed and mixed with unwashed (13-0.5) mm 3. Conclusion
part, particularly where difference of ash It can be seen from the above study that the
content between two groups are quite high, can power coals of thick seams of Son-Mahanadi
lead to similar end product with washing of valley coalfields show characteristic difference
much less quantity of materials. Two cases are in concentration of mineral matter in different
presented here, one from Kusmunda seam ROM size range of partic les and that c an be
with 48.6 percent dry ash and the other from judiciously utilized in selecting scheme of their
Lajkura seam with 41.2 percent dry ash, where beneficiation. It can also be emphasized that
the clean product obtained from washing of before setting up of washery for these coals, lab
(100- 0.5) mm (Tables 1 and 2 respectively) are scale study is of utmost importance for selection
compared with clean coal yield obtained of proper scheme of washing.
following selective washing (flow diagram 1
and 2 respec tively). The (13-0.5) mm Acknowledgement
washability data for Kusmunda and Lajkura
The authors are grateful to Director, CSIR-
ROM samples are given in table nos 3 and 4
CIMFR for his kind permission to undertake the
respectively.
study and prepare the paper for presentation
It can be seen from table-1, that is of Kusmunda
in seminar.
seam ROM, that a clean product with 31.3
percent dry ash can be obtained with 63.3 References
percent yield on ROM basis. If only the (100-
0.5) mm part of that coal is subjected to washing Chattopadhyay A. K., Tatwadi. S. T., 1991.
and the cleans are mixed with unwashed (13- Resource Potential of Power Coals in
0.5) mm slack the resultant yield becomes 67.5 Korba Coalfield, Proceedings of National
with 34.8 percent dry ash (Flow diagram-1). Workshop on Coal Exploration.
Here the yield increases by 4.2 percent with 3.5 Indian Standards IS-6345, 1971
percent increase in ash which is tolerable from Raja Rao,C.S., Coalfields of India, vol.III (G.S.I.
the point of view of its use in power sector. This Bull. A no.45)
350
MPT-2013
Sarkar. G.G, An introduc tion to Coal Table 4: Washability Studies of Lajkura Seam
Preparation Practic e, Oxford & IBH IB Valley Coal Field
Publishing Co. Pvt. Ltd. Size (100-13) mm Wt%-79.0
Unpublished project reports of CFRI/CSIR- Cumulative Cumulative
CIMFR Bilaspur Unit, 2002-2012 Sp.Gr. Wt%
Dry Floats Sinks Ch. Mayer’s
Ash% Wt% pt. value
Whitaker. J. W. and Sarkar. G. G., Studies on Wt%
Ash
%
Wt%
Ash
%
Coal Washability, Parts 1-6 (CFRI >1.30 3.0 17.0 3.0 17.0 97.0 44.1 1.5 0.5
1.40 19.3 27.7 22.3 26.3 77.7 48.1 12.7 5.9
Publication, 1950-51) 1.50 23.3 35.7 45.6 31.1 54.4 53.5 34.0 14.2
1.60 18.5 42.7 64.1 34.4 35.9 59.0 54.9 22.1
Table 1: Washability Studies of Kusmunda 1.70 9.6 51.5 73.7 36.5 26.3 62.1 68.9 26.9
Seam Korba Coal Field 1.80 8.1 54.5 81.8 38.3 18.2 65.5 77.8 31.3
Size (100-0.5) mm Wt%-93.5 <1.80 18.2 65.5 100.0 43.2 90.9 43.2
100 43.2
Cumulative
Dry Cumulative Sinks Ch. Mayer’s
Sp.Gr. Wt% Floats
Ash% Wt% pt. value
Wt% Ash% Wt% Ash%
>1.30 5.0 4.7 5.0 4.7 95.0 49.2 2.5 0.2
1.40 13.1 15.4 18.1 12.5 81.9 54.6 11.6 2.2
1.50 18.1 26.7 36.2 19.6 63.8 62.5 27.1 7.1
1.60 11.3 36.9 47.5 23.7 52.5 68.1 41.8 11.3
1.70 10.1 44.0 57.6 27.3 42.4 73.8 52.6 15.7
1.80 6.2 51.6 63.9 29.6 36.1 77.6 60.7 18.9
1.90 3.9 58.0 67.7 31.3 32.3 80.0 65.8 21.2
<1.90 32.3 80.0 100 47.0 83.9 47.0
100.0 47.0
Clean coal yield: 63.3 percent on ROM basis.
Table 2: Washability Studies of Lajkura Seam
IB Valley Coal Field
Size (100-0.5) mm Wt%-97.3
Cumulative Floats Cumulative Sinks Mayer’s
Sp.Gr. Wt% Dry Ash% Ch. Wt% pt.
value
Wt% Ash% Wt% Ash%
>1.30 4.8 15.0 4.8 15.0 92.2 43.3 2.4 0.7
1.40 20.9 25.3 25.7 23.4 74.3 48.4 15.3 6.0
1.50 21.6 35.4 47.3 28.8 52.7 53.7 36.5 13.6
1.60 17.0 43.1 64.3 32.6 35.7 58.7 55.8 20.1
1.70 9.0 49.6 73.3 34.7 26.7 68.8 68.8 25.4
1.80 7.8 53.8 81.1 36.5 18.9 65.1 77.2 29.6
<1.80 18.9 65.1 100 41.9 90.6 41.9
100 41.9
*******
351
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Crude oil and coal are the backbone of energy chain for industrial growth, but limited production
of oil in India makes coal as the only reliable source of energy. Due to non-availability of good
quality coal, supply of high ash (15-55%) coal to power sector has increased over the years. Such
coals cause erosion, difficulty in pulverization, low flame temperature and affect efficiency of
thermal power station. Although coal is mostly beneficiated by physical method, but combining
it with chemical method may improve the quality and efficiency of boilers/plant capacity while
reducing the greenhouse gas emissions.
This study is based on the treatment of Hingula coal (29.6% ash) obtained from Talcher coal field,
Odisha. After physical beneficiation (prox. anal.: 13.3% ash, 49.0% FC, 37.7% VM and 11.8%
moisture) material was chemically treated with different alkali and acids to further reduce the
ash content. Process parameters such as alkali/acid concentration, time, temperature and pulp
density were optimised for de-ashing of coal. Bench scale treatment with Na2CO3 solution for 60
min at 85 oC and 60% pulp density followed by acid wash with dil. HCl, reduced ash content to
9.8%. Similar results were obtained when coal was treated with 10% H2SO4 for 60 min at room
temperature and 10% pulp density. Coal before and after chemical beneficiation was characterised
by XRD and EPMA. Experiments were carried out on kg scale to validate the bench scale data.
When physically beneficiated coal (~1.2 kg) was treated with 0.25N Na2CO3 solution for 60 min at
85 oC and 60% pulp density followed by acid wash with 1% HCl in an agitated reactor, ash content
was reduced to 8.98%. The product is being characterised to ascertaining the properties of the
demineralised coal.
352
MPT-2013
Its demand has increased due to its low cost former methods are found to be more efficient
and easy availability compared to other fuels with respect to demineralisation efficiency. One
(Franco and Diaz, 2009). The coals obtained of the c hemic al methods is alkali-ac id
today were generally formed from different treatement(Adeleke et al., 2013). The common
origin and contain many impurities and have alkalis used for demineralization include
to be cleaned before its use in industries. NaOH, KOH, Na2CO3, NaHCO3 and Ca(OH)2 and
Therefore, coal washing has become important the acids used are HCl,H2SO4, HNO3, HF etc
from both economic and environmental point either alone or in combination of the two. The
of view. The raw coal contains organic matter, multistage de-ashing of coal with sodium
moisture, impurities etc. The minerals usually carbonate followed by acid leaching has also
found in coals are silicates; clay minerals such been reported (Afonja, 1976; Adeleke et al., 2011;
as kaolinite, illite, quartz, sandstone, pyrites Sharma and Gihar1991; Doymaz et al., 2007;
and carbonates such as siderites and ankerites, Yang et al., 1985). In the present study the
etc. (Sharma and Gihar, 1991). Therefore, coal demineralisation of physically beneficiated
beneficiation term involving de-mineralisation Hingula coal is reported using alkali treatment
and de-sulfurization has all such processes with Na2CO3 followed by HCl washing. The
carried on the ROMs to make it suitable for experiments have been carried out with the aim
application in industries without destroying of converting kaolinite and other such minerals
the physical identity (Sahu et al., 2011). The to its sodium derivatives using dilute to
effic ienc y of different methods of moderately concentrated solutions of alkali and
demineralization and desulfurization depends removing the remaining minerals by treatment
on the structure and composition of the with ac id leac hing/washing; results are
minerals and on the place and time of their analysed and discussed in the text.
deposition and formation. Due to the scarcity
of coking coal worldwide and its high cost in 2. Experimental
the international market, methods to improve 2.1. Materials
the low grade coals by reducing the ash and In the present study Hingula coal- a non-coking
sulfur contents have been developed. These coal from Talcher coal fields, Odisha was used
methods are classified as physical, chemical and for the c hemic al demineralization. The
biological and their application has led to the proximate and ultimate analyses of the ROM,
production of coal concentrates with low ash, and after physical treatment are presented in
low sulfur and improved thermoplastic Table-1. It can be seen that the ash in the coal is
properties (Mazumder and Sengupta, 1979). reduc ed to a large extent by physic al
Physical methods depend on the differences in beneficiation. Therefore, to have a further
the physical properties of the minerals and the reduction in the ash content chemical treatment
carbonaceous part of the coal. The physical was followed. The chemical analysis of the
treatment of coal involves separation and the physically beneficiated coal is given in Table-2.
techniques like crushing and grinding to The particle size of the sample for chemical
decrease the mineral matter through coal treatment was found to be -50 mm after
washing. Chemical methods are useful for physical beneficiation. The experiments were
removing mineral matters which are finely carried out in a three-necked glass reactor of
distributed and bound strongly to the 250 mL. A condenser was fitted to one of the
coal.Although chemical processes are slightly opening to overcome the evaporation at high
expensive than physical methods, but the
353
MPT-2013
temperatures, a temperature sensor to maintain sample was first leached with 0.25 N sodium
the temperature of the reactants inside the carbonate solutions for 60 min at 85 oCand 60%
reactor and third neck for charging the material. pulp density. After alkali treatment the coal was
The reaction was carried over a hot plate and filtered, washed with 10% HCl and then with
was agitated with a magnetic stirrer. The effects distilled water. The sample was dried in oven
of various proc ess parameters like at 80 oC. This alkali treated coal was further
concentration, time, temperature and pulp
treated with 1% HCl for 60 min at 95oC and 10%
density were studied. The samples after
pulp density. The laboratory scale experiment
treatment was filtered, washed with acid and
was carried out with ~1.2 kg coal in a 3Lreactor
then with distilled water. The filtered coal
with the optimised process parameters. The
samples were dried in a hot air oven at 80 oC.
c oal before and after treatment was
Table 1: Proximate (dry-basis) and Ultimate characterised by XRD and EPMA.
analysis of Hingula Coal
3. Results and Discussion
Proximate Analysis
Coal Type Constituents
3.1. Effect of alkali concentration
Ash Volatile Matter Fixed Carbon Moisture The physically beneficiated sample was treated
ROM coal 29.6% 35.7% 34.7% 4.5% with different concentrations (0.1"5 N) of alkali
Physically beneficiated 13.3% 37.7% 49.0% 11.7%
coal (Na2CO3) at 95 oC for 60 min and pulp density of
Ultimate analysis 10% followed by leaching with 10% HCl in
Constituents Carbon Sulfur Hydrogen Nitrogen
second stage at same temperature and time. It
Physically beneficiated 57.58% 0.76% 5.18% 1.31%
coal was noticed that after Na2CO3 (0.25 - 5.0 N)
treatment, the ash content of Hingula coal was
For the laboratory scale, chemical treatment found to be in the range 13.3- 14.3% (Fig.1). The
was carried out in a thermostatically controlled inc rease in ash c ontent after the alkali
jacketed glass reactor (3L) while flowing the treatment may be due to formation of insoluble
water to maintain the temperature. The sodium alumino-silicates [Fan et al., 1985]. Upon
leaching reactor had arrangements of reflux further treatment of alkali treated coal with 10%
condenser, temperature sensor, and material/ HCl at 95 oC for 60 min, sodium alumino-
reactant charging port. The demineralization silicates present in the coal dissolved and ash
study was c arried out under agitated content of the coal was reduced to ~10.3%. At
conditions to validate the bench scale data. all concentrations of Na2CO3, followed by IInd
Table 2: Chemical analysis of the physically stage leaching with 10% HCl, the ash was
treated coal reduced to ~10.3%. The 0.25 N Na2CO3 was found
Chemical analysis to be the optimum concentration for treatment
Constituents (%) Al2 O3 SiO2 Fe TiO2 K2 O CaO Na 2 O MgO of coal for ash removal.
Physically treated 3.29 5.54 0.4 0.29 0.73 0.15 0.092 0.016
coal 3.2. Effect of contact time
2.2. Methods The physically treated Hingula coal was treated
with 0.25 N Na2CO3 at 95 oC and 10% pulp
A two-step alkali-acid leaching process was density for different time periods in the range
carried out to reduce the ash content after 15-300 min. The slurry was filtered, dried and
physical beneficiation. A known amount of coal
354
MPT-2013
the alkali treated coal was further treated with was noticed (Fig. 3) that at temperatures
10% HCl at 95 oC for 60 min; results are given in between 25oC -75oC the ash content reduced to
Fig.2. It was observed that with 120 min of ~11% and on increasing the temperature from
alkali treatment followed by acid wash, the ash
85 oC-95 oC the ash was reduc ed to ~9.8%.
content reduced from 13.3% to ~10.3% and
Therefore, 85 oC was taken as the optimum
when coal was treated with alkali for more than
120 min followed by acid treatment, the ash temperature to carry out the demineralization
content decreased to ~9.8%. Fixed carbon also of caol.
increased from ~ 49% to ~54% at this stage.For
15
all time variations the ash removal was nearly
the same, therefore rest of the experiments were
10
carriedout for 60 min with 0.25 N Na2CO3 to %
sh
remove the impurities present in the coal. A
5
A f te r A lk a li T re atm en t A f te r A c id Tre a tme nt
15
0
15 25 35 45 55 65 75 85 95 105
T e m pe r a tur e( o C)
10
%
h
s
A Fig. 3: Effect of temperature on removal of ash
5
A f te r A lka li Treatm ent A f te r A c id Trea tme nt
from physically beneficiated Hingula coal.
Na2CO3: 0.25 N, Pulp density: 10%, Time: 60
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
min; in 2nd stage leaching HCl: 10%
N a 2 C O 3 C onc entr at ion (N )
3.4. Effect of pulp density
Fig.1: Effect of Na 2CO 3 concentration on After having optimised the conditions of
physically beneficiated Hingula Coal. Pulp concentration, time, temperature the coal
density: 10%, Temp: 95 oC, Time: 60 min; in 2nd sample was taken for different solid to liquid
stage leaching HCl: 10%
ratio of 5% - 80% and treated with 0.25 N
15 sodium carbonate solution for 60 min at 85 oC
followed by acid treatment. Fig. 4 shows that
%
10
increase in S/L ratio reduced the ash content
sh
A ~11% in the 1st stage leaching and ~9.8% in the
5
A f te r A lk a li T r e a tm e n t A f te r A c id T r e a tm e n t 2nd stage leaching.
0
0 60 120 180 240 300 360
T im e ( m in )
355
MPT-2013
3.5. Effect of acid concentration in the 2nd stage was treated with 10% sulphuric acid at 95 oC
leaching for different time (15 - 240 min). It was observed
that 60 min leaching time was sufficient to
After having treated the physically beneficiated reduce the ash content of the coal from 13.3 to
Hingula coal with 0.25 N sodium carbonate ~9.8% (Fig.6). Under this condition fixed carbon
solution for 60 min at 85 oC with 60% pulp also increased from ~49% to ~54%.
density, the HCl concentration in the 2nd stage
treatment was varied from 1- 30 (v/v)% . From
Fig-5, it was observed that inc rease in
concentration had no effect on the ash reduction.
Therefore, 1% HCl was enough for the treatment
of alkali treated coal in the 2nd stage. The GCV
and the sulfur content were found to be
increased after the chemical treatment, as given Fig. 6: Effect of 10% H2SO4 treatment time on
in Table 3 . physically beneficiated Hingula coal.
H2SO4: 10%, Pulp density: 10% Temp: 95oC,
Pulp Density: 10%
3.7. XRD phase characterisation and EPMA-
EDS of the coal before and after chemical
treatment
The X-ray diffraction technique is preferably
suited for characterization and identification
Fig. 5: Effect of HCl Concentration after alkali of polycrystalline phases. The XRD was done
treatment. Na2CO3: 0.25 N, Time: 60 min, for characterisation to study the phase changed
Temp: 95oC, Pulp Density: 10% in the coal minerals.Fig. 7 shows the XRD
profiles for physically beneficiated Hingula
Table 3: Ultimate analysis of Hingula Coal
coal, alkali treated coal and acid treated coal.
after alkali and acid treatment on bench scale
Quartz and Kaolinite (Al2Si2O5(OH)4) are the
Ultimate analysis
Constituents Carbon% Sulfur % Hydrogen% Nitrogen% GCV(cal/g) dominant c rystalline phases and some
Physically beneficiated coal 57.58 0.76 5.18 1.31 5355.867
Alkali Treated coal 61.79 0.94 4.67 1.47 5659.816
amounts of Illite [K1-1.5Al4[Si6-7Al1-1.5O20](OH)4],
After Acid Treatment 63.56 0.99 4.84 1.57 5857.525 iron oxides are also present in the physically
beneficiated Hingula coal. The intensity of
3.6. Effect of different acid treatment Quartz and Kaolinite were reduced after the
The physical beneficiated coal was treated with treatment of alkali (0.25 N Na2CO3). These new
various mineral acids like HCl, H2SO4, HNO3. peaks correspond to sodium aluminium silicate
With 10% HCl at 95 oC the ash content was (Na8Al4Si4O18). This phase has a tendency to get
reduced to 10.7% and the fixed carbon remained dissolved in acidic solutions as can be seen with
unchanged (49.6%). When nitric acid was used reduced peak in the XRD pattern of acid treated
a lot of fumes were generated at all
coal.
temperatures, therefore experiments with
Energy-dispersive X-ray analysis of the
nitric acid were discontinued. Further it has
been reported in the literature that nitric acid physically treated Hingula coal, alkali and acid
damages the coal structure and reduces the treated coal was recorded to observe and
carbon content. Physically beneficiated coal compare the leaching behaviour of ash in coal
356
MPT-2013
001
2.0
Counts[x1.E+3]
then polished with SiC paper. The polished
1.2
1.0
0.2
Cl KK FeKesc
Ca Ti Ti Fe Fe
3.5 C
Counts[x1.E+3]
2.5
Ti
2.0 001
aluminum and silicon were still present. From 1.8
Ti
CO
1.4
Counts[x1.E+3]
the chemically treated sample is corroborated 1.2
1.0 Al
Ti
and Ti. Cl Ca
0.4 K K Ca FeKesc
Ti Ti Fe Fe
0.2
0.0
0.00 1.00 2.00 3.00 4.00 5.00 6.00 7.00 8.00 9.00 10.00
keV
357
MPT-2013
beneficiated c oal [Table-5]. Petrography soluble. Experiments also show that sodium
analysis has to be studied for the coals of the carbonate also removes quartz and converts
lab scale trial. XRD characterisation was done iron pyrite into hematite to some extent, but
for the large scale and the phases obtained were not as readily as sodium hydroxide solutions.
similar to those of bench scale (Fig. 7). The ash content can be reduced from 13% to
8.9% in the process of chemical treatment.
ROM Coal
[Ash= 29.6%, VM= 35.7%, FC=34.7%] Acknowledgements
Physical Beneficiation The authors are grateful to the Director, CSIR-
Physically treated coal National Metallurgical Laboratory for his
[Ash= 13.3%, VM=37.7%, FC=49.0%] continuous support and encouragement and
Alkali Leaching the permission to present the paper.
0.25N Na2 CO3
[60% PD,85o C,60 min]
Filtration,Washing with 10% References
HCl and Distilled water
Adeleke, A. A., Ibitoye, S. A., Afonja, A. A. and
Leach residue
[Ash= 9.8%,VM= 39.9%, FC= 49.6%] Chagga, M. M., 2011.Multistage Caustic
Deashing of Nigerian Lafia-Obi
1% HCl Acid leaching
[10% PD, 95oC, 60 min] coal.Petroleum & Coal. 54(4), 259-265.
Leach residue Adeleke, A. A., Ibitoye, S. A., and Afonja, A. A.,
[ Ash= 8.9%, VM= 38.7%, FC= 54.5%] 2013.Multistage Caustic Leac hing
Fig. 9 :Flowsheet for chemical beneficiation Desulphurisation of a High Sulphur
of Hingula Coal Coal.Department of Materials Science and
Engineering, ObafemiAwolowo
4. Conclusions University, Ile-Ife, Petroleum & Coal. 55(2),
In the present study on the beneficiation of 112-117.
Hingula coal, it is concluded that chemical Afonja, A.A., 1976. Deashing and
treatment with 0.25N sodium c arbonate Desulphurization of Nigerian c oals.
solution at 85 oC for 60 min and 10% pulp Research Report No.IFE/CHE/CP/06.
density followed by 1% HCl is more efficient Doymaz, I., Gulen. J., Pisken, S., 2007.The Effect
because of its low cost, less corrosive nature to of Aqueous Caustic and Various Acid
and ready available. The hot sodium carbonate Treatments on the Removal of Mineral
solution easily converts kaolinite into sodium Matter in Asphaltite.Yildiz Technical
hydro-alumino-silicates whic h are acid- University, Department of Chemical
Table 5 Ultimate analysis of Hingula Coal after alkali and acid treatment on bench and laboratory
scale Ultimate analysis
Bench Scale Laboratory Scale
Constituents Physically After After Acid Physically After Alkali After Acid
beneficiate Alkali Treatment beneficiate Treatment Treatment
d coal Treatment d coal
Carbon% 57.58 61.79 63.56 57.58 58.06 60.96
Sulfur % 0.76 0.94 0.99 0.76 0.97 1.12
Hydrogen% 5.18 4.67 4.84 5.18 4.06 3.79
Nitrogen% 1.31 1.47 1.57 1.31 1.11 Nf
GCV(cal/gm) 5355.867 5659.867 5857.816 5355.867 5255.6936 5554.525
358
MPT-2013
Engg.Esenler-Istanbul.Turkry. Energy Sources, Sahu, H.B., Dash, S. and Swar, A.K., 2011.
Part A. 29, 337-346 .ISSN: 1556-7036. Environmental Impac t of Coal
Fan, C.W., Markuszewski, R., and Wheelock, T. Beneficiation and Its Mitigation Measures,
D., 1984.Chemical Behaviour of mineral National Institute of Tec hnology,
matter during alkaline leaching of coal, Department of Mining Engineering,
American.Chemical.Society.Division.of Rourkela Indian Journal Environmental
Fuel Chem. Preprints. 29(4), 319-325. Protection. 31(B), 691-698.
Franco, A. and Diaz, A.R., 2009. The future Sharma, D. K. and Gihar, S.,1991.Chemical
challenges for “Clean Coal Technology”: cleaning of low grade coals through alkali-
joining efficiency increase & pollutant acid leaching employing milder conditions
emission control. Energy. 34(3), 348-354. under ambient pressure.Fuel. 70, 663-665.
Mazumder, B. K. and Sengupta, A. N., Yang, Ralph T., Das,Subho K. and Benjamin,
1979.Proceedings of the International M.C.Tsai, 1985.Coal deminerilisation
Symposium on Coal Sc ienc e and using sodium hydroxide and ac id
Tec hnology for the Eighties.Vol.42; solutions.Fuel, 64.
Dhanbad, CFRI.
*******
359
MPT-2013
Proceedings of the XIII International Seminar on
Mineral Processing Technology (MPT-2013)
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
Heavy Media Cyclone is considered to be the heart of any heavy media cyclone based coal
preparation plant. Quantity as well as quality of washed coal depends upon the performance of
heavy media cyclone.There are different operational factors which directly or indirectly affects
the performance of heavy media cyclone. Among these factors pressure and sp.gravity inside a
heavy media cyclone are the two important parameters. Fluctuation in pressure and sp. gravity
inside a heavy media cyclone directly affects the quantity as well as quality of washed coal.
Coal preparation plant at Dongamahua of M/S Jindal Steel and Power Ltd. is a heavy media
cyclone based coal preparation plant. We have two units for coal preparation purpose. Both the
units are pump feeding heavy media cyclone plant. We have online pressure and specific gravity
motoring system installed in our coal preparation plant. In this paper we have studied the pressure
and sp.gravity inside heavy media cyclone installed at our plant,to optimize the yield and quality
of washed coal.
Keyword: Heavy media cyclone; operating factors; pressure and sp. gravity;yield and quality
360
MPT-2013
stage is being mined and benefic iated The only difference between Washery-II & III is
ec onomic ally and giving overall c ost that in Washery-III all coal is first deshaled and
advantage. then fed in the Heavy Media tank for onward
In the year 1996 JSPL commissioned its first jig separation in Cyclones and in Washery-II 50%
based coal washery at Raigarh. With jig coal is directly fed in Heavy Media tank and
50% coal is fed in Heavy Media tank after
washery result were not satisfactory because
deshaling. All other process is identicalto
of various reasons and was phased out by 2.4
Washery-II.
MTPA Heavy Media Cyclone Washery and was The desired quality parameters are clean coal
commissioned successfully in August 2002 ash of 32-33% & middling ash 60-61%. The wash
followed by commissioning of 1.1 MTPA coal is dewatered in a Centrifuge machine and
deshalling plant in January 2003 and then 3.6 followed by Thermal Coal Drier so as to deliver
MTPA two stage (High, Low) HM Bath & HM wash coal with 14 -16 % moisture. The wash
cyclone based washery was commissioned in coal is finally screened to remove –3mm fraction
April,2005. coal so that dispatched product contains about
The requirement of ash% in wash coal is 32- 14% of –3mm fraction.
33% for DRI production. We should maintain The final products for the washeries, wash coal,
the ash% according to the requirement. We have middling & Rejects are conveyed by belt
conveyors to overhead Bunkers for truck
tried to carryout a study that shows the trend
loading. The wash Coal is dispatched to Raigarh
of variation between ash% of wash coal with
for the DRI operations. The middling coal is by
feed pressure and sp. Gravity to optimize yield Powerplant.
of wash coal. Fine Coal Treatment: The deslimed material, -
0.5mm size coal goes to the fine coal tank from
2. Process
where it is pumped to a battery of Classifying
Washery II is a two-stage coal washing plant Cyclones. The underflow of the classifying
with a capacity of 2.5 MTPA. The crushed coal cyclones (+150 ì) is dewatered in a high
of lower ash seam is directly washed in the frequenc y screen & mixed with process
dense medium Cyclones after desliming at middling. The –150 ì material is fed to
0.5mm. The deslimed coal + 0.5 - 25mm size coal theThickener. The Thickened slurry from the
goes to the Heavy media tank for feeding to HM underflow of the thickener pumped to a mines
Cyclones. pond where a flocculent dosing system has been
Crush coal(VII T & B seam) is first deslimed at incorporated for quick release of trapped water
0.5mm# in Desliming screens and then fed to from the slurry. This water is filtered through
the Heavy Medium Bath for separating Rejects a thick wall of rejects and we get sufficiently
(of ash% >77%). The deshaled coal goes to the clear water which is fed back to washery. This
Heavy media tank along with deslimed raw has allowed us to maintain a close circuit.
coal of VIII, X & IX seam. Here after mixing with 2.1. Basic principle of dense media separation
heavy media of appropriate specific gravity fed
to HM Cyclones. Sinc e dense media cyclone works on the
Washery III is a 3.5MTPA washery. It has three principle of dense media separation, we have
independent circuits, Circuit I & II are two to first understand the principle of dense media
stage-washing (HM bath & HM Cyclone) separation.
circuits and circuit III is a single stage HM In a medium, the velocity at which a spherical
Cyclone circuit. Feed from the main feed coal particle sinks is given by the following
conveyor is divided into three different circuits. equation:
u gdv gDv R (1)
361
MPT-2013
where, d=density of the coal,v=volume of the in capital cost , they may prove more expensive
coal particle,D=density of the medium & R= to operate due to greater wear and tear on
resistance that a coal particle encounters in pumps and pipeline and added power costs.
attempting to move downwards in a medium. Also, any fluctuation in pump performance
The forces governing the settling velocity in a may lead to lower operating pressure and
cyclone is given by the equation: subsequent loss in efficiency.
Provided that feed conditions are maintained
u 2vd U 2 vd
u R (2) as per the original design the c yc lone
r r performance will be the same in each case for a
‘U’ is velocity of coal or grain given cyclone diameter.
Eqn (1) is showing that stability can be
increased by having: 3. Our areas of Interest
a) low v i.e for small particles
Effect of sp. gravity & pressure
b) low d i.e. low relative density medium solids
We know as the sp. gravity inside the dense
c) high R i.e. high liquid resistance to particle
medium c yc lone increases, c ut density
motion
increases and ash% of the washed coal also
The magnitude of ‘g’ in the Eqn (1) cannot be
increases.
altered or removed, but it can be reduced to a
Increasing the pressure, to a certain limit,
negligible amount by replacing it with a much
increases efficiency .As the pressure energy is
larger force i.e. centrifugal force. The coal grain
converted into centrifugal force within the
when subjected to the effects of this new force
cyclone, an increase in the centrifugal force
will move in the direction which the force is
causes an increase in the radial displacement
applied. This concept is utilized in the dense-
of coal towards the cyclone wall. There is a
medium cyclonic separators. Because the force
limiting condition where further increases in
potential of this separator is great, it is possible
pressure do not result loss in corresponding
to treat relatively large quantities of raw coal
increases in centrifugal force due to frictional
in a unit of small physical sized unit.
losses. Consequently, efficiency not improved.
Eqn (2) shows that as the coal grain spirals
Operating at higher than necessary pressure
towards the centre of the cyclone, both the
also increases wear and, therefore, maintenance
settling velocity & forces causing it, become
costs. However, reducing pressure leads to an
greater i.e. the value of r is becoming smaller
almost exponential increase in cut density.
and v is getting larger.
2.2. Medium used in our coal washery 4. Results and Discussion
Finely grounded magnetite powder with Data collected for sp. gravity, pressure of HMC
magnetic content >88% used in our washery: & ash% of wash coal represents the data for
two months. The data collected from online
2.3. Type of feeding system in dense medium
pressure transmitter, online density gauge &
cyclone at our washery
online ash analyzer systems which are installed
The coal washery of M/S JSPL is a pump-fed in our washery-III is given in Table 1.
dense medium cyclone washery. The following data of pressure v/s ash% of wash
Pump fed systems: Pump fed cyclones are coal is showing that as the pressure increases,
simpler in terms of plant layout and involve a ash% decreases. Feed rate is kept almost
lower plant profile because the desliming screen constant during the period when data were
need not be installed above the level of the collected. The data is shown below:
cyclone. Although they are generally cheaper
362
MPT-2013
Table 1: Collected data from Washery-2 Sp. gravity in the c yc lone is maintained
according to quality of the feed coal. Generally
HMC Pr. Ash% HMC Pr. Ash%
1.18 32.16 0.94 33.34 the Sp. Gravity is maintained around 1.51.The
1.19 32.22 0.95 33.47 relationship between sp. gravity and ash% of
1.22 31.93 1.05 33.08 wash coal is linear. The Sp. Gravity data for
1.19 32.2 1.10 32.54 HM cyclone & ash% of the wash coal is recorded
1.25 31.93 0.93 33.72
as shown in Table 2.
1.23 31.96 1.00 33.08
1.24 31.93 1.08 32.84 4.1. Graphical trend of the above recorded data
1.12 32.48 1.03 33.04
1.18 32.17 1.04 33.1 The relationship between ash% and pressure
1.22 31.85 1.10 32.54 is graphically presented in Fig. 1.
1.2 32.06 1.07 32.72
1.13 32.43 0.93 33.38
1.25 31.85 1.01 32.76
1.18 32.35 1.04 32.45
1.23 32 1.04 32.89
1.21 31.76 1.04 31.89
1.26 31.66
1.12 32.74
1.12 32.65
1.08 32.76
1.06 32.75
Fig. 1: Variation of ash% with pressure
1.01 32.92 The relationship between Sp. Gravity and ash%
Table 2: Sp. Gravity data for HM cyclone & of the above recorded data is graphically shown
ash% of the wash coal in Fig. 2.
Sp. gravity Ash%
1.61 33.47
1.61 33.34
1.60 33.72
1.61 33.55
1.54 32.76
1.54 32.84
1.58 33.29
1.56 33.21
1.55 33.08
1.54 32.68
1.55 32.91
1.55 32.87
1.55 32.74
1.57 33.19
1.53 32.71
1.52 32.54
1.51 32.54
1.54 32.86
1.54 32.83
1.53 32.83
1.51
1.52
32.52
32.68
Fig. 2: Variation of ash% with Sp. Gravity
1.52 32.45 The above relations show a downward trend
1.54 32.89
1.54 32.65 between ash% and HMC pressure and a linear
1.47 31.44
1.49 32.02 trend with a positive slope between ash% and
1.47 31.45
1.45 30.67
Sp. Gravity.
1.50 32.17
1.50 32.36 5. Conclusion
1.50 31.63
1.49 31.95
1.51 32.08 From the above study it is seen that to maintain
1.46 30.93
the desired ash% of the wash coal, the HMC
363
MPT-2013
*******
364
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
K.M.K. Sinha, G.S. Jha, K.M.P. Singh, Nilesh Kumar, Pradeep Sahu and T. Gouri
Charan
Central Institute of Mining & Fuel Research (Digwadih Campus), Dhanbad
Abstract
A study of coal washing spiral operation treating Indian coals and its performance is under way
at CSIR-CIMFR. The purpose of the coal spirals is to take the samples on-line for the size -3 to 0.5
mm from 40 TPH coal washing pilot plant. The objective is to use the pilot plant data to develop a
fundamental understanding of the spiral separation process and to formulate of spiral performance
which can be subsequently validated and extended by the incorporation of field data.
A fundamental analysis was subsequently undertaken of the forces and mechanism occurring
during the spiral separation process and results from the current series of pilot plant tests
demonstrated the validity of this approach. Both the pulp behaviour (pulp profile and flow rate)
and coal particle position on spiral profile can be accurately predicted using this technique for the
spiral profile tested. For the spirals there was a strong correlation between solid feed rate and
clean coal ash content and yield at constant middlings setting.
365
MPT-2013
al., 1988; Benusa et al. 2009). Increasing the solids desired feed rate. The splitter position was
concentration will increase the tons per hour measured from the outer rim to the tip of the
of material being proc essed but might splitter.
ultimately decrease the performance of the
spiral. In general, a high feed ash requires a
lower solids concentration (Benusa et al. 2009;
Honaker et al. 2007).
The feed rate of dry solids through a spiral
generally ranges from 1.8 to 2.7 tons per hour
(t/h). The dry feed rate is proportional to the
solids concentration, so the higher solids
concentration results in more tons per hour of
dry solids being processed.
Splitter position also gives significant impact Fig. 1 : Spiral set up
on beneficiation. In maximum opening, lower
density material is migrated towards higher Experimental Program
density material. In minimum opening, higher A statistically designed test program using
density material is migrated towards lower simple factorial design of experiments has been
density material. The fifty percent opening used where three levels of all variables are taken.
gives balanced distribution .But; finally it The formula used is
depends on liberation characteristics and N = 2k +3*
presence of free shale/stone.
Where N = number of trials
2. Experimental k = number of variables
3 * = Three number of replicate
Material
experiments carried out under base level
The fine coal was collected from the online
This is known as a factorial experiments and
underflow stream of a wet vibrating screen
(3mm) passing over a desliming screen all possible combination of the factor levels have
(0.5mm) in an operating 40 tph coal washing been executed during the experimentation.
pilot plant at CSIR-Central institute of Mining Actual and code variables are shown in
and Fuel research (CFRI Campus) Dhanbad Table1.Test results has been shown in Table
treating coal extracted from Kathra Open Cast 2.The design matrix and results obtained are
Mines under Central Coalfield Limited. The shown in Table 3.
treated feed coal size was -3.0 + 0.5 mm.The Table 1: Code for spiral experiments
overall feed ash was 30.6 %. Pulp
Code Splitter position Code Flow rate Code
Density
Methods
( 7,14,21"), 21"≈0%,
(litter/
All experiments were conducted using a single- (%) X1 14"≈50%, 7 " = 100% X2 X3
minute)
start LD7 spiral (MDL, Australia). The spiral from outer rim
Table 3: Design Matrix of Experiments and results of Recovery of Non- Ash Material (RNA)
Expt.No X1 X2 X3 RNA X1*RNA X2*RNA X3*RNA X1*X2*RNA X1*X3*RNA X2*X3*RNA X1*X2*X3*RNA
1 +1 +1 +1 93.8 93.8 93.8 93.8 93.8 93.8 93.8 93.8
2 +1 +1 -1 88.7 88.7 88.7 -88.7 88.7 -88.7 -88.7 -88.7
3 +1 -1 +1 85.7 85.7 -85.7 85.7 -85.7 85.7 -85.7 -85.7
4 +1 -1 -1 82.5 82.5 -82.5 -82.5 -82.5 -82.5 82.5 82.5
5 -1 +1 +1 89.9 -89.9 89.9 89.9 -89.9 -89.9 89.9 -89.9
6 -1 +1 -1 84.2 -84.2 84.2 -84.2 -84.2 84.2 -84.2 84.2
7 -1 -1 +1 93.2 -93.2 -93.2 93.2 93.2 -93.2 -93.2 93.2
8 -1 -1 -1 90.2 -90.2 -90.2 -90.2 90.2 90.2 90.2 -90.2
9 0 0 0 90.5 0 0 0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0
10 0 0 0 89.0 0 0 0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0
11 0 0 0 89.4 0 0 0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0
367
MPT-2013
*******
368
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
369
MPT-2013
of vitrinite and higher amount of finely ELEMENTAR ANALYSER was used. Fig. 7
disseminated inter grown mineral matter, the shows the flowsheet of experimental work
NGM at 1.45-1.65 cut density range are high carried out.
thus making the LVMC coals difficult to wash.
2.2.1. Sink-Float test
For long term security of supply greater use of
these c oals in steel plants, along with For the purpose of sink-float analysis, the feed
indigenous prime and high volatile coking coals coal was divided into following five size
can save huge foreign exchange provided frac tions viz: (-25.4+19.05mm), (-
proper emphasis is given by setting up of 19.05+12.7mm), (-12.7+6.35mm), (-
washeries to beneficiate these coals for use in 6.35+3.175mm) and (-3.175mm). The sink float
the steel plants after designing suitable flow test of the size fractions were carried out to
sheets. Coal India has planned to wash 19Mt of know the exact washability nature of the feed
LVMC coal in near future and is in the process coal. Fines of size fraction below 3.175mm are
of installing 6 coal washeries for its LVMC coal discarded. Different baths of varying specific
beneficiation on private-public cooperation gravities are prepared by dissolving ZnCl2 salt
concept. in warm water. An air-dried sample of coal was
placed in small quantity at time in the highest
2. Experimental
specific gravity bath and stirred well. The
2.1. Material material was allowed to settle. The float
After surveying and observation of source of obtained was transferred to next bath of lower
low volatile medium coking coal, Godhar specific gravity. Sink was again stirred to
collieries of BCCL (Kusunda area) has been taken liberate any trapped light particles. This process
for present study. 400 kg coal sample collected is repeated until lowest specific gravity. All sink
from combined seam (V-lX). ROM coal was and floats were washed properly with warm
collected and staged crushed in a Jaw crusher water for removal of ZnCl2. All fractions were
followed by Double roll crusher set at 50mm. then dried and weighed. From the sink float test
Bulk sampling, coning and quartering is done data the washability curves of the different size
to get representative samples for further tests. frac tions were drawn. The washability
characteristics of the different size fractions
2.2. Methods were analyzed from the washability curves and
Size analysis of sample was done by vibratory washability study was done to know the size
screen in the size range of +50 to -3.15 mm and fraction to which the ROM coal is to be crushed.
ash analysis of each fraction by standard 3. Result and Discussion
method was done. For proximate and ultimate
analysis sample was further ground to -72 3.1. Characterization
mesh. Sink- Float tests were performed for each Proximate analysis of ROM shows it is a
size fraction of size analysis in descending order medium coking coal and results are given in
of specific gravities. Aqueous Zinc Chloride salt table 1.
was used as medium of varying density of 1.3 Table 1: Proximate analysis of ROM
to 1.7. Proximate analysis, ultimate analysis,
Variables Values
free swelling index (FSI) and caking index (CI)
Ash % 32.07
was determined for each fraction of Sink-Float Volatile matter % 21.45
test. For ultimate analysis Vario EL Moisture % 1.6
FSI 2.5
370
MPT-2013
371
MPT-2013
(-25.4+19.05mm)
1.57. (-25.4+19.05mm) (-19.05+12.7mm) (-12.7+6.35mm) (-6.35+3.175mm) (-3.175mm) (-19.05+12.7mm)
(-12.7+6.35mm)
Sink -float test Sink -float test Sin k -float test Sink -float tes t S ink -float test
(-6.35+3.175mm)
Proximate analysis Pro xim ate analysis Prox imat e analysis Proximate analysis
(-3.175mm)
372
MPT-2013
*******
373
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
New Coal Preparation Plant Circuitry for Indian Metallurgical
Coal
1. Introduction
* Correspending Author: Swadhin Saurabh, Sr. Process
Designing and building a metallurgical coal
Engineer, FLSmidth Salt Lak e City, Inc., Email: preparation plant in India based on the Indian
swadhin.saurabh@flsmidth.com , Phone: +1-8015548286 metallurgical coal data has always been a
374
MPT-2013
difficult task. In India, preparation plant circuit equal incremental ash method is mentioned in
optimization is the key to ac hieving the Results and Discussion section.
metallurgical clean coal specification of 16-18% This paper discusses a plant optimization
ash (typical dry-basis) with the maximum study performed based on three Indian coal
plant c lean c oal (metallurgic al) yield. sample data from the Jharkhand area. Plant
Optimization is a real challenge in India when simulations were performed using the equal
one has to deal with the Indian coal from incremental ash method in LIMN™ flowsheet
Gondwana origin, which has very high near processing software. The simulations were
gravity materials (NGM) (>25%). The general performed and c ompared between the
practice in India is to crush the Run-of-Mine conventional India plant circuitry (HM Cyclone
(ROM) coal to a top size of 13mm. It has been – Flotation) and the proposed plant circuitry
widely accepted that crushing the coal to (HM Cyclone – Reflux Classifier™ – Flotation)
smaller top size will provide better ash with a 13mm top size plant feed. The results of
liberation (Ryan et al., 1999). The conventional these simulations have been discussed in this
Indian coal preparation plants are designed to paper.
deslime the raw coal at 0.5mm and the 13mm x
0.5mm coarse coal reports to the HM Cyclone 2. Plant Feed Data Preparation for Simulation
circuits. The primary and secondary HM Raw Coal data for 50mm x 0 size from three
Cyc lone c irc uits produc e the c lean different samples (1, 2 and 3) from Jharkhand
(metallurgical) coal and middling (power region were used for the coal quality analysis.
station coal at around 33-34% ash). The -0.5mm The intention of performing the coal quality
fine clean coal is obtained from the flotation analysis was to form a representative plant feed
process. size distribution and washability data for
In North America, the general practice is to accurate simulations.
crush the ROM coal to approximately 50mm The original 50mm x 0 size distribution data in
top size and clean 50mm x 0 raw coal in a coal all the three samples indicated that the dry
preparation plant. The amount of NGM in the sc reening methodology was used. Dry
coals mined in these regions is very low. screening data do not represent the actual plant
Moreover, this methodology also enables a feed. In dry sc reening, lots of fine c oal
reduction in the amount of fines generated in agglomerate to the surface of the coarse coal
the preparation plant feed (crushing done at and report to the oversize material. This shows
much coarser size). These plants deslime at less fines (-1mm or -0.5mm) in the size
1mm, with 50mm x 1mm going to the HM distribution than in the actual plant feed. The
Cyclone circuit and the 1mm x 0.25mm (or even fines circuit could be under-designed if the dry
0.15mm) raw coal in water-based gravity screening size distribution data is directly used
separation circuit (reflux classifier™, teeter bed verbatim. Conversely, dry screening also
separator, spiral, water-only-cyclone etc.), with changes the washability of the coarse size
the -0.25mm raw coal passing to flotation. The fractions due to the presence of fines in the
plant circuitry in these regions are typically coarse coal.
optimized and designed based on the equal A typical sampling methodology used in North
incremental ash method (Abbott, 1982, Rayner, America is to use wet screening or sieving at
1987, Bethell et al., 2006, Gupta et al., 2006, 6mm and below and prepare the washability
Watters et al., 2010). More information on the data based on that. This method generates a
375
MPT-2013
more ac c urate size distribution and Table 2: Predicted 50mm x 0 Size Distribution
washability data to be used for simulations and Data for Three Samples Based on Wet
plant process design. Table 1 shows the original Screening
dry screening size distribution data of the three
Sample 1 Sample 2 Sample 3
samples. Size (mm) Cumulative Cumulative Cumulative
Table 1: Original size distribution data for Top Bottom Wt. (%) Ash (%) Wt. (%) Ash (%) Wt. (%) Ash (%)
50 x 25 6.0 39.1 5.0 33.4 7.0 42.2
three samples based on dry screening 25 x 13 20.5 38.6 16.0 33.0 25.0 41.8
13 x 6 40.0 38.3 31.5 32.9 45.5 41.6
Sample 1 Sample 2 Sample 3
6 x 3 56.0 38.1 48.0 32.8 60.0 41.3
HGI*= 72 HGI = 84 HGI = 68
3 x 1 75.0 37.9 70.5 32.6 77.0 41.1
SIZE (mm) Cumulative Cumulative Cumulative
1 x 0.5 81.5 37.8 77.0 32.5 83.0 41.1
Top Bottom Wt. (%) Ash (%) Wt. (%) Ash (%) Wt. (%) Ash (%)
50 x 25 57.8 39.0 42.1 33.4 50.3 42.2 0.5 x 0.25 86.0 37.8 83.0 32.5 87.0 41.1
25 x 13 78.6 38.6 60.3 33.1 70.5 41.9 0.25 x 0 100.0 37.6 100.0 32.4 100.0 41.1
13 x 6 88.3 38.4 74.5 33.0 81.6 41.7
6 x 3 92.6 38.2 85.1 32.9 88.2 41.4
3 x 0.5 96.3 37.9 92.5 32.6 93.5 41.2 Step 2 - Washability Adjustment for the 50mm
0.5 x 0 100.0 37.6 100.0 32.4 100.0 41.1
x 0 wet screening from the 50mm x 0 dry
The following steps were taken to adjust the screening washability data to maintain the
50mm x 0 dry screening sizing and washability same head ash:
data to form the 50mm x 0 wet screening sizing The washability data of different weight
and washability data. This 50mm x 0 wet frac tions of dry screening sample were
screening data was eventually used to form the adjusted to provide the predicted washability
13mm x 0 wet screening plant feed data. data for the corresponding size fractions of the
Step 1 - Size distribution and ash adjustment new particle size distribution data. While
of the 50mm x 0 dry screening data to determine adjusting the washability, the ash of individual
the 50mm x 0 wet screening data: From specific gravity fractions were kept the same,
historical data of the same HGI coals worldwide while the weight was adjusted to achieve the
with 50mm top size, an adjusted plant feed size new fractional ash of that size fraction. The
distribution for wet screening was assumed to original dry screening sample provided the
take degradation into considerations. These washability data for the size down to 0.5mm.
predicted wet screening size distribution data There was no washability provided for the size
(50mm x 0) of the three samples showed more fractions smaller than 0.5mm. During this
fines (-1mm) than the dry screening data. The study, the washability of 3mm x 0.5mm from
fractional size ash contents were adjusted the dry screening data was assumed to be the
acc ordingly while maintaining the same same as that for -0.5mm size fraction. This data
sample head ash. was then adjusted, using the same methodology
After plotting the new wet screening size mentioned in the previous paragraph, to get
distribution in the Rosin-Rammler plot, the the washability of 0.5mm x 0.25mm. These new
weight percent of plus 1mm and plus 0.25mm predic ted plant feed wet sc reening size
were determined. The washability of 3mm x distribution and adjusted washability for the
1mm and 1mm x 0.5mm were assumed to be three samples were assumed to be the
the same as that of 3mm x 0.5mm. Similarly, representative 50mm x 0 plant feeds.
the washability of the 0.5mm x 0.25mm and - Step 3 – Size, ash and washability adjustment
0.25mm were assumed to be the same as that of to get 13mm x 0 wet screening plant feed from
-0.5mm. Table 2 shows the new wet screening the 50mm x 0 wet screening size and
size distribution data for 50mm x 0 plant feed. washability data maintaining the same head
ash: The next step was to determine the 13mm
376
MPT-2013
x 0 plant feed size and washability data. The 3. Results and Discussions
weight percents of the +13mm size fractions
Liberation comparison between 50mm x 0
from the predicted 50mm x 0 wet screening size
plant feed with 13mm x 0 plant feed in the
fraction data were assumed to be crushed and
proposed circuitry:
distributed in the same particle distribution as
Simulations were performed to evaluate
the -13mm size fractions in the original 50mm
whether changing 50mm x 0 plant feed to
x 0 wet screening data. To obtain the same head
13mm x 0 plant feed would show some increase
ash in 13mm x 0 as that in 50mm x 0, the percent
in the plant yield at the same product ash. This
ash values were adjusted using the same
would justify the effect of crushing the high
methodology as mentioned in Step 1. The
NGM coal for better ash liberation. Figures 1
washability data of the 50mm x 0 were adjusted
and 2 mention the circuits used to perform these
using the same methodology as that in Step 2.
simulations. The simulation results based on
This gave a new 13mm x 0 representative wet
these two circuitry options for the three
screening size and washability data for the
samples are shown in Figures 3, 4 and 5.
plant feed. Table 3 shows the new wet screening
size distribution for 13mm x 0 plant feed.
Table 3: Predicted 13mm x 0 size distribution
data for three samples based on wet screening
Sample 1 Sample 2 Sample 3
Size (mm) Cumulative Cumulative Cumulative
Top Bottom Wt. (%) Ash (%) Wt. (%) Ash (%) Wt. (%) Ash (%)
13 x 6 24.5 38.1 18.5 32.8 27.3 41.5
6 x 3 44.7 38.0 38.1 32.8 46.7 41.2
3 x 1 67.5 37.8 63.0 32.6 65.0 41.1
1 x 0.5 76.7 37.8 72.6 32.5 77.3 41.0
0.5 x 0.25 83.0 37.7 80.3 32.5 84.5 41.0
0.25 x 0 100.0 37.6 100.0 32.4 100.0 41.1
377
MPT-2013
378
MPT-2013
379
MPT-2013
SG50 and assists in increasing the overall yield April 6-10, Newcastle, Australia, pp. 87-
at the same product ash. 105
4. Since the -0.25mm size fraction in flotation Bethell, P.J., Luttrell, G.H., Firth, B., 2006.
brings less solids in the flotation circuit Comparison of Preparation Plant Design
than the -0.5mm size fraction, the reagent Practices for Metallurgical and Stream
consumption for flotation should decrease Coal Applications, XV International Coal
considerably thus reducing the operating Preparation Conference and Exhibition,
cost. Beijing, China, October 17–20, 2006, pp.
98–110.
4. Conclusion Galvin, G., 2012. Development of Reflux
Based on the simulation results, 13mm x 1mm Classifier, Challenges in Fine Coal
in HM Cyclone, 1mm x 0.25mm in Reflux Processing, Dewatering and Disposal,
Classifier™ and 0.25mm x 0 (option 2) in Soc iety of Mining, Metallurgy and
Flotation is the optimized (higher yield at the Exploration, Colorado, USA.
target ash) circuitry for Indian metallurgical Gupta, V., Mohanty, M.K., 2006. Coal
coal as compared to the conventional circuitry preparation plant optimization: A critical
(13mm x 0.5mm in HM Cyclone and 0.5mm x 0 review of the existing methods,
in Flotation – option 3) followed in coal International Journal of Mineral
preparation plants in India. The overall plant Processing, 79(1), pp. 9–17.
yields are 1-5% higher than the conventional Rayner, J.G., 1987. Direct Determination of
plant circuitry at 16-18% product ash. This new Washing Parameters to Maximize Yield at
plant circuitry should also help in reducing the a Given Ash, Bull. Proc. Australia Inst.
overall operating costs in regard to magnetite Mining and Metallurgy, 292(8), pp. 67–70.
and flotation reagent consumption by inserting Ryan, B., Leeder, R., Price, J.T. , Gransden, J.F.,
a water-based gravity separation circuitry for 1999. The effect of coal preparation on the
intermediate coal (1mm x 0.25mm). quality of clean coal and coke, British
Columbia Geological Survey Geological
Acknowledgement Fieldwork, 1998, pp.247–275.
The authors would like to express gratitude to Watters, L.A., Dynys, A., Keles, S., Ali, Z.,
David Bingham, David Meadows, Vishal Luttrell, G., 2010. Identific ation of
Gupta, Asa Weber and Philip Thompson (all Optimum Strategies for Process of Fine
from FLSmidth USA) for their valuable Coal Streams, XVI International Coal
suggestions and support in writing and Preparation Congress 2010 Conference
reviewing this paper. Proceedings, Lexington, USA, April 25–29,
pp. 30–36.
References
Yoon, R.H., Luttrell, G.H. , Asmatulu, R., 2002.
Abbott, J., 1982. The optimization of process Extending the upper particle size limit for
parameters to maximize the profitability coal flotation, The Journal of the South
from a three-c omponent blend, 1 st Afric an Institute of Mining and
Australian Coal Preparation Conference, Metallurgy, October 2002, pp.411–416.
*******
381
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
An operating Coking Coal Washery is presently feeding coal from nine different sources having
varying feed ash contents. The coal fines varies in ash content ranging from 19.5% - 43.6%. For
treating the coal fines, the washery is operating Spiral for last few years. Under operating
conditions the samples were collected from the Washery as Feed to the spiral and products as
well. Detailed investigations were carried out along with Froth Flotation study to compare with
the existing Spiral washer. It was found that Froth Flotation is much better and efficient option to
replace the Spiral Washer in respect to an improvement for the said washery on the basis of
enhancement of yield% at the desired ash level.
382
MPT-2013
hydro cyclone. The underflow of the hydro The coal fines was classified into two sizes viz.,
cyclone is presently being fed to the spirals and -0.5 + 0.15 mm and -0.15mm. Laboratory
the overflow being screened in high frequency flotation tests were carried out on the overall
screens and used separately. coal fines and on the fractions -0.5 + 0.15 mm
Table 1: Size analysis of coal fines and -0.15mm using a Denver D-12 sub-aeration
Size (mm) Wt% Total% Ash% flotation machine with a 2.5 litre capacity cell.
0.5-0.25 48.8 8.1 41.8 Diesel Oil and MIBC are used collector and
0.25-0.15 13.0 2.2 38.8
0.15-0.074 10.2 1.7 33.4
frother respectively. Impeller speed was
-0.074 28.0 4.7 41.6 maintained at 1500 rpm for all the experiments
Total 100.0 16.7 40.6 and the air flow rate is 2.07 meter cube / meter
The raw coal fines generated from feed to the square/minute. The flotation data is shown in
washery was collected. Samples were also Tables 4, 5 & 6 respectively.
collected from feed to the spiral, Spiral cleans
and Spiral rejects when the Washery was under
operational condition. The size analysis of the
coal fines sample was carried out and the data
is presented in Table- 1. The coal fines were
also subjected to float & sink test and the Mayers
Curve was plotted and is depicted in Figure – 1.
383
MPT-2013
content is about 60%, which is depicted in The flotation studies on the coal fines (below
Figure 1. The coal fines are classified into two 0.5mm) indicated that it is possible to recover
sizes viz., -0.5 + 0.15mm and below 0.15mm. about 34.5% (5.8%) clean coal as concentrate at
The fraction 0.5 + 0.15mm was subjected to float an ash c ontent of 11.1% under normal
& sink test and it indicates that the theoretical conditions, however the yield% of clean coal
yield at 18.0% ash level is about 58.8% (6.1%) may be increased to 58.9% (9.8%) at ash content
and the corresponding rejects being 41.2% of 14.5% and c lean c oal may be further
(4.2%) and ash contents 69.7%. augmented to 68.1% (11.4%) at an ash content
It may be noticed from Table -2 size analysis of of 16.5%, when the collector dosage and frother
the feed to the spiral, that the below 0.074mm dosage was increased.
fraction is to the tune of 20.8% and below The coal fines was split into two fractions viz.,
0.15mm is of 36.4% indic ating that the - 0.5 + 0.15 mm and – 0.15mm and the flotation
classification is improper as a result these fines studies on 0.5 + 0.15mm fraction shows that it
reporting to the spiral and thereby reducing is possible to recover 69.7% (7.2%) clean coal as
the separation efficiency. From the ash balance concentrate at an ash content of 16.4%. Whereas
of cleans and rejects it may be noted the yield of when the ultrafines -0.15mm was subjected to
cleans in the spiral is about 66.7% and the ash laboratory flotation tests, it was found that it
content being 27.0%, while the rejects is about is possible to achieve flotation concentrate of
33.3% and ash content being 50.1%. 73.2% (4.7%) at an ash content of 20.5%.
Table 5: Froth Flotation Tests of Raw (0.5
mm to 0.15mm fraction) 4. Conclusions
*******
384
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
In the entire spectrum of industrialization from global perspective, coal as the primary source of
energy is the fulcrum of major developmental factors on which hinges the growth of economy at
macro level. This supposedly happens to be vital for improvement in quality of living conditions,
thereby, impacting the lives of millions across the world. The International Energy Agency (IEA)
as well as national/regional energy agencies have projected coal to be the key component of energy
mix, well into the future. The primacy of coal as source of energy is factually expected to surpass
the significance of oil as a typical and primary source of energy in next 4-5 years or even earlier.
Indian coal has been observed to be of low quality on account of its high ash content attribute and
the high ash non coking category coal constitutes sizeable quantity of near-gravity materials
(NGM), which entails beneficiation to suit end-user or application specific qualitative level. The
present manuscript demonstrates the beneficiation of high ash non-coking coal from Vasundhara
mines, Odhisa, with 57% ash content intended for scaling down the ash content to 25% in obtaining
clean coal at a reasonable yield, deploying physical beneficiation techniques. The coal was
characterised thoroughly in terms of petrographic characteristics, size analysis, washability,
chemical composition and the gross calorific value of the coal was observed to be 3221 Kcal/kg.
The beneficiation process was initiated at a top size of 6.3 mm after initial deshaling of the ROM
coal. Tactical combination of gravity separation and flotation techniques yielded clean coal with
25% ash at 40% yield and an intermediate clean product with 49% ash at 12% yield. Low ash
content in the final clean coal is possibly achievable from the combined clean coal with 25% ash
content adopting chemical beneficiation route.
Keywords: Non-coking coal; beneficiation; washability; gravity separation; flotation
385
MPT-2013
level. The beneficiated coal has immense The mineral matters (mainly the argillites and
potential for being used as a blendable mix for carbonate minerals) occur in dark colour either
metallurgical applications (Reddy and Biswal, as cavity filling or in disseminated form and
2006; Haldar, 2010; Sahu et al. 2011; Gouri contribute 52.7% (Table 1). The gross calorific
Charan et al. 2011) and such blend formulation value of the coal was found to be 3221 kcal/kg.
of clean coal facilities maximising the infusion Table 1: Maceral constituents present in
of non-coking coal with scarce coking coal for Vasundhara coal sample
catering to metallurgical industries, enabling
Petrographic constituents Vol. % Vol. % (Vmmf basis)
lesser dependence on import of high-rank low Normal Vitrinite 14.7 31.1
ash content coke. Vitrinite Oxidised 1.2 2.5
2. Experimental
2.1. Raw material
High-ash non-c oking c oal sample from (a) Photomicrograph showing mineral matter
Vasundhra mines, Odhisa was taken up for the (black and brown) under reflected light.
present investigation.
2.2. Petrographic Studies
Coal petrography was done though Advanced
Polarizing Mic roscope DM 4500 (Leic a,
Germany) following IS-9127. Petrographic
investigation on polished grains (16 #) of
Vasundhara coals unravelled vitrinite maceral (b) Photomic rograph showing inertinite
is 14.7% (31.1% Vmmf) while oxidised vitrinite mac eral (white) and vitrinite (grey) and
content is 1.2% (2.5% vmmf), thus, reveals mineral matter (brown) under reflected light.
deficiency of overall vitrinite maceral. Oxidised
vitrinite shows oxidation cracks. Inertinites are
dominant and are represented by semifusinites
with small cellular structures and brighter
colour, fusinites with prominent cell cavities
and bright colour, inertodetrinites in bright
fragmental form, contributing 25.2% (53.3%
vmmf), while liptinite macerals occur with (c) Photomicrograph showing vitrinite grain
thread like appearance in dark colour 6.2 % (grey) inertodetrinites (white) and mineral
(13.1% vmmf). matter (dark) under reflected light.
386
MPT-2013
387
MPT-2013
388
MPT-2013
be recycled as cleaner feed. The concentrate of Clean coal with 25% ash is generated at a mass
the re-cleaner contains 25% ash with a mass yield of 34%. The reject stream (rougher tailing)
yield of ~20%. All the clean coal streams with has 80% ash content and 31% yield. The re-
around 25% ash are combined to give a mass cleaner tailing (40% ash and ~15% yield) is
yield of 40%. The process flowsheet is shown in intended for recycling as cleaner feed. The
Fig. 3 and the product streams of physical cleaner tailing (66% ash at 21% yield) may also
beneficiation are summarized as follows: be considered as a reject stream. This coal has
poorer floatability, thus, unsustainable for
being treated by flotation alone.
4. Conclusions
389
MPT-2013
c oking c oal by dry jigging. Minerals & Reddy, P.S.R., Biswal, S.K., 2006. Beneficiation
Metallurgical Processing 28 (1), 21-23. of non-c oking c oal for metallurgic al
Haldar, D.D., 2010. Beneficiation of non-coking purpose. Proc. International Seminar on
coals: Basic concepts and technology Mineral Processing Technology (MPT-
routes. Proc. XI International Seminar on 2006)., G. Bhaskar Raju, S. Prabhakar, S.
Mineral Processing Technology (MPT- Subba Rao, D.S. Rao and T.V.V. Kumar
2010)., R. Singh., A. Das., P.K. Banerjee., K.K. (Eds.), pp. 595-604.
Bhattacharyya., N.G. Goswami (Eds.), Sahu, A.K., Tripathy, A., Biswal, S.K., Parida, A.,
NML Jamshedpur, pp. 419-427. 2011. Stability study of an air dense
Indian Minerals Year Book., 2011. Coal & Lignite. medium fluidized bed separator for
Indian Bureau of Mines., Chapter 24. beneficiation of high-ash Indian coal. Int.
J. Coal Preparation and Utilization. 31 (3-
4), 127-148.
*******
390
MPT-2013
©CSIR-IMMT, Bhubaneswar
Abstract
The coking coal fines (-0.5mm) generated from various coal washeries are lying in the lagoons/
settling ponds for decades long which is to the tune of around 3.5 million tonnes. In addition to
these a huge quantity are bled every month to these waste basins on a regular basis. These fines
are basically vitrinite enriched coking material which can be utilized properly if beneficiated in a
judicious manner. Beneficiation of this coal slurry by physico chemical techniques is assuming
increasing importance in India. The present study of beneficiation of these waste settling pond
fines can recover fine cleans (ash <15%) which if used suitably can improve the coking property of
the coke oven blend for coke making. The present paper highlights the work carried out on coal
samples collected from the ponds nearby the washeries. The results indicated that good amount
of coking coal with less than 15% ash may be recovered and used for metallurgical purposes.
391
MPT-2013
optimizing the reagent doses for maximizing The slurry then conditioned for 2 min. at an
yield at clean coal of 15% or less. impeller speed 1500 r.p.m. The conditioning
Thus by application of the optimization time of pre-wetted sample (at 33% solid content)
tec hnique it may be possible to suggest with calculated diesel oil for 2 min. and mixing
desirable level of yield and ash content values time of frother was 0.5min, after dilution to fill
of finer size fractions of c oal treated in the cell upto 25mm from overflow brim. Then
washeries. The problem confines to selection of the air inlet valve was opened and the
conditions for flotation of fine coal slurries c oncentrate was collec ted in a tray. The
which will produce the desired result. concentrate and tailings were filtered, dried and
The continuous technique in studying the rate analyzed for ash c ontent. After some
of coal flotation was established by Brown et al exploratory tests a set of 13 experiments were
(1952) wherein a simple proportionality carried out to study the selection of the process
between rate and cell concentration for a and operating variables and ash content of the
limited pulp density. Sublik et al (1983) products considering the collector and frother
attempted to explain the influence of ultrafine doses as mentioned in Table 1.
coal particles (below 0.06 mm) on the floatability Laboratory flotation tests were carried out to
of three phase system constituting solid, liquid study under the following conditions:
and gas (normally air). Aeration and bubble Size of the feed particle : -0.5mm
characteristic for the recovery of fine particles Impeller speed : 1500 r.p.m
were studied by Jameson (1983). It is observed pH of the Slurry : Neutral
by Tarhar (1981) that by the use of sufficient Conditioning time : 2 min.
quantity of collector to effectively coal the Solid content during Conditioning : 33% by wt.
surface area developed by the increase in fines Air rate (m3/m2/min.) : 2.07
content can reduce the ash content of the
Table 1: Level of Collector and Frother doses
concentrate to a reasonable extent. Kalyan Sen
et al (1984) studied the effect of varying both
Diesel Oil(Kg/t) Frother(Kg/t)
the collector and frother doses on the flotation
Principle Level 1.25-1.75 0.25-0.36
products which was significant to optimize the
Incremental Size 0.25 0.50
flotation circuit. A recent published report by
Yoon (1984) said that coal particles below The Process
(approximately) 38 micron in diameter are The process adopted for the production of low
difficult to float and consume more quantity of ash good quality coking coal in mini coal
reagents. beneficiation plant is a specially designed Froth
flotation system.
2. Experimental Procedure
The fine coal particles of size below 0.5mm are
For each Flotation test required amount of conditioned in a conditioner by using water
slurry sample collected from a Commercial Coal and collector (like, diesel oil). Conditioned coal
washing Plant was taken in a beaker and made slurry is then fed into a series of flotation cells
into slurry with a known volume of water and where air bubbles are generated by the rotation
kept 30 minutes for proper wetting. Then the of high-speed impellers of special design, with
slurry was transferred into a 2.5 lit cell of the help of a frother.
Denver -12 machine and the rest of the water Thus the coaly particles float on to the surface
was added to maintain required pulp density. of the cell as froth. The ash forming mineral
matter remains in the pulp and is discharged
392
MPT-2013
from cell as tailings. The froth containing low Table 3: Optimum doses of Collector and
ash coal is dewatered and separated as cake Frother
used as coking blend for metallurgical coke
Collector Frother Yield% Ash%
making.
Dose(kg/t) Dose(kg/t)
The objective of a flotation cell is to operate at a 1.55 0.35 75.5 14.0
high yield while producing low ash clean coal.
In order to achieve these objective, optimal 3. Results and Discussion
operating c onditions is essential. Henc e Regression model equation has been developed
optimization procedure depends upon complex considering collector dosage and frother dosage.
interaction between the structural variables, The complete design matrix together with the
response values obtained from the
which define the inter-connection between the experimental works is given in Table - 4 . The
process parameters such as pulp density, centre runs (0 and 0) were repeated five times
aeration rate, reagent dose etc. which affect the as they contribute to the estimation of the
flotation performance of the individual cell. quadratic terms in the model. Based upon the
Designed experiments were carried out under design of experiment the following equations
have been developed.
predetermined condition using Box Hunter
Conc.(Wt%) = 73.24-
Method with the frother and collector as 1.75(CD)+4.24(FD)+2.73(CD)2-
variables to find out the maximum yield at 3.15(FD)2+5.83(CD)(FD)
desired ash level. The coded and natural form Conc.(Ash%) = 14.26-0.33(CD)-
of the design matrix is depicted in Table: 2. The 0.0004(FD)+0.56(CD)2-0.37(FD)2+0.78(CD)(FD)
optimum doses for collector and frother is Where , CD = Collector dose
FD = Frother dose
shown in Table 3.
Table 4: Response values from Design of
Table 2: Coded and natural form of Design
Experiments
Matrix
Expt.
No Collector Frother Concentrate Tailings
No of Coded Form Natural Form
Kg/t Kg/t Wt% Ash% Wt% Ash%
Observation X1 X2 Z1 Z2 1 1.75 0.35 79.9 15.5 20.1 65.1
1 +1 +1 1.75 0.35 2 1.25 0.35 71.2 13.6 28.8 54.2
3 1.75 0.25 65.0 14.2 38.8 44.1
2 -1 +1 1.25 0.35
4 1.25 0.25 79.4 16.1 22.9 56.8
3 +1 -1 1.75 0.25 5 1.15 0.30 80.6 15.9 19.4 65.5
4 -1 -1 1.25 0.25 6 1.85 0.30 74.6 14.4 25.4 61.2
7 1.50 0.23 56.3 12.7 40.7 42.8
5 -1.412 0 1.147 0.3 8 1.50 0.37 75.4 13.9 24.6 58.1
6 +1.412 0 1.853 0.3 9 1.50 0.30 75.1 14.7 24.9 58.6
10 1.50 0.30 71.2 14.0 28.8 57.0
7 0 -1.412 1.5 0.229
11 1.50 0.30 73.1 14.2 26.9 56.2
8 0 +1.412 1.5 0.37 12 1.50 0.30 74.0 13.9 26.0 58.7
9 0 0 1.5 0.3 13 1.50 0.30 72.8 14.6 27.2 58.1
10 0 0 1.5 0.3
11 0 0 1.5 0.3
The detailed kinetic study at 15 sec, 30 sec, 60 sec,
12 0 0 1.5 0.3
120 sec, and 240 sec has been carried out after
optimization of the process parameters like
13 0 0 1.5 0.3
reagent doses. It was observed that within 60 sec,
around 75% of the concentrate with average ash
of 14.5% is possible from the present sample as
depicted in Table 5.
Table 5: Kinetic Study
Sam Feed.
. No Ash% 15 Sec 30 Sec 60 Sec 120 Sec 240 Sec Tailings
Ash
Wt% Ash% Wt% Ash% Wt% Ash% Wt% Ash% Wt% Ash% Wt% %
1 26 50 14.4 15 14.7 10.2 15 1.2 35.5 0.8 47.5 22.8 60.2
393
MPT-2013
*******
394